Press Alt + R to read the document text or Alt + P to download or print.
This document contains no pages.
HomeMy WebLinkAbout2540 FARADAY AVE; ; FPC2021-0095; Permit1;1 IIli1I]I
Cäty of
Carlsbad
IkIHjj]I
Print Date: 02/25/2022
Job Address: 2540 FARADAY AVE, CARLSBAD, CA 92010
Permit Type: FIRE-Construction Commercial Work Class:
Parcel #: 2091200100 Track #:
Valuation: $0.00 Lot #:
Occupancy Group: Project #:
#of Dwelling Units: Plan #:
Bedrooms: Construction Type:
Bathrooms: Orig. Plan Check #:
Plan Check #:
Project Title:
Description: OAKMONT - NEW INSTALLATION OF ANSUL R102 SYSTEMS
Permit No: FPC2021-0095
Status: Closed - Finaled
Fixed Extinguishing Syste
Applied: 06/03/2021
Issued: 09/28/2021
Finaled Close Out: 02/25/2022
Inspector:
Final Inspection:
Applicant: FPContractor:
PARACLETE FIRE AND SAFETY INC PARACLETE FIRE AND SAFETY INC
MICHAEL IRAN 2950 SATURN ST, # STE I
2950 SATURN ST, # STE I BREA, CA 92821-6205
BREA, CA 92821-6205-ORANGE (714) 577-5779
(714) 321-7015
FEE AMOUNT
FIRE Hood & Duct Extinguishing System Initial Sys $417.00
Total Fees: $417.00 Total Payments To Date: $417.00 Balance Due: $0.00
Fire Department Page 1 of 1
1635 Faraday Avenue, Carlsbad CA 92008-7314 1 760-602-4665 1760-602-8561 f I www.carlsbadca.gov
RECEIVED
JUN 022021
CARLSBAD
FIRE DEPARTMENT
rmit Applicatio
Project Information
Project Name OAKMONT SENIOR LIVING
Project Address 2540 & 2560 FARADAY AVENUE
FPC202I -0095
2540 FARADAY AVE
OAKMONT - NEW INSTALLATION OF 2 ANSUL R102 SYSTEMS
2091200100
6/3/2021
FPC202I -0095
Suite #
Scope of Work NEW INSTALLATION OF TWO (2) ANSUL R102 FIRE SYSTEMS
Associated Building Permit # (if applicable) C V 005 o
o3°
LI Fire Sprinkler System: Number of risers Number of Heads
Li Underground: Number of Hydrants
Li Fire Alarm
Li Sprinkler Monitoring
U New System
LI Tenant Improvement
LI Other:
Contractor Information
Company Name PARACLETE FIRE & SAFETY, INC.
2091200100
7/28/2021
FPC202I -0142
FPC202I-0 142
2560 FARADAY AVE
OAKMONT -NEW INSTALLATION ANSUL R102 SYSTEMS
Address 2950 SATURN STREET, UNIT I
Applicant Name MICHAEL IRAN
Phone 714-321-7015
BREA City
CA 92821 State Zip
Email SERVICE@PARACLETEFIRE.COM
Contractor License Number and Type 854489 Exp. Date 10/31/2.
City Business License Number BLOS004002-10-2018
Sig Date 05/28/2021
For questions about the application submittal package please email: Fire Permit Technician
Fire Prevention 1 1635 Faraday Ave I Carlsbad, CA 92008 1 760-602-4660 1 www.carIsbadfire.org
O,'ewT Se,vio€ twi,vf -
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 4-66 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
DISTRIBUTION PIPING REQUIREMENTS (Continued)
Distribution Piping Requirements - 1.5 Gallon System
DUCT, PLENUM, AND APPLIANCE PROTECTION
This option allows for duct protection, plenum protection,
appliance protection, or any combination. However, only one
duct nozzle may be used, either a 1W or a 2W, nozzle.
All distribution piping, supply and branch, must be 3/8 in.
Schedule 40 black iron, chrome-plated, or stainless steel.
Each 1.5 gallon tank allows a maximum of five flow
numbers.*
The pipe length between the start of the first branch line and
the start of the last branch line must not exceed 8 ft (2.4 m).
When the supply line is split, the combined length of both
legs of the supply line (start of first branch line to start of last
branch line) must not exceed 8 ft (2.4 m). See Figure 4-132.
The combined length of all branch lines must not exceed 22
ft (6.7 m). See Figure 4-133.
The requirements of the following table must not be
exceeded:
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
START OF LAST
BRANCH LINE
START OF FIRST
BRANCH LINE
SUPPLY
LINE TEE TOTAL LENGTH_...
MUST NOT
EXCEED 8
(2.4 m)
START OF LAST
BRANCH LINE
START OF FIRST BRANCH LINE
FIGURE 4-132
000784
1W NOZZLE
(BRANCH LINES IN BOLD) COMBINED LENGTH MUST
NOT EXCEED 22 FT (6.7 m)
FIGURE 4-133
000785
1.5 GALLON SYSTEM
Supply Duct Plenum Appliance
Requirements Line Branch Line Branch Line Branch Line
Pipe Size 3/8 in. 3/8 in. 3/8 in. 3/8 in.
Maximum Length 40 ft 6 I 4 f lOft
(12.1 m) (1.8m) (1.2m) (3.0 m)
Maximum Tees 1 1 2 3
Maximum Flow Numbers 5* 2 2 3
Exceptions:
Six flow numbers are allowed when a duct branch line is the last branch line on the piping network and no 1 N nozzles are used to protect woks or griddles.
Six flow numbers are allowed when six iN nozzles are used and none of the nozzles are used to protect woks, griddles, ranges, and salamanders.
Note: Only five flow numbers are allowed if a 1 nozzle is used for wok, griddle, range, or salamander protection.
Six flow numbers are allowed when only two 3N nozzles are used.
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 4-67
DISTRIBUTION PIPING REQUIREMENTS (Continued)
Distribution Piping Requirements - 3.0 Gallon System
The maximum length between the start of the first branch
line and the start of the last branch line must not exceed
24 ft (7.3 m). When the supply line is split, the combined
total of both legs of the supply line (from the start of the
first branch line to the start of the last branch line) must not
exceed 24 ft (7.3 m). See Figure 4-134.
The total length of all branch lines must not exceed 36 ft
(10.9 m). See Figure 4-134.
Use a 3/8 in. union to connect the tank adaptor to the 3/8 in.
supply line.
A maximum of two nozzles are allowed per duct branch line.
The requirements of the following table must not be
exceeded:
SUPPLY
TEE (
'\V
OD0266 COMBINED LENGTH OF
BOTH LEGS OF SUPPLY
LINE MUST NOT 3 BRANCH LINES
EXCEED 24 FT (7.3 m)
1 NOZZLE 2W NOZZLE - -
1 NOZZLE
[II1 230 NOZZLE
2411 112N NOZZLE
(BRANCH LINE IN BOLD)
COMBINED LENGTH MUST 000502
NOT EXCEED 36 FT (10.9 m)
FIGURE 4-134
3.0 GALLON SYSTEM
Duct Plenum Appliance
Requirements Supply Line Branch Line Branch Line Branch Line
Pipe Size 3/8 in. 3/8 in. 3/8 in. 3/8 in.
Maximum Length 40 ft 8 f 4 ft 12 ft
(12.1 m) (2.4 m) (1.2 m) (3.6 m)
Maximum Rise 6 It 4 ft 2 ft 2 ft
(1.8m) (1.2m) (0.6m) (0.6m)
Maximum 90° 9 4 4 6
Elbows
Maximum Tees 1 2 2 4
Maximum Flow 11* 4 2 4
Numbers
*Exceptions:
Twelve flow numbers are allowed in anyone tank for duct and plenum protection only.
Twelve flow numbers are allowed with any one tank using only two-flow appliance nozzles.
Twelve flow numbers are allowed with any one tank using only three-flow appliance nozzles.
Special Instructions:
Twelve flow numbers are allowed when four Dean Industries OTt Gas Fryers are protected at low proximity as shown in Figure 4-66 on Page 4-32. The discharge piping must be
as shown in Figure 4-67 on Page 4-32.
For certain McDonald's applications, 11.5 flow numbers are allowed when using a combination of one 2W duct nozzle, one 1/2N electrostatic precipitator nozzle,
one 1N plenum nozzle, and tour two-flow appliance nozzles. Contact the Applications Engineering Department for additional information.
2W
NOZZLES .. 1
'ZLE
ZLE
Duct Plenum Appliance
Supply Line Branch Line Branch Line Branch Line
3/8 in. 3/8 in. 3/8 in. 3/8 in.
32 ft 8 f 4 f 12 ft
(9.7 m) (2.4 m) (1.2 m) (3.6 m)
6 f 4 f 2 f 2 f
(1.8 m) (1.2 m) (0.6 m) (0.6 m)
8 4 4 6
2 2 4
22 4 4
Requirements
Pipe Size
Maximum Length
Maximum Rise
Maximum 900
Elbows
Maximum Tees
Maximum Flow
Numbers
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 4-68 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
DISTRIBUTION PIPING REQUIREMENTS (Continued)
Distribution Piping Requirements - 6.0 Gallon Manifolded
System
As an option to piping two 3.0 gallon tanks separately, two 3.0
gallon tanks can be manifolded together to share a common
agent distribution line. Only 3.0 gallon tanks connected to the
same regulator can be manifolded. The following requirements
must be met when manifolding:
All piping must be 3/8 in. Schedule 40.
See Figure 4-136 for tank connections.
The length of supply line piping between the start of the first
branch line and the start of the last branch line must not
exceed 24 ft (7.3 m). See Figure 4-135. When the supply
line is split, the combined total of both legs of the supply
line (from the start of the first branch line to the start of the
last branch line) must not exceed 24 It (7.3 m).
The combined length of all branch lines must not exceed
36 ft (10.9 m). See Figure 4-135.
A maximum of 22 flow numbers are allowed.
The requirements of the following table must not be
exceeded.
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
LENGTH OF PIPING MUST NOT EXCEED 24 FT.
(7.3 m) FROM START OF FIRST BRANCH LINE
TO START OF LAST BRANCH LINE
START OF LAST
BRANCH LINE
2 FLOW APPLIANCE NOZZLE
(BRANCH LINES IN BOLD)
COMBINED LENGTH MUST NOT EXCEED 36 FT (10.9 m)
FIGURE 4-135
000267
6.0 GALLON SYSTEM
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
DISTRIBUTION PIPING REQUIREMENTS (Continued)
Distribution Piping Requirements - 6.0 Gallon Manifolded
System (Continued)
This configuration consists of two 3 gallon tanks. Both tanks are
connected to a common manifold tee and are pressurized from
a single double tank (Part No. 73022) nitrogen cartridge in the
regulated release assembly. See Figure 4-136. Note: A tank
mounting bracket can be utilized instead of the tank/enclosure
assembly.
318 IN.
3/8 IN. 3/8 IN.
SUPPLY SUPPLY / USE HOSE! SEE
GROMMET NOTE
PACKAGE NO. 1
(PART NO. .- 3/8 IN BRANCH
418511) F-"~:-IN-LINE BURST DISC
ASSEMBLY - SEE NOTE NO. 4
- REMOVE
BURST DISC -
SEE NOTE NO. 3
3.0 3.0
GALLON GALLON
TANK TANK DOUBLE TANK
NITROGEN
CARTRIDGE OR
N(LT10130
CARTRIDGE -
008127 REGULATED I 3.0 GALLON REGULATED RELEASE I ASSEMBLY OR 3.0 GALLON REGULATED ACTUATOR ONLY)
I ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY
TANK/ENCLOSURE
ASSEMBLY
NOTE 1: THE PIPE CONNECTION FROM TANK CENTER TO TANK
CENTER CANNOT EXCEED 8 1/2 IN. (215 mm). ALSO, OEM
RELEASE/BRACKET ASSEMBLY CAN BE UTILIZED WHEN
MANIFOLDING 3.0 GALLON TANK.
NOTE 2: ONLY 3 GALLON TANKS CAN BE MANIFOLDED.
NOTE 3: THE BURST DISC THAT IS PART OF THE TANK ADAPTOR!
BURST DISC ASSEMBLY MUST BE REMOVED AND
MODIFIED. SEPARATE THE ALUMINUM DISC MATERIAL
FROM THE PLASTIC GASKET. DISCARD THE ALUMINUM
DISC MATERIAL AND REINSTALL THE PLASTIC GASKET
BACK INTO THE TANK ADAPTOR/BURST DISC ASSEMBLY.
NOTE 4: THE IN-LINE BURST DISC ASSEMBLY (PART NO. 416970)
IS TO BE MOUNTED AS CLOSE TO THE TANK OUTLET AS
POSSIBLE. AFTER SYSTEM DISCHARGE, THE ASSEMBLY
MUST BE DISASSEMBLED AND A NEW BURST DISC
INSTALLED.
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 4-69
Distribution Piping Requirements - With Independent Pipe
Runs
Independent pipe runs can also be used with the regulated
release assembly and the tank/enclosure assembly or tank
mounting brackets. See Figure 4-137. When manifolding is not
used, each of the two 3 gallon tanks utilize the piping limitations
of a single tank system.
HOSE!
GROMMET
PACKAGE
(PART NO.
418511)
im
3.0 GALLON 11111 3.0 GALLON
TANK TANK
U DOUBLE TANK
NITROGEN
CARTRIDGE
OR LT-A-101-30
4 CARTRIDGE
(LT-A-101-30 REGULATED RELEASE ASSEMBLY OR CARTRIDGE - REGULATED ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY REGULATED
TANK/ENCLOSURE ACTUATOR ONLY)
ASSEMBLY
FIGURE 4-137
000788
Note: If an expellant gas hose is to be used for a second tank
in an adjacent tank enclosure or tank bracket assembly, the
second tank will need to be installed on the left side of the
AUTOMAN Regulated Release, with the outlets a maximum of
8.5 in. (215 mm) from center to center, similar to the manifolded
system in Figure 4-136. Otherwise, the second tank will require
1/4 in. NPT pipe instead of expellant gas hose.
FIGURE 4-136
SECTION 3— SYSTEM COMPONENTS R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 3-8 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
DETECTORS
The detector consists of three basic components: the bracket,
linkage, and fusible link. (Fusible links are not included and must
be ordered separately.) The bracket holds the entire assembly
to the mounting surface. The linkage is used to support the
fusible link. The fusible link is designed to separate at a specific
temperature and release the wire rope, thereby actuating the
regulated release mechanism.
The scissor style detector allows the wire rope to be strung com-
pletely through the detection system conduit and brackets first
and the detector linkage assemblies are then clipped on later.
The detector consists of two types of assemblies:
The Terminal Detector (Part No. 435546) includes a test link
and is placed last in a series of detectors. This detector is some-
times referred to as the end-of-line detector and is thus named
because it is at the point at which the wire rope "terminates," or
is anchored at the detector bracket. Only one terminal detector
is required per detection system.
The Series Detector (Part No. 435547) is any detector located
in-line between the regulated release assembly and the terminal
detector.
When using Part No. 435546 and 435547 detectors, a total of
15 detectors can be in one detection system: 14 series detectors
(Part No. 435547) and 1 terminal detector (Part No. 435546).
Note 1: Series Detector (Part No. 435547) is also available as
Part No. 435548, 25/Pkg.
Note 2: Scissor-style linkage is also available in a 10-Pack (Part
No. 439515).
FIGURE 3-23
000159
PULLEY ELBOWS
There are two types of pulley elbows used to change the
direction of the wire rope by 90°. ANSUL recommends for tem-
peratures not in excess of 700 "F (371 "C). Part No. 415670
has socket ends with set screws for 1/2 in. conduit, and Part
No. 423250 has compression ring ends also for 1/2 in. conduit.
Pulley elbows must be ordered in quantities of 50 as Shipping
Assembly Part No. 415671 (socket end type) and Part No.
423251 (compression end type).
PART NO. 415670 PART NO. 423250
FIGURE 3-24
000160/000161
PULLEY TEE
The Pulley Tee (Part No. 427929) is used to change the direc-
tion of two wire ropes by 90°. It must be used in areas where
the temperatures are within the range of 32 °F to 130 "F (0 "C
to 54 °C). Pulley tees can be used in mechanical gas valve
actuation lines and remote manual pull station lines. Pulley tees
cannot be used within a detection line.
~ 0-011
iii
FIGURE 3-25
000447
ANSUL STAINLESS STEEL CABLE
The 1/16 in. stainless steel cable is run from the terminal detec-
tor, through conduit, all series detectors and pulley elbows,
and into the regulated release mechanism trip lever. When any
fusible link separates, the tension on the cable is relaxed, and
the trip lever actuates the regulated release mechanism. The
cable can also be used for mechanical gas valves and remote
manual pull stations. The cable is available in 50 ft (15.2 m)
(Part No. 15821) and 500 ft (152.4 m) (Part No. 79653) lengths.
The ANSUL stainless steel cable contains a blue tracer cable.
BRACKET
/
REMOTE MANUAL PULL STATION DUAL APPLICATION - OPTION 1
(ONE WIRE ROPE CONNECTED TO CABLE LEVER ASSEMBLY)
6 IN. (153 mm) MINIMUM
FROM CRIMP SLEEVE
TO PULLEY TEE
2 IN. (51 mm) MINIMUM
FROM CRIMP SLEEVE
TO COMPRESSION
FITTING
PULLEY TEE ELBOW
D PULLEY ELBOWS -LOWED WHERE TWO WIRE DPES ARE PRESENT
USE TWO
OVAL SLEEVES
(PART NO.
4596)
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual SECTION 5— INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 5-17
INSTALLING REMOTE MANUAL PULL STATION
GENERAL INSTALLATION REQUIREMENTS
To install a remote manual pull station complete the following
steps:
Make certain that regulated release assembly enclosure
cover is detached and lock pin is properly inserted within the
regulated release mechanism.
NOTICE
Failure to follow these instructions may
lead to system actuation.
Verify that cartridge has been removed from regulated
release assembly and that the regulated release assembly
is in the cocked position.
If regulated release assembly does not have lock pin
inserted or cartridge removed, refer to the "Semi-Annual
Maintenance," Page 8-1, in "Maintenance Examination"
section, and complete Steps 2 and 3 before completing the
following installation steps.
Select a convenient location in the path of egress for mount-
ing the pull station(s) to the wall. The pull station should
be installed at a height of 42 in. to 48 in. (1067 mm to
1219 mm) in accordance with the authority having jurisdic-
tion and the American Disabilities Act (ADA) requirements.
A maximum of two manual pull stations can be connected
to each AUTOMAN release.
INSTALLATION FOR REMOTE MANUAL PULL STATION
UTILIZING EMT CONDUIT ONLY
The total length of the wire rope used for each manual pull
station within a system must not exceed 150 ft (45.7 m).
The maximum number of pulley elbows that may be used
per each manual pull station is 20.
If junction box(es) is used, fasten a 4 in. (102 mm) junction
box to wall or in wall where pull station is to be mounted,
with mounting screws positioned so that when pull station
cover is positioned in place, the printing will appear right
side up and readable.
Install and secure 1/2 in. conduit, pulley tee (if required),
and pulley elbows from each pull station junction box to
regulated release assembly as necessary. See Figure 5-37.
See Figures 5-38 thru 5-40 for optional methods of installing
wire rope when utilizing a pulley tee.
REMOTE MANUAL PULL STATION SINGLE APPLICATION
\SE
ANISM
JUNCTION BOX
(SUPPLIED BY OTHERS)
FIGURE 5-37 009463
II
aJ
JUNC11ON Box REMOTE /
(SUPPLIED BY OTHERS)) MANUAL PULL STATION
FIGURE 5-38
009464
REMOTE MANUAL PULL STATION DUAL APPLICATION - OPTION 2 (TWO WIRE ROPES CONNECTED TO CABLE LEVER ASSEMBLY)
PULLEY II
U
OVAL
OVAL ELBOW
VE
RELEASE
LLEYTE I
CABL
tLEVER
• MECHANISM
JUNCTION BOX REMOTE
(SUPPLIED BY OTHERS) MANUAL PULL STATION
FIGURE 5-39 009465
REMOTE MANUAL PULL STATION APPLICATION - OPTION 3
CAI
LE\
SECTION 5— INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 5-18 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
INSTALLING REMOTE MANUAL PULL
STATION (Continued)
NOTICE
INSTALLATION FOR REMOTE MANUAL PULL STATION
UTILIZING EMT CONDUIT ONLY (Continued) Make certain that wire rope rides on top
and in center of pulley sheave. If the 50
ft (15.2 m) wire rope has been spliced
to accommodate a longer run, do not
allow the spliced ends to be within 6 in.
(153 mm) of any pulley elbow or conduit
adaptor.
AN 5. Fasten pull station assembly to each junction box (if junction
box is used).
Slide oval crimp sleeve onto wire rope. Loop wire rope
through cable lever guide holes and back through the oval
crimp sleeve. See Figure 5-37.
Pull slack out of each wire rope and crimp sleeve. (Use the
National Telephone Supply Company Nicopress Sleeve
RELEASE Tool Stock No. 51-C-887 or equal to properly crimp stop
MECHANISM sleeve.) See Figure 5-37.
Note: When utilizing flexible conduit for remote manual pull
station or mechanical gas valve installation, refer to "Installation
of Remote Manual Pull Station or Mechanical Gas Valve Utilizing
Flexible Conduit" instructions on pages 5-22 through 5-34.
INSTALLING MECHANICAL GAS VALVE
FIGURE 5-40
009466
6 IN. (153 mm
SLEEVES
. 4596) TO AIR
CYLINDER
MINIMUM OF S
MINIMUM OF
L CONTINUOUS
ALLOWED FOR GAS
6 IN. (153 mm)E
O WIRE VALVES OR
PRESENT RELEASE
SPLICED WiRE WIRE CABLE
LEVER ROPE FOR PULL
STATIONS
PULLEY TEE (PART
NO. 427929) ONLY
TO EITHER GAS VALVES OR PULL-
STATIONS. MIXING IS NOT ALLOWED.
TWO WIRE ROPES CONNECTED BETWEEN A PULLEY
ELBOW AND A PULLEY TEE
4. Feed wire rope from the AUTOMAN release through conduit
and pulley elbows and pulley tee, if provided, to the pull
station junction box. Follow the instructions for assembling
the pull station and block assembly and attaching the wire
rope to the pull station pull knob (see Figures 5-70 through
5-85).
NOTICE
Mechanical gas valves are designed for
indoor installation only.
To install each Mechanical Gas Shut-off Valve complete the
following steps. (All gas valve installation and testing shall be
made in accordance with the authority having jurisdiction.)
Note: Mechanical gas valve air cylinder(s) can be installed
in regulated release assemblies and also regulated actuator
assemblies. Installation in either is the same.
Make certain that regulated release assembly enclosure
0. cover is detached and lock pin is properly inserted in the
regulated release mechanism.
NOTICE
Verify that cartridge has been removed from regulated
release assembly and that the regulated release mecha-
nism is in the cocked position.
If regulated release mechanism does not have lock pin
inserted or cartridge removed, refer to the "Semi-Annual
Maintenance," Page 8-1, in "Maintenance Examination"
section, and complete Steps 2 and 3 before completing the
following installation steps.
Failure to follow these instructions may
FIGURE 5-41 lead to system actuation.
008393
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
REMOTE MANUAL PULL STATION
The remote manual pull station (Part No. 434618 or 435960)
is made out of a molded red composite material. The red color
makes the pull station more readily identifiable as the manual
means for fire suppression system operation. The pull station
is compatible with the ANSUL Flexible Conduit. The molded
manual pull station should be mounted at a point of egress
and positioned at a height determined by the authority having
jurisdiction. Trim Rings (Part No. 427074) (pack of 10), are
available.
Part No. 434618 (Without Wire Rope)
Part No. 435960 (With 50 ft (15.2 m) of Wire Rope)
FIGURE 3-26
008326
FLEXIBLE CONDUIT
Flexible conduit allows for quicker installations and the conve-
nience of being able to route the cable over, under and around
obstacles. Flexible conduit can be used as a substitute for stan-
dard EMT conduit or can be used with EMT conduit. Flexible
conduit can be used only with the Molded Manual Pull Station
(Part No. 434618) and mechanical gas valve installations. The
Flexible Conduit comes in a 500 ft (152.4 m) length (Part No.
434525) or together with 500 ft (152.4 m) of wire rope (Part No.
435959).
A 50 ft (15.2 m) Flexible Conduit pre-fed with wire rope (Part
No. 439104) is available.
Also available is a Flexible Conduit Strain Relief (50-pack) (Part
No. 435979).
A 50-pack of Flexible Conduit Inserts (Part No. 434347) and a
50-pack of P-Clips (Part No. 436150) are also available.
Note 1: Flexible conduit is intended for indoor use ONLY
Note 2: Flexible conduit cannot be used in detection sys-
tems.
SECTION 3- SYSTEM COMPONENTS
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 3-9
MECHANICAL GAS VALVES
The mechanical gas valves are designed to shut off the flow of
gas to the appliances upon actuation of the regulated release
assembly. The valves are available in sizes of 3/4 in., 1 in., 1
1/4 in., 1 1/2 in., and 2 in. ANSUL style; and 2 1/2 in. and 3 in.
ASCO style. The valves are rated for natural and LP gas. Both
styles are UL Listed and includes the air cylinder, tubing, and
fittings (Part No. 15733) for connection to the release mecha-
nism.
Maximum
Part Operating
No. Description Pressure
55598 3/4 in. Gas Valve (ANSUL) 10 psi (0.69 bar)
55601 1 in. Gas Valve (ANSUL) 10 psi (0.69 bar)
55604 1 1/4 in. Gas Valve (ANSUL) 10 psi (0.69 bar)
55607 1 1/2 in. Gas Valve (ANSUL) 10 psi (0.69 bar)
55610 2 in. Gas Valve (ANSUL) 10 psi (0.69 bar)
25937 2 1/2 in. Gas Valve (ASCO) 5 psi (0.35 bar)
25938 3 in. Gas Valve (ASCO) 5 psi (0.35 bar)
Flow Capacity BTU/HR, at 1 in. P.D.
(CFH) 0.64 SP GR
Pipe Size P.D. 1 in. WC 1000 BTUIft3
(inches) 0.64 SP GR Natural Gas
3/4 751 751,000
1 1288 1,288,000
11/4 1718 1,718,000
1 1/2 2630 2,630,000
2 4616 4,616,000
21/2 5700 5,800,000
3 7100 7,300,000
To calculate gas flow for other than 1 inch p.d.:
New cfh = (cfh at 1 inch) x J new p.d.
To calculate gas flow for other than 0.64 SP GR:
New cfh = (cfh at 0.64) x J0.64-
New SP GR
A B C
Valve Size in. (mm) in. (mm) in. (mm)
3/4 in. 33/4 (95.3) 63/8 (161.9) 51/2 (139.7)
1 in. 33/4 (95.3) 63/8 (161.9) 51/2 (139.7)
11/4 in. 47/8 (123.8) 73/8 (187.3) 63/8 (161.9)
11/2 in. 47/8 (123.8) 73/8 (187.3) 63/8 (161.9)
21n. 57/8 (149.2) 77/8 (200.0) 6 11/16(169.9)
2 1/2 in. 713/16 (198.4) 9 1/16 (230.2)
3 in. 725/32 (197.6) 9 1/16 (230.2)
3/4 IN. THF6J 2 IN.
004208
2 1/2 IN. THRIJ 3 IN.
004209
FIGURE 3-27
R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
SYSTEM DESIGN
The ANSUL R-1 02 Restaurant Fire Suppression System may be
used on a number of different types of restaurant cooking appli-
ances and hood and duct configurations. The design information
listed in this section deals with the limitations and parameters
of this pre-engineered system. Those individuals responsible
for the design of the R-102 system must be trained and hold a
current ANSUL certificate in an R-1 02 training program.
The R-102 and the PIRANHA systems use compatible agents
and components, therefore, they may be used together for
cooking appliance, hood, and duct protection. The primary
AUTOMAN Release can be either an R-102 or a PIRANHA
AUTOMAN Release and can actuate up to two additional R-102
or PIRANHA Regulated Actuators. In systems utilizing a 101
remote release, any combination of the maximum number of
regulated actuators can be used.
Both systems must actuate simultaneously.
Each system must be designed and installed per its appropri-
ate manual.
Adjacent appliances requiring protection must be protected
with the same type of system, either R-102 or PIRANHA,
unless the center-to-center spacing between the adjacent
R-102 and PIRANHA nozzles is no less than 36 in. (914 mm).
When appliances are protected with R-102 nozzles, the
hood and connecting duct above those appliances cannot be
protected with PIRANHA nozzles.
Mixing systems in a common plenum is not allowed.
One of the key elements for restaurant fire protection is a correct
system design. This section is divided into 10 sub-sections:
Nozzle Placement Requirements, Tank Quantity Requirements,
Actuation and Expellant Gas Line Requirements, Distribution
Piping Requirements, Detection System Requirements,
Manual Pull Station Requirements, Mechanical Gas Valve
Requirements, Electrical Gas Valve Requirements, Electrical
Switch Requirements, and Pressure Switch Requirements.
Each of these sections must be completed before attempting
any installation. System design sketches should be made of all
aspects of design for reference during installation.
NOZZLE PLACEMENT REQUIREMENTS
This section gives guidelines for nozzle type, positioning, and
quantity for duct, plenum, and individual appliance protection.
This section must be completed before determining tank quan-
tity and piping requirements.
Duct Protection - Single Nozzle
All duct protection is UL listed without limitation of maximum duct
length (unlimited length). This includes all varieties of ductworks
both horizontal and vertical including ducts that run at angles to
the horizontal and ducts with directional bends.
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 4-1
GENERAL INFORMATION
1. Nozzles must be located 2-8 in. (51-203 mm) into the center
of the duct opening, discharging up. See Figure 4-1.
2 - 8 IN.
(51 - 203 mm)
FIGURE 4-1
000173
In installations where a UL listed damper assembly is
employed, the duct nozzle can be installed beyond the 8
in. (203 mm) maximum, to a point just beyond the damper
assembly that will not interfere with the damper. Exceeding
the maximum of 8 in. (203 mm) in this way will not void the
UL listing of the system.
Previously listed three flow number and five flow number
duct protection detailed in earlier published manual (Part No.
418087-06) can also still be utilized.
DUCT SIZES UP TO 50 IN. (1270 mm)
PERIMETER/ 16 IN. (406 mm) DIAMETER
One 1W nozzle = one flow number
50 in. (1270 mm) perimeter maximum
16 in. (406 mm) diameter maximum
DUCT SIZES UP TO 100 IN. (2540 mm)
PERIMETER! 32 IN. (812 mm) DIAMETER
One 2W nozzle = two flow numbers
100 in. (2540 mm) perimeter maximum
32 in. (812 mm) diameter maximum
The chart below shows the maximum protection available from
each duct nozzle.
3.0 Gallon 1.5 Gallon
Description System System
2W Nozzle Maximum Maximum
100 in. (2540 mm) 100 in. (2540 mm)
Perimeter Perimeter
Note: Ducts from multiple hoods connected to a common 1W Nozzle Maximum Maximum ductwork must be protected in compliance with NFPA 96 and 50 in. (1270 mm) 50 in. (1270 mm) all local codes. Perimeter Perimeter
The R-1 02 system uses different duct nozzles depending on the
size of duct being protected.
FIGURE 4-9
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
Plenum Protection
The R-102 system uses the 1W nozzle or the 1N nozzle for
plenum protection. The 1W nozzle is stamped with 1W and
the 1 N nozzle is stamped with 1 N, indicating they are one-flow
nozzles and must be counted as one flow number each. When
protecting a plenum chamber, the entire chamber must be
protected regardless of filter length.
VERTICAL PROTECTION - GENERAL
1W NOZZLE - SINGLE AND "V BANK PROTECTION
One 1W nozzle will protect 4 linear feet (1.2 m) of plenum. The
maximum distance from the end of the hood to the first and last
nozzle must be no more than 2 It (0.6 m). After the first nozzle,
any additional nozzles must be positioned at a maximum of 4 It
(1.2 m) apart down the entire length of the plenum. The plenum
width must not exceed 4 ft (1.2 m). (The 1W nozzle can be used
on single or V-bank filter arrangements.) See Figure 4-6.
0r rn A
FIGURE 4-6
000197
When protecting plenums with the 1W nozzle, two options of
coverage are available:
Option 1: The 1W nozzle must be on the center line of the
single or "V bank filter and positioned within 1-20 in.
(26-508 mm) above the top edge of the filter. See
Figure 4-7.
FIGURE 4-7
000199
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 4-5
Option 2: The 1W nozzle must be placed perpendicular, 8-12 in.
(203-304 mm) from the face of the filter and angled to
the center of the filter. The nozzle tip must be within
2 in. (50 mm) from the perpendicular center line of the
filter. See Figure 4-8.
MM)
4 IN
(101
204 mm)
IUM
NOZZLE TIP
MUST BE W
THIS AREA
FIGURE 4-8
000200
HORIZONTAL PROTECTION - OPTION 1
iN NOZZLE SINGLE BANK PROTECTION
One 1 N nozzle will protect 10 linear feet (3.0 m) of single filter bank
plenum. The nozzle(s) must be mounted in the plenum, 2 to 4 in.
(50 to 102 mm) from the face of the filter, centered between the
filter height dimension, and aimed down the length. The nozzle
must be positioned 0-6 in. (0-152 mm) from the end of the hood to
the tip of the nozzle. See Figure 4-9.
000201
(508 mm)
IUM
R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
Range Protection (With or Without Back Shelf/Obstruction)
When this type of hazard is equipped with a back shelf or other
similarly sized obstruction located above the range top, two
protection options are available: One requires a 1 nozzle and
the other option requires a 260 nozzle.
Range Protection 1 F (1-Flow) Nozzle (With or Without Back
Shelf/Obstruction)
Single and multiple burner ranges can be protected using a
1 F nozzle. The nozzle is stamped with 1 F indicating that it is a
one-flow nozzle and must be counted as one flow number.
When using the 1 F nozzle for range protection with or without back
shelf or other similarly sized obstruction, the maximum length of
the burner grates being protected must not exceed 28 in. (711
mm) and the maximum area of the burner grates must not exceed
336 in.2 (21677 mm2). See Figure 4-37 for nozzle location details.
IF NOZZLE
SHELF OR OTHER SIMILARLY SIZED
OBSTRUCTION CAN OVERHANG BURNER(S)
BY MAXIMUM OF 11 IN. (279 mm)
II 20 AIM (508 mm) 40-481N. I \POINT MINIMUM (1016 - 1219 mm)
14 IN.
(351
MAXIMUM 12
mm)
(304 mm) FRONT T:) REA MAXIMUM MAXIMUM CENTERLINE
1 NOZZLE LOCATED OVER FRONT EDGE OF BURNER GRATE AND ORIENTED
SO NOZZLE TIP FLATS ARE PARALLEL WITH BURNER GRATE FRONT TO REAR
CENTERLINE AND SHALL BE AIMED AT THE CENTER OF THE COOKING SURFACE.
FIGURE 4-37
000238
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 4-17
Range Protection 260 (2-Flow) Nozzle (With or Without
Back Shelf/Obstruction)
Single and multiple burner ranges can be protected using a 260
nozzle. The nozzle is stamped with 260 indicating that it is a
two-flow nozzle and must be counted as two flow numbers.
When using the 260 nozzle for range protection with or without
back shelf or other similarly sized obstruction, the maximum
length of burner grates being protected must not exceed 32 in.
(812 mm) and the maximum area of the burner grates must
not exceed 384 in.2 (24774 mm2). Nozzle must be located on
the front edge of the burner grates and aimed at a point 10 in.
(254 mm) from the back edge of the burner grates. Nozzle must
be mounted 30 to 40 in. (762 to 1016 mm) above the hazard
surface. See Figure 4-38.
260 NOZZLE
SHELF OR OTHER SIMILARLY SIZED
OBSTRUCTION CAN OVERHANG BURNER(S)
BY A MAXIMUM OF 11 IN. (279 mm)
I
18 IN.
(457 mm)
30-40 IN. MINIMUM
(762-1016mm)
I I
(254 mm)
FROM BACK
OF BURNER
GRATES
FIGURE 4-38
OOO238
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
Salamander Broiler Protection - 1 (1-Flow) Nozzle
Overhead
A salamander broiler with a maximum hazard area (internal
broiler chamber) of 16 in. (406 mm) deep x 29 in. (736 mm) wide
can be protected using a 1 N nozzle. The nozzle is stamped with
1 N, indicating that this is a one-flow nozzle.
The single 1 N nozzle must be located directly in line with either
vertical edge of the broiler opening, 6 in. (152 mm) to 12 in. (304
mm) in front of the broiler, and 0 in. to 12 in. (304 mm) above the
top of the broiler. The nozzle must be aimed at the center of the
broiler opening. See Figure 4-57a.
VERTICAL EDGE
OF BROILER
OPENING 1 NOZZLE
(PART NO. 419335)
NOZZLE
12 IN - LOCATION ZONE
304 mm) 6 IN. (152 mm)
6 Nt
(152 mm)
-------------
AT CENTER
AIM AT CENTER OF OF BROILER
BROILER OPENING OPENING
FIGURE 4-57a
008426
Salamander Broiler Protection - 1 F (1-Flow) Nozzle
Overhead
A salamander broiler with a maximum hazard area (internal
broiler chamber) of 15.5 in. (393 mm) deep x 31 in. (787 mm)
wide can be protected using a 1 F nozzle. The nozzle is stamped
with 1 F, indicating that this is a one-flow nozzle.
The single 1 nozzle must be located directly in line with the
center of the broiler opening, 8 in. (203 mm) to 12 in. (304 mm)
in front of the broiler and 12 in. (304 mm) to 18 in. (457 mm)
above the top of the broiler. The nozzle must be aimed at the
center of the top broiler opening when the grate is located in the
middle position. The nozzle must be orientated so the nozzle
tip flats are parallel with the grate left to right centerline. See
Figure 4-57b.
i ø N 6 I NOZZLE F NOZZLE -
(PART NO.
8 IN (203 mm) 419333) (152mm) LOCATION ZONE [
41N. \\ 121N
(101 mm 1(304mm)
AIM AT CENTER OF THE AIM AT CENTER OF THE TOP
TOP BROILER OPENING BROILER OPENING WHEN THE
WHEN THE GRATE GRATE IS LOCATED IN THE
IS LOCATED IN THE MIDDLE POSITIONAIM AT CENTER
MIDDLE POSITION OF BROILER OPENING
FIGURE 4-57b
008426
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 4-23
Salamander Broiler Protection - 1 (1-Flow) Nozzle Local
Note: The use of the Agent Distribution Hose should be consid-
ered when protecting a salamander broiler/range combination
appliance that employs casters.
A salamander broiler with a maximum hazard area (internal
broiler chamber) of 15 in. (381 mm) deep x 31 in. (787 mm) wide
P. can be protected using a 1 N nozzle. The nozzle is stamped with
1 N, indicating that this is a one-flow nozzle.
The single 1 N nozzle must be affixed to the side of the cooking
P. chamber, above the grate on either vertical edge of the broiler
opening. The nozzle must be aimed at the center of the grates.
See Figure 4-57c.
FIGURE 4-57c
008428
Upright Broiler/Salamander Protection
The R-102 system uses two 1/2N Nozzles for all upright broiler
9. protection. The nozzle is stamped 1/2N, indicating that this is
a half-flow nozzle. A pair of these nozzles will equal one flow
number.
Two 1/2N nozzles will protect a maximum hazard area (internal
broiler chamber) of 30 in. x 32.5 in. (761 mm x 825 mm). These
nozzles must always be used in pairs on an upright broiler. One
nozzle must be positioned above the grate and pointed at the
back opposite corner of the broiler chamber. The second nozzle
must be pointed down into the center of the drip pan through the
open slot. See Figure 4-58.
iN NO;
AT CENTER OF
GRATES
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 4-16 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
Range Protection 1 (1-Flow) Nozzle - Low Proximity
Application
15 in. to 20 in. (381 mm to 508 m) above the cooking surface.
The low proximity 1-flow nozzle application for the protection of
ranges requires the 1 N nozzle.
The nozzle is stamped with 1N indicating that it is a one-flow
nozzle and must be counted as one flow number,
When using the 1 N nozzle for low proximity range protection
with or without obstruction, the maximum length of the burner
grates being protected must not be exceed 24 in. (609 mm)
length, aimed along a centerline to a point 20 in. (508 mm) from
the end of the length, protecting a maximum width of 18 in. (457
mm).
When protecting a range, the 1 nozzle must be located a
maximum of 9 in. (228 mm) from each burner grate centerline
and must be positioned above the edge of the hazard area to be
protected.
The 1 N nozzle tip must be positioned at or below the obstruc-
tion, if present. The protected area begins at the point straight
down from the nozzle tip. The nozzle can be placed at the side
of the range aimed either left or right, or can be placed in the
front or back of the range. See Figures 4-33 and 4-34 for nozzle
location details.
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
Range Protection Two 290 (2-Flow) Nozzles - Low
Proximity Application
15 in. to 20 in. (381 mm to 508 mm) above the cooking surface.
The low proximity 2-flow application requires the use of two 290
nozzles.
Both nozzles are stamped with 290 indicating they are two flow
nozzles and must be counted together for a total of four flow
numbers.
Two 290 nozzles will protect a cooking area of 1008 in.2
(65032 mm2) with a maximum dimension of 36 in. (914 mm).
When using two of these nozzles for low proximity range protec-
tion, the nozzles must be positioned along the cooking surface
perimeter to 1.5 in. (38 mm) inside the perimeter, and aimed at
a 450 angle along the longitudinal centerline of the range. See
Figures 4-35 and 4-36.
290 NOZZLE TIP
LOCATION 0-1.5 IN.
(0-38 mm)
IN FROM EDGE OF
45* COOKING SURFACE 45*
II
15 IN. TO2OIN.
I t - 15 IN. TO 20 IN.
(381 to 508 mm) I I (381 to 508 mm)
MAXIMUM I i I MAXIMUM
II 'I
000076
000000
F: \\
15-201N. I I AIM (381 - 508 mm) IPOINT
I 20 IN (508 mm
. )
0000
007924
FIGURE 4-33
PROTECTED AREA
9 IN
M
T
18 IN.
AIM POINT
20 IN.
24 IN.
FIGURE 4-34
FIGURE 4-35
COOKING LONGITUDINAL
AREA "I CENTERLINE
COOKING
AREA
000239
I 290 NOZZLE TIP
- I-.-- - k- LOCATION CENTER OF
COOKING SURFACE
290 NOZZLE TIP LOCATION ± 2 IN. )50 mm)
0-1.5 IN. (38 mm) IN FROM EDGE
OF COOKING SURFACE
COOKING
AREA
000240
COOKING
AREA
) 290 NOZZLE TIP
- - LOCATION CENTER OF
COOKING SURFACE
290 NOZZLE TIP LOCATION ± 2 IN. (50 mm)
0-1.5 IN. (38 mm) IN FROM EDGE
OF COOKING SURFACE
FIGURE 4-36
FROr'(r
VIEW
Gas-Radiant/Electric Char-Broiler Protection
FIGURE 4-58
000252
SIDE VIEW
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 4-24 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
Upright Broiler/Salamander Protection (Continued)
UPRIGHT BROILER BROILER CHAMBER
Electric Char-Broiler Protection (Optional)
The R-102 system uses the 1 nozzle for electric char-broiler
protection.
The nozzle is stamped with a IN, indicating that this is a
one-flow nozzle and must be counted as one flow number.
One 1 nozzle will protect a hazard with a maximum length of
34 in. (863 mm) and a total cooking area which does not exceed
680 in .2 (43870 mm2). The nozzle tip must be located 20 in. to
50 in. (508 mm to 1270 mm) above the hazard surface. When
using this nozzle for electric char-broiler protection, the nozzle
must be positioned anywhere along or within the perimeter of
the maximum cooking area and shall be aimed at the center of
the cooking surface. See Figure 4-59b.
The R-1 02 system uses the 1 N nozzle for gas-radiant/electric
char-broiler protection.
The nozzle is stamped with a iN, indicating that this is a
one-flow nozzle and must be counted as one flow number.
One 1 N nozzle will protect a hazard with a maximum length of
36 in. (914 mm) and a total cooking area which does not exceed
864 in.2 (55741 mm2). The nozzle tip must be located 15 in. to
40 in. (381 mm to 1016 mm) above the hazard surface. When
using this nozzle for gas-radiant/electric char-broiler protection,
the nozzle must be positioned anywhere along or within the
perimeter of the maximum cooking area and shall be aimed at
the center of the cooking surface. See Figure 4-59a.
* 40 IN.
(1016 mm)
/ I MAXIMUM
/ 151N. (381 mm) \\I// MINIMUM
000257
*
50 IN.
(1270 mm)
/ I MAXIMUM
/ 20 IN. (508 mm)
MINIMUM
000257
FIGURE 4-59b
FIGURE 4-59a
When using this nozzle for griddle protection, the nozzle must
be positioned along the cooking surface perimeter to 2 in.
(50 mm) inside perimeter, and aimed at the center of the cooking
surface. See Figure 4-43 and 4-44.
NOZZLE LOCATION I 0-2 IN. (0-50mm) )ifl
I INSIDE PERIMETER
L4.. OF COOKING SURFACE
50 IN.
(1270 mm)
/ MAXIMUM
HEIGHT $ / 0F260 NOZZLE TIP II
Ii I 30 IN. (762mm)
MINIMUM I
EDGE I I HEIGHT I OF —01 OF 260
NOZZLE TIP I
SURFACE
r=
COOKING
000243
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
Griddle Protection 260 (2-Flow) Nozzle - High Proximity
Application
Option 2— Nozzle Perimeter Located
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 4-19
Griddle Protection 290 (2-Flow) Nozzle - Medium Proximity
Application
Option 2a - Nozzle Perimeter Located (Continued)
30 in. to 50 in. (762 mm to 1270 mm) above the cooking surface. 20 in. to 30 in. (508 mm to 762 mm) above the cooking surface.
This high proximity application uses the 260 nozzle. The medium proximity application uses the 290 nozzle.
The nozzle is stamped with 260 indicating this is a two-flow The nozzle is stamped with 290 indicating this is a two-flow
nozzle and must be counted as two flow numbers. nozzle and must be counted as two flow numbers.
One 260 nozzle will protect a maximum cooking area of 1440 in.2 One 290 nozzle will protect a maximum cooking area of 1440 in.2
(92903 mm2) with a maximum dimension of 48 in. (1219 mm). (92903 mm2) with a maximum dimension of 48 in. (1219 mm).
FIGURE 4-43
000243
COOKING AREA
T t MIDPOINT OF 1 I I I
COOKING SURFACE I I
I I I COOKING
I AIM POINT
AREA
When using this nozzle for griddle protection, the nozzle must
be positioned along the perimeter to 2 in. (50 mm) inside
perimeter, and aimed at the center of the cooking surface. See
Figure 4-45 and 4-46.
COOKING AREA
t CENTER OF I I I
COOKING SURFACE I I I
I I I COOKING
Ill AREA
l— AIM POINT
L1J I
290 NOZZLE LOCATED ALONG COOKING SURFACE EDGE
ANY SIDE OF GRIDDLE SURFACE
WITHIN 0-2 IN. (0-50 mm) OF
COOKING SURFACE EDGE. NOZZLE
MUST BE AIMED AT CENTER OF
COOKING SURFACE.
FIGURE 4-45
000241
I NOZZLE LOCATION
0-2 IN. )0-5lmm)
INSIDE PERIMETER 30 IN.
-0 OF COOKING SURFACE I i (762 mm)
I MAXIMUM
HEIGHT
OF 290 I NOZZLE TIP
/ I 20 IN. (508 mm) I
/ / I MINIMUM I I HEIGHT I
OF 290 I
NOZZLE TIP
Ik I I
EDGE OF
COOKING
SURFACE
FIGURE 4-46
000243
260 NOZZLE LOCATED ALONG
ANY SIDE OF GRIDDLE SURFACE
WITHIN 0-2 IN. (0-51 mm) OF
COOKING SURFACE EDGE. NOZZLE
MUST BE AIMED AT MIDPOINT OF
COOKING SURFACE.
COOKING SURFACE EDGE
FIGURE 4-44
000241
F
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 4-9
Fryer - Single Nozzle Protection (Continued)
Maximum Area Dimensions - Single Nozzle Fryer Protection (Continued)
Max. Size
Max. Size Overall Type of Nozzle Height
Frypot Only With Dripboard Nozzle Above Top of Fryer
14.5 in. x 16.5 in. 14.5 in. x 26.5 in. 290 16 in. to 21 in.
(368 mm x 419 mm) (368 mm x 673 mm) (406 to 533 mm)
19.5 in. xl9in. 19.5 in. x 25 3/8 in. 290 l3 in. tol6in.
(495 mm x 482 mm) (495 mm x 644 mm) (330 to 406 mm)
19.5 in. x 19 in. 19.5 in. x 25 3/8 in. 3N See Figure 4-18
(495 mm x 482 mm) (495 mm x 644 mm)
18 in. x 18 in. 18 in. x 27 3/4 in. 3N 25 in. to 35 in.
(457 mm x 457 mm) (457 mm x 704 mm) (635 mm to 889 mm)
Nozzle
See Figure 4-17
See Figure 4-17
See Figure 4-18
See Figure 4-19
FRYER WITHOUT DRIPBOARD FRYER WITH DRIPBOARD
290 NOZZLE TIP POSITIONED OVER THE MIDPOINT OF THE HAZARD AREA ± 3 IN.
(76 mm) FROM THE MIDPOINT ALONG THE LONGEST SIDE OF THE HAZARD AND ± 000010 CENTERLINE 1 IN. (25 mm) FROM THE MIDPOINT ALONG THE SHORTEST SIDE OF THE HAZARD
AND AIMED AT THE MIDPOINT OF THE COOKING AREA. FRYER WITHOUT DRIPBOARD FRYER WITH DRIPBOARD
NOTE: 3N NOZZLE TIP MUST BE LOCATED WITHIN THE PERIMETER OF THE SURFACE FIGURE 4-17 AREA WITHIN THE FRONT HALF OF THE FRY POT AND AIMED AT THE CENTER.
002286
FIGURE 4-19
34 IN. (863 mm) MAXIMUM DIAGONAL
DISTANCE BETWEEN NOZZLE AND
CENTER OF HAZARD AREA
MINIMUM
1VERTICALNOZZLE 'I
)
FRYER WITHOUT DRIPBOARD FRYER WITH DRIPBOARD
3N NOZZLE TIP POSITIONED ANYWHERE ALONG OR WITHIN PERIMETER OF
COOKING SURFACE AND AIMED TO THE CENTER OF THE COOKING AREA.
FIGURE 4-18
002287
CONTRACTORS
STATE LICENSE BOARD
ACTIVE LICENSE
854489 CORP
PARACLETE FIRE & SAFETY INC
Ocs) C16
E e 10/31/2021 www.cslbca.gov
NOT TRANSFERABLE CITY OF CARLSBAD POST IN CONPICUOU$ PLACE
1635 Faraday Ave. Carlsbad CA 92008
UC NUMBER BusiNEss RESTRAflON CERI1
4 p PVN ktIOf$POnkcnfl.#$ed b1oW4s VItdthn h.4.,n.t.fl4cIS pusSNEP,E pO*",MdwCPI S.,nl.Lan. Gansrcn m.flgag, Vt B L0S00400210-20 Vcnd.,.dEw VVVT*N. VV Nw. TNt kctø* 4fl4O$d .KtA V.q*siwlflwfl*Nsqe *tlJt$ct it by Vw. kr,mg by flit
DATE ISSUED
BUSINESS LOCATION
10/06/2020
2950 Saturn ST STE I NAICS CODE NAIcS DESCRIPTION
238990 All Other Specialty Trade Contractors
EXPIRATION DATE
09130/2021
owe, FIRM ov PARACLETE FIRE AND SAFETY INC DPO5A lION NAME
BUENCESNAME PARACLETE FIRE AND SAFETY INC (City of
MAlUflID ADDRESS 2950 Saturn ST STE I Carlsbad
CITY A143SWE Brea, CA 92821-6205
KEEP FOR YOUR RECORDS
LICENSE NUMBER
BLOS004002-10-2018
DATE ISSUED
10/06/2020
EXPIRATION DATE
09/30/2021
BUSINESS NAME
PARACLETE FIRE AND SAFETY
INC
BUSINESS LOCATION
2950 Saturn ST STE I
TAXES PAID IN AGCw.DAJJXE IDmtltv BUSINESS rAE
CITY OF CARLSBAD
1 1ui!]
It is hereby certified that
Allen Quirk
Has successfully completed the training course for
ANSUL R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression System
Recertification
Certificate of Completed this 4/13/2020
Training This certificate is considered valid for a period of three years
from completion date and linked to the attendee and the
company mentioned above.
Training Hours: 8
Johnson Ob Controls
Katherine A. Adrian
Global Director
Technical and Training Services
Johnson Controls
© 2018 Johnson Controls. All rights reserved. F-2018092-01
DESIGN, INSTALLATION, RECHARGE, AND MAINTENANCE MANUAL
I I
0
o1jo
t Q One Stanton Street / Marinette, WI 54143-2542, USA / +1-715-735-7411 / www.ansul.com
Fire Protection Products Copyright © 2014 Tyco Fire Products LP. / All rights reserved. / Part No. 418087-12
12 IN.
(304 mm)
MAXIMUM
14 IN.
(355 mm)
MAXIMUM FRONT TO REAR
CENTERLINE
SHELF OR OTHER SIMILARLY SIZED
OBSTRUCTION CAN OVERHANG BURNER(S)
BY A MAXIMUM OF 11 IN. (279 mm)
Bulletin No. 2017244
UL EX3470
DATE: October 6, 2017
TO: Authorized ANSUL® R-102 Restaurant System Distributors and OEMs
FROM: Product Management, Restaurant Systems
SUBJECT: Improved 1 F Range Protection With or Without Back Shelf - R-1 02
NOTICE: It is the responsibility of your company to verify that this information has been received by the
employees who currently hold valid certification credentials for design and/or service of the system(s)
referenced within this bulletin.
We are pleased to announce improved range protection with or without a back shelf. The 1 F nozzle range protection
now allows the shelf to be installed at a minimum height of 18 in. (457 mm) above the hazard area compared to the
prior minimum shelf height of 20 in. (508 mm) above the hazard area.
When using the 1 F nozzle for range protection with or without back shelf, the maximum length of the burner grates
being protected must not exceed 28 in. (711 mm) and the maximum area of the burner grates must not exceed
336 in .2 (2167 cm2). See the figure below for nozzle location details.
This bulletin serves as a supplement to the ANSUL R-1 02 System Design, Installation, Recharge, and Maintenance
Manual (Part No. 418087-12) dated September 1, 2014 and is not intended to replace the requirements and
limitations therein. The information contained in this bulletin will be added to the manual at the next revision.
1 NOZZLE
1 NOZZLE LOCATED OVER FRONT EDGE OF BURNER GRATE AND ORIENTED
SO NOZZLE TIP FLATS ARE PARALLEL WITH BURNER GRATE FRONT TO REAR
CENTERLINE AND SHALL BE AIMED AT THE CENTER OF THE COOKING SURFACE.
Should you have questions pertaining to this bulletin please contact your Territory Sales Manager or Technical
Services at the below listed number.
Main Telephone Number: +1-800-862-6785 or +1-715-735-7415
Customer Services .......Press 2 Technical Services.......Press 4
Training Services ........Press 6 Quality Assurance .......Press 8
One Stanton Street
Marinette, WI 54143-2542
www.017su/.com
Johnson 060
Controls
2017 Johnson Controls. All rights reserved. S-2010156-04
Bulletin No. 2017240
UL EX3470
DATE: October 6, 2017
TO: Authorized ANSUL® R-102 System Distributors and OEMs
FROM: Product Management, Restaurant Systems
SUBJECT: R-102 Protection Options for Garland 2-platen: MWE/G2W, MWE2S, MWE/G L/R 9501 E/D/CE,
MWGJ 9801, MWE 9801 E/D/CE; Garland 3-platen: MWE/G 3W, MWE 3W5; Taylor 2-platen: 32,
34, 35, C832, C834, C835; and Taylor 3-platen: C842, C844, C845.
NOTICE: It is the responsibility of your company to verify that this information has been received by the
employees who currently hold valid certification credentials for design and/or service of the system(s)
referenced within this bulletin.
We are pleased to announce additional appliance-specific R-1 02 fire protection options for the models listed here:
Garland 2-platen: MWE/G2W, MWE2S, MWE/G L/R 9501 E/D/CE, MWGJ 9801, MWE 9801 E/D/CE
Garland 3-platen: MWE/G 3W, MWE 3WS
Taylor 2-platen: 32, 34, 35, C832, C834, C835
Taylor 3-platen: C842, C844, C845.
This protection can act as a modular type for the models listed above. In the case of multiple units installed directly
adjacent to each other, only one nozzle is required between the two units, while maintaining the nozzle spacing
over each appliance.
This bulletin serves as a supplement to the ANSUL R-1 02 System Design, Installation, Recharge, and Maintenance
Manual (Part No. 418087-12) dated September 1, 2014 and is not intended to replace the requirements and
limitations therein. The information contained in this bulletin will be added to the manual at the next revision.
The following nozzle positioning and coverage limitations must be followed:
Nozzle Type: 1
Nozzle Quantity: 4
Nozzle Height: 14 in. to 28 in. (356 mm to 711 mm)
Nozzle Location: 0 in. to 14 in. (356 mm) forward of back edge of cooking surface
Nozzles positioned 13 in. (330 mm) apart
0 in. to 1 in. (25 mm) right or left of side of cooking surface
Nozzle Aim Point: Front to back centerline of cooking surface
Main Telephone Number: +1-800-862-6785 or +1-715-735-7415 One Stanton Street
Customer Services .......Press 2 Technical Services.......Press 4 Marinett e, WI 54143-2542 Johnson 061
Training Services ........Press 6 Quality Assurance .......Press 8 www.onstil.com Controls
2017 Johnson controls. All rights reserved. S-2010156-04
Bulletin No. 2017240
October 6, 2017
Page 2 UL EX3470
Garland 2-platen - MWE/G2W, MWE2S, MWE/G L/R 9501 E/D/CE, MWGJ 9801, MWE 9801 E/D/CE
Protection using four 1 nozzles with 13 in. (330 mm) nozzle spacing, aiming to centerline of each lower platen.
C in. ± fin.
(0 ± 25mm) to first
nozzle from edge of
cook surface
Front to back
centerline of
moking surface
FRONT VIEW
SIDE VIEW
Specifications
Cook Surface Size: 24 in. x 36 in. (610 mm x 914 mm)
Heat Output: 26.2 kW, 70,000 btu
Main Telephone Number: +1-800-862-6785 or +1-715-735-7415
Customer Services .......Press 2 Technical Services.......Press 4
Training Services ........Press 6 Quality Assurance .......Press 8
One Stanton Street
Marinette, WI 54143-2542
www.onsul.com
Johnson '4SIj'(4
Controls
2017 Johnson Controls. All rights reserved. S-2012086-02
I
Bulletin No. 2017240
October 6, 2017 UL EX3470 10 Page 3
Garland 3-platen - MWE/G 3W, MWE 3WS
Protection using four 1 N nozzles with 13 in. (330 mm) nozzle spacing, aiming to centerline of each lower platen.
(330mm)-o. FM
R :
0
1NNoze
spacing
1
Front to back cenlerfine of cooking surface
SIDE VIEW
Specifications
Cook Surface Size: 24 in. x 36 in. (610 mm x 914 mm)
Heat Output: 22.95 kW, 96,000 btu
Main Telephone Number: +1-800-862-6785 or +1-715-735-7415
Customer Services ..........ess 2 Technical Services.......Press 4
Training Services ........Press 6 Quality Assurance .......Press 8
) 2017 Johnson Controls. All rights reserved.
0 0 0
0 0
FRONT VIEW
One Stanton Street
Marinette, WI 54143-2542
www.ansul.com
0 in. u1 in.
(0±25mm)to
first
nsze boor edge of • cook surface
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
I
S
S
S
S
S
Johnson )A' •
Controls
S-2012086-02 5
Front to back
centerline of
moking surface
SIDE VIEW
Bulletin No. 2017240
October 6, 2017
Page 4 UL EX3470
Taylor 2-platen - 32, 34, 35, C832, C834, C835
Protection using four 1 N nozzles with 13 in. (330 mm) nozzle spacing, aiming to centerline of each lower platen.
in. in.
-4-- ° ± 25 OSTm
nozzle from edge of cook surface
FRONT VIEW
Specifications
Cook Surface Size: 24 in. x 36 in. (610 mm x 914 mm)
Heat Output: 22.2 kW, 60,000 btu
Main Telephone Number: +1-800-862-6785 or +1-715-735-7415
Customer Services .......Press 2 Technical Services.......Press 4
Training Services ........Press 6 Quality Assurance .......Press 8
2017 Johnson Controls. All rights reserved.
One Stanton Street
Marinette, WI 54143-2542
www. onsul. corn
Johnson 060
Controls
S-2012086-02
Specifications
Cook Surface Size: 24 in. x 36 in. (610 mm x 914 mm)
Heat Output: 25 kW, 75,000 btu
0 in. ±lin.
(0 ± 25 mm) to first nozzle from edge of
cook surface
SIDE VIEW FRONT VIEW
'k 1 Nozzle
* 1315. (330 mm) spacing
I
.
..,.
Bulletin No. 2017240
October 6, 2017 UL EX3470 Page 5
Taylor 3-platen - C842, C844, C845
Protection using four 1 N nozzles with 13 in. (330 mm) nozzle spacing, aiming to centerline of each lower platen.
S
S
S
S
I
S
to back
tilineef surface
S
S
S
I
Should you have questions pertaining to this bulletin, please contact Technical Services as noted below. 9
Main Telephone Number: +1-800-862-6785 or +1-715-735-7415 One Stanton Street
Customer Services .......Press 2 Technical Services.......Press 4 Marinette, WI 54143-2542
Training Services ........Press 6 Quality Assurance .......Press 8 www.ansuI.com
2017 Johnson Controls. All rights reserved.
I
I
S
S
S
Johnson J" .
Controls 5
5-2012086-02 •
Bulletin No. 2017103
UL EX3470 - May 05, 2017
DATE: June 15, 2017
TO: Authorized ANSUL® R-102 System Distributors and OEMs
FROM: Product Management, Restaurant Systems
SUBJECT: R-102 Protection Options for Garland ME/G-1 P, ME/G-2P, ME/G-3PX, or Taylor 0850, 0851, C852,
C855, C857, C858 three-platen clamshell grills
NOTICE: It is the responsibility of your company to verify that this information has been received by the
employees who currently hold valid certification credentials for design and/or service of the system(s)
referenced within this bulletin.
We are pleased to announce additional appliance-specific R-1 02 fire protection options for the Garland ME/G-1 P,
ME/G-2P, ME/G-3PX, or Taylor 0850, 0851, C852, C855, C857, C858 three-platen clamshell grills.
This protection can act as a modular type for the models listed above. In the case of 1, 2 or 3 platens, or multiple
units installed directly adjacent to each other, one additional nozzle is required when compared to the number of
total platens. Example 1: a 2-platen grill will require 3 total nozzles. Example 2: two 3-platen grills installed directly
adjacent to each other will require 7 total nozzles.
This bulletin serves as a supplement to the ANSUL R-1 02 System Design, Installation, Recharge, and Maintenance
Manual (Part No. 418087-12) dated September 1, 2014 and is not intended to replace the requirement and
limitations therein. The information contained in this bulletin will be added to the manual at the next revision.
The following nozzle positioning and coverage limitations must be followed:
Nozzle Type: 1 N
Nozzle Quantity: 4 (or 1 more nozzle than the number of total platens as stated in the paragraph above)
Nozzle Height: 14 in. to 28 in. (356 mm to 711 mm)
Nozzle Location: 0 in. to 14 in. (356 mm) forward of back edge of cooking surface
Nozzles positioned 13 in. (330 mm) apart
0 in. to 1 in. (25 mm) right or left of side of cooking surface
Nozzle Aim Point: Front to back centerline of cooking surface
Copyright © 2017Tyco Fire Products LP. All rights reserved.
tfl'CiDJ One Stanton Street Main Telephone Numbers: +1-800-862-6785 or +1-71 5-735-7415
"Fire Protection Products Marinette, WI 54143-2542 Customer Services..........Press 2 Technical Services ..........Press 4
www.ansul.com Training Services ...........Press 6 Quality Assurance ..........Press 8
S-2010156-04
Bulletin No. 2017103
June 15, 2017
Page 2
Garland ME/G-1P, ME/G-2P or ME/G-3PX
S
UL EX3470 - May 05, 2017
Protection using four 1 nozzles with 13 in. (330 mm) nozzle spacing, aiming to centerline of each lower platen. f w
S
S
- O in. ±lin.
(0 ± 25 mm) to first
nozzle from edge of
cook surface
\
13 in.
(330 mm)
spacing
1 Nozzle
28 in.
(711 mm)
Front to back
centedine of
cooking surface
ip1
SIDE VIEW FRONT VIEW
Specifications
Lower cook surface size: MEIG-1 P - 11.75 in. x 22 in. (298 mm x 559 mm)
MEIG-2P - 23.75 in. x 22 in. (603 mm x 559 mm)
ME/G-3PX - 23.75 in. x 22 in. (603 mm x 559 mm) and
11.75 in. x22 in (298 mm x559mm)
Upper platen size: 11.5 in x 17.5 in (292 mm x 445 mm) each
Heat Output: ME/G-1 P Electric - 7.8 kW, Gas - 24,000 btu
MEIG-2P Electric - 15.6 kW, Gas - 48,000 btu
ME/G-3PX Electric - 23.4 kW, Gas - 72,000 btu
Fire Protection Products
One Stanton Street
Marinotte, WI 541432542 Main Telephone Numbers: +1-800-862-6785 or +1-7 1 5-735-7415
Customer Services..........Press 2 Technical Services ..........Press 4
wwwansuL corn Training Services ...........Press 6 Quality Assurance ..........Press 8
S-201200601 W
• Bulletin No. 2017103 . June 15,2017
Page 3 UL EX3470 - May 05, 2017
O Taylor C850, C851, C852, C855, C857, C858
Protection using four 1 nozzles with 13 in. (330 mm) nozzle spacing, aiming to centerline of each lower platen.
• /
(330mm)—oU Li • I spacing
iN Nozzle 28 in.
(711 mm) / / 1*....0 in ± fin. . 14 in.
(0 ± 25 mm) to first
nozzle from edge of
cook Surface (356 mm)
On back edge of cook
surface to 14 in.
(356 mm) in front of
back edge
•
______ ______
046 Go . centeine of
Front to back I I I I I cooking surface
I -I
• SIDE VIEW FRONT VIEW
O Specifications
Lower cook surface size: 11.4 in. x 24 in (290 mm x 610 mm) each
•
Upper platen size: 11 in. x 17.3 In (279 mm x 439 mm) each
• Heat Output: 0850 - 8 kW C851 - 25,000 btu
• C852 - 15 kW C855 - 50,000 btu
• C858 -22 kW C857 - 75,000 btu
O Should you have questions pertaining to this bulletin please contact Technical Services as noted below.
S
jq One Stanton Street Main Telephone Numbers: +1-800-862-6785 or +1-715-735-7415
Fire Protection Products Marinette, WI 54143-2542 Customer Services...,.. Press 2 Technical Services ..........Press 4
S ww.'v.ansuL corn Training Services ...........Press 6 Quality Assurance ..........Press 8
/1.
Bulletin No. 2017064
UL EX3470
DATE: April 7, 2017
TO: Authorized ANSUL® R-102 System Distributors and OEMs
FROM: Product Management, Restaurant Systems
SUBJECT: R-102 Protection Options for Nieco Broiler Models PB93G and PB63G
NOTICE: It is the responsibility of your company to verify that this information has been received by the
employees who currently hold valid certification credentials for design and/or service of the system(s)
referenced within this bulletin.
We are pleased to announce additional appliance-specific R-102 fire protection options for the Nieco Automatic
Chain Broiler Models PB93G and PB63G with catalyst filters installed in the exhaust openings.
This bulletin serves as a supplement to the ANSUL R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression System Design, Installation,
Recharge, and Maintenance Manual (Part No. 418087-12) dated September 1, 2014 and is not intended to replace
the requirement and limitations therein. The information contained in this bulletin will be addd to the manual at the
next revision.
The following nozzle positioning and coverage limitations must be followed:
Nozzle Type: 230
Nozzle Quantity: 2
Nozzle Height: 12 in. to 20 in. (305 mm to 508 mm)
Nozzle Location: 0 in. to 5 in. (127 mm) from front or back edge of exhaust opening
Nozzles positioned 17.25 in. (438 mm) apart
0 in. to 4 in. (101 mm) right or left of center of exhaust opening.
Nozzle Aim Point: Center of exhaust opening front to back
and center left to right
Specifications
Broiler Chamber Size: 25.06 in. x 8 in. (637 mm x 204 mm)
25.06 in. x 15 in. (637 mm x 381 mm)
Exhaust Opening Size: 16 in. x 15.19 in. (406 mm x 386 mm)
8 in. x 15.19 in. (204 mm x 386 mm)
Output Rating: 120,000 BTU/Hr.
Copyright ©2O17Tyco Fire Products LP All rights reserved
tcq One Stanton Street Main Telephone Numbers: +1-800-862-6785 or +1-715-735-7415
Li Fire Protection Products Marinette, WI 54143-2542 Customer Services..........Press 2 Technical Services ..........Press 4
wwwansulcorn Training Services ...........Press 6 Quality Assurance ..........Press 8
S-2010156-04
I
Bulletin No. 2017064
April 7, 2017 W Page 2 UL EX3470 . All, n
S 0-5 in. / A
(508 mm)
in front of
(3m) if
exhaust
Z(O-127 mm)
man
ago IN
•
. 17.25 in. (438 mm)
Fixed spacing between nozzles
SIDE VIEW TOP VIEW
Should you have questions pertaining to this bulletin please contact Technical Services as noted below.
S
S .
I •
S . . . . .
I
tilco One Stanton Street Main Telephone Numbers: +1-800-862-6785 or +1-7 1 5-735-7415
* Fire Protection Products Marinette, WI 54143-2542 customer Services..........Press 2 Technical Services ..........Press 4
www.ainsul.com Training Services ...........Press 6 Quality Assurance ..........Press 8
0 to 4 in.
(0 to 101 mm)
ight or left of center of
exhaust opening
Aim to center of
sxhaust openings
________ •
Bulletin No. 2016287 • UL EX3470; UL EX5174 - May 5, 2016
DATE: September 8, 2016
TO: Authorized ANSUL® R-102 and PIRANHA System Distributors and OEMs
FROM: Product Management - Restaurant Systems S
SUBJECT: Restaurant Nozzle 10-Pack Offering
Tyco Fire Protection Products is pleased to announce that we are offering all restaurant nozzles with metal blow-off • caps in 10-packs for all ANSUL Restaurant Fire Suppression Systems. This will add consistency to the ordering
process and inventory control of the restaurant nozzles.
The current Restaurant Nozzle 9-packs, 25-packs, and 50-packs will be offered until inventories are depleted.
Please make note of the new part numbers and price changes when ordering restaurant nozzles as follows:
New Part No.
R-102 Nozzle
(10-Packs)
443319 Nozzle, 1 F
443321 Nozzle, 1/2 N
443317 Nozzle, 1
443323 Nozzle, 1W
443325 Nozzle, 2W
443327 Nozzle, 3N
443329 Nozzle, 230
443331 Nozzle, 245
443333 Nozzle, 260
443335 Nozzle, 290
443337 Nozzle, 2120
New Part No.
PIRANHA Nozzle
(10-Packs)
443339 Nozzle, AP
443341 Nozzle, DL
442088 P34,10-Pack
442153 P41, 10-Pack
Note: Prices are subject to change without notice.
i
S
S
S
S
S
S
Copyright © 2016Tyco Fire Products LP All rights reserved.
One Stanton Street Main Telephone Numbers: +1-800-862-6785 or +1-715-735-7415
Fire Protection Products Marinette, WI 541432542 Customer Services..........Press 2 Technical Services ..........Press 4
www.ansul.com Training Services ...........Press 6 Quality Assurance ..........Press 8
S-2010156-04
I
Bulletin No. 2016287
September 8, 2016 S Page 2 UL EX3470 UL EX5174 - May 5, 2016
This bulletin is a supplement to the ANSUL R-102 Restaurant System Design, Installation, Recharge and
Maintenance Manual (418087-12) and the ANSUL PIRANHA Restaurant System Design, Installation, Recharge and
Maintenance Manual (423385-08).
For questions concerning the information in this bulletin, please contact Technical Services as noted below.
I
S
I
I
I
I
S
S
S
•
•
One Stanton Street Main Telephone Numbers: +1-800-862-6785 or +1-715-735-7415
Fire Protection Products Marinette, WI 541432542 Customer Services. ......... Press 2 Technical Services ..........Press 4
W wwv.ansuL corn Training Services ...........Press 6 Quality Assurance ..........Press 8
..,
[Hi1iJIw
J..
Bulletin No. 2016045 •
UL EX3470
DATE: May 3, 2016
TO: All Authorized ANSUL Restaurant System Distributors and OEMs
FROM: Product Management - Restaurant Systems
SUBJECT: R-102 Coverage of the Imperial Model IABR-36, IABR-48, and IABR-60 Gas-Radiant Char-Broiler
with Wood Smoker Box and Chip Holders
NOTICE: It is the responsibility of your company to verify that this information has been received by the
employees who currently hold valid certification credentials for design and/or service of the system(s)
referenced within this bulletin.
We are pleased to announce an appliance-specific coverage for R-1 02 Restaurant Fire Suppression Systems when
protecting the following Imperial Gas Radiant Char-broilers: lABR-36, lABR-48, and IABR-60 with Wood Smoker
Box and Chip Holders.
The information in this bulletin will serve as a manual supplement for the R-102 Fire Suppression System Design,
Installation, Recharge and Maintenance Manual (Part No. 418087-12) dated September 1St 2014 and will be added
to the manual at the next reprint.
S See Pages 2 and 3 for details.
tlqclDi One Stanton Street
Fire Protection Products Marinette, WI 54143-2542
wwwansu/, corn
5-2010156-04
S
S
S
I
S
Copyright 7016 Tyco Fire Products LP. All rights reserved.
Ask
Main Telephone Numbers: +1-800-862-6785 or +1-715-735-7415 W
Customer Services..........Press 2 Technical Services ..........Press 4
Training Services ............Press 6 Quality Assurance ..........Press 8
Bulletin No. 2016045
May 3, 2016
Page 2 UL EX3470
Model IABR-36 with Wood Smoker Box and Chip Holders is to be protected within the parameters indicated below.
The following nozzle position and coverage limitations must be followed:
Nozzle Quantity: 2
Nozzle Type: 3N
Nozzle Height: 25 in. (635 mm) to 40 in. (1016 mm) above the hazard surface
Nozzle Location Each nozzle protects half of the cooking area. The nozzles are located within 1 in. (25 mm) of the
center of the respective cooking area, aimed at the center of that hazard area.
3N NOZZLES
CENTER LINE
OF RESECTIVE
COOKING AREA +1- 1 IN. (2.5 cm) NOZZLE HEIGHT IN ANY DIRECTION 25 IN. -40 IN.
(65-102cm)
1/2 OF 1/2 OF
AREA AREA
1 IN. (2.5 cm)
- COOKING
-*j4
COOKING -
MAXIMUM 4 1 IN. (2.5 cm)
MAXIMUM
COOKING
AREA
CENTER OF
RESPECTIVE
COOKING AREA
008495
Model Grate Dimension Gas Output
IABR-36 32.5 in. (825 mm) x 21 in. (533 mm) 90,000 BTU'
tqc
Fire Protection Products
One Stanton Street Main Telephone Numbers: +1-800-862-6785 or +1-71 5-735-7415
Marinette, WI 54143-2542 Customer Services..........Press 2 Technical Services ..........Press 4
www.aiisul.com Training Services ...........Press 6 Quality Assurance ..........Press 8
Bulletin No. 2016045
May 3, 2016
Page 3 UL EX3470
Model IABR-48 and IABR-60 with Wood Smoker Box and Chip Holder is to be protected within the parameters
indicated below.
The following nozzle position and coverage limitations must be followed:
Nozzle Quantity: Three
Nozzle Type: 3N
Nozzle Height: 25 to 40 in. (635 to 1,016 mm) above the broiler surface
Nozzle Location: All three nozzles are to be centered front to back above the broiling surface. The middle nozzle
is to be centered left to right above the broiling surface. The remaining two nozzles are to be
located 9 in. (229 mm) inside the broiler sides.
9 IN.
(229 MM)
I I 91N,
(2
H3N BROILER
CENTER OF
I 3N
CENTER OF
BROILER
26 TO 40 IN.
(635 to 1016 mm)
FRONT
009867
Model Grate Dimensions Gas Output
IABR-48 44.5 in. (1,130 mm) x21 in. (533 mm) 120,000 BTU
IABR-60 56.5 in. (1,435 mm) x 21 in. (533 mm) 150,000 BTU
For all models, the Smoker Box and Chip Holders shall not exceed a depth of logs greater than 4 in. (102 mm) or a
maximum allowable wood chip depth of 4 in. (102 mm).
Should you have questions regarding this bulletin, please contact your US Standard Product Manager or International
Area Manager, or contact Technical Services as listed below.
One Stanton Street Main Telephone Numbers: +1-800-862-6785 or +1-715-735-7415
Fire Protection Products Marinotte, WI 54143-2542 Customer Services..........Press 2 Technical Services ..........Press 4
wwwansul. Corn Training Services ...........Press 6 Quality Assurance ..........Press 8
Bulletin No. 2015259
UL EX3470; UL EX5174
DATE: December 14, 2015
TO: All Authorized ANSUL® R-102 and PIRANHA System Distributors and OEMs
FROM: Product Management, Restaurant Systems
SUBJECT: New Nitrogen Cartridge Options for Remote Mechanical Release Assemblies
NOTICE: It is the responsibility of your company to verify that this information has been received by the
employees who currently hold valid certification credentials for design and/or service of the system(s)
referenced within this bulletin,
Tyco Fire Protection Products is pleased to announce additional cartridge options for use in the Remote Mechanical
Release Assemblies (Part No. 433485 and 439946).
The current remote mechanical release assembly uses the 101-10 Carbon Dioxide Cartridge as the only option for
the actuation pressure to operate the regulated actuators. The 101-10 Carbon Dioxide Cartridge can still be used
for this application, however, in addition to the 101-10 Carbon Dioxide Cartridge, the following LT-20-R Nitrogen
Cartridges can be used for this application.
The following LT-20-R Nitrogen Cartridge options are now approved for use in the remote mechanical release
assembly:
TO/DOT 423429
European Part No. 428440
Australian Part No. 428948
Chinese Part No. 441086
This bulletin is a supplement to the ANSUL R-102 Restaurant System Design, Installation, Recharge, and
Maintenance Manual (418087-12) and the ANSUL PIRANHA Restaurant System Design, Installation, Recharge,
and Maintenance Manual (423385-08).
This bulletin is not intended to replace the requirements and limitations outlined within the ANSUL R-102 Restaurant
System Design, Installation, Recharge, and Maintenance Manual and the ANSUL PIRANHA Restaurant System
Design, Installation, Recharge, and Maintenance Manual listed in this bulletin. The information contained in this
bulletin will be added to the manual at the next update. However, we are providing this document immediately for
product protection.
If you have questions regarding the LT-20-R Nitrogen Cartridge options, feel free to contact Technical Services as
noted below.
Thank you for your continued support of ANSUL brand fire suppression products.
Copyright 2015 Tyco Fire Products LP. I All rights reserved.
talco One Stanton Street Main Telephone Numbers: +1-800-862-6785 or +1-715-735-7415
Fire Protection Products Marinette, WI 541432542 Customer Services..........Press 2 Technical Services ..........Press 4
wwwansul corn Training Services ...........Press 6 Quality Assurance ...........Press 8
S-201015&-04
IV
(a
CD
c)
0
2 0 N N
CD
0
C)
a.
C)
w I,, —& N,
w -' 0
CD —I
H
CD
0
(0
0 N N CD
0
T.
0
(0
0)
0.
C-) 0
CD -' 0) (Li CD
3
0)
0
U)
3
9 a- CD
0
CD
0 -S 0
0.
C)
0) :3 0)
(0
CD 2 CD :3
CD ci,
I))
-S 0) :3
(I)
(I,
CD 3 U)
cC,omm- o 0 c-,,z:j-
- -n
C
(1)0>
OOo — z
Z r,,3
3
coom
1 3
I
0) CD 0
C) 0 U
C-,
CD
(0 0
CD CD
U) 5S 0)ZS CD
-D_CD -
CD 0) a
ozg
-
0U)
I-
-' CD
C-) U) N) DCD cl (I) 92 9 0
0)
'CD 0) C)o ,-.. -n -' C)
CDU)CD :3- WCD 0) =:3 0m -o
U) Ll
-, 0
00)
'-< CD 9 --a CD ¼)0
CD r ,OJ:3
- rn , CD - CD
. N)
CD
9C)
0) 0 c
0 CD
C•) '--
(079
0)
0 - 0) :3
0. 0 CD
Z (1) -Ti -
0 c m 0>
H OJ 0 H
r c)
-. U)
CD 5 -. :3-
CD CD
CD CD-I 0. U) CD
U) -a '-'• 0 :3
C) !. a-
a-..-. o
CD --2o
0)C) = 0
C) CD0) a
C) —
0< CD
C) -S CD 0...-. CD ZT :30) — —
Ln
0) —
-':3 CD- CD 1 (I) (0 :3
0)0
0. -:3-
(fl U)
CD a- CD --CD
CD o CD
zr CD
CD CD-
CD
CD
.......................................
Bulletin No. 2015197
October 5, 2015
Page 2
R102: UL EX3470
Specifications
Top Cooking Surface 10.2 in. x 22.4 in.
(259 mm x 568 mm)
Bottom Cooking Surface: 10.8 in. x 22.2 in
(274 mm x 564 mm)
Total Load: 16 kW
This bulletin is a supplement to the ANSUL R-102 Restaurant System Design, Installation, Recharge, and
Maintenance Manual (Part No. 418087-12), dated 2014-SEP-01.
This bulletin is NOT intended to replace the requirements and limitations outlined within the ANSUL R-102 System
Manual listed in this bulletin. The information contained in this bulletin will be ADDED to the manual at the next
update. However, we are providing this document immediately for appliance protection.
Should you have questions regarding this bulletin, please contact Technical Services as noted below.
Thank you for your continued support of ANSUL brand fire suppression products.
tqcti
Fire Protection Products
One Stanton Street Main Telephone Numbers: +1-800-862-6785 or +1-715-735-7415
Marinette, WI 541432542 Customer Services..........Press 2 Technical Services ..........Press 4
WWWaIISUIX0177 Training Services ...........Press 6 Quality Assurance ..........Press 8
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual FOREWORD
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11
This manual is intended for use with ANSUL® R-102
Restaurant Fire Suppression Systems.
Those who install, operate, recharge, or maintain these fire
suppression systems should read this entire manual. Specific
sections will be of particular interest depending upon one's
responsibilities.
Design, installation, recharge, and maintenance of the system
must conform to the limitations detailed in this manual and
performed by an individual who attended an ANSUL training
program and became trained to install, recharge, design, and
maintain the ANSUL system.
Fire suppression systems are mechanical devices. They need
periodic care. Maintenance is a vital step in the performance
of your fire suppression system. As such it must be performed
in accordance with NFPA 96 (Standard for the Installation
of Equipment for the Removal of Smoke and Grease-Laden
Vapors from Commercial Cooking Equipment) and NFPA 17A
(Standard on Wet Chemical Extinguishing Systems) by an
authorized ANSUL distributor. To provide maximum assurance
that the fire suppression system will operate effectively and
safely, maintenance must be conducted at six-month intervals,
or earlier if the situation dictates. Twelve-year maintenance
must include agent tank hydrostatic testing.
ANSUL PART NO. 418087-12
ANSUL, R-102, and the product names listed in this material are marks and/or registered
marks. Unauthorized use is strictly prohibited.
EXPLANATION OF SAFETY ALERTS R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
I
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
I
: . Indicates a hazardous situation in which a person will expe-
rience serious personal injury or death if the situation is not
avoided.
Indicates a hazardous situation in which a person could expe-
rience serious personal injury or death if the situation is not
avoided.
Indicates a hazardous situation in which a person could expe-
rience minor or moderate personal injury if the situation is not
avoided.
Addresses practices not related to personal injury, such as
a system part malfunctioning, property damage, or system
failure.
NOTICE
Addresses general practices or observations
related to system function that are not related
to personal injury.
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual REVISION RECORD
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 1
DATE PAGE REV. NO. - DATE PAGE REV. NO.
2014-SEP-01 Complete manual has
been reformatted along
with several revised
updated technical
all pages have been
regardless of previous
revision number.
Technical information
changes have been
noted with a revision
indicator (k).
pages that contain
information. For clarity,
changed to Revision 11,
Indicates revised information.
. Indicates change in page sequence.
REVISION RECORD R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 2 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
DATE PAGE REV. NO. DATE PAGE REV. NO.
Indicates revised information.
Indicates change in page sequence.
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual TABLE OF CONTENTS
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-1 REV. ii PAGE TOC-i
SECTION PA(ES SFC.TICThI PAGES
GENERAL INFORMATION 1-1 -1-4
DESIGN AND APPLICATION 1-1
UL LISTING 1-1
SYSTEM APPROVALS 1-1
DEFINITION OF TERMS 1-1 -1-3
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION 2-1 -2-2
TOTAL SYSTEM 2-1
Single-Tank 2-1
Double-Tank 2-1
Three-Tank 2-2
Multiple-Tank 2-2
SYSTEM COMPONENTS 3-1-3-12
EXTINGUISHING AGENT 3-1
AUTOMAN REGULATED 3-1
RELEASE ASSEMBLY
(MECHANICAL)
AUTOMAN REGULATED 3-1
RELEASE ASSEMBLY
(ELECTRICAL)
REMOTE MECHANICAL RELEASE 3-2
SINGLE TANK ENCLOSURE 3-2
ASSEMBLY
RED PAINTED BRACKET ASSEMBLY 3-2
REGULATED ACTUATOR 3-3-
ASSEMBLY
AGENT TANK ASSEMBLY 3-3
OEM RELEASE/BRACKET 3-3
ASSEMBLY (FOR OEM
IN-CABINET USE ONLY)
OEM REGULATED ACTUATOR 3-3
ASSEMBLY
TWO TANK ENCLOSURE ASSEMBLY 3-
24VDC REGULATED RELEASE 3-4
ASSEMBLY
ADDITIONAL SHIPPING ASSEMBLY 3-'-
GAS CARTRIDGES 3-5
NOZZLES 3-5
SILICONE LUBRICANT 3-5
SWIVEL ADAPTOR 3-6
RUBBER BLOW-OFF CAP 3-6
METAL BLOW-OFF CAP 3-6
REDUCING COUPLING 3-6
CONDUIT OFFSET ASSEMBLY 3-6
QUIK-SEAL" ADAPTOR 3-6
COMPRESSION-SEAL" ADAPTOR 3-7
"HOOD SEAL" ADAPTOR 3-7
ASSEMBLY
COCKING LEVER/LOCK PIN 37
DETECTORS 3-8
PULLEY ELBOWS 3-8
III. SYSTEM COMPONENTS 3-1-3-12
(Continued)
PULLEY TEE 3-8
ANSUL STAINLESS STEEL CABLE 3-8
REMOTE MANUAL PULL STATION 3-9
FLEXIBLE CONDUIT 3-9
MECHANICAL GAS VALVES 3-9
ELECTRICAL GAS VALVES 3-10
MANUAL RESET RELAY 3-10
ELECTRICAL SWITCHES 3-10
ALARM INITIATING SWITCH 3-11
REGULATOR TEST KIT 3-11
FUSIBLE LINK 3-11
MAXIMUM REGISTERING 3-11
THERMOMETER
HOSE/GROMMET PACKAGE 3-11
IN-LINE BURST DISC ASSEMBLY 3-12
(MANIFOLDED SYSTEMS ONLY)
1/4 IN. CHECK VALVE 3-12
NOZZLE AIMING DEVICE 3-12
STAINLESS STEEL ACTUATOR HOSE 3-12
AGENT DISTRIBUTION HOSE AND 3-12
RESTRAINING CABLE KIT
SYSTEM DESIGN 4-1 -4-76
NOZZLE PLACEMENT 4-1 -4-31
REQUIREMENTS
Duct Protection 4-1 -4-3
Transition Protection 4-4
Electrostatic Precipitator 4-4
Protection
Plenum Protection 4-5 -4-6
Appliance Protection
Fryer - Single Nozzle Protection 4-7 -4-9
Fryer— Multiple Nozzle Protection 4-10-4-12
Tilt Skillet/Braising Pan 4-12
Range Protection 4-13 -4-17
Griddle Protection 4-18 -4-21
Chain Broiler Protection 4-21
Horizontal Chain Broiler Protection 4-21
Overhead Chain Broiler Protection 4-22
Salamander Broiler Protection 4-23
Upright Broiler/Salamander 4-23 -4-24
Protection
Gas-Radiant/Electric Char-Broiler 4-24
Protection
Electric Char-Broiler Protection 4-24
Lava-Rock (Ceramic) Char-Broiler 4-25
Protection
Natural Charcoal Broiler Protection 4-25
Alternate Ceramic/Natural 4-26
Charcoal Char-Broiler Protection
Wood Fueled Char-Broiler Protection 4-26
Wok Protection 4-27
Nozzle Application Chart 4-28 -4-31
SPECIFIC APPLICATION BY MODEL 4-32 -4-52
OVERLAPPING NOZZLE COVERAGE 4-53 -4-60
TABLE OF CONTENTS R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE TOC-2 REV. ii 2014-SEP-1
SECTION PAGES SECTION PAGES
IV. SYSTEM DESIGN (Continued) 4-1 -4-76 INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS 5-1 -5-44
TANK AND CARTRIDGE 4-61 (Continued)
REQUIREMENTS INSTALLING ELECTRICAL 5-35
ACTUATION AND EXPELLANT 4-61 -4-63 GAS VALVE
GAS LINE REQUIREMENTS INSTALLING ELECTRICAL 5-36 -5-38
DISTRIBUTION PIPING 4-63 -4-70 SWITCHES
REQUIREMENTS INSTALLING ALARM 5-39
General Piping Requirements
Supply and Branch Line
4-63
4-64 -4-65
INITIATING SWITCH
ELECTRICAL SWITCH 5-40 -5-42 Identification REQUIREMENTS 1.5 Gallon System 4-66
3.0 Gallon System 4-67 WIRING 24VIC REGULATED 543
6.0 Gallon Manifolded System 4-68 -4-69 RELEASE ASSEMBLY
9.0 Gallon System 4-70
DETECTION SYSTEM 4-71 -4-73 TESTING AND PLACING IN SERVICE 6-1 -6-4
REQUIREMENTS TESTING MANUAL PULL STATION 6-1
Detector Identification 4-71 TESTING MECHANICAL GAS 6-1 -6-2
Detector/Pulley Elbow/Conduit 4-71 VALVES
Off-set Design Limitations TESTING ELECTRICAL GAS 6-2 Detector Placement Requirements 4-71 -4-72 VALVES Detection Line Requirements 4-72
Fusible Link Selection 4-72 TESTING ELECTRIC SWITCH 6-2 -6-3
Electric Thermal Detector 4-73 TESTING DETECTION SYSTEM 6-3-6-4
MANUAL PULL STATION 4-73
REQUIREMENTS RECHARGE AND RESETTING
PROCEDURES
7-1 -7-6
MECHANICAL GAS VALVE 4-74
REQUIREMENTS CLEANUP PROCEDURES 7-1
O ELECTRICAL GAS VALVE 4-74 -4-75 RECHARGE 7-1 -7-4
REQUIREMENTS RESETTING 7-4 -7-6 Approvals 4-75 REPLACEMENT CARTRIDGE 7-6 ALARM INITIATING SWITCH 4-75
- REQUIREMENTS MAINTENANCE EXAMINATION 8-1 -8-12
ELECTRICAL SWITCH 4-75 SEMI-ANNUAL MAINTENANCE 8-1 -8-5 REQUIREMENTS EXAMINATION
V. INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS 5-1 ANNUAL MAINTENANCE 8-5
EXAMINATION INSTALLING RELEASE ASSEMBLY 5-1 -5-3
COMPONENTS 12-YEAR MAINTENANCE 8-6 -8-11
EXAMINATION
INSTALLING THE DISTRIBUTION 5-4 -5-5
PIPING IX. APPENDIX 9-1 -9-18
INSTALLING THE AGENT 5-5 -5-8 SYSTEM SELECTION GUIDE 9-1 -9-4 DISTRIBUTION HOSE (FOR
CASTERED/MOVEABLE EQUIPMENT) SYSTEM COMPONENT INDEX 9-5 -9-8
INSTALLING THE ACTUATION AND 5-8 -5-12 PARTS LISTS 9-9 -9-14
EXPELLANT GAS LINE MULTIPLE NOZZLE FRYER
PROTECTION CALCULATION
9-15 -9-16
INSTALLING THE DETECTION 5-13-5-16
SYSTEM EXAMPLES
INSTALLING REMOTE MANUAL 5-17-5-18 WIRING DIAGRAM 9-16-9-17
PULL STATION
General Installation Requirements 5-17
Installation for Remote Manual Pull 5-17 -5-18
Station Utilizing EMT Conduit Only
INSTALLING MECHANICAL 5-18 -5-22
GAS VALVE
INSTALLING REMOTE MANUAL 5-22 -5-34
PULL STATION OR MECHANICAL
GAS VALVE UTILIZING
FLEXIBLE CONDUIT
R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual SECTION 1 - GENERAL INFORMATION
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 1-1
DESIGN AND APPLICATION
The ANSUL R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression System is
developed and tested to provide fire protection for restaurant
cooking appliances, hoods, and ducts. It is a pre-engineered
group of mechanical and electrical components for installation
by an authorized ANSUL distributor. The basic system consists
of an AUTOMAN regulated release assembly which includes a
regulated release mechanism and a liquid agent storage tank
housed within a single enclosure. Nozzles, detectors, cartridg-
es, liquid agent, fusible links, pulley tees, and pulley elbows are
supplied in separate packages in the quantities needed for each
fire suppression system arrangement.
The system provides automatic actuation; or it can be actuated
manually through a remote manual pull station. The system is
also capable of shutting down appliances at system actuation.
For appliance shutdown requirements, refer to the current ver-
sion of NFPA 17A, "Standard For Wet Chemical Extinguishing
Systems," and NFPA 96, "Standard For Ventilation Control and
Fire Protection of Commercial Cooking Operations."
Additional equipment includes: remote manual pull station,
mechanical and electrical gas valves, and electrical switches
for automatic equipment and gas line shut-off. Accessories can
be added, such as alarms, warning lights, etc., to installations
where required.
The R-102 system suppresses fire by spraying the plenum area,
the filters, cooking surfaces, and the exhaust duct system with
a predetermined flow rate of ANSULEX Low pH Liquid Fire
Suppressant. When the liquid agent is discharged onto a cook-
ing appliance fire, it cools the grease surface, and reacts with
the hot grease (saponification) forming a layer of soap-like foam
on the surface of the fat. This layer acts as insulation between
the hot grease and the atmosphere, thus helping to prevent the
escape of combustible vapors.
Exhaust fans in the ventilating system should be left on. The
forced draft of these fans assists the movement of the liquid
agent through the ventilating system, thus aiding in the fire sup-
pression process. These fans also provide a cooling effect in the
plenum and duct after the fire suppression system has been dis-
charged. The system is UL listed with or without fan operation.
Make up or supply air fans, internal to the exhaust hood(s) being
protected, shall be shut down upon system actuation.
Along with the fire suppression system, the total system design
must include hand portable fire extinguisher(s) located within the
cooking/restaurant area that can be used to manually suppress
a fire that may be burning in an unprotected area. Class K extin-
guisher(s) must be provided for hazards where there is a potential
for fires involving combustible cooking media (vegetable or animal
oils and fats). Refer to NFPA 10, "Standard For Portable Fire
Extinguisher," for additional information.
UL LISTING
The R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression System has been test-
ed and is listed by Underwriters Laboratories, Inc. as a pre-en-
gineered system. The system is in compliance with UL Test
Standard 300. These tests require extinguishment of fires which
are initiated in deep fat fryers, ranges, griddles, char-broilers,
woks, upright broilers, chain-broilers, filters, plenum chambers,
hoods, and ducts after pre-loading each appliance with a pre-
scribed amount of cooking grease. Each fire is allowed to prog-
ress to maximum intensity before the fire suppression system
is actuated.
SYSTEM APPROVALS
UL EX3470
ULC EX3470
COA #5663 (NYC)
DEFINITION OF TERMS
Actuation Gas Line: Piping and/or stainless steel braided hose
assemblies from the AUTOMAN Regulated Release Assembly
which supplies high pressure nitrogen or carbon dioxide to the
Regulated Actuator Assembly for multiple-tank system actuation.
Agent Tank: A pressure vessel containing the liquid agent.
AUTOMAN Regulated Release Assembly (Electrical): An
assembly which contains the regulated release mechanism,
agent tank (ordered separately), expellant gas hose, solenoid,
and electric switch within a metal enclosure. The enclosure con-
tains knockouts to facilitate component hookups.
AUTOMAN Regulated Release Assembly (Mechanical): An
assembly which contains the regulated release mechanism,
agent tank (ordered separately), and expellant gas hose within a
metal enclosure. The enclosure contains knockouts to facilitate
component hookups.
Authority Having Jurisdiction: The "authority having juris-
diction" is the organization, office, or individual responsible
for "approving" equipment, an installation, or a procedure.
The phrase "Authority Having Jurisdiction" is used in a broad
manner since jurisdictions and "approval" agencies vary as
do their responsibilities. Where public safety is primary, the
"authority having jurisdiction" may be a federal, state, local, or
other regional department or individual such as a fire chief, fire
marshal, chief of a fire prevention bureau, labor department,
health department, building official, electrical inspector, or
others having statutory authority. For insurance purposes, an
insurance company representative may be the 'authority having
jurisdiction." In many circumstances the property owner or his
designated agent assumes the role of the "authority having juris-
diction;" at government installations, the commanding officer or
departmental official may be the "authority having jurisdiction."
Blow-Off Cap: A siliconized rubber or metal cap which covers
the end of the nozzle to protect the nozzle tip and minimize
cooking grease migration into the nozzle orifice.
Branch Line: The agent distribution piping which extends from
the supply line to the nozzle(s).
SECTION 1 -GENERAL INFORMATION R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 1-2 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
DEFINITION OF TERMS (Continued)
Bursting Disc: A disc installed in the tank adaptor which min-
imizes the remote chance of siphoning of the agent into the
discharge piping during extreme temperature variations.
Cartridge: A hermetically sealed, steel pressure vessel con-
taining nitrogen or carbon dioxide gas used to pressurize the
agent tank.
'Cooking Appliance: Includes, but is not limited to, fryers, grid-
dles, ranges, upright broilers, chain broilers, natural charcoal
broilers, or char-broilers (electric, lava rock, gas-radiant, or
mesquite).
Cooking Area: Cooking area is defined as the maximum
surface that requires protection. Each type of appliance has a
defined cooking area with parameters that vary for each appli-
ance. For example, the cooking area for a griddle is the entire
flat cooking surface, while a fryer may have two areas that need
consideration, depending on whether the fryer has a dripboard
or not.
Conduit Offset Assembly: A pre-formed piece of conduit which
can be installed between the ANSUL regulated release and the
conduit to allow the wire rope for the detection, gas valve and
remote manual pull station to be installed in a more convenient
manner.
Depth: When referring to depth as a linear dimension, it is the
horizontal dimension measured from front to back of the appli-
ance or plenum.
Detector: A device which includes the detector bracket, detector
linkage, and fusible link used for automatic operation of the fire
suppression system.
Detector Linkage: A device used to support the fusible link.
Discharge Hose Assembly: An agent distribution hose to be
used with castered cooking appliances with castered supports
to allow the movement of the appliance for service or cleaning
purposes.
Distribution Piping: Piping which delivers the extinguishing
agent from the tank to each discharge nozzle. See also Supply
or Branch lines.
Ducts (or Duct System): A continuous passageway for the
transmission of air and vapors which, in addition to the contain-
ment components themselves, may include duct fittings, damp-
ers, duct filters, duct transitions, in-line or end-duct pollution con-
trol units (PCUs), and/or other items or air handling equipment.
Electrostatic Precipitator: A device used to aid in the cleaning
of the exhaust air. This device is normally installed at or near the
base of the ventilation duct or may be included as an integral
part of a pollution control unit (PCU).
Expellant Gas Line: Piping and/or hose which supplies the
nitrogen or carbon dioxide gas from the regulated release
assembly/regulated actuator assembly to each agent tank.
Flexible Conduit: A flexible means to route stainless steel cable
from the AUTOMAN Regulated Release to a manual pull station
or mechanical gas valve.
Flow Number: Term used in system design to describe the flow
capacity of each nozzle used to determine the quantity of tanks
needed to cover a certain group of hazards.
Fusible Links: A fixed temperature heat detecting device
employed to restrain the operation of a mechanical control until
its designed temperature is reached, allowing separation of the
link and system operation.
Gas Valve: An electrically or mechanically operated device
used to shut off the gas supply to the cooking equipment when
the system is actuated.
Gas Valve Air Cylinder: An air cylinder, located in the release
mechanism, which operates pneumatically to mechanically
unlatch a mechanical gas valve actuator, causing the gas valve
to close upon system actuation.
High Proximity: Indicates a distance (vertically) between the
nozzle tip and the surface of the appliance being protected.
Hood: A device provided for cooking appliances to direct and
capture grease-laden vapors and exhaust gases from cooking
appliances. It shall be constructed in a manner which meets the
requirements of NFPA 96.
Liquid Agent: A potassium-based solution used for the knock-
down and suppression of fire.
Low Proximity: Indicates a distance (vertically) between the
nozzle tip and the surface of the appliance being protected.
Maximum Length of Cooking Appliance: The maximum
dimension, on any side, which may be protected by one nozzle.
Maximum Piping: Specified length of piping and number of
fittings which must not be exceeded for each system.
Medium Proximity: Indicates a distance (vertically) between
the nozzle tip and the surface of the appliance being protected.
Minimum Piping: Minimum length of distribution piping required
between the agent tank outlet and any nozzle protecting a
range, fryer, or wok.
Nozzle: A device designed to deliver the liquid agent with a
specific flow rate and stream pattern.
Overlapping Protection: When discharge nozzles are spaced
equally apart over one or more appliances requiring protection.
Nozzles used in this manner provide area protection of eligible
appliances within the protected area. Two types of overlapping
protection is available: full hood continuous protection and group
protection. Overlapping protection is in addition to appliance spe-
cific coverages.
Plenum: The space enclosed by the filters and the portion of the
hood above the filters.
Pre-engineered System: NFPA 17A defines a pre-engineered
system as one which has "...predetermined flow rates, nozzle
pressures, and quantities of liquid agent." The R-102 system, as
Prescribed by UL (Underwriter's Laboratories), has specific pipe
sizes, maximum and minimum pipe lengths and numbers of fit-
tings, and number and types of nozzles. The hazards protected
by this system are also specifically limited as to type and size by
UL based upon actual fire tests. All limitations on hazards that
can be protected and piping and nozzle configurations are con-
tained in the R-1 02 installation and maintenance manual which
is part of the UL listing.
R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual SECTION 1 -GENERAL INFORMATION
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
204-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 1-3
DEFINITION OF TERMS (Continued)
Pulley Elbow: A device used to change the direction of the wire
rope which runs between: the regulated release mechanism
and the detectors, the regulated release mechanism and the
mechanical gas valve, and/or the regulated release mechanism
and the remote manual pull station.
Pulley Tee: A device used to change the direction of two wire
ropes which run from a regulated release or a regulated actu-
ator to two remote manual pull stations, or from two regulated
releases or regulated actuators to a single mechanical gas valve
or from one regulated release or regulated actuator to two gas
valves.
Regulated Actuator Assembly: An assembly which contains
the regulator, pneumatic actuator, agent tank, and expellant gas
hose within a metal enclosure. This assembly is used to pressur-
ize additional agent tanks in a multiple tank system.
Regulated Release Mechanism: An enclosed device within
the AUTOMAN regulated release assembly which releases the
expellant gas, activates alarms, and/or shuts off other devices
when signaled automatically by a detector or manually with a
remote pull station.
Regulator: A device used to regulate the pressure from the
nitrogen cartridge into the agent tank(s) when the system is
actuated.
Remote Manual Pull Station: A device which provides manual
actuation of the system from a remote location.
Remote Mechanical Release: A device that provides actua-
tion gas, activates alarms, and/or shuts off other devices when
signaled automatically by a detector, or manually with a remote
pull station.
Salamander Broiler: A broiler very similar in design to the
upright broiler. A salamander broiler is used for general broiling
of meats and fish, toasting, and holding/warming foods. Most
contain a removable grease drip tray.
Series Detector: Any detector located in-line between the regu-
lated release assembly and the terminal detector.
Silicone Lubricant: A heat-resistant organic compound used to
lubricate 0-rings, rubber and mechanical components.
Supply Line: The agent distribution piping which extends from
the agent tank outlet and serves as a manifold for the branch
lines.
Terminal Detector: The last in a series of detectors, or the only
detector used in a single-detector system. This detector is thus
named because it is at the point at which the wire rope ends,
or "terminates." There is only one terminal detector per detection
system.
Transition: An extension of the hood or canopy which allows for
the smooth transmission of gases, air, and vapors between the
hood opening and the base of the ventilation duct.
Vent Plug: A device used to prevent pressure build-up within
the agent tank or agent distribution lines due to temperature
fluctuations.
SECTION 1 -GENERAL INFORMATION R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 1-4 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
NOTES:
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
TOTAL SYSTEM -
There are four types of R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression
Systems:
Single-tank System
Double-tank System
Three-tank System (1 Cartridge)
Multiple Tank System (Three Tanks or More - Multiple
Cartridges)
The type of system required for the particular installation will be
determined through the guidelines covered in "System Design."
Additional equipment which may be required to complete the
system design is explained in the "System Components" sec-
tion. Additional devices covered are: remote manual pull sta-
tions, mechanical and electrical gas shut-off valves, electrical
switches, and pressure switches.
Single-Tank System
The R-1 02 single-tank system is available with a stainless steel
enclosure and consists of:
AUTOMAN Regulated Release Assembly (Electrical or
Mechanical)
Nitrogen Cartridge and/or Carbon Dioxide Cartridge
ANSULEX Low pH Liquid Fire Suppressant
Discharge Nozzles
Detection Components
Additional Devices (As Required)
The regulated release assembly contains the regulated release
mechanism, agent tank, expellant gas hose for agent tank hook-
up, and enclosure knockouts to facilitate installing detection sys-
tem and additional equipment. Refer to "System Components"
section for individual component descriptions.
FIGURE 2-1
000133
SECTION 2 - SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 2-1
Double-Tank System
The R-102 double-tank system is available with stainless steel
enclosures and consists of:
AUTOMAN Regulated Release Assembly (Electrical or
Mechanical)
Nitrogen Cartridge and/or Carbon Dioxide Cartridge
ANSULEX Low pH Liquid Fire Suppressant
Enclosure or Bracket Assembly
Discharge Nozzles
Detection Components
Additional Devices (As Required)
The regulated release assembly contains the regulated release
mechanism, agent tank, expellant gas hose for agent tank
hookup, and enclosure knockouts to facilitate installing expellant
piping, detection system, and additional equipment.
The enclosure or bracket assembly is mounted separately but
within the guidelines of the regulated release assembly expellant
gas piping requirements to ensure simultaneous actuation of the
system. Refer to "System Components" section for individual
component descriptions.
FIGURE 2-2
008321
SECTION 2 -SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 2-2 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
TOTAL SYSTEM (Continued)
Three-Tank System (1 Cartridge with Three 3.0 Gal Tanks
ONLY)
The R-102 three-tank system is available with stainless steel
enclosures and consists of:
AUTOMAN Regulated Release Assembly (Electrical or
Mechanical)
Double Tank Enclosure Assembly
Nitrogen Cartridge
ANSULEX Low pH Liquid Fire Suppressant
Discharge Nozzles
Detection Components
Additional Devices (As Required)
The regulated release assembly contains the regulated release
mechanism, agent tank, expellant gas hose for agent tank
hookup, and enclosure knockouts to facilitate installing expellant
piping, detection system, and additional equipment.
The double tank enclosure assembly is mounted separately but
within the guidelines of the regulated release assembly expellant
gas piping requirements to ensure simultaneous actuation of the
system. Refer to "System Components" section for individual
component descriptions.
FIGURE 2-3
008322
R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
Multiple Tank System (Three Tanks or More - Multiple
Cartridges)
The R-102 multiple-tank system is available with stainless steel
enclosures and consists of:
AUTOMAN Regulated Release Assembly
(Electrical or Mechanical) or AUTOMAN Remote Release
Assembly(ies)
Nitrogen Cartridge(s) and/or Carbon Dioxide Cartridge(s)
Regulated Actuator Assembly(ies)
ANSULEX Low pH Liquid Fire Suppressant
Enclosure or Bracket Assembly(ies)
Discharge Nozzles
Detection Components
Additional Devices (As Required)
The regulated release assembly contains the regulated release
mechanism, agent tank, expellant gas hose for agent tank
hookup, and enclosure knockouts to facilitate installing actua-
tion piping, expellant piping, detection system, and additional
equipment.
The remote release assembly(ies) is used in large systems or
multi-hood systems to actuate regulated actuator assembly(ies)
ONLY. The remote release assembly contains a release mecha-
nism (unregulated), with enclosure knockouts to facilitate install-
ing the actuation piping, expellant piping, detection system, and
additional equipment.
Each regulated actuator assembly is mounted separately but
within the guidelines of the regulated release assembly actua-
tion/expellant gas piping requirements to ensure simultaneous
actuation of the system. The assembly contains the pneumatic
actuator, regulator, agent tank, expellant gas hose for agent
tank hookup, and enclosure plugs to facilitate installing expellant
piping.
Each enclosure or bracket assembly is mounted separately but
within the guidelines of the regulated release assembly or reg-
ulated actuator assembly expellant gas piping requirements to
ensure simultaneous actuation of the system. Refer to "System
Components" section for individual component descriptions.
FIGURE 2-4
008323
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual SECTION 3— SYSTEM COMPONENTS
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 3-1
EXTINGUISHING AGENT
ANSULEX Low pH Liquid Fire Suppressant (1.5 gallon - Part
No. 79694 or 3.0 gallon - Part No. 79372) is a potassium-based
solution designed for fast knock-down and suppression of
grease-related fires. The agent is shipped in plastic containers
which provide one complete tank charge. (Refer to Section V,
Page 5-2.1, for maximum agent fill capacity.) Agent storage life
expectancy is twelve years and can be stored at a temperature of
—40 OF to 130 OF (-40 °C to 54°C). Note: When installing agent
in R-102 system, temperature range is 32 OF (0 °C) to 130 OF
(54 °C). The distributor must record the batch numbers and date
of shipment receipt to be filed with each installation record.
"ANSULEX" LOW pH LIQUID FIRE SUPPRESSANT
3.0 GALLON 1.5 GALLON
SHIPPING WT. 35 LB (15.9 kg) SHIPPING WT. 19 LB (8.6 kg)
000136 000137
FIGURE 3-1
REGULATED RELEASE ASSEMBLY (MECHANICAL)
The AUTOMAN Regulated Mechanical Release Assembly (Part
No. 429853) contains the regulated release mechanism, expel-
lant gas hose for agent tank hookup, and enclosure knockouts
to facilitate installing actuation piping; expellant piping; detec-
tion System; and additional equipment. This regulated release
assembly is used in single, double, and multiple-tank systems
and must be mounted to a rigid surface. The release mecha-
nism can be used to interconnect both the actuation and expel-
lant gas lines as required per system design. The regulator is
designed to allow a constant flow of gas into the tank at 110 psi
(7.6 bar) when the system is actuated. The agent tank must be
ordered separately.
In single, double, and multiple-tank systems, the provided
expellant gas hose connects the agent tank to the bottom outlet
of the regulator. In double and multiple-tank system configura-
tions, the back outlet of the regulator is used as an expellant
gas feed for one additional tank-enclosure or tank-bracket
hookup. The enclosure contains the required knockouts to
facilitate this connection. If a pressure switch is to be attached
to the regulator, additional fittings are required.
The tank is mounted within the enclosure. The tank contains
an adaptor/tube assembly with a burst disc union. The burst
disc helps prevent siphoning of the agent up the pipe due to
significant temperature fluctuations in the area where the tank
is located. The tank is stainless steel and, under normal condi-
tions, requires hydrostatic testing every twelve years.
The detection and additional equipment required per system
design are connected to the release mechanism. The enclosure
contains knockouts to facilitate detection and additional hookups.
The system can be actuated automatically or manually.
Automatic actuation occurs when a fusible link within the detec-
tion system separates in a fire condition. Manual actuation of
the system occurs when personnel pull on the remote manual
pull station pull ring.
AUTOMAN REGULATED RELEASE ASSEMBLY
(MECHANICAL)
NOTE: AGENT TANK MUST BE
ORDERED SEPARATELY
(SEE PAGE 3-3)
JOZ , I I 116
SHIPPING WI. 20.9 LB (9.5 kg)
FIGURE 3-2
009,454
REGULATED RELEASE ASSEMBLY (ELECTRICAL)
The AUTOMAN Regulated Electrical Release Assembly (Part
No. 429856) is identical to the mechanical version except it also
contains a factory installed 120 VAC solenoid and electrical
switch.
The solenoid is used to provide electrical actuation of the
release mechanism. The electric switch is used to, protect the
solenoid by opening the circuit to the solenoid once the system
is fired. Additional electrical switches can be added as required
for automatic equipment and gas shut-off accessories, as well
as initiating audible and visual alarms.
AUTOMAN REGULATED RELEASE ASSEMBLY
(ELECTRICAL)*
NOTE: AGENT TANK MUST SHIPPING WT. 22.1 LB (10.0 kg) BE ORDERED
SEPARATELY
(SEE PAGE 3-3)
TOR
-- . SWITCH
r"_._1""
SOLENOID
FIGURE 3-3
009455
* Note: AUTOMAN Regulated Electrical Release (Part No. 429856) is not intend-
ed to be used with electric detection.
SECTION 3 - SYSTEM COMPONENTS
UL EX3476 ULC EX3470
PAGE 3-2 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
REMOTE MECHANICAL RELEASE
The Remote Mechanical Release (Part No. 433485) is used
to actuate up to five R-102 regulated actuators. The remote
mechanical release utilizes a 101-10 carbon dioxide cartridge
as the actuation pressure to operate the regulated actuators.
The release is housed in a stainless steel enclosure.
Also available is an OEM Remote Release/Bracket Assembly
(Part No. 439946). The OEM Remote Release/Bracket contains
the same release mechanism as the standard Remote Release,
and must be installed in a suitable equipment enclosure either
horizontally or vertically. The remote release contains all the
necessary mounting and conduit holes needed to fully install
the assembly. Note: OEM Release/Bracket Assembly must be
installed high enough in cabinet so that there is sufficient room
to install and remove cartridge.
RELEASE
MECHANIS
SHIPPING WEIC
14.4 LB (6.5 kg)
R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
SINGLE TANK ENCLOSURE ASSEMBLY
The Single Tank Enclosure Assembly (Part No. 429870) is used
in double and multiple-tank systems and must be mounted to
a rigid surface near the regulated release or regulated actuator
assembly its expellent gas line will be connected to.
The enclosure is designed for mounting either a 1.5 gallon (Part
No. 429864) or a 3.0 gallon tank (Part No. 429862) in a mini-
mum amount of space.
ENCLOSURE ASSEMBLY
NOTE: AGENT TANK MUST
BE ORDERED
SEPARATELY
ni
(SEE PAGE 3-3)
MOUNTING
ENCLOSURE
SHIPPING WT.
13 LB (5.9 kg)
FIGURE 3-5
000142
RED PAINTED BRACKET ASSEMBLY
FIGURE 3-4 The Bracket Assembly (Part No. 429878) is used in double and
009456 multiple-tank systems and must be mounted to a rigid surface
near the regulated release assembly or regulated actuator
assembly that its expellant gas line will be connected to.
The tank bracket is constructed of mild steel and painted red.
It is designed for mounting the tank in a minimum amount of
space. The Bracket Assembly can only be utilized with 3.0 gal-
lon tanks (Part No. 429862).
BRACKET ASSEMBLY
MOUNTING
BRACKET
SHIPPING WT. 7 LB (3.2 kg)
FIGURE 3-6
000141
NOTE: AGENT TANK
MUST BE
ORDERED
SEPARATELY
(SEE PAGE 3-3)
PNEUMATIC
ACTUATOR
ASSEMBLY
REGULATOR
ING WT.
(8.6 kg)
FIGURE 3-7 .
000143
RELEASE
MECHANISM
REGULO
REGULATED ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY
MOUNTING
BRACKET
FIGURE 3-9
009457
HIPPING WT.
13 LB (4.2 kg)
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
REGULATED ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY
The Regulated Actuator Assembly (Part No. 429850) contains the
regulator, pneumatic actuator, expellant gas hose for agent tank
hookup, and enclosure knockouts to facilitate installing expellant
piping. This assembly is used in multiple-tank systems and must
be mounted to a rigid surface.
The regulator contains two outlets 1 350 apart. One outlet is
used to interconnect the expellant gas hose to the enclosed
agent tank. The other outlet connects an expellant gas line to
an additional enclosure or bracket assembly. The regulator is
designed to allow a constant flow of expellant gas into each
agent tank at 110 psi (7.6 bar).
The pneumatic actuator is designed to puncture the expellant
gas cartridge seal upon receiving pressure from the regulated
release assembly actuation piping. The enclosure contains a
knockout to facilitate distribution piping hookup.
SECTION 3— SYSTEM COMPONENTS
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 3-3
OEM RELEASE/BRACKET ASSEMBLY
(FOR OEM IN-CABINET USE ONLY)
The OEM Regulated Mechanical Release/Bracket Assembly
(Part No. 79493) contains the same regulated release mecha-
nism as the standard AUTOMAN Regulated Release Assembly.
The OEM Regulated Electrical Release/Bracket Assembly (Part
No. 4373241, is identical to the mechanical version except that
it contains a factory installed 120 VAC solenoid and electrical
switch. These release/bracket assemblies must be installed in
a suitable equipment enclosure either horizontally or vertically.
They contain all the necessary mounting and conduit holes
needed to fully install the assembly. The agent tank is installed
separately and need not be bracketed once it is piped and filled.
Note: OEM Release/Bracket Assembly must be installed high
enough in cabinet so that there is sufficient room to install and
remove cartridge.
Note: OEM Regulated Electrical Release/Bracket Assembly (Part No. 437324) is
not intended to be used with electric detection.
AGENT TANK ASSEMBLY
The agent tank shipping assembly (3 Gallon (Part No. 429862)
and 1.5 Gallon (Part No. 429864)) consists of a stainless steel
tank and an adaptor/tube assembly. The adaptor/tube assem-
bly contains a burst disc. The burst disc prevents agent leakage
due to significant temperature fluctuations in the area where
the tank is located. Under normal conditions, the tank requires
hydrostatic testing every twelve years. The date of manufacture
is stamped on the tank nameplate.
The tank is shipped uncharged and must be filled with only
ANSULEX Low pH Liquid Fire Suppressant during installation.
(ADAPTOR!
ASSEMBLY
3 GALLON
SHIPPING WT.
7 LB (3.2 kg)
1.5 GALLON
SHIPPING WT.
5 LB (2.3 kg)
AGENT
TANK
FIGURE 3-8
000140
OEM REGULATED ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY
The OEM Regulated Actuator Assembly (Part No. 418691)
includes the regulator, pneumatic actuator, expellant gas hose
and OEM bracket. Also available is an OEM Regulated Actuator
Assembly with all the above mentioned components except for
the bracket. This assembly is Part No. 418522.
10
SHIPPING WT. 4 LB (1.8 kg)
FIGURE 3-10
002225
SECTION 3— SYSTEM COMPONENTS R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 3-4 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
TWO TANK ENCLOSURE ASSEMBLY ADDITIONAL SHIPPING ASSEMBLIES
The Two Tank Enclosure Assembly (Part No. 429872) consists
of two expellant gas hoses, two grommets, and the mounting
enclosure. The assembly is used in 9-gallon systems. It can be
coupled with a 3-gallon regulated release assembly or a 3-gal-
Ion regulated actuator assembly to give a total of 9 gal (34.1 L)
of agent. Agent tanks must be ordered separately.
The tank enclosure is designed to mount in a minimum amount
of space.
SHIPPING WT. 430300 1.5 Gallon Mechanical Release 30 (14)
26 LB (11.8 kg) Shipping Assembly including:
429853 Mechanical Regulated
Release Assembly
429864 1.5 Gallon Tank Assembly
430309 3.0 Gallon Regulated Actuator 36 (16)
Shipping Assembly including:
429850 Regulated Actuator Assembly
429862 3.0 Gallon Tank Assembly
The 24VDC Regulated Release Assembly (Part No. 429859) is
used where electric, thermostat detection is required via the use
of a releasing control unit. This assembly consists of a 24VDC
AUTOMAN Il-C regulated release mechanism, expellant gas
hose, and enclosure knockouts to facilitate installing actuation
piping, expellant piping, detection system, and additional equip-
ment. Agent tank must be ordered separately.
The system can be actuated automatically or manually.
Automatic actuation occurs when the control panel receives
a signal from the detection circuit. The panel then sends an
electrical signal to the 24VDC regulated release, causing it to
actuate. When actuation occurs, the gas cartridge is punctured,
pressurizing the agent tank and discharging the agent through
the distribution piping. Manual actuation of the system occurs
when personnel pull on the remote manual pull station pull ring.
NOTE: AGENT TANK MUST BE
ORDERED SEPARATELY
(SEE PAGE 3-3)
SHIPPING WT.
34 LB (15.4 kg)
430332 3.0 Gallon Mounting Bracket Shipping 20 (9)
Assembly including:
429878 3.0 Gallon Mounting Bracket
Assembly
429862 3.0 Gallon Tank Assembly
FIGURE 3-12
002279
Several complete shipping assemblies are available containing
both the release or actuator mechanism and the agent tank.
When ordering a complete shipping assembly, order the follow-
ing part numbers:
Shipping Wt.
Part No. Description lb (kg)
430299 3.0 Gallon Mechanical Release 33 (15)
Shipping Assembly including:
429853 Mechanical Regulated
Release Assembly
429862 3.0 Gallon Tank Assembly
FIGURE 3-11
002277
'24VDC REGULATED RELEASE ASSEMBLY
430316 1.5 Gallon Stainless Steel Enclosure 18 (8)
Shipping Assembly including:
429870 Single Tank Mounting Box
Assembly
429864 1.5 Gallon Tank Assembly
418511 Hose Assembly
430317 3.0 Gallon Stainless Steel Enclosure 20 (9)
Shipping Assembly including:
429870 Single Tank Mounting Box
Assembly
429862 3.0 Gallon Tank Assembly
418511 Hose Assembly
430324 6.0 Gallon Stainless Steel Enclosure 40 (18)
Shipping Assembly including:
429872 Two Tank Mounting Box
Assembly
429862 3.0 Gallon Tank Assembly (2)
R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual SECTION 3— SYSTEM COMPONENTS
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 3-5
GAS CARTRIDGES
The R-102 system uses gas cartridges to store nitrogen or
carbon dioxide expellant gases under pressure until the system
is actuated, at which time the cartridge seal is punctured and
the released gas expels liquid agent from one or more tanks
through the discharge piping and out the discharge nozzles.
Four nitrogen gas cartridges and three carbon dioxide gas car-
tridges are available as shown in Figure 13.
Cartridges noted as TC/DOT are both Transport Canada (TC)
and Department of Transportation (DOT) approved. Cartridges
noted as DOT are Department of Transportation approved only.
Cartridge selection options are provided in Section 4 under
Tank and Cartridge Requirements.
NITROGEN GAS CARTRIDGES
12114f
17 1/4 IN.
11 5/8 IN . 438mm)
7 7/8 N. (295 mm) (311m (200 mm)
tu
21/21N. 21/21N. 43/161N. 39/161N.
(64 mm) (64 mm) (106 mm) (90 mm)
LT-20-R LT-30-R DOUBLE-TANK LT-A-101-30 CARTRIDGE CARTRIDGE CARTRIDGE CARTRIDGE
000145 000146 000147 000148
CARBON DIOXIDE CARTRIDGES
11
gIN. 77/8 IN.
(200 m
(205 mm)
(229 mm)
2 IN. 2 1/2 IN. 2 1/2 IN. (51 mm) (64 mm) (64 mm)
101-10 CARTRIDGE 101-20 CARTRIDGE 101-30 CARTRIDGE 000149 000150 000151
FIGURE 3-13
Additional cartridge shipping assemblies are available for
European and Australian requirements.
Cartridge European Australian TC/DOT
Description Part No. Part No. Part No.
LT-20-R 428440 428948 423429
LT-30-R 428441 426553 423435
Double Tank 428446 426563 423493
LT-A-101-30 428442 426555 423491
101-10—0O2 428443 N/A 423439
101-20—CO2 428445 N/A 423441
101-30—0O2 428444 N/A 423443
Note: For 101-10 cartridge, Part No. 15850 is DOT only.
NOZZLES
There are 11 types of discharge nozzles each designed to
distribute the liquid agent in a uniform pattern throughout the
hazard area:
1. 1/2N Nozzle 7. 245 Nozzle
2. 1 Nozzle 8. 260 Nozzle
3. 1W Nozzle 9. 290 Nozzle
4. IN Nozzle 10. 2120 Nozzle
5. 2W Nozzle 11. 3N Nozzle
6. 230 Nozzle
Although these nozzles are similar in appearance and have
certain common parts, the tip of each nozzle is designed for a
specific application and must only be used in those areas. See
Nozzle Application Chart in Section 4 - System Design, for
individual nozzle usage. Nozzles are shipped with metal blow-
off caps included.
r 25 pack of Nozzle 0-rings (Part No. 439848) is also available.
3/8-18 NPT
FEMALE THREAD
NOZZLE
i 1I IDENTIFICATION
INTERNAL CUP
I STRAINER INSIDE
1fr2N*
1 4 SILICONE
0-RING
FIGURE 3-14
009474
Nozzle
Nozzle Nozzle Package Flow
Type Part No. Quantity No. Nozzle Material
1/2N Nozzle 439837 9 1/2 Chrome-Plated Body
1 F Nozzle 439836 9 1 Chrome-Plated Body
1W Nozzle* 439839 25 1 Chrome-Plated Body
1 N Nozzle* 439838 25 1 Chrome-Plated Body
2W Nozzle 439840 25 2 Chrome-Plated Body
230 Nozzle 439842 25 2 Chrome-Plated Body
245 Nozzle 439843 25 2 Chrome-Plated Body
260 Nozzle 439844 9 2 Chrome-Plated Body
290 Nozzle 439845 9 2 Chrome-Plated Body
2120 Nozzle 439846 9 2 Chrome-Plated Body
3N Nozzle 439841 9 3 Chrome-Plated Body
*Stainless steel versions are available in the 1W nozzle (Part No. 439864) and
the 1 nozzle (Part No. 439865).
SILICONE LUBRICANT
Dow Corning Compound 111 (Part No. 78112) is available in a
5.3-ounce tube. Compound has excellent qualities for sealing
and lubricating system components.
Nozzle Identification Chart
SECTION 3— SYSTEM COMPONENTS
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 3-6 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
SWIVEL ADAPTOR
The Swivel Adaptor Assembly consists of a swivel nut, swivel
body and swivel ball. All are chrome-plated. The swivel adaptor
allows any nozzle to be rotated approximately 300 in all direc-
tions. Swivel Adaptors must be ordered as a Swivel Adaptor
Shipping Assembly (Part No. 423572) which contains 25 Swivel
Adaptors or Part No. 419385, which contains 9 Swivel Adaptors.
318-18 NPT
FEMALE THREAD
3/8-18 NPT
MALE THREAD
30 DEGREE
ROTATION
FIGURE 3-15
000003
METAL BLOW-OFF CAP
The Metal Blow-Off Cap helps keep the orifice of the nozzle free
of grease or other substances that could interfere with agent
distribution.
The Metal Blow-Off Cap Package (Part No. 439861) contains
10 blow-off caps.
Also available is a 10 pack of Stainless Steel Blow-Off Caps
(Part No. 439866).
METAL AP
STAINLESS
STEEL WIRE
FIGURE 3-16
009475
REDUCING COUPLING
The reducing coupling (Part No. 436228) is made of stainless
steel material with 3/8 in. x 1/2 in. NPT inlet threads. If neces-
sary, the reducing coupling can be utilized when installing the
Agent Distribution Hose Line Kit (Part No. 435982). Two cou-
plings are required per Agent Distribution Hose.
1/41N. I
(6 mm)
M-6 t
1 3/16 IN.
mm)
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
CONDUIT OFFSET ASSEMBLY
The conduit offset assembly (Part No. 435961) is used to
change direction of the wire rope on detection, mechanical gas
valve, and remote pull station lines. The conduit offset assem-
bly can only be used in the area where the conduit attaches to
the regulated release assembly. When using the conduit offset
assembly, the maximum number of pulley elbows allowed is
16. The Conduit Offset Shipping Assembly (Part No. 436063)
consists of 6 conduit offsets.
CONDUIT
COUPLING
CONDUIT
OFFSET
CONDUIT
CONNECT
FIGURE 3-18
000153
"QUIK-SEAL" ADAPTOR
The "Quik-Seal" adaptor is a listed mechanical bulkhead fitting
that produces a liquid-tight seal around both distribution piping
and detection conduit which runs through restaurant hoods and
ducts. The "Quik-Seal" adaptor accepts threaded pipe or con-
duit. The adaptor is available for 1/4 in. (Part No. 78196), 3/8 in.
(Part No. 77285), 1/2 in. (Part No. 77287), or 3/4 in. (Part No.
77289) pipe or conduit sizes. When using with EMT conduit, a
conduit connector must be installed in each end of the adaptor.
The "Quik-Seal" Adaptor Shipping Assembly must be ordered
as stated below:
Shipping
Assembly Hole Size
Size Part No. oty. Required
1/4 in. 78196 24 3/4 in.
3/8 in. 77285 24 11/8 in.
1/2 in. 77287 24 11/8 in.
3/4 in. 77289 24 1 3/8 in.
ADAPTOR BODY
L GASKET
LOCKWASHER
NUT
FIGURE 3-19
000154
FIGURE 3-17
R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
"COMPRESSION-SEAL" ADAPTOR
This adaptor is a mechanical bulkhead fitting that produces a
liquid-tight seal around pipe and conduit when installing distribu-
tion piping and detection conduit through restaurant hoods and
ducts. The "Compression-Seal" adaptor is a straight-through
design requiring no cutting or threading of conduit or pipe. The
adaptor is available for pipe sizes of 1/4 in. (Part No. 79149),
3/8 in. (Part No. 79151), 1/2 in. (Part No. 79147), and EMT con-
duit size of 1/2 in. (Part No. 79153). Each "Compression-Seal"
Adaptor Shipping Assembly must be ordered as stated below:
Shipping
Assembly Hole Size
Size Part No. Qty. Required
1/4 in. Pipe/1/2 in. tube 79149 24 3/4 in.
3/8 in. Pipe /5/8 in. tube 79151 24 11/8in.
1/2 in. Pipe 79147 24 1 1/8 in.
1/2 in. EMT Conduit 79153 24 1 1/8 in.
GASKET
NUT
COMPRESSION NUT
ADAPTOR BODY
LOCK WASHER
FIGURE 3-20
000155
"HOOD SEAL" ADAPTOR ASSEMBLY
This adaptor is a mechanical bulkhead fitting that produces a
liquid-tight seal around 1/2 in. EMT conduit when installing the
detection line through restaurant hoods and duct. The adap-
tor accepts a high temperature pulley elbow and, when used,
correctly positions the elbow or conduit in line with the conduit
adaptor hole in the detector bracket. The "Hood Seal" elimi-
nates the need for multiple elbows when penetrating the top of
a hood when installing the detection line. "Hood Seal" Adaptors
are available in quantities of six as Shipping Assembly Part No.
423253.
SEAL NUT
SECTION 3 - SYSTEM COMPONENTS
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 3-7
COCKING LEVER/LOCK PIN
The cocking lever is a component required to cock (arm) both
the mechanical/electrical AUTOMAN release and the mech-
anical gas valve. After the AUTOMAN is cocked (armed), the
i. lock pin must be inserted to eliminate the accidental firing of
the release mechanism. These components are available as
either an individual shipping assembly or a shipping assembly
containing both. Listed below are the various shipping assem-
bly part numbers.
Part No. Description
441042 Short Handle Cocking Lever with Lock Pin
(Mechanical/Electrical AUTOMAN)
441041 Long Handle Cocking Lever with Lock Pin
(Mechanical/Electrical AUTOMAN)
26310 Cocking Lever only (AUTOMAN Il-C)
416018 Cocking Lever only (Mechanical Gas Valve)
438031 Lock Pin
Short Handle Cocking Lever
Long Handle Cocking Lever
*Requires a crescent wrench or
open end/box wrench
SEAL ______ ___
ADAPTOR.
LILL-W d, WASHER
BODY i.E
GASKET
PULLEY
ELBOW
(NOT PART
OF ASSEMBLY)
P. Lock Pin
USE ONLY PULLEY ELBOW, PART NO. 423250 FIGURE 3-21
000156
FIGURE 3-22
008325
SECTION 3 - SYSTEM COMPONENTS
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 3-8 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
DETECTORS
The detector consists of three basic components: the bracket,
linkage, and fusible link. (Fusible links are not included and must
be ordered separately.) The bracket holds the entire assembly
to the mounting surface. The linkage is used to support the
fusible link. The fusible link is designed to separate at a specific
temperature and release the wire rope, thereby actuating the
regulated release mechanism.
The scissor style detector allows the wire rope to be strung com-
pletely through the detection system conduit and brackets first
and the detector linkage assemblies are then clipped on later.
The detector consists of two types of assemblies:
The Terminal Detector (Part No. 435546) includes a test link
and is placed last in a series of detectors. This detector is some-
times referred to as the end-of-line detector and is thus named
because it is at the point at which the wire rope "terminates," or
is anchored at the detector bracket. Only one terminal detector
is required per detection system.
The Series Detector (Part No. 435547) is any detector located
in-line between the regulated release assembly and the terminal
detector.
When using Part No. 435546 and 435547 detectors, a total of
15 detectors can be in one detection system: 14 series detectors
(Part No. 435547) and 1 terminal detector (Part No. 435546).
Note 1: Series Detector (Part No. 435547) is also available as
Part No. 435548, 25/Pkg.
Note 2: Scissor-style linkage is also available in a 10-Pack (Part
No. 439515).
BRACKET
LINKAGE /ON 11/
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
PULLEY ELBOWS
There are two types of pulley elbows used to change the
direction of the wire rope by 900. ANSUL recommends for tem-
peratures not in excess of 700 OF (371 °C). Part No. 415670
has socket ends with set screws for 1/2 in. conduit, and Part
No. 423250 has compression ring ends also for 1/2 in. conduit.
Pulley elbows must be ordered in quantities of 50 as Shipping
Assembly Part No. 415671 (socket end type) and Part No.
423251 (compression end type).
PART NO. 415670 PART NO. 423250
FIGURE 3-24
000160/000161
PULLEY TEE
The Pulley Tee (Part No. 427929) is used to change the direc-
tion of two wire ropes by 909. It must be used in areas where
the temperatures are within the range of 32 OF to 130 OF (0 °C
to 54 °C). Pulley tees can be used in mechanical gas valve
actuation lines and remote manual pull station lines. Pulley tees
cannot be used within a detection line.
FIGURE 3-25 FUSIBLE 000447 LINK -
ANSUL STAINLESS STEEL CABLE
FIGURE 3-23 The 1/16 in. stainless steel cable is run from the terminal detec-
000159 tor, through conduit, all series detectors and pulley elbows,
and into the regulated release mechanism trip lever. When any
fusible link separates, the tension on the cable is relaxed, and
the trip lever actuates the regulated release mechanism. The
cable can also be used for mechanical gas valves and remote
manual pull stations. The cable is available in 50 ft (15.2 m)
(Part No. 1582 1) and 500 ft (152.4 m) (Part No. 79653) lengths.
'The ANSUL stainless steel cable contains a blue tracer cable.
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
REMOTE MANUAL PULL STATION
The remote manual pull station (Part No. 434618 or 435960)
is made out of a molded red composite material. The red color
makes the pull station more readily identifiable as the manual
means for fire suppression system operation. The pull station
is compatible with the ANSUL Flexible Conduit. The molded
manual pull station should be mounted at a point of egress
and positioned at a height determined by the authority having
jurisdiction. Trim Rings (Part No. 427074) (pack of 10), are
available.
Part No. 434618 (Without Wire Rope)
Part No. 435960 (With 50 ft (15.2 m) of Wire Rope)
FIGURE 3-26
008326
FLEXIBLE CONDUIT
Flexible conduit allows for quicker installations and the conve-
nience of being able to route the cable over, under and around
obstacles. Flexible conduit can be used as a substitute for stan-
dard EMT conduit or can be used with EMT conduit. Flexible
conduit can be used only with the Molded Manual Pull Station
(Part No. 434618) and mechanical gas valve installations. The
Flexible Conduit comes in a 500 ft (152.4 m) length (Part No.
434525) or together with 500 ft (152.4 m) of wire rope (Part No.
435959).
A 50 ft (15.2 m) Flexible Conduit pre-fed with wire rope (Part
No. 439104) is available.
Also available is a Flexible Conduit Strain Relief (50-pack) (Part
No. 435979).
A 50-pack of Flexible Conduit Inserts (Part No. 434347) and a
50-pack of P-Clips (Part No. 436150) are also available.
Note 1: Flexible conduit is intended for indoor use ONLY
Note 2: Flexible conduit cannot be used in detection sys-
tems.
SECTION 3- SYSTEM COMPONENTS
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 3-9
MECHANICAL GAS VALVES
The mechanical gas valves are designed to shut off the flow of
gas to the appliances upon actuation of the regulated release
assembly. The valves are available in sizes of 3/4 in., 1 in., 1
1/4 in., 1 1/2 in., and 2 in. ANSUL style; and 2 1/2 in. and 3 in.
ASCO style. The valves are rated for natural and LP gas. Both
styles are UL Listed and includes the air cylinder, tubing, and
fittings (Part No. 15733) for connection to the release mecha-
nism.
Maximum
Part Operating
No. Description Pressure
55598 3/4 in. Gas Valve (ANSUL) 10 psi (0.69 bar)
55601 1 in. Gas Valve (ANSUL) 10 psi (0.69 bar)
55604 1 1/4 in. Gas Valve (ANSUL) 10 psi (0.69 bar)
55607 1 1/2 in. Gas Valve (ANSUL) 10 psi (0.69 bar)
55610 2 in. Gas Valve (ANSUL) 10 psi (0.69 bar)
25937 2 1/2 in. Gas Valve (ASCO) 5 psi (0.35 bar)
25938 3 in. Gas Valve (ASCO) 5 psi (0.35 bar)
Flow Capacity BTU/HR, at 1 in. P.D.
(CFH) 0.64 SP GR
Pipe Size P.D. 1 in. WC 1000 BTU/ft3
(inches) 0.64 SP GR Natural Gas
3/4 751 751,000
1 1288 1,288,000
11/4 1718 1,718,000
1 1/2 2630 2,630,000
2 4616 4,616,000
21/2 5700 5,800,000
3 7100 7,300,000
To calculate gas flow for other than 1 inch p.d.:
New cfh = (cfh at 1 inch) x new p.d.
To calculate gas flow for other than 0.64 SP GR:
New cfh = (cfh at 0.64) x /T.6217-
New SP GR
A B C
Valve Size in. (mm) in. (mm) in. (mm)
3/4 in. 33/4 (95.3) 63/8 (161.9) 51/2 (139.7)
1 in. 33/4 (95.3) 63/8 (161.9) 51/2 (139.7)
11/4 in. 47/8 (123.8) 73/8 (187.3) 63/8 (161.9)
11/2 in. 47/8 (123.8) 73/8 (187.3) 63/8 (161.9)
2in. 57/8 (149.2) 77/8 (200.0) 6 11/16(169.9)
2 1/2 in. 713/16 (198.4) 9 1/16 (230.2)
3m. 725/32 (197.6) 9 1/16 (230.2)
3/4 IN. THRU 2 IN.
004208
2 1/2 IN. THRU 3 IN.
004209
FIGURE 3-27
SECTION 3 - SYSTEM COMPONENTS
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 3-10 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
ELECTRICAL GAS VALVES
The electrical gas valves are designed to shut off the flow of
either natural or LP gas to the appliances upon actuation of
the regulated release assembly. The valves are available in
sizes of 3/4 in., 1 in., 1 1/4 in., 1 1/2 in., 2 in., 2 1/2 in., and 3
in. The valve is held open by an energized solenoid and upon
system actuation, the switch contacts in the regulated release
assembly open, thus de-energizing the circuit to the gas valve
solenoid, causing the valve to close. Valves are available in 120
VAC and are UL Listed.
Part Max. Operating
No. Description Pressure
13707 3/4 in. Solenoid Gas Valve (ASCO) 25 psi (1.7 bar)
13708 1 in. Solenoid Gas Valve (ASCO) 25 psi (1.7 bar)
550360 1 1/4 in. Solenoid Gas Valve (ASCO) 25 psi (1.7 bar)
13709 1 1/2 in. Solenoid Gas Valve (ASCO) 25 psi (1.7 bar)
13710 2 in. Solenoid Gas Valve (ASCO) 25 psi (1.7 bar)
550363 2 1/2 in. Solenoid Gas Valve (ASCO) 5 psi (0.3 bar)
17643 3 in. Solenoid Gas Valve (ASCO) 5 psi (0.3 bar)
Flow Capacity BTU/HR, at .1 in. P.D.
(CFH) 0.64 SP GR
Pipe Size P.D. 1 in. WC 1000 BTU/ft
(inches) 0.64 SP GR Natural Gas
3/4 264.96 247,500
1 1091.01 1,119,000
11/4 1662.49 1,730,000
11/2 1818.35 1,900,000
2 3117.18 3,251,000
21/2 6078.49 5,821,000
3 7169.51 7,430,000
To calculate gas flow for other than 1 inch p.d.:
New cfh = (cfh at 1 inch) x new p.d.
To calculate gas flow for other than 0.64 SP GR:
New cfh = (cfh at 0.64) x J 0.64
New SP GR
Valve A B
Size in. (mm) in. (mm)
3/4 in. 35/16 (81) 35/8 (92)
1 in. 5 (127) 627/32 (174)
11/4 in. 713/16 (198) 729/32 (201)
1 1/2 in. 5 (127) 519/32 (142)
2in. 63/32 (155) 515/16 (151)
2 1/2 in. 713/16 (198) 729/32 (201)
3in. 713/16 (198) 729/32 (201)
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
MANUAL RESET RELAY
The Manual Reset Relay (Part No. 426151) is required when
using an electrical gas valve shut-off system. After the electric
gas valve has closed, either due to system actuation or power
failure, the valve cannot be re-opened, allowing gas to flow,
until the reset relay button is manually pressed, re-energizing
the circuit. The reset relay is available 120 VAC. The manual
reset relay is also recommended for electrical shut down.
FIGURE 3-29
000087
ELECTRICAL SWITCHES
The electrical switches are intended for use with electric gas
valves, alarms, contactors, lights, contractor supplied electric
power shut-off devices and other electrical devices that are
designed to shut off or turn on when the system is actuated.
Switches are available in kits: One Switch Kit (Part No. 423878),
Two Switch Kit (Part No. 423879), Three Switch Kit (Part No.
423880), and Four Switch Kit (Part No. 423881). Mounting
hardware and 24 in. (610 mm) long wire leads are provided with
each kit. A Two-Switch Assembly without wire leads (Part No.
436770) is also available. Each switch has a set of single-pole,
double-throw contacts rated at:
ULIcULICSA Rating ENEC Rating
250 VAC, 21A Resistive lE4T105p Approved
250 VAC, 2 HP 250V, 21A Resistive
125 VAC, 1 HP 8A Motor Load
FIGURE 3-30
001612
FIGURE 3-28
004210
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
ALARM INITIATING SWITCH
The Alarm Initiating Switch Kit (Part No. 428311) can be field
mounted within the AUTOMAN release. This switch must be
used to close a supervised alarm circuit to the building main fire
alarm panel when the AUTOMAN release actuates. This action
will signal the fire alarm panel that there was a system actua-
tion in the kitchen area. The switch kit contains all necessary
mounting components along with a mounting instruction sheet.
The switch is rated 50 mA, 28 VDC.
FIGURE 3-31
004890
REGULATOR TEST KIT
The Test Kit Assembly (Shipping Part No. 56972) is required
to test the regulator setting and nitrogen flow during 12-year
maintenance examinations. This will ensure that the regulator
is functioning properly.
SECTION 3— SYSTEM COMPONENTS
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 3-11
FUSIBLE LINK
Select correct UL Listed fusible link(s) for installation in detec-
tor(s) according to the temperature condition chart below:
SL STYLE
To Be Used
Where
Temperature Color
Temperature Does Not of
Rating Exceed Link
165°F 100°F Black
(74 °C) (38 °C)
212°F 150°F White
(100°C) (66°C)
280 OF 225 OF Blue
(138°C) (107°C)
360°F 290°F Red
(182°C) (143°C)
450 OF 360 OF Green
(232°C) (182°C)
A-PC STYLE
Fusible Link To Be Used
Shipping Where
Assembly Temperature Temperature
Part No. Rating Does Not Exceed
439227 (10) 165 OF (74 °C) 100 OF (38 °C)
439228 (10) 212 OF (100 °C) 150 OF (66 °C)
439229 (10) 280°F (138 °C) 225 OF (107 °C)
439230 (10) 360°F (182 °C) 290°F (143 °C)
439231 (10) 450 OF (232 °C) 360°F (182 °C)
439232 (25) 500 OF (260 °C) 400 OF (204 °C)
P~~
ALARM
INITIATING
SWITCH
Fusible Link
Shipping
Assembly
Part No.
439085 (25)
439086 (25)
439087 (25)
439088 (25)
439089 (25)
0 4NSUL.
01
Ed IN
1-410PIA
TEMPERATURE
RATING STAMPED ON
FUSIBLE LINK BODY
41, ~==A
FIGURE 3-32
000169
rVENT PLUG ASSEMBLY
The Vent Plug Assembly (Part No. 74274) is installed on the
agent tank adaptor to prevent pressure buildup within the agent
tank or distribution lines due to temperature fluctuations.
CARTRIDGE RECEIVER GASKET
The Cartridge Receiver Gasket (Part No. 181) is installed in the
release and actuator assembly cartridge receiver to create a
seal between the cartridge receiver assembly and the cartridge.
The Hose/Grommet Package (Part No. 418511) consists of a
24 in. rubber hose and two grommets. This package is required
when expellant gas hose is routed outside the AUTOMAN
Regulated Release, Regulated Actuator, and/or tank enclosure
assemblies.
SL STYLE A-PC STYLE
000170 000171
FIGURE 3-33
MAXIMUM REGISTERING THERMOMETER
The Maximum Registering Thermometer (Part No. 15240) may
be used to indicate the highest normal temperature for the pro-
tected area. Once this is established, the correct rated fusible
link can be chosen. Other methods for determining maximum
temperatures may be used.
HOSE/GROMMET PACKAGE
FIGURE 3-34
008383
RED SIDE 01
DISC TO BE
ADAPTOR (PART NO. 417707)
SECTION 3 - SYSTEM COMPONENTS
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 3-12 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
IN-LINE BURST DISC ASSEMBLY (MANIFOLDED
SYSTEMS ONLY)
The in-line burst disc assembly is required to eliminate the
siphoning of the agent up the pipe during extreme temperature
variations. In addition to eliminating the siphoning effect, the
common in-line burst disc assembly eliminates the possibility
of one or more individual discs located in the tank adaptor from
failing to burst. The assembly consists of a stainless steel body
which houses the burst disc. When utilizing this assembly in a
manifolded system, it is necessary to modify (remove) the burst
disc located in all of the R-1 02 tank adaptors in the system. The
in-line burst disc assembly is to be mounted as close to the tank
outlet as possible. After system discharge, the assembly must
be disassembled and a new burst disc installed.
Part No. Description
416970 In-Line Burst Disc Assembly
417911 Burst Disc (Pack of 10)
1/4 IN. CHECK VALVE
The 1/4 in. check valve (Part No. 25627) blocks the flow of
actuation gas from the actuator that was actuated to the actu-
ator(s) that was not actuated. This prevents actuation gas from
escaping from an open actuator which may have had the car-
tridge removed.
CHECK VALVE (PART NO. 25627)
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
NOZZLE AIMING DEVICE
The Nozzle Aiming Device (Part No. 439877) is available to
properly aim each nozzle to the correct aiming point. The device
clamps to the nozzle and emits a small laser light that reflects on
the surface that it is aiming at. The nozzle can then be rotated to
point at a predetermined aiming point and then tightened to hold
that angle. The aiming device adaptor attaches to the nozzle.
The shipping assembly consists of the aiming device and the
adaptor.
ADAPTOR
. (PART NO 439876)
NOZZLE
AIMING
DEVICE
(PART NO. 551265) FIGURE 3-36
006520
STAINLESS STEEL BRAIDED ACTUATION HOSE
The Stainless Steel Actuation Hose is used to connect the actu-
ation line compression tees between each pneumatic actuator.
The hose has the same thread, 7/16-20, as the fittings. The
actuation hose allows flexibility between the AUTOMAN and
each regulated actuator.
Hose
Part No. Length Couplings
31809 16 in. (406 mm) 7/16-20 x 7/16-20 Females
32335 20 in. (508 mm) 7/16-20 x 7/16-20 Females
32336 24 in. (610 mm) 7/16-20 x 7/16-20 Females
430815 42 in. (1067 mm) 7/16-20 Female x 1/4 in. NPT
Male
Fitting
Part No. Description
31810 Male Elbow (7/16-20 x 1/4 in. NPT)
31811 Male Tee (7/16-20 x 7/16-20 x 1/4 in. NPT)
415371 Tee (7/16-20 x 1/8 in. Male NPT x 1/8 in. Female NPT)
32338 Male Straight Connector (7/16-20 x 1/4 in. NPT)
25627 1/4 in. Check Valve
7/16-20 7/16-20 FIGURE 3-37
000433
AGENT DISTRIBUTION HOSE AND RESTRAINING CABLE
KIT
The Agent Distribution Hose and Restraining Cable Kit (Part
No. 435982) consists of a 5 ft (1.5 m) long Agent Distribution
Hose, a 3 ft (0.9 m) long Restraining Cable, and a Restraining
Cable Hardware Package. The Agent Distribution Hose can be
utilized with castered cooking appliances with castered sup-
ports found in commercial kitchens. The hose allows for move-
ment of the appliance for cleaning without having to disconnect
any fire suppression system discharge piping.
FIGURE 3-35 i 000899 Note: The Agent Distribution Hose s authorized for use with
only UL Listed ANSUL Wet Chemical Restaurant Fire Suppres-
sion Systems.
1/4 IN. NPT
(6 mm) 2 IN.
(51 mm)
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
SYSTEM DESIGN
The ANSUL R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression System maybe
used on a number of different types of restaurant cooking appli-
ances and hood and duct configurations. The design information
listed in this section deals with the limitations and parameters
of this pre-engineered system. Those individuals responsible
for the design of the R-102 system must be trained and hold a
current ANSUL certificate in an R-102 training program.
The R-102 and the PIRANHA systems use compatible agents
and components, therefore, they may be used together for
cooking appliance, hood, and duct protection. The primary
AUTOMAN Release can be either an R-102 or a PIRANHA
AUTOMAN Release and can actuate up to two additional R-102
or PIRANHA Regulated Actuators. In systems utilizing a 101
remote release, any combination of the maximum number of
regulated actuators can be used.
Both systems must actuate simultaneously.
Each system must be designed and installed per its appropri-
ate manual.
Adjacent appliances requiring protection must be protected
with the same type of system, either R-102 or PIRANHA,
unless the center-to-center spacing between the adjacent
R-102 and PIRANHA nozzles is no less than 36 in. (914 mm).
When appliances are protected with R-102 nozzles, the
hood and connecting duct above those appliances cannot be
protected with PIRANHA nozzles.
Mixing systems in a common plenum is not allowed.
One of the key elements for restaurant fire protection is a correct
system design. This section is divided into 10 sub-sections:
Nozzle Placement Requirements, Tank Quantity Requirements,
Actuation and Expellant Gas Line Requirements, Distribution
Piping Requirements, Detection System Requirements,
Manual Pull Station Requirements, Mechanical Gas Valve
Requirements, Electrical Gas Valve Requirements, Electrical
Switch Requirements, and Pressure Switch Requirements.
Each of these sections must be completed before attempting
any installation. System design sketches should be made of all
aspects of design for reference during installation.
NOZZLE PLACEMENT REQUIREMENTS
This section gives guidelines for nozzle type, positioning, and
quantity for duct, plenum, and individual appliance protection.
This section must be completed before determining tank quan-
tity and piping requirements.
Duct Protection - Single Nozzle
All duct protection is UL listed without limitation of maximum duct
length (unlimited length). This includes all varieties of ductworks
both horizontal and vertical including ducts that run at angles to
the horizontal and ducts with directional bends.
Note: Ducts from multiple hoods connected to a common
ductwork must be protected in compliance with NFPA 96 and
all local codes.
The R-102 system uses different duct nozzles depending on the
size of duct being protected.
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 4-1
GENERAL INFORMATION
1. Nozzles must be located 2-8 in. (51-203 mm) into the center
of the duct opening, discharging up. See Figure 4-1.
2-8 IN.
(51 - 203 mm)
FIGURE 4-1
000173
In installations where a UL listed damper assembly is
employed, the duct nozzle can be installed beyond the 8
in. (203 mm) maximum, to a point just beyond the damper
assembly that will not interfere with the damper. Exceeding
the maximum of 8 in. (203 mm) in this way will not void the
UL listing of the system.
Previously listed three flow number and five flow number
duct protection detailed in earlier published manual (Part No.
418087-06) can also still be utilized.
DUCT SIZES UP TO 50 IN. (1270 mm)
PERIMETER! 16 IN. (406 mm) DIAMETER
One 1W nozzle = one flow number
50 in. (1270 mm) perimeter maximum
16 in. (406 mm) diameter maximum
DUCT SIZES UP TO 100 IN. (2540 mm)
PERIMETER! 32 IN. (812 mm) DIAMETER
One 2W nozzle = two flow numbers
100 in. (2540 mm) perimeter maximum
32 in. (812 mm) diameter maximum
The chart below shows the maximum protection available from
each duct nozzle.
3.0 Gallon 1.5 Gallon
Description System System
2W Nozzle Maximum Maximum
100 in. (2540 mm) 100 in. (2540 mm)
Perimeter Perimeter
1W Nozzle Maximum Maximum
50 in. (1270 mm) 50 in. (1270 mm)
Perimeter Perimeter
SECTION 4- SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 4-2 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
Duct Protection - Multiple Nozzle
DUCT SIZES UP TO 135 IN. (3429 mm) PERIMETER -
THREE FLOW OPTION
One 1W nozzle and one 2W nozzle = three flow numbers
135 in. (3429 mm) perimeter maximum
No round duct option available
Follow design table in Figure 4-2 to determine maximum
module size for each nozzle
1W Module 2W Module
Side A Side B Side B Side B
Maximum Maximum Maximum Maximum
in. (mm) in. (mm) in. (mm) W. (mm)
4 (101) 60.0 (1524) 23.0 (584) 37.0 (939)
5 (127) 60.0 (1524) 23.0 (584) 37.0 (939)
6 (151) 59.5 (1511) 22.5 (571) 37.0 (939)
7 (177) 59.0 (1498) 22.0 (558) 37.0 (939)
8 (203) 58.5 (1485) 22.0 (558) 36.5 (927)
9 (228) 58.0 (1473) 21.5 (546) 36.5 (927)
10 (254) 57.0 (1447) 21.0 (533) 36.0 (914)
11 (279) 56.0 (1422) 20.5 (520) 35.5 (901)
12 (304) 55.5 (1409) 20.0 (508) 35.5 (901)
13 (330) 54.5 (1384) 19.5 (495) 35.0,(889)
14 (355) 53.5 (1358) 18.5 (469) 35.0 (889)
15 (381) 52.0 (1320) 18.0 (457) 34.0 (863)
16 (406) 51.0 (1295) 17.0 (431) 34.0 (863)
17 (431) 49.5 (1257) 16.0 (406) 33.5 (850)
18 (457) 47.5 (1206) 14.5 (368) 33.0 (838)
19 (482) 46.0 (1168) 13.5 (342) 32.5 (825)
20 (508) 43.5 (1104) 12.0 (304) 31.7 (805)
21 (533) 41.0 (1041) 10.0 (254) 31.0 (787)
22 (558) 38.0 (965) 7.5 (190) 30.5 (774)
23 (584) 33.5 (850) 4.0 (101) 29.5 (749)
4 ISideB I 110.
ISideA ' S . liwl I2WI
FIGURE 4-2
006521
Example: Protection is required for a duct that has an A"
dimension of 8 in. (203 mm) wide and a "B" dimension of 55 in.
(1397 mm) long.
Referring to the table in Figure 2, if the "A" dimension is
8 in. (203 mm), the "B" dimension must not exceed 58.5
in. (1485 mm). In this example, the "B" dimension is 55 in.
(1397 mm), therefore, this duct can be protected with a three
flow application.
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
Read over from the 8.0 in. (203 mm) line on the table to the
1W Module column. At that point, the chart shows that the "B"
module length for the 1W nozzle can be 22.0 in. (558 mm).
Center the 1W nozzle in that module. The 2W module can now
be centered within the remaining module.
I 00 DDDDODDDD0 D 000
u•u•uu•uu•uu••••••u•u
SIDE
A"
In.
CHART 4-2
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
Duct Protection - Multiple Nozzle (Continued)
DUCT SIZES GREATER THAN 100 IN. (2540 mm)
PERIMETER
Ducts over 100 in. (2540 mm) perimeter may be modularized
using 2W nozzles
No round duct option available
Follow the design chart to determine maximum module size
for each 2W nozzle
When determining number of nozzles required, it is sometimes
an advantage to check the chart using the shortest side as
Side "A" and then recheck it using the longest side as Side
"A." This comparison may reveal a need for a lesser quantity
of nozzles one way versus the other way.
When working with Chart 4-1, the quantity of nozzles deter-
mined must be equally divided within the duct area.
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 4-3
When working with Chart 4-2, one half of the quantity of nozzles
determined must be equally positioned in the top half of the
area of the duct and the remaining half of the nozzles must be
positioned in the bottom half of the duct area.
Example: The duct to be protected has a Side "A" of 40 in.
(1016 mm) and a Side "B" of 60 in. (1524 mm). Referring to the
design chart, this duct requires four nozzles. One half of 4 = 2.
Therefore, two nozzles must be equally positioned in each of the
two duct areas. See Figure 4-3.
SIDE "B"
30 IN. (762 mm) 30 IN. (762 mm)
20 IN.
(508 mm)
SIDE
A"
20 IN.
(508 mm)
CHART 4-1
A ... in.
SIDE "B" cm
FIGURE 4-3
006523
Al. • .1 - - NOTE: NOZZLE QUANTITIES LISTED IN CHART 4-2 MUST BE EQUALLY DIVIDED INTO EACH OF THE TWO DUCT MODULES.
nuiiu••u••un•u••uuuiu•••
006522
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 4-4 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
Transition Protection
Transitions are protected at a point in the transition where the
perimeter or the diameter is equal to or less than the maximum
size duct that can be protected. The nozzle(s) must be located
in the center of the area at that point, or center of the module
protected when more than one duct nozzle is required. Note:
Nozzles to protect ducts with a transition that is more than
4 ft (1.2 m) in height, will be required to be positioned in
the opening of the transition from the hood 2 to 8 in. (50
to 203 mm) into the opening using standard duct nozzle
design parameters. See Figure 4-4.
FIGURE 4-4
000174
Electrostatic Precipitator Protection
Some restaurant ventilating ducts have an electrostatic precip-
itator installed at or near the base. These precipitators are
generally small and are used to aid in the cleaning of exhaust air.
Ducts with precipitators located at or near the base can be
protected using duct nozzle(s) above the precipitator and 1/2N
nozzle(s) for the precipitator. One 1/2N nozzle must be used
for each cell being protected. This nozzle is stamped with 1/2N,
indicating that it is 1/2-flow nozzle and must be counted as 1/2
flow number.
When protecting ducts equipped with precipitators, the duct
nozzle(s) must be installed above the precipitator and aimed to
discharge downstream. If the area above the precipitator is a
duct, the nozzle(s) must be positioned according to duct protec-
tion guidelines. If the area above the precipitator is a transition,
the transition guidelines must be followed.
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
The 1/2N nozzle must be centered 10 to 26 in. (254 to 660 mm)
below the precipitator and aimed to discharge at the center of
each precipitator cell. However, if it is physically impossible to
mount the nozzle at 10 to 26 in. (254 to 660 mm) due to precip-
itator placement, the nozzle may be mounted closer than 10 in.
(254 mm). See Figure 4-5.
SEE DUCT FOR DUCT TRANSITION NOZZLE PROTECTION
PRECIPITATOR
-f 10-26 IN.
(254-660 mm)
NOZZLE FOR
PRECIPITATOR
PROTECTION
* IF PHYSICALLY IMPOSSIBLE AT 10 TO 26 IN. (254 TO 660 mm), NOZZLE MAYBE
MOUNTED CLOSER THAN 10 IN. (254 mm).
FIGURE 4-5
000196
Note: For protection of Pollution Control Units (PCUs) or air
scrubbers with or without ESPs, contact Technical Services for
non-UL listed recommended application.
FIGURE 4-9
R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
Plenum Protection
The R-102 system uses the 1W nozzle or the iN nozzle for
plenum protection. The 1W nozzle is stamped with 1W and
the 1 N nozzle is stamped with 1 N, indicating they are one-flow
nozzles and must be counted as one flow number each. When
protecting a plenum chamber, the entire chamber must be
protected regardless of filter length.
VERTICAL PROTECTION - GENERAL
1W NOZZLE - SINGLE AND "V BANK PROTECTION
One 1W nozzle will protect 4 linear feet (1.2 m) of plenum. The
maximum distance from the end of the hood to the first and last
nozzle must be no more than 2 ft (0.6 m). After the first nozzle,
any additional nozzles must be positioned at a maximum of 4 ft
(1.2 m) apart down the entire length of the plenum. The plenum
width must not exceed 4 ft (1.2 m). (The 1W nozzle can be used
on single or V-bank filter arrangements.) See Figure 4-6.
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 4-5
Option 2: The 1W nozzle must be placed perpendicular, 8-12 in.
(203-304 mm) from the face of the filter and angled to
the center of the filter. The nozzle tip must be within
2 in. (50 mm) from the perpendicular center line of the
filter. See Figure 4-8.
MM)
4 IN
(101
204 mm)
IUM
NOZZLE TIP
MUST BE W
THIS AREA
FIGURE 4-8
000200
HORIZONTAL PROTECTION - OPTION 1
iN NOZZLE SINGLE BANK PROTECTION ZT (1.2 m)
XIMUM One iN nozzle will protect 10 linear feet (3.0 m) of single filter bank
plenum. The nozzle(s) must be mounted in the plenum, 2 to 4 in.
(50 to 102 mm) from the face of the filter, centered between the
filter height dimension, and aimed down the length. The nozzle
must be positioned 0-6 in. (0-152 mm) from the end of the hood to
the tip of the nozzle. See Figure 4-9.
FIGURE 4-6
000197
000201
When protecting plenums with the 1W nozzle, two options of
coverage are available:
Option 1: The 1W nozzle must be on the center line of the
single or "V' bank filter and positioned within 1-20 in.
(26-508 mm) above the top edge of the filter. See
Figure 4-7.
20 IN. (508 mm)
MAXIMUM
1 IN. (26 mm)
MINIMUM
(508 mm)
IUM
MM)
FIGURE 4-7
000199
FIGURE 4-12
000206
FIGURE 4-13
000207
FIGURE 4-14
000208
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 4-6 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
Plenum Protection (Continued)
HORIZONTAL PROTECTION - OPTION 2
1W NOZZLE - "V' BANK PROTECTION
One 1W nozzle will protect 6 linear feet (1.8 m) of "V' bank
plenum. The nozzle must be mounted horizontally, positioned 1/3
the filter height down from the top of the filter. Nozzles can be
located at 6 ft (1.8 m) spacings on longer plenums. The nozzle
must be positioned 0-6 in. (0-152 mm) from the end of the hood to
the tip of the nozzle. See Figure 4-10.
R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
For a plenum, either single or 'V' bank, with a linear extension
m. longer than 10 ft (3.0 m), each bank may be protected using one
1 nozzle every 10 ft (3.0 m) or less depending on the overall
length of the plenum. See Figure 4-12. The nozzles may point
in the opposite directions as long as the entire plenum area is
protected, and the 10 ft (3.0 m) limitation is not exceeded. See
Figure 4-13. The nozzle positioning shown in Figure 4-14 is not
an acceptable method of protection because the plenum area
directly under the tee is not within the discharge pattern of either
nozzle.
1W NOZZLE
FIGURE 4-10
006524
TWO 1 N NOZZLES - "V BANK PROTECTION
Two 1 N nozzles will protect 10 linear feet (3.0 m) by 4 It (1.2 m)
wide of "V bank plenum. The nozzles must be mounted in the
plenum, 2 to 4 in. (50 to 101 mm) from the face of the filter,
centered between the filter height dimension, and aimed down the
length. The nozzle must be positioned 0-6 in. (0-381 mm) from the
end of the hood to the tip of the nozzle. See Figure 4-11.
2
ri
FIGURE 4-11
I
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN I
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 4-7
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
Appliance Protection
The following pages detail types of appliance protection. Each
design requires several factors: correct nozzle choice, correct
nozzle height above hazard, correct nozzle location and correct
aiming point.
Fryer - Single Nozzle Protection
1. Design requirements for fryers are broken down into two
types.
FRYERS WITHOUT DRIPBOARDS
If the fryer does not include a dripboard, measure the
internal depth (horizontal dimension from front to back)
and length of the frypot.
FRYERS WITH DRIPBOARDS
If the fryer includes any dripboard areas, measure both
the internal depth (horizontal dimension from front to
back) and length of the frypot portion, and then measure
the internal depth and length of the overall hazard area
including any dripboard areas.
2. Using Table, "Maximum Cooking Area Dimension - Single
Nozzle Fryer Protection," determine which nozzle is needed
to protect the fryer based on the maximum dimensions
listed.
If the fryer does not include a dripboard, use the
maximum dimensions listed in the first column of the
table to select the correct nozzle.
If the fryer includes any dripboard areas, use both the
maximum frypot dimensions in the first column of the
table, and the maximum overall dimensions in the
second column of the table to select the correct nozzle.
None of the maximum dimensions in either column may
be exceeded.
3. If either the maximum frypot or the overall sizes are
exceeded, an additional nozzle(s) will be required. Refer to
the multiple nozzle requirements.
Example: A fryer with a dripboard. The inside of the frypot
without the dripboard measures 18 in. in depth x 18 in. in length
(457 mm x 457 mm) and the inside of the overall area includ-
ing the dripboard measures 18 in. in depth x 24 in. in length
(457 mm x 610 mm). From the Table Maximum Cooking Area
Dimension - Single Nozzle Fryer Protection," either the 3N or
the 290 nozzle should be selected to protect the fryer, depend-
ing on the maximum nozzle height above the fryer and the
positioning requirements allowed. Refer to appropriate Figures.
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
Nozzle Height Nozzle
Above Top of Fryer Location
27 in. to 47 in. See Figure
(686 mm to 1193 mm) 4-15 and 4-16
20 in. to 27 in. See Figure
(508 mm to 685 mm) 4-15 and 4-16
13 in. to 16 in. See Figure 4-17
(330 mm to 406 mm)
16 in. to 27 in. See Figure 4-17
(406 mm to 685 mm)
FRYER WITHOUT DRIPBOARD FRYER WITH DRIPBOARD
SPLIT VAT
NOZZLE TIP POSITIONED ANYWHERE ALONG OR WITHIN PERIMETER OF COOKING
SURFACE AND AIMED TO THE CENTER OF THE COOKING AREA.
FIGURE 4-16
002283
TOP OF FRYER
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 4-8 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
I
Fryer - Single Nozzle Protection (Continued)
Maximum Area Dimensions - Single Nozzle Fryer Protection
Max. Size •Max. Size Overall Type of
Frypot Only With Dripboard Nozzle
Full or Split Vat Full or Split Vat 230 .l4 in. xl5in. l4 in. x2lin.
(355 mm x 381 mm) (355 mm x 533 mm)
Full or Split Vat Full or Split Vat 245
l4 in. xl5in. l4 in. x2lin.
•
(355 mm x 381 mm) (355 mm x 533 mm)
Full or Split Vat Full or Split Vat 290
l4 in. xl5in. l4 in. x2lin.
(355 mm x 381 mm) (355 mm x 533 mm) •Full or Split Vat Full or Split Vat 290
141/2 in. xl4in. 14 1/2 in. x 26 1/2 in.
(368 mm x 355 mm) (368 mm x 673 mm)
--- •
I lj I II Il
/1
H Li'
TOP OF FRYER
i I
S
S - I
I \. . FRYER WITHOUT DRIPBOARD FRYER WITH DRIPBOARD
NOZZLE TIP POSITIONED ANYWHERE ALONG OR WITHIN PERIMETER OF COOKING
SURFACE AND AIMED TO THE CENTER OF THE COOKING AREA.
S
S
S
•
S
FIGURE 4-15
002280
TOP OF FRYER
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 4-9
Fryer - Single Nozzle Protection (Continued)
Maximum Area Dimensions - Single Nozzle Fryer Protection (Continued)
Max. Size
Max. Size Overall Type of Nozzle Height
Frypot Only With Dripboard Nozzle Above Top of Fryer
14.5 in. x 16.5 in. 14.5 in. x 26.5 in. 290 16 in. to 21 in.
(368 mm x 419 mm) (368 mm x 673 mm) (406 to 533 mm)
19.5 in. x 19 in. 19.5 in. x25318 in. 290 13 in. to 16 in.
(495 mm x 482 mm) (495 mm x 644 mm) (330 to 406 mm)
19.5 in. x 19 in. 19.5 in. x 25 3/8 in. 3N See Figure 4-18
(495 mm x 482 mm) (495 mm x 644 mm)
18 in. x 18 in. 18 in. x 273/4 in. 3N 25 in. to 35 in.
(457 mm x 457 mm) (457 mm x 704 mm) (635 mm to 889 mm)
Nozzle
Location
See Figure 4-17
See Figure 4-17
See Figure 4-18
See Figure 4-19
---..--..-
FRYER WITHOUT DRIPBOARD FRYER WITH DRIPBOARD
290 NOZZLE TIP POSITIONED OVER THE MIDPOINT OF THE HAZARD AREA ± 3 IN.
(76 mm) FROM THE MIDPOINT ALONG THE LONGEST SIDE OF THE HAZARD AND ±
1 IN. (25 mm) FROM THE MIDPOINT ALONG THE SHORTEST SIDE OF THE HAZARD
AND AIMED AT THE MIDPOINT OF THE COOKING AREA.
FIGURE 4-17
002286
34 IN. (863 mm) MAXIMUM DIAGONAL
DISTANCE BETWEEN NOZZLE AND
CENTER OF HAZARD AREA
FRYER WITHOUT DRIPBOARD FRYER WITH DRIPBOARD
3N NOZZLE TIP POSITIONED ANYWHERE ALONG OR WITHIN PERIMETER OF
COOKING SURFACE AND AIMED TO THE CENTER OF THE COOKING AREA.
FIGURE 4-18
002287
000008 ODDDIO RIGHT-TO-LEFT
CENTERLINE
FRYER WITHOUT DRIPBOARD FRYER WITH DRIPBOARD
NOTE: 3N NOZZLE TIP MUST BE LOCATED WITHIN THE PERIMETER OF THE SURFACE
AREA WITHIN THE FRONT HALF OF THE FRY POT AND AIMED AT THE CENTER.
FIGURE 4-19
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 4-10 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
Fryer - Multiple Nozzle Protection
Design Requirements:
Fryers exceeding the coverage of a single nozzle can be divided
into modules. Each module must not exceed the maximum
area allowed for a single nozzle. However, when utilizing multi-
ple nozzle protection, the longest side allowed for a fryer with
dripboard can be used, regardless of whether the fryer has a
dripboard or not.
The maximum size fryer that can be modularized is 864 in.2
(55742 mm2).
1. Design requirements for multiple nozzle fryers are broken
down into two types:
FRYERS WITHOUT DRIPBOARD(S)
If the fryer does not include a dripboard, measure the
internal depth (horizontal dimension from front to back)
and length of the frypot. Then, multiply the depth and
length to obtain the area of the frypot in square inches.
FRYERS WITH DRIPBOARD(S)
If the fryer includes any dripboard areas, measure
both the internal depth and length of the frypot portion,
and then measure the internal depth and length of the
overall hazard area including any dripboard areas.
Determine the area of both the frypot and the area of
the overall vat by multiplying corresponding depth and
length dimensions.
2. Divide the frypot or overall vat into modules, each of which
can be protected by a single nozzle, based on the maximum
dimension and area coverage of the nozzle as specified
in Table, "Maximum Cooking Area Dimension - Multiple
Nozzle Protection."
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
If the module considered does not include any portion
of the dripboard, use only the maximum frypot area and
maximum dimension listed in the first column of the
table to select the correct nozzle.
If the module considered includes any dripboard areas,
use both the maximum frypot area and dimension
listed in the first column of the table, and the maximum
overall area and dimensions listed in the second
column of the table to select the correct nozzle.
3. None of the maximum dimensions in either column may be
exceeded. If either the maximum frypot or the overall sizes
are exceeded, the area divided into modules will need to be
redefined with the possibility of an additional nozzle.
Options For Modularizing Fryers
The following Figure 4-20 shows approved methods of divid-
ing (modularizing) fryers so that each section can be properly
protected. Example: A fryer with a dripboard. The inside vat
without the dripboard measures 18 in. in depth x 30 in. in length
(457 mm x 762 mm) and the inside of the overall vat includ-
ing the dripboard measures 24 in. in depth x 30 in. in length
(610 mm x 762 mm). Because the fryer is 30 in. (762 mm) in
length, it exceeds the coverage of a single nozzle.
Dividing the length in half, each module now has an overall
vat dimension of 24 in. in depth x 15 in. in length (610 mm x
381 mm). From the Table, "Maximum Cooking Area Dimension
- Multiple Nozzle Fryer Protection," either the 3N or the 290
nozzle should be selected to protect each fryer module, depend-
ing on the maximum nozzle height above the fryer and the
positioning requirements allowed. Refer to appropriate Figures,
4-15 through 4-19.
See additional examples in Appendix Section.
DRIP BOARD
EXAMPLE ONLY
FRYER WITH DRIPBOARD
EACH MODULAR AREA, INCLUDING DRIPBOARD,
MUST NOT EXCEED 497 IN.2 (32064 mm2)
MIDPOINT
+
MIDPOINT
I +
DRIP BOARD DRIP BOARD
000214
EXAMPLE ONLY
FRYER WITH DRIPBOARD
AREA OF EACH FRY
POT MODULE
CANNOT EXCEED
324 IN.2
(20903 mm2)
AREA OF THIS
I MODULE (FRY
I POT PLUS DRIP
BOARD) CANNOT
EXCEED
497 IN.2
(32064 mm21
000215
AREA OF EACH FRY POT MODULE
CANNOT EXCEED 324 IN.2 (20903 mm2)
EXAMPLE ONLY
FRYER WITHOUT DRIPBOARD
002296
FIGURE 4-20
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
Fryer - Multiple Nozzle Protection (Continued)
Maximum Area Dimension - Multiple Nozzle Fryer Protection
Max. Size Module
Max. Size Module Overall Type of
Frypot Only With Dripboard Nozzle
Full or Split Vat Full or Split Vat
21 in. x 210 in.2 21 in. x 294 in.2 230
(533 mm x 0.14 m2) (533 mm x 0.19 m2)
Full or Split Vat Full or Split Vat
21 in. x 210 in.2 21 in. x 294 in.2 245
(533 mm x 0.14 m2) (533 mm x 0.19 m2)
Full or Split Vat Full or Split Vat
21 in. x 210 in.2 21 in. x 294 in.2 290
(533 mm x 0.14 m2) (533 mm x 0.19 m2)
25 3/8 x 370.5 in2 25 3/8 x 495 in2 290
(644 mm x 0.24 m2) (644 mm x 0.32 m2)
Full or Split Vat Full or Split Vat
26 1/2 in. x 203 in.2 26 1/2 in. x 384 1/4 in.2 290
(673 mm x 0.13 m2) (673 mm x 0.25 m2)
25 3/8 x 370.5 in2 25 3/8 x 495 in2 3N
(644 mm x 0.24 m2) (644 mm x 0.32 m2)
27 3/4 x 324 in.2 27 3/4 x 497 in2 3N
(704 mm x 0.21 m2) (704 mm x 0.32 m2)
.-i0218 - - 4.-i0213
FRYER WITHOUT DRIPBOARD FRYER WITH DRIPBOARD
POSITION NOZZLE TIP ANYWHERE ALONG OR WITHIN THE PERIMETER OF THE
MODULE IT IS PROTECTING AND AIM AT THE MIDPOINT OF THAT MODULAR AREA.
FIGURE 4-21
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 4-11
Nozzle Height Nozzle
Above Top of Fryer Location
27 in. to 47 in. See Figure 4-21
(686 mm to 1194 mm)
20 in. to 27 in. See Figure 4-21
(508 mm to 686 mm)
13 in. to 16 in. See Figure 4-22
(330 mm to 406 mm)
13 in. to 16 in. See Figure 4-22
(330 mm to 406 mm)
16 in. to 27 in. See Figure 4-22
(406 mm to 686 mm)
See Figure 4-23 See Figure 4-23
25 in. to 35 in. See Figure 4-24
(635 mm to 889 mm)
34 IN. (864 mm) MAXIMUM DIAGONAL
DISTANCE BETWEEN NOZZLE
AND CENTER
HAZARD AREA
21 in. (533
MINIMUM
VERTICAL
NOZZLE
HEIGHT
..-
FRYER WITHOUT DRIPBOARD FRYER WITH DRIPBOARD
3N NOZZLE TIP MUST BE POSITIONED ANYWHERE ALONG OR WITHIN THE PERIMETER
OF THE MODULAR IT IS PROTECTING AND AIMED AT THE MIDPOINT OF THAT
RESPECTIVE MODULE AREA.
FIGURE 4-23
AIM POINT
(DIAGONAL
CENTER OF
MODULE
COOKING
AREA)
RIGHT-
TO-LEFT
CENTER-
LINE
r
I AIM POINT (DIAGONAL I I CENTER OF MODULE
I COOKING AREA)
RIGHT-TO-LEFT
L. CENTERLINE
FRYER WITHOUT DRIPBOARD FRYER WITH DRIPBOARD
290 NOZZLE TIP POSITIONED OVER THE MIDPOINT OF THE RESFECTIVE MODULAR
AREA ± 3 IN. (76 mm) FROM THE MIDPOINT ALONG THE LONGEST SIDE OF THE
MODULE AND ± 1 IN. (25 mm) FROM THE MIDPOINT ALONG THE SHORTEST SIDE OF
THE MODULE AND AIMED AT THE MIDPOINT OF THE MODULE.
FRYER WITHOUT DRIPBOARD FRYER WITH DRIPBOARD
THE 3N NOZZLE TIP MUST BE POSITIONED ANYWHERE ALONG OR WITHIN THE
PERIMETER AND FORWARD OF THE RIGHT-TO-LEFT CENTERLINE OF THE COOKING
AREA. THE AIMING POINT OF THE NOZZLE MUST BE AT THE DIAGONAL CENTER OF
THE MODULAR COOKING AREA.
FIGURE 4-22 FIGURE 4-24
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 4-12 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
Multiple Nozzle Fryer Protection - Tilt Skillet / Braising Pan
Protection for tilt skillets or braising pans is to be based upon the
coverage limitations provided for deep fat fryer protection. Refer
to Section IV, DESIGN, starting on Page 4-10, for maximum fryer
nozzle coverages and maximum fryer nozzle height limitations.
Although the maximum 864 in.2 (55741 mm2) total surface
cooking area requirement applies to fryer protection, it does not
apply to tilt skillets or braising pans.
Each tilt skillet/braising pan protected module must not exceed
the fryer limitations for "MAXIMUM SIZE MODULE OVERALL
WITH DRIPBOARD" coverage per nozzle as described in Table
on Page 4-11.
Tilt skillets and braising pans generally utilize a hinged cover.
Fryer protection nozzles are to be placed toward the front of the
appliance to minimize the potential for the tilt skillet or braising
pan cover to interfere with the nozzle discharge. See Figures
4-25 and 4-26.
THE NOZZLE IS TO BE PLACED TOWARD THE FRONT OF THE APPLIANCE TO MINIMIZE
THE POTENTIAL FOR THE SKILLET OR BRAISING PAN COVER TO INTERFERE WITH
THE NOZZLE DISCHARGE. FIGURE 4-25
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
COVER MUST NOT
INTERFERE WITH EDGE
OF DISCHARGE PATTERN
i
FOR MINIMUM
AND MAXIMUM
NOZZLE
HEIGHTS, REFER
TO FRYER
NOZZLE
FRYER NOZZLE USED FOR TILT SKILLET OR BRAISING PAN PROTECTION MUST BE
POSITIONED NEAR THE FRONT EDGE OF THE PAN AND AIMED AT THE FRONT TO BACK
CENTERLINE OF THE PAN. THE DISCHARGE FROM THE NOZZLE(S) MUST COMPLETELY
CLEAR THE PAN COVER WITH AN UNOBSTRUCTED VIEW TO THE BACK OF THE PAN.
FIGURE 4-26
R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 4-13
Range Protection
The R-102 system uses five different nozzles for the protection
of ranges. Two of the design options require a one-flow nozzle 10 IN.
and three of the design options require two-flow nozzles. (254 mm)
MAX IMUl
NOTICE
A 13 in. (330 mm) diameter wok pan is the 1
largest wok size that can be protected on NOZZLE
ranges.
When protecting hot top ranges, the entire
cooking surface must be protected.
10 IN.
(254 mm
MAXIMU
Range Protection 1 (1-Flow) Nozzle - High Proximity
Application
No Obstructions
AIMING POINT
FIGURE 4-28
Single and multiple burner ranges can be protected using a 1
nozzle. The nozzle is stamped with iN, indicating that this is a
one-flow nozzle and must be counted as one flow number.
When using this nozzle for range protection, the maximum
length of the burner grates being protected with a single nozzle
must not exceed 32 in. (812 mm) and the maximum area of the
burner grates must not exceed 384 in.2 (24774 mm2) per nozzle.
When protecting a range, the 1N nozzle must be located a
maximum of 10 in. (254 mm) from each burner grate centerline
and must be aimed at the center of the cooking surface. See
Figures 4-27 and 4-28.
1
1/
(1016 M) \
006539
FIGURE 4-27
AREA
245 NOZZLE TIP COOKING +
LOCATION CENTER OF AREA
COOKING SURFACE
)KM)KL
OR j 11 3/8 IN. (288 mm)
MAXIMUM FROM
CENTERLINE OF NOZZLE
O T CENTER OF ANY
BURNER GRATE
COOKING
AREA
I
COOKING 245 NOZZLE TIP AREALOCATION CENTER O
COOKING SURFACE
OR Ti11 3/8 IN. (288 mm)_____________________ 0
MAXIMUM FROM
CENTERLINE OF NOZZLE
TO CENTER OF ANY 000766
BURNER GRATE FIGURE 4-30
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 4-14 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
Range Protection 245 (2-Flow) Nozzle - High Proximity
Application
No Obstructions
40 in. to 50 in. (1016 mm to 1270 mm) above the cooking
surface.
This high proximity application uses the 245 nozzle.
The nozzle is stamped with 245 indicating this is a two-flow
nozzle and must be counted as two flow numbers.
One 245 nozzle will protect a maximum cooking area of 672 i2
(43354 mm2) with a maximum longest dimension of 28 in.
(711 mm).
When using this nozzle for range protection, the nozzle must
be pointed vertically down and positioned as shown in Figures
4-29 and 4-30.
245 NOZZLE TIP LOCATION
CENTERLINE OF COOKING SURFACE
-7 4'l
50 IN.
(1270 mm)
MAXIMUM
HEIGHT
OF 245
NOZZLE
TIP
40 IN.
(1016 mm) I MINIMUM
HEIGHT
OF 245
'NOZZLE I TIP
000236
FIGURE 4-29
NOTICE
Four burner grates shown in Figure 4-30. For
single or double burner grates, locate nozzle
at center of cooking surface or 11 3/8 in.
(288 mm) maximum from nozzle centerline to
center of any burner grate.
COOKING
AREA
260 NOZZLE TIP
LOCATION CENTER
OF COOKING
SURFACE
OR
10 IN. (254 mm)
MAXIMUM FROM
CENTERLINE
OF NOZZLE TO
CENTER OF ANY
BURNER GRATE
260 NOZZLE TIP
LOCATION CENTE
OF COOKING
SURFACE
OR
10 IN. (254 mm)
MAXIMUM FROM
CENTERLINE
OF NOZZLE TO
CENTER OF ANY
BURNER GRATE
ING
FIGURE 4-32
000766
NOTICE
Four burner grates shown in Figure 4-32. For
single or double burner grates, locate nozzle
at center of cooking surface.
S.
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 4-15
Range Protection 260 (2-Flow) Nozzle - Medium Proximity
Application
No Obstructions
30 in. to 40 in. (762 mm to 1016 mm) above the cooking surface.
The medium proximity application uses the 260 nozzle.
The nozzle is stamped with 260 indicating this is a two-flow
nozzle and must be counted as two flow numbers.
One 260 nozzle will protect a cooking area of 768 in.2
(49548 mm2) with a maximum dimension of 32 in. (812 mm).
When using this nozzle for range protection, the nozzle must
be pointed vertically down and positioned as shown in Figures
4-31 and 4-32.
260 NOZZLE TIP LOCATION
CENTERLINE OF COOKING SURFACE
I 40t.
(1016 mm) MAXIMUM
HEIGHT
OF 260
NOZZLE
TIP
30 IN.
(762 mm) I MINIMUM I HEIGHT
OF 260
'NOZZLE I TIP I I
000236
0000
4
FIGURE 4-31
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 4-16 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
Range Protection 1 (1-Flow) Nozzle - Low Proximity
Application
15 in. to 20 in. (381 mm to 508 m) above the cooking surface.
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
Range Protection Two 290 (2-Flow) Nozzles - Low
Proximity Application
15 in. to 20 in. (381 mm to 508 mm) above the cooking surface.
The low proximity 1-flow nozzle application for the protection of The low proximity 2-flow application requires the use of two 290
ranges requires the 1N nozzle. nozzles.
The nozzle is stamped with 1N indicating that it is a one-flow
nozzle and must be counted as one flow number,
When using the 1 nozzle for low proximity range protection
with or without obstruction, the maximum length of the burner
grates being protected must not be exceed 24 in. (609 mm)
length, aimed along a centerline to a point 20 in. (508 mm) from
the end of the length, protecting a maximum width of 18 in. (457
mm).
When protecting a range, the 1 N nozzle must be located a
maximum of 9 in. (228 mm) from each burner grate centerline
and must be positioned above the edge of the hazard area to be
protected.
The 1 N nozzle tip must be positioned at or below the obstruc-
tion, if present. The protected area begins at the point straight
down from the nozzle tip. The nozzle can be placed at the side
of the range aimed either left or right, or can be placed in the
front or back of the range. See Figures 4-33 and 4-34 for nozzle
location details.
\ I F ' I
I I
I I
15-2OIN. I I AIM (381 - 508 mm) I POINT
I I 20 IN. I (508 mm)
0000
007924
FIGURE 4-33
PROTECTED AREA
-T
91N (228 mm)
- - I -
AIM POINT
20 IN.
(508 mm)
- 241N.
(609 mm)
FIGURE 4-34
Both nozzles are stamped with 290 indicating they are two flow
nozzles and must be counted together for a total of four flow
numbers.
Two 290 nozzles will protect a cooking area of 1008 in.2
(65032 mm2) with a maximum dimension of 36 in. (914 mm).
When using two of these nozzles for low proximity range protec-
tion, the nozzles must be positioned along the cooking surface
perimeter to 1.5 in. (38 mm) inside the perimeter, and aimed at
a 450 angle along theongitudinal centerline of the range. See
Figures 4-35 and 4-36.
t
290 NOZZLE TIP
LOCATION 0-1.5 IN.
(0 - 38 mm)
IN FROM EDGE OF
45* COOKING SURFACE 45*
II -
15 IN. T020 IN. 15 IN. TO 20 IN.
(381 to 508 mm) I (381 to 508 mm)
MAXIMUM I I MAXIMUM
L 0 0 0 0
FIGURE 4-35
COOKING LONGITUDINAL
AREA I CENTERLINE
COOKING
AREA
I I I \ 000239
I 290 NOZZLE TIP
- -' k- LOCATION CENTER OF
COOKING SURFACE
290 NOZZLE TIP LOCATION ± 2 IN. (50 mm)
0— 1.5 IN. (38 mm) IN FROM EDGE
OF COOKING SURFACE
COOKING
AREA
000240
COOKING
AREA
I 290 NOZZLE TIP l LOCATION CENTER OF
COOKING SURFACE
290 NOZZLE TIP LOCATION ± 2 IN. (50 mm)
0— 1.5 IN. (38 mm) IN FROM EDGE
OF COOKING SURFACE
FIGURE 4-36
R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
Range Protection (With or Without Back Shelf/Obstruction)
When this type of hazard is equipped with a back shelf or other
similarly sized obstruction located above the range top, two
protection options are available: One requires a 1 nozzle and
the other option requires a 260 nozzle.
Range Protection 1 (1-Flow) Nozzle (With or Without Back
Shelf/Obstruction)
Single and multiple burner ranges can be protected using a
1 F nozzle. The nozzle is stamped with 1 F indicating that it is a
one-flow nozzle and must be counted as one flow number.
When using the 1 F nozzle for range protection with or without back
shelf or other similarly sized obstruction, the maximum length of
the burner grates being protected must not exceed 28 in. (711
mm) and the maximum area of the burner grates must not exceed
336 in.2 (21677 mm2). See Figure 4-37 for nozzle location details.
1 NOZZLE
SHELF OR OTHER SIMILARLY SIZED
OBSTRUCTION CAN OVERHANG BURNER(S)
BY A MAXIMUM OF 11 IN. (279 mm)
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 4-17
Range Protection 260 (2-Flow) Nozzle (With or Without
Back Shelf/Obstruction)
Single and multiple burner ranges can be protected using a 260
nozzle. The nozzle is stamped with 260 indicating that it is a
two-flow nozzle and must be counted as two flow numbers.
When using the 260 nozzle for range protection with or without
back shelf or other similarly sized obstruction, the maximum
length of burner grates being protected must not exceed 32 in.
(812 mm) and the maximum area of the burner grates must
not exceed 384 in.2 (24774 mm2). Nozzle must be located on
the front edge of the burner grates and aimed at a point 10 in.
(254 mm) from the back edge of the burner grates. Nozzle must
be mounted 30 to 40 in. (762 to 1016 mm) above the hazard
surface. See Figure 4-38.
260 NOZZLE
SHELF OR OTHER SIMILARLY SIZED
OBSTRUCTION CAN OVERHANG BURNER(S)
BY A MAXIMUM OF 11 IN. (279 mm)
40-48 IN.
(1016. 1219 mm) I
II 201N. AIM II (508 mm) POINT II MINIMUM
30-40 IN.
(762. 1016 mm)
14 IN.
(355 mm)
MAXIMUM 12 (355 mm) (304 mm)
MAXIMUM MAXIMUM CENTERLINE
IF NOZZLE LOCATED OVER FRONT EDGE OF BURNER GRATE AND ORIENTED
SO NOZZLE TIP FLATS ARE PARALLEL WITH BURNER GRATE FRONT TO REAR
CENTERLINE AND SHALL BE AIMED AT THE CENTER OF THE COOKING SURFACE.
FIGURE 4-37
000238
(254 mm)
FROM BACK
OF BURNER
GRATES
FIGURE 4-38
000238
I I NOZZLE LOCATION I 0-2 IN. (0-50mm)
INSIDE PERIMETER 40 IN.
4- OF COOKING SURFACE (1016 mm) I I
/ MAXIMUM
II OF 1N
I
/7
HEIGHT
I II NOZZLE TIP
I / I 35 IN. (889 mm) I
MINIMUM I II Il HEIGHT I EDGE H
OF —1I I/
OF 1N
COOKING I
SURFACE I I
NOZZLE TIP
COOKING
AREA
1 IN. (25 mm)
MAXIMUM
CENTER OF GRIDDLE SURFACE OR A
MAXIMUM DIMENSION OF 20.6 IN.
(523 mm) FROM NOZZLE CENTERLINE TO
FURTHEST CORNER OF GRIDDLE
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 4-18 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
Griddle Protection 1 (1-Flow) Nozzle - High Proximity
Application
The R-102 system uses four different nozzles for the protection
of griddles. One of the applications requires a 1-flow nozzle and
three of the applications require a 2-flow nozzle.
High Proximity Application: 35 in. to 40 in. (889 to 1016 mm)
above the cooking surface.
This high proximity application uses the iN nozzle.
The nozzle is stamped with 1 N indicating this is a one-flow
nozzle and must be counted as one flow number.
One 1 nozzle will protect a maximum cooking area of 1080 in.2
(69677 mm2) with the maximum longest side of 36 in. (914 mm).
When using this nozzle for griddle protection, the nozzle must be
positioned along the cooking surface perimeter to a maximum of
2 in. (50 mm) inside the perimeter, and aimed to the midpoint of
the cooking surface. See Figure 4-39 and 4-40.
NOTICE
When using this type of griddle protection,
only five flow numbers are allowed on a 1.5
gal (5.7 L) system and only 11 flow numbers
are allowed on a 3 gal (11.4 L) system.
n MIDPOINT OF I I
I
COOKING SURFACE I I
II
II
J I I
1 N NOZZLE LOCATED ALONG COOKING
ANY SIDE OF GRIDDLE SURFACE WITHIN SURFACE
0-2 IN. (0-50 mm) OF COOKING EDGE
SURFACE EDGE. NOZZLE MUST BE
AIMED AT MIDPOINT OF COOKING SURFACE. FIGURE 4-39
000241
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
Griddle Protection 290 (2-Flow) Nozzle - High Proximity
Application
Option 1 - Nozzle Center Located
30 in. to 50 in. (762 mm to 1270 mm) above the cooking surface.
This high proximity application uses the 290 nozzle.
The nozzle is stamped with 290 indicating this is a 2-flow nozzle
and must be counted as two flow numbers.
One 290 nozzle will protect a maximum cooking area of 720 in.2
(46451 mm2) with a maximum, dimension of 30 in. (762 mm).
When using this nozzle for high proximity applications, the
nozzle must be positioned within 1 in. (25 mm) of the center
of the cooking surface and pointed vertically down. See Figure
4-41 and 4-42.
CENTER LINE OF GRIDDLE
I SURFACE ± 1 IN. (25 mm) IN
ANY DIRECTION
hi
I I 501N.
(1270 mm)
MAXIMUM
I HEIGHT
I 0F290
NOZZLE TIP
I 30 IN.
I (762 mm)
MINIMUM
HEIGHT
OF 290
NOZZLE
TIP
'I!
FIGURE 4-41
000244
COOKING
I
AREA
NOZZLE L.- 1 IN. (25 mm)
LOCATION 'k- MAXIMUM
FIGURE 4-42
000773
FIGURE 4-40
000243
One 260 nozzle will protect a maximum cooking area of 1440 in.2
(92903 mm2) with a maximum dimension of 48 in. (1219 mm).
When using this nozzle for griddle protection, the nozzle must
be positioned along the cooking surface perimeter to 2 in.
(50 mm) inside perimeter, and aimed at the center of the cooking
surface. See Figure 4-43 and 4-44.
NOZZLE LOCATION
0-2 IN. (0-50 mm)
INSIDE PERIMETER
* OF COOKING SURFACE
50 IN.
(1270 mm)
I MAXIMUM
HEIGHT
OF 260
/
NOZZLE TIP
I / I 30 IN. (762mm)
(MINIMUM I I
EDGE I / I HEIGHT I
OF -k-u I / 0F260
COOKING I
NOZZLE TIP
SURFACE
000243
FIGURE 4-43
000243
COOKING AREA
r t MIDPOINT OF I
COOKING SURFACE I
I
I I COOKING
AIM POINT I AREA
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
Griddle Protection 260 (2-Flow) Nozzle - High Proximity
Application
Option 2 - Nozzle Perimeter Located
30 in. to 50 in. (762 mm to 1270 mm) above the cooking surface.
This high proximity application uses the 260 nozzle.
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 4-19
Griddle Protection 290 (2-Flow) Nozzle - Medium Proximity
Application
Option 2a - Nozzle Perimeter Located (Continued)
20 in. to 30 in. (508 mm to 762 mm) above the cooking surface.
The medium proximity application uses the 290 nozzle.
The nozzle is stamped with 260 indicating this is a two-flow The nozzle is stamped with 290 indicating this is a two-flow
nozzle and must be counted as two flow numbers. nozzle and must be counted as two flow numbers.
One 290 nozzle will protect a maximum cooking area of 1440 in.2
(92903 mm2) with a maximum dimension of 48 in. (1219 mm).
When using this nozzle for griddle protection, the nozzle must
be positioned along the perimeter to 2 in. (50 mm) inside
perimeter, and aimed at the center of the cooking surface. See
Figure 4-45 and 4-46.
COOKING AREA
r t CENTER OF
COOKING SURFACE I I I I
I I I I COOKING /+ 111 1
I I AREA
l— AIM POINT L 1J
290 NOZZLE LOCATED ALONG COOKING SURFACE EDGE
ANY SIDE OF GRIDDLE SURFACE
WITHIN 0-2 IN. (0-50MM) OF
COOKING SURFACE EDGE NOZZLE
MUST BE AIMED AT CENTER OF
COOKING SURFACE.
FIGURE 4-45
000241
I NOZZLE LOCATION f II 0-2 IN. (0-5lMM)
INSIDE PERIMETER 30 IN.
OF COOKING SURFACE I i (762 mm)
MAXIMUM I HEIGHT
OF 290 I
II /,r NOZZLE TIP
I I I 20 IN. (508 mm( I
/ I MINIMUM
- EIGHT
F 290
OZZLE TIP
EDGE OF
COOKING
SURFACE
FIGURE 4-46
000243
260 NOZZLE LOCATED ALONG
ANY SIDE OF GRIDDLE SURFACE
WITHIN 0-2 IN. (0-51 mm) OF
COOKING SURFACE EDGE. NOZZLE
MUST BE AIMED AT MIDPOINT OF
COOKING SURFACE.
COOKING SURFACE EDGE
FIGURE 4-44
000241
2W NOZZLE AIM POINT
0-3 IN. (0-76 mm) TO REAR OF
COOKING SURFACE CENTER
LINE WHEN 2W NOZZLE IS
POSITIONED AT OR TO THE
REAR OF CENTER LINE
2W NOZZLE AIM POINT
0-3 IN. (0-76 mm) FORWARD
OF COOKING SURFACE
CENTER LINE WHEN 2W
NOZZLE IS POSITIONED AT
OR FORWARD OF COOKING
SURFACE CENTER LINE
OVERHEAD VIEW
36 IN. (914 mm) MAX.
0-101N. 10-254mm) FROM CENTERLINE MAX.
0-101N.
- 254 mm FROM ENTERLI E MAX.
30 IN.
(762 mm) MX.
008149
I NOZZLE LOCATION t 0-21N.(0-51 mm) I INSIDE PERIMETER 20 IN. _..I OF COOKING SURFACE I i (508 mm) I / I MAXIMUM
I HEIGHT
I 0F2120
II
I I ri NOZZLE TIP
10 IN. (254 mm) I
EDG
COOKING SURFACE
I MINIMUM
EIGHT
F 2120
DZZLE TIP
000243
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 4-20 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
Griddle Protection 2120 (2-Flow) Nozzle - Low Proximity
Application
Option 2b - Nozzle Perimeter Located (Continued)
10 in. to 20 in. (254 mm to 508 mm) above the cooking surface.
The low proximity application uses the 2120 nozzle.
The nozzle is stamped with 2120 indicating this is a two-flow
nozzle and must be counted as two flow numbers.
One 2120 nozzle will protect a maximum cooking area of 1440
in.2 (92903 mm2) with a maximum dimension of 48 in. (1219 mm).
When using this nozzle for griddle protection, the nozzle must
be positioned along the perimeter to 2 in. (50 mm) inside perim-
eter, and aimed at the center of the cooking surface. See Figure
4-47 and 4-48.
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
Griddle Protection 2W (2-Flow) Nozzle - Low Proximity
Application
Option 2c - Nozzle Perimeter Located (Continued)
10 in. to 20 in. (254 mm to 508 mm) above the cooking surface.
The low proximity application uses the 2W nozzle.
The nozzle is stamped with 2W indicating this is a two-flow
nozzle and must be counted as two flow numbers.
One 2W nozzle will protect a maximum cooking area of 1080 in.2
(69677 mm2) with a maximum dimension of 36 in. (914 mm).
When using this nozzle for griddle protection, the nozzle must be
positioned 0-10 in. (0-254 mm) forward or behind the right to left
centerline of the hazard area. See the diagram below for nozzle
location and aiming.
FIGURE 4-47 L J
000243 AIM POINT 9 IN. (228 mm)
FROM EITHER SIDE OF
COOKING AREA COOKING SURFACE
FIGURE 4-49
FRONT VIEW - -1 - ------- TI CENTER OF -1
COOKING SURFACE 0-3 IN. (76 mm)
NOTE A 2W NOZZLE CAN PROTECT A
COOKING GRIDDLE WITH A MAXIMUM COOKING
SURFACE OF 30 IN X 36 IN. (762 mm X /+ I AREA 914 mm). AT A HEIGHT OF 10-20 IN. (254
-' k— AIM POINT I 20 IN. THE 2W NOZZLE CAN BE POSITIONED (508mm) A MAXIMUM OF :t 10 IN. (254 mm)
______________________________ORWARD MAX.AX OR BEHIND COOKING
L__.__......___j
SURFACE CENTER LINE AND A
~N ji
MAXIMUM OF 3 IN. (76 mm) AWAY
10
FROM EITHER SIDE OF THE COOKING
(254 mm) SURFACE, AIMED IN 9 IN. (228 mm) TO
2120 NOZZLE LOCATED ALONG COOKING SURFACE EDGE MIN. A POINT 0-3 IN. (0-76mm). FORWARD
ANY SIDE OF GRIDDLE SURFACE OR TO THE REAR OF THE COOKING
SURFACE CENTER LINE. WITHIN 0-2 IN. (0-51 mm) OF
COOKING SURFACE EDGE. NOZZLE
MUST BE AIMED AT CENTER OF
COOKING SURFACE.
FIGURE 4-48
F 000241 AIM POINT SIN.
(228 mm) FROM
008150
FIGURE 4-50
I I
15-201N. I
I AIM
(381 -508mm) I J POI
I 201N.
fl (508 mm)
007524
000245
IN.
76 mm)
FIGURE 4-51
PROTECTED AREA
20.5 IN. (520mm)
R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
Griddle Protection 1W (1-Flow) Nozzle - Low Proximity
Application
15 in. to 20 in. (381 mm to 508 mm) above the cooking surface.
The low proximity 1-flow nozzle application for the protection of
griddles requires the 1W nozzle.
The nozzle is stamped with 1W indicating that this is a one-flow
nozzle and must be counted as one flow number.
When using the 1W nozzle for low proximity griddle protection
with our without obstruction, the maximum length of the cooking
surface to be protected must not exceed 26 in. (660 mm). The
nozzle must be centered at one end of the maximum 26 in.
(660 mm) length, aimed along a centerline to a point 20 in. (508
mm) from the end of the length, protecting a maximum width of
20.5 in. (520 mm).
The 1W nozzle tip must be positioned at or below the obstruc-
tion, if present. The protected area begins at the point straight
down from the nozzle tip. The nozzle can be positioned above
the edge of the hazard area to be protected. See Figure 4-51
and 4-52.
Note: If the hazard area exceeds the single nozzle coverage
listed above, additional nozzles will be required. The additional
nozzle can be positioned in front at high proximity or at the side
at low proximity.
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 4-21
Chain Broiler Protection
The following listed protection guidelines can be applied to any
manufacturer's chain broilers, if the chain broiler meets the
specified parameters. Chain broilers utilizing catalytic converters
can be protected from overhead using model specific protec-
tion identified in the "Specific Application by Model" section in
System Design. Or, they can be protected with standard 1 N
nozzle horizontal chain broiler protection with the nozzles posi-
tioned at either end of the chain broiler openings. Refer to the
"Horizontal Chain Broiler Protection" section for specific design
information.
Horizontal Chain Broiler Protection
The R-102 system can use two 1 N nozzles for horizontal chain
m. broiler protection. The nozzle is stamped 1 N, indicating that
this is a one-flow nozzle and must be counted as one flow
number (total of two flow numbers for each chain broiler being
protected).
Two 1N nozzles are always needed for chain broiler protec-
tion when the hazard area to be protected does not meet the
"Overhead Broiler Protection" requirements. The maximum
internal size of the broiler is 43 x 31 in. (1092 mm x 787 mm).
The nozzles must be positioned at each end of the enclosed
cooking chamber 1 to 3 in. (25 mm to 76 mm) above the surface
of the chain and a maximum distance of 4 in. (101 mm) away
from the broiler opening. The nozzles may be mounted at either
corner as long as they are at opposite ends of the chain broiler
and positioned to discharge diagonally across the top of the
chain. See Figure 4-53 and 4-54.
AIM POINT
20 IN.
(508 mm) -
26 IN.
(660 mm)
FIGURE 4-53
FIGURE 4-52
MAXIMUM INTER
BROILER SIZE 4
(1092 X 787 mm)
FIGURE 4-54
000247
Overhead Chain Broiler Protection
The R-1 02 system can use two 1W nozzles for overhead chain
broiler protection. The nozzle is stamped with 1W, indicating
that this is a one-flow nozzle and must be counted as one flow
number.
Overhead protection is only available for chain broilers with
exhaust opening dimensions that are not less than 60% of the
internal broiler length and not less than 60% of the internal
broiler width, to a minimum size of 12 in. x 12 in. (305 mm x
305 mm). Internal broiler size can not be larger than 32 in. x
34 in. (812 mm x 863 mm).
When overhead protection is used, the nozzles must be
centered above the exhaust opening within 4 to 8 in. (101 to 203
mm) of each other and they must be located 10 to 26 in. (254 to
660 mm) above the top of the broiler surface. See Figure 4-55.
12 IN. (305 mm)
MINIMUM
XIMUM INTERNAL
101LER SIZE
X 34 IN.
...12 0863mm'
FIGURE 4-55
000248
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 4-22 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
Horizontal Chain Broiler Protection (Continued)
The nozzles may vary in position as long as they are evenly
spaced from the exhaust center and are always 1800 opposite
of each other. If the opening is not square, the nozzles must be
positioned along the centerline, parallel to the longest side of the
opening. See Figure 4-56.
TOP VIEW TOP VIEW
FIGURE 4-56
000249
m. Note: The Metal Blow-off Cap must be used when utilizing
chain broiler protection.
Example No. 1 - Internal broiler size is 24 in. long x 20 in. wide
(609 mm x 508 mm), with an opening of 16 in. x 16 in.
(406 mm x 406 mm).
To determine minimum opening size, multiply the internal
length and the internal width by 0.6:
Length of opening —24 in. x 0.6 = 14.4 in.
(609 mm x 0.6 = 366 mm)
Width of opening - 20 in. x 0.6 = 12.0 in.
(508 mm x 0.6 = 304 mm)
The minimum allowable opening for overhead protection
would be 14.4 in. x 12.0 in. (365 mm x 304 mm).
This example would be acceptable for overhead protec-
tion.
Example No. 2 - Internal broiler size is 30 in. long x 24 in.
wide (762 x 609 mm) with an opening of 22 in. x 12 in.
(558 x 304 mm).
To determine minimum opening size, multiply internal
length and internal width by 0.6:
Length of opening - 30 in. x 0.6 = 18.0 in.
(762 mm x 0.6 = 457 mm)
Width of opening —24 in. x 0.6 = 14.4 in.
(609 mm x 0.6 = 365 mm)
Minimum allowable opening for overhead protection
would be 18 in. x 14.4 in. (457 mm x 365 mm).
Because this broiler has an opening of 22 in. x 12 in.
(558 mm x 304 mm), the 12 in. (304 mm) width is below
the minimum allowable calculated dimension of 14.4 in.
(365 mm) and therefore would not be acceptable for
overhead protection.
Salamander Broiler Protection
The R-102 system uses three different nozzle locations for
salamander broiler protection. All of the design options require
a one-flow nozzle.
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
Salamander Broiler Protection - 1 N (1-Flow) Nozzle
Overhead
A salamander broiler with a maximum hazard area (internal
broiler chamber) of 16 in. (406 mm) deep x 29 in. (736 mm) wide
P. can be protected using a 1 N nozzle. The nozzle is stamped with
1 N, indicating that this is a one-flow nozzle.
The single 1 N nozzle must be located directly in line with either
vertical edge of the broiler opening, 6 in. (152 mm)to 12 in. (304
mm) in front of the broiler, and 0 in. to 12 in. (304 mm) above the
top of the broiler. The nozzle must be aimed at the center of the
broiler opening. See Figure 4-57a.
VERTICAL EDGE
OF BROILER
OPENING 'IN NOZZLE
(PART NO. 419335)
I
NOZZLE
2IN - LOCATION ZONE
304 mm) IN. (52 mm)
6 IN. \ ()----------1
(152 mm)
AT CENTER
AIM AT CENTER OF OF BROILER
BROILER OPENING OPENING
FIGURE 4-57a
008426
Salamander Broiler Protection - 1 (1-Flow) Nozzle
Overhead
A salamander broiler with a maximum hazard area (internal
broiler chamber) of 15.5 in. (393 mm) deep x 31 in. (787 mm)
wide can be protected using a 1 F nozzle. The nozzle is stamped
with 1 F, indicating that this is a one-flow nozzle.
The single 1 nozzle must be located directly in line with the
center of the broiler opening, 8 in. (203 mm) to 12 in. (304 mm)
in front of the broiler and 12 in. (304 mm) to 18 in. (457 mm)
above the top of the broiler. The nozzle must be aimed at the
center of the top broiler opening when the grate is located in the
middle position. The nozzle must be orientated so the nozzle
tip flats are parallel with the grate left to right centerline. See
Figure 4-57b.
IF NOZZLE NOZZLE
(PARTO) 6 IN.
\
(152 mm) LOCATION ZONE
-0-
81N (203 mm)
4 I. \\ 121N
(10 1, mm\\ j(304mm)
AIM AT CENTER OF THE AIM AT CENTER OF THE TOP
TOP BROILER OPENING BROILER OPENING WHEN THE
WHEN THE GRATE GRATE IS LOCATED IN THE
IS LOCATED IN THE MIDDLE POSITIONAIM AT CENTER
MIDDLE POSITION OF BROILER OPENING
FIGURE 4-57b
008426
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 4-23
Salamander Broiler Protection - 1 (1-Flow) Nozzle Local
Note: The use of the Agent Distribution Hose should be consid-
ered when protecting a salamander broiler/range combination
appliance that employs casters.
A salamander broiler with a maximum hazard area (internal
broiler chamber) of 15 in. (381 mm) deep x 31 in. (787 mm) wide
o. can be protected using a 1 N nozzle. The nozzle is stamped with
iN, indicating that this is a one-flow nozzle.
The single 1 N nozzle must be affixed to the side of the cooking
chamber, above the grate on either vertical edge of the broiler
opening. The nozzle must be aimed at the center of the grates.
See Figure 4-57c.
FIGURE 4-57c
008428
Upright Broiler/Salamander Protection
The R-102 system uses two 1/2N Nozzles for all upright broiler
m. protection. The nozzle is stamped 1/2N, indicating that this is
a half-flow nozzle. A pair of these nozzles will equal one flow
number.
Two 1/2N nozzles will protect a maximum hazard area (internal
broiler chamber) of 30 in. x 32.5 in. (761 mm x 825 mm). These
nozzles must always be used in pairs on an upright broiler. One
nozzle must be positioned above the grate and pointed at the
back opposite corner of the broiler chamber. The second nozzle
must be pointed down into the center of the drip pan through the
open slot. See Figure 4-58.
1N NO
AT CENTER OF
GRATES
Upright Broiler/Salamander Protection (Continued)
UPRIGHT BROILER BROILER CHAMBER
RIP
AN
SIDE VIEW
FIGURE 4-58
000252
Gas-Radiant/Electric Char-Broiler Protection
The R-1 02 system uses the 1 N nozzle for gas-radiant/electric
char-broiler protection.
The nozzle is stamped with a iN, indicating that this is a
one-flow nozzle and must be counted as one flow number.
One 1 nozzle will protect a hazard with a maximum length of
36 in. (914 mm) and a total cooking area which does not exceed
864 in.2 (55741 mm2). The nozzle tip must be located 15 in. to
40 in. (381 mm to 1016 mm) above the hazard surface. When
using this nozzle for gas-radiant/electric char-broiler protection,
the nozzle must be positioned anywhere along or within the
perimeter of the maximum cooking area and shall be aimed at
the center of the cooking surface. See Figure 4-59a.
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 4-24 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
Electric Char-Broiler Protection (Optional)
The R-1 02 system uses the 1 N nozzle for electric char-broiler
protection.
The nozzle is stamped with a 1 N, indicating that this is a
one-flow nozzle and must be counted as one flow number.
One 1 N nozzle will protect a hazard with a maximum length of
34 in. (863 mm) and a total cooking area which does not exceed
680 in.2 (43870 mm2). The nozzle tip must be located 20 in. to
50 in. (508 mm to 1270 mm) above the hazard surface. When
using this nozzle for electric char-broiler protection, the nozzle
must be positioned anywhere along or within the perimeter of
the maximum cooking area and shall be aimed at the center of
the cooking surface. See Figure 4-59b.
50 IN.
(12 70 mm)
/ I MAXIMUM
20 IN. (508 mm)
/ / I MINIMUM
000257
FIGURE 4-59b
40 IN.
(10 16 mm)
/ I MAXIMUM
15 IN. (381 mm)
/ / MINIMUM
000257
FIGURE 4-59a
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
Lava Rock (Ceramic) Char-Broiler Protection
The R-102 system uses the iN nozzle for all lava rock char-
broiler protection. The nozzle is stamped with iN, indicating
that this is a one-flow nozzle and must be counted as one flow
number.
One iN nozzle will protect a hazard which has a maximum
length of 24 in. (609 mm) and a total cooking area which does
not exceed 312 in.2 (20128 mm2). The nozzle tip must be
located 18 in. to 35 in. (457 mm to 889 mm) above the hazard
surface. When using this nozzle for lava rock (ceramic) char-
broiler protection, the nozzle must be positioned anywhere along
or within the perimeter of the maximum cooking area and angled
to the center. See Figure 4-60.
COOKING
AREA COOKING
AREA AREA
I •
-.
CS
IT
/ 1
351N.
(889 mm)
MAXIMUM
18 IN.
(457 mm)
MINIMUM
1 000259 II
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 4-25
Natural Charcoal Broiler Protection
The R-102 system uses the 1 N nozzle for all natural charcoal
broiler protection. The nozzle is stamped with 1 N indicating
that this is a one-flow nozzle and must be counted as one flow
number.
One 1 N nozzle will protect a hazard area which has a maximum
length of 24 in. (610 mm) and a total cooking area which does
not exceed 288 in.2 (18580 mm2). The nozzle tip must be
located 18 in. to 40 in. (457 mm to 1016 mm) above the hazard
surface. When using this nozzle for natural charcoal broiler
protection, the nozzle must be positioned anywhere along or
within the perimeter of the maximum cooking area and aimed at
the center of the cooking surface. See Figure 4-61.
The coverage of such appliances only applies when the depth of
the charcoal does not exceed 4 in. (101 mm).
COOKING .COOKING AREA AREA
I
-
F
r
\ / 40 IN.
(1016 mm)
MAXIMUM
4 IN. (101 mm) / I 18
MAXIMUM I (457 mm)
DEPTH I MINIMUM
F 000259
FIGURE 4-60
FIGURE 4-61
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 4-26 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
Alternate Ceramic/Natural Charcoal Char-broiler Protection
The R-102 system may also use the 3N nozzle for all ceramic
(lava rock) and natural charcoal char-broiler protection. The
nozzle is stamped with 3N, indicating that this is a three-flow
nozzle and must be counted as three flow numbers.
One 3N nozzle will protect a hazard which has a maximum
length of 30 in. (762 mm) and a total cooking area which does
not exceed 720 in.2 (46451 mm2). The nozzle tip must be
located 14 in. to 40 in. (355 mm to 1016 mm) above the hazard
surface. The nozzle must be positioned anywhere along or
within the perimeter of the maximum cooking area and angled
to the center. See Figure 4-62.
For natural charcoal char-boiler protection, this coverage only
applies when the depth of the charcoal does not exceed 4 in.
(101 mm).
COOKING .4w-.. COOKING AREA AREA
I - I - -S
1<--.-.
I ---L - I l -S1-
R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
Wood Fueled Char-Broiler Protection
The R-102 system uses the 3N nozzle for mesquite char-broiler
o. protection. The nozzle is stamped with 3N indicating that this is
a three-flow nozzle and must be counted as three flow numbers.
One 3N nozzle will protect a hazard which has a maximum
length of 30 in. (762 mm) and a total cooking area which does
not exceed 720 in.2 (46451 mm2). The nozzle tip must be
located 14 in. to 40 in. (355 mm to 1016 mm) above the hazard
surface. The nozzle must be positioned anywhere along or
within the perimeter of the maximum cooking area and aimed at
the center of the cooking surface. See Figure 4-63.
Mesquite logs and pieces, no larger than 4 in. (102 mm) in diam-
eter, may be protected with a maximum allowable wood depth
of 6 in. (152 mm).
COOKING I
AREA COOKING
AREA
-.5- A I
TT
40IN
/t
I (101116 mm) I MAXIMUM
I I
4 IN. (101 mm"\ \
/1 /163____f•
/ (355mm) I
/ I
MAXIMUM
DEPTH
N I Ii
IF,
40 IN. / (1016 mm)
MAXIMUM
6 IN. (125 mm) 14 IN.
'
I
MAXIMUM DEPTH (355 mm)
N
I MINIMUM
000259
FIGURE 4-63
000259
FIGURE 4-62
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 4-27
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
Wok Protection
The R-1 02 system uses two different nozzles for the protection
of woks.
1. A 260 nozzle will protect a wok 14 in. (355 mm) minimum
diameter up to 30 in. (762 mm) maximum diameter. The wok
depth must be no less than 3.75 in. (95 mm) and no greater
than 8 in. (203 mm).
The nozzle is stamped with 260 indicating that this is a
two-flow nozzle and must be counted as two flow numbers.
When using this nozzle, the nozzle must be positioned as
shown in Figure 4-64.
NOZZLE MUST BE POSITIONED WITHIN 1 IN. (25 mm) RADIUS
OF THE CENTER OF THE WOK, POINTED VERTICALLY DOWN
260 NOZZLE
T
35-45 IN.
(889- 1143 mm)
MINIMUM DEPTH 3.75 IN. (95 mm)
MAXIMUM DEPTH 8 IN. (203 mm) I
f .4
14 IN. (355 mm) MINIMUM DIAMETER
30 IN. (762 mm) MAXIMUM DIAMETER
FIGURE 4-64
000261
2. A iN nozzle will protect a wok 11 in. (279 mm) minimum
diameter up to 24 in. (609 mm) maximum diameter. The wok
depth must be no less than 3 in. (76 mm) and no greater
than 6 in. (152 mm). The nozzle is stamped with iN indi-
cating that this a one-flow nozzle and must be counted as
one flow number. When using this nozzle, the nozzle must
be positioned anywhere along or within the perimeter of the
wok, aimed at the center, 30 in. to 40 in. (762 mm to 1016
mm) above the hazard surface, as shown in Figure 4-65.
NOTICE
When using this type of wok protection,
only five flow numbers are allowed on a
1.5 gal (5.7 L) system, and only eleven
flow numbers are allowed on a 3 gal (11.4
L) system.
/40 IN.
(1016 mm)
MINIMUM DEPTH
3.0 IN. (76 mm)
MAXIMUM DEPTH
6.0 IN. (152 mm)
30 IN.
(762
MM)
11 IN. (279 mm) MINIMUM DIAMETER
24 IN. (609 mm) MAXIMUM DIAMETER
FIGURE 4-65
000261
• SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
5 UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 4-28 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
5 Nozzle Application Chart . The following chart has been developed to assist in calculating
the quantity and type of nozzle required to protect each duct,
• plenum, or appliance.
Minimum •Maximum Hazard Nozzle
Hazard Dimensions Quantity
S Duct or Transition Length - Unlimited 1
5 (Single Nozzle) Perimeter-50 in. (1270 mm)
Diameter— 16 in. (406 mm)
Duct or Transition Length - Unlimited 1 5 (Single Nozzle) Perimeter - 100 in. (2540 mm)
Diameter - 31 7/8 in. (809 mm) •Duct or Transition Length - Unlimited 2
(Dual Nozzle) Perimeter— 150 in. (3810 mm)
5 Diameter-48 in. (1219 mm) . Electrostatic Precipitator Individual Cell 1
(At Base of Duct)
Plenum Length - 10 ft (3.0 m) 1
5 (Horizontal Protection)
5 Plenum Length —6 ft (1.8 m) 1
• (Horizontal Protection) Width —4 ft (1.2 m)
5 Plenum Length - 4 ft (1.2 m) 1
(Vertical Protection) Width - 4 ft (1.2 m)
5 Fryer (Split or Maximum Size
• Non-Split Vat) (without drip board)
14 in. (355 mm) x
5 15 in. (381 mm) 1
• Low Proximity
Fryer (Split or Maximum Size
Non-Split Vat) (without drip board)
• 14 1/2 in. (368 mm) x
14 in. (355 mm) 1
5 Medium Proximity
5 Fryer (Split or Maximum Size
S Non-Split Vat)* (without drip board)
15 in. (381 mm) x
S 14 in. (355 mm)
High Proximity 1
5 Medium Proximity 1
5 Fryer (Non-Split Vat Only) Maximum Size
5 (without drip board)
191/2 in. (495 mm) x
• 19 in. (482 mm)
High Proximity 1
5 Low Proximity 1 . Maximum Size
(without drip board)
5 18 in. (457 mm)
• xl8 in. (457mm)
High Proximity 1 .
* For multiple nozzle protection of single fryers, see detailed information on Pages 4-10 and 4-11
S
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
NOTICE
This chart is for general reference only. See
complete details for each type of hazard.
Nozzle
Nozzle Nozzle Stamping -
Heights Part No. Flow No.
- 439839 1W
- 439840 2W
- 439840 2W
- 439837 1/2N
- 439838 iN
- 439839 1W
- 439839 1W
13—l6in. 439845 290
(330 - 406 mm)
16-27 in. 439845 290
(406 - 685 mm)
27-47 in. 439842 230
20-27 in. 439843 245
21-34in. 439841 3N
13—l6in. 439845 290
25 —35 in. 439841 3N
(635-889 mm)
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
I
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN I
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
rA riti AA rA,'I A *•t 2014-SEE-01 REV. ii riu '+- .
Minimum Nozzle
Nozzle Nozzle Nozzle Stamping -
Quantity Heights Part No. Flow No.
1 16-21 in. 439845
(406-533 mm)
290
S
5 27 —47 in. 439842 230
(685-1193 mm)
20-27 in. 439843 245
(508 - 685 mm)
S
S
21 —34 in. 439841 3N
(533 - 863 mm)
13-16 in. 439845 290 5 (330-406 mm)
25 - 35 in. 439841 3N 5 (635-889 mm) •
16-21 in.
(406-533 mm)
439845 290 5
Nozzle Application Chart (Continued)
Maximum Hazard
Hazard Dimensions
Fryer (Non-Split Vat Only) Maximum Size
(Continued) (without drip board)
14 1/2 in. (368 mm)
x 16.5 in. (419 mm)
High Proximity
Fryer (Non-Split Maximum Size
Vat Only)* (with drip board)
21 in. (533 mm) x
14 in. (355 mm)
(Fry Pot must not exceed
15 in. x 14 in.
(381 mm x 355 mm))
High Proximity
Medium Proximity
Maximum Size
(with drip board)
25 3/8 in. (644 mm)
x 19 1/2 in. (495 mm)
(Fry pot side must not
exceed 19 1/2 in.
(495 mm) x 19 in.
(483 mm)
High Proximity
Low Proximity
Maximum Size
(with drip board)
18 in. (457 mm)
x 27 3/4 in. (704 mm)
High Proximity
Maximum Size
(with drip board)
14 1/2 in. (368 mm)
x 26.5 in. (673 mm)
High Proximity
Fryer (Split or Maximum Size
Non-Split Vat) (with drip board)
14 in. (355 mm) x
21 in. (533 mm)
Low Proximity
Fryer (Split or Maximum Size
Non-Split Vat) (with drip board)
14 1/2 in. (368 mm) x
26 1/2 in. (673 mm)
Medium Proximity
* For multiple nozzle protection of single fryers, see detailed information on Pages 4-10 and 4-11.
S
S
13 —16 in. 439845 290 5 (330-406 mm)
S
16 —27 in. 439845 290 S
(406 - 685 mm)
S
S
Minimum
Nozzle Nozzle Nozzle
Quantity Heights Part No.
1 30-40 in. 439838
(762-1016 mm)
1 15-20 in. 439838
(381 - 508 mm)
40 —48 in. 439836
(1016-1219 mm)
(With Backshelf)
30 —40 in. 439844
(762-1016 mm)
(With Backshelf)
1 40-50 in. 439843
(1016— 1219 mm)
1 30-40 in. 439844
(762-1016 mm)
2 15-20 in. 439845
(381 —508 mm)
1 30—SUin. 439844
(762-1270 mm)
(perimeter
located)
1 30-50in. 439845
(762-1270 mm)
(center located)
1 35-40in.
(889-1016 mm)
(perimeter located)
1 20-301n.
(508 - 762 mm)
(perimeter
located)
1 15-20in.
(381 - 508 mm)
(center located)
Nozzle
Stamping -
Flow No.
1
1
1
260
245
260
290
260
290
439838/439865 1 N/1 NSS
439845 290
439839 1W
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 4-30 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
Nozzle Application Chart (Continued)
Maximum Hazard
•
Hazard Dimensions . Range Longest Side (High Proximity)
32 in. (812 mm)
Area - 384 in.2
• (24774 mm2)
Longest Side (Low Proximity)
24 in. (609 mm)
Area - 432 in.2
(27870 mm2)
Longest Side
28 in. (711 mm)
Area - 336 in.2
• (21677 mm2)
Longest Side
32 in. (812 mm)
Area - 384 in.2
(24774 mm2)
Longest Side (High Proximity)
• 28 in. (711 mm)
Area-672 in.2
S (43354 mm2) . Longest Side
(Medium Proximity)
32 in. (812 mm)
Area - 768 in.2
(49548 mm2)
Longest Side (Low Proximity)
• 36 in. (914 mm)
Area - 1008 in.2
(65032 mm2)
Griddle Longest Side (High Proximity)
48 in. (1219 mm)
Area-1440 in.2
(92903 mm2)
• Longest Side (High Proximity)
30 in. (762 mm) . Area - 720 in.2
(46451 mm2)
S Longest Side (High Proximity)
36 in. (914 mm)
Area - 1080 in.2
(69677 mm2)
Longest Side . (Medium Proximity)
48 in. (1219 mm) . Area-1440 in.2
(92903 mm2) S Longest Side (Low Proximity)
26 in. (660 mm)
Area - 533 in.2
(34387 mm2)
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
.
I
I
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
Nozzle Application Chart (Continued)
Minimum
Maximum Hazard Nozzle Nozzle
Hazard Dimensions Quantity Heights
Griddle (Continued) Longest Side (Low Proximity) 1 10-20
36 in. (914 mm) (254—
Area - 1080 in.2 (perime
(69677 mm2)
Longest Side (Low Proximity) 1 10-20
48 in. (1219 mm) (254—
Area - 1440 in.2 (perime
(92903 mm2) located;
Chain Broiler* Length - 34 in. (863 mm) 2 10 -26
(Overhead Protection) Width —32 in. (812 mm) (254 -
Chain Broiler Length —43 in. (1092 mm) 2 1 - 3 in
(Horizontal Protection) Width - 31 in. (787 mm) (25 -7(
Gas-Radiant/Electric Longest Side —36 in. (914 mm) 1 15-40
Char-Broiler Area - 864 in.2 (381 -
(55741 mm2)
Electric Char-Broiler Longest Side - 34 in. (863 mm) 1 20 -50
Area - 680 in.2 (508 -
(43870 mm2)
Lava-Rock Broiler Longest Side —24 in. (609 mm) 1 18-35
Area —312 in.2 (457-1
(20128 mm2)
Natural Charcoal Broiler Longest Side - 24 in. (609 mm) 1 18 -40
Area - 288 in.2
. (457 -'
(18580 mm2)
Lava-Rock or Natural Longest Side - 30 in. (762 mm) 1 14 —40 in
Charcoal Char-Broiler Area —720 in.2 (355 -10
(46451 mm2)
Wood Fueled Char-Broiler Longest Side —30 in. (762 mm) 1 14 —40 in
Area - 720 in.2 (355 -10
(46451 mm2)
Upright Broiler/ Length - 32.5 in. (825 mm) 2 -
Salamander Width —30 in. (762 mm)
Salamander Length - 29 in. (736 mm) 1 -
Broiler Width - 16 in. (406 mm)
Length - 31 in. (787 mm) 1 -
Width - 15 in. (381 mm)
Length - 31 in. (787 mm) 1 -
Width-15 in. (381 mm)
Wok l4 in. —30 in. (355-762mm) 1 35-45in
Diameter (889 - 11
3.75 - 8.0 in. (95 —203 mm)
Deep
11 in.-24 in. (279-609 mm) 30-40 in
Diameter (762 -10'
3.0-6.0 in. (76-152 mm)
Deep
* Minimum chain broiler exhaust opening —12 in. x 12 in. )305 mm x 305 mm), and not less than 60% of internal broiler size.
I
I SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
ULEX347O ULCEX347O
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 4-31
I
Nozzle
Nozzle Stamping -
Part No. Flow No.
439840 2W 1
rim)
cated)
S
439846 2120
rim)
S 439839/439864 1W/1 WSS
rim)
S 439838/439865 iN/i NSS
S
439838/439865 iN/i NSS
mm)
439838/439865 1N/1NSS
mm)
439838/439865 iN/i NSS S
imP) 5
5 439838/439865 1N/1 NSS
mm) 5
439841 3N
m)
S
439841 3N
rn)
S
439837 1/2N 5
439838 iN
439836 iF 5
5 439838 iN
439844 260
5 439838/439865 iN/i NSS
Ti)
S
S
S
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 4-32 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
SPECIFIC APPLICATION BY MODEL FRY POT CENTERLINE
'It. Due to the configuration, application, and/or additional features 81N. 11/S IN.
(203 mm) 11/8 IN. —.-.1 Ij.- 1
(28W NOZZLE
mm) that pose protection problems using conventional protection, (28 mm)
noted in the guidelines previously addressed, the following appli-
(152 mm)
290 NOZZLE
_j,
ances/applications are considered hazard specific. 6 IN. -.
The following hazard specific applications have been individually
tested and listed by make and model number of the equipment I I AIM POINT I I " I 73/4-8 IN. ONLY I
designated. I LL2.J I (196 _203 mm)
000282 Dean Industries Gas Fryer, Model 2424 GTI, 120,000 BTU/
hr. Rating
This specialized gas fryer can be protected with a combination
of a 290 nozzle and a 1W nozzle for low proximity (7 3/4-8 in.
(197 - 203 mm) nozzle height only) and two 230 nozzles (Part
No. 419339) for high proximity (45 in. (1143 mm) nozzle height
only).
The maximum dimension of the fry pot is 24 in. x 24 in. (610 mm
x610mm).
Nozzles must be positioned and aimed as shown in Figure 4-66.
Note: For low proximity protection, see Special Piping Layout
in Figure 4-67.
LOW PROXIMITY (73/4-BIN. (196-203 mm) NOZZLE HEIGHT)
21/4 IN.
2 1/4 IN. (57 mm)
(57 mm) 230 NOZZLE
FRONT EDGE
OF FRY POT A ZZ 230 NO I
11 IN.
LNLY
(279 mm)
45 IN.
I(1143mm)
TOP OF FRYER
H PI 000283 I AIM POINT H L-------.J L - --
HIGH PROXIMITY (45 IN. (1143 mm) NOZZLE HEIGHT ONLY)
FIGURE 4-66
Dean Industries Model GTI Gas Fryer Special Piping
Layout
Section A (Tank to Hood Penetration) Piping Limitations
Maximum Length: 30 ft (9.1 m)
Maximum Rise: 6 ft (1.8 m)
Maximum Number of 900 Elbows: 7
Maximum Number of Tees: 0
Section B (Hood Penetration to Nozzles) Piping Limitations
Piping configuration shall be as shown with ±1/4 in. (6 mm)
tolerance on dimensions.
All nozzles shall be at the same elevation.
Each pair of appliance nozzles shall be equally spaced from
left-to-right centerline of fryer.
2907
2 1/4 IN.
21 IN. (533 mm) or (57 mm) I . 24 IN. (609 mm)
TO 3 GAL (11.4 L) TANK
SECTION A 290 -0.1 21/8IN. 23/41N.
(53 mm) (69 mm)
HOOD PENETRATION
1W
IN. (533 mm) or
290
21/4 IN. 24 IN. (609 mm)
29 5/8 IN.
(752 mm) 2 11/16 IN 1W (68 mm) (609 mm)
__,..
2
24 IN.
1 IN, (533 mm) or (57 mm)
21/4 IN.
(57 mm)
21/4 IN.
(57 mm)
SPECIFIC DISCHARGE PIPING FOR LOW PROXIMITY PROTECTION OF FOUR DEAN INDUSTRIES MODEL GTI GAS FRYERS FIGURE 4-67
000284
11
163/4 IN. (425 mm)
MAXIMUM
FIGURE 4-69
000209
14
(355
FIGURE 4-68
R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
SPECIFIC APPLICATION BY MODEL (Continued)
Far West Hospitality Products Gas Fryer, Model PAR-1-20,
63000 BTU/hr Rating
This specialized gas fryer can be protected with a single, 290
nozzle.
The maximum dimension of the fry pot is 21 in. x 21 in. (533
mm x 533 mm).
The 290 nozzle must be located on the front-to-rear centerline
and aimed at the center of the cooking surface. See Figure 4-68.
4 1/2 IN.
(114 mm)
1411
(355
BACK OF
FRYER
SIDE VIEW OF FRYER
000285
290 NOZZLE LOCATED ON FRONT-TO-REAR CENTERLINE ± 4.5 IN. (114 mm) FROM
SIDE TO SIDE CENTERLINE AND AIMED AT CENTER OF COOKING AREA.
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 4-33
Frymaster 14 KW - 208V Electric Fryer, Model MACH 14
Series
This specialized single vat electric fryer can be protected either
with a single 230 nozzle located 27 in. to 47 in. (685 mm to
1193 mm) above the top surface of the fryer or with a single 245
nozzle located 20 in. to 27 in. (508 mm to 685 mm) above the
top surface of the fryer.
Either nozzle must be located anywhere along or within the
perimeter of the cooking surface and aimed at the midpoint.
See Figure 4-69. The maximum size of the fry pot (without drip
board) is 13 3/4 in. x 16 3/4 in. (349 mm x 425 mm) and the
maximum size of the cooking surface (with drip board) is 13 3/4
in. x 20 7/8 in. (349 mm x 530 mm). The vat may be divided in
half to make two split vats.
230 NOZZLE TIP OR 245 NOZZLE TIP ANYWHERE ALONG OR WITHIN THE PERIMETER
OF THE COOKING SURFACE AND AIMED AT THE MIDPOINT.
2 20 7/8 IN. 30 NOZZLE
(0 mm)
MAXIMUM
71 230 NOZZLE
245 27 IN. -47 IN.
/ NOZZLE (685 mm -
I
1193 mm)ABOVE 13 TOP SURFACE
(349 mm) OF FRYER
/
245
20 i 27 IN. I
MAXIMUM
OZZLE I
(508mm- I /1 685 mm) I
I / I ABOVETOP I
I II SURFACE OF I II IFRYER .1
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 4-34 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
SPECIFIC APPLICATION BY MODEL (Continued)
r Frymaster Energy Efficient RE 14 Fryer
This electric fryer can be protected with either a single 230
nozzle located 27 to 47 in. (685 mm to 1193 mm) above the top
surface of the fryer or with a single 245 nozzle located 20 to 27
in. (508 mm to 685 mm) above the top surface of the fryer.
Either nozzle must be located anywhere along or within the
perimeter of the cooking surface and aimed at the midpoint.
See Figure 4-70. The maximum size of the fry pot (without drip
board) is 14 x 15 1/2 in. (355 mm x 393 mm) and the maximum
size of the cooking surface (with drip board) is 14 x 20 7/8 in.
(355 mm x 530 mm). The vat may be divided in half to make
two split vats.
230 NOZZLE TIP OR 245 NOZZLE TIP ANYWHERE ALONG OR WITHIN THE PERIMETER
OF THE COOKING SURFACE AND AIMED AT THE MIDPOINT.
2 20 7/8 IN. 30 NOZZLE
(530 mm)
MAXIMUM
230 NOZZLE
245 27 IN. -47 IN.
/ NOZZLE (685 mm -
1193 mm) ABOVE 14 IN TOP SURFACE (355 mm) OF FRYER MAXIMUM
OZZLE I
/L.-271N.
I
/ I (508mm- I
/ I 685 mm) I
ABOVE TOP I
SURFACE OF I / FRYER .1
15 1/2 IN. (393 mm)
MAXIMUM
FIGURE 4-70
McDonald Fryer (Nozzle Heights of Less Than 20 in.
(508 mm))
When the 245 nozzle is used to protect McDonald's fryers at
heights less than 20 in. (508 mm) above the top of the fryer, the
following appliance and distribution piping rules shall apply:
1. Each McDonald's gas or electric fryer shall be protected by
one 245 nozzle. The fryer vat dimensions for one full vat or
two split vats shall not exceed 14 in. x 15 in. (355 mm x 381
mm) without the dripboard and 14 in. x 21 in. (355 mm x 533
mm) with the dripboard.
The heat input rating of the fryer shall not exceed 122,000
BTU/HR.
The 245 nozzle shall be located 18 in. to 20 in. (457 mm to
508 mm) above the top of the fryer vat, 2 in. to 2 1/4 in.
(51 mm to 57 mm) to the right or left of the front-to-rear vat
centerline, and 0 to 3 1/4 in. (0 to 82 mm) forward of the
right-to-left vat centerline, and aimed at the vat center point.
See Figure 4-71.
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
REAR
FRONT-TO-REAR
VAT CENTERLINE
I RIGHT-TO-LEFT VAT
CENTERLINE AIM
/POINT
NOZZLE
_
t3 1/4 IN. LOCATION (82 ZONES
-21N.
(51 mm)
21/4 IN. 21/4 IN
(57 mm) • (57 mm)
FRONT
FIGURE 4-71
002297
The distance between the start of the first branch line and the
start of the last branch line shall not exceed 79 in. (2006 mm).
The total length of all branch lines shall not exceed 162 in.
(4114 mm).
The 3 gallon agent tank shall be elevated above the connec-
tions between the supply and branch lines.
The requirements of the following table shall not be
exceeded:
Duct Plenum Appliance
Supply Branch Branch Branch
Requirement Line Line Line Line
Pipe Size 3/8 in. 3/81n. 3/8 in. 3/8 in.
Maximum Length 140 in. 67 in. 6 in. 42 in.
(3556 mm) (1701 mm) (152 mm) (1066 mm)
Minimum Length 81 in. 4 in. 4 in. 17 in.
(2057 mm) (101 mm) (101 mm) (431 mm)
Maximum 5 3 1 6
90° Elbows
Maximum Tees 0 1 1 1
Maximum Flow 11 2 1 2
Numbers
Minimum Flow 5 0 0 1/2
Numbers
TOP VIEW 5 IN.
(127 mm)
1/16 IN.
'mm)
6 IN.
6 mm)
SIDE VIEW
79/16 IN.
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
SPECIFIC APPLICATION BY MODEL (Continued)
Henny Penny Mono Rail Center Lift System - Models 690,
691,692
Nozzle Type: One 1 N nozzle (Upper position)
One 1 F nozzle (Lower position)
Nozzle Location:
iN Nozzle (Upper position): From the Tee Block, position
nozzle tip 16 in. (406 mm) up from base of fryer surface and 5
in. (127 mm) in from right side of appliance back shroud
1 F Nozzle (Lower Position): Running down from the Tee Block
to the base of the fryer, position the nozzle tip 2 in. (51 mm) from
back side of fry vat, and 8 in. (203 mm) in from the right side of
appliance back shroud
Nozzle Aiming Point:
1 N Nozzle: At center point of fry vat
1 F Nozzle: The 1 F nozzle is a flat spray nozzle and the spray
must be horizontal to that of the edge of the back lip of the fry vat
System Coverage: Each fryer requires a minimum of 3 gal
(11.4 L) of ANSULEX Low pH agent discharging through the two
one-flow nozzles (1 N and 1 F)
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 4-35
Note: In this application, R-102 agent storage tanks must
be pressurized from a dedicated R-102 double-tank nitrogen
cartridge. The cartridge utilized for this hazard-specific Henny
Penny fryer protection cannot be shared with tanks intended
for standard R-102 protection. Standard protection will require
an expellant gas cartridge installed in another actuation device
such as an AUTOMAN regulated release or regulated actuator
assembly.
AIMING POINT
NOTE 1: IT IS RECOMMENDED THAT THE AGENT DISTRIBUTION
HOSE rr (PART NO. 435982) BE UTILIZED DURING
SYSTEM INSTALLATION.
NOTE 2: VAT DIMENSIONS -
16 IN. (406 mm) WIDTH
20 1/4 IN. (514 mm) LENGTH
28 1/2 IN. (724 mm) DEPTH
MAXIMUM LID HEIGHT ABOVE VAT -
15 IN. (381 mm)
TEE
BLOCK
FRONT VIEW
(TEE BLOCK LOCATION)
FIGURE 4-72
AIM INC POINT 5 IN.
IM)
N.
nm)
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 4-36 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
SPECIFIC APPLICATION BY MODEL (Continued)
Henny Penny Dual Lift System - Models 580, 581, 582, 590,
591, 592, 680, 682, 691
Nozzle Type: One 1 N nozzle (Upper position)
One 1 F nozzle (Lower position)
Nozzle Location:
IN Nozzle (Upper position): From the Tee Block, position
nozzle tip 16 in. (406 mm) up from base of fryer surface and
5 in. (127 mm) in from left side of appliance back shroud
IF Nozzle (Lower position): Running down from the Tee Block
to the base of the fryer, position the nozzle tip 2 in. (51 mm) from
back side of fry vat, and 8 in. (203 mm) in from the left side of
appliance back shroud.
Nozzle Aiming Point:
1 Nozzle: At center point of fry vat
1 F Nozzle: The 1 F nozzle is a flat spray nozzle and the spray
must be horizontal to that of the edge of the back lip of the fry vat
System Coverage: Each fryer requires a minimum of 3 gal
(11.4 L) of ANSULEX Low pH agent discharging through the two
one-flow nozzles (1 N and 1 F)
NOTE 1: IT IS RECOMMENDED THAT THE AGENT DISTRIBUTION
HOSE KR (PART NO. 435982) BE UTILIZED DURING SYSTEM
INSTALLATION.
NOTE 2: VAT DIMENSIONS -
16 IN. (406 mm) WIDTH
20 1/4 IN. (514 mm) LENGTH
28 1/2 IN. (724 mm) DEPTH
MAXIMUM LID HEIGHT ABOVE VAT -
15 IN. (381 mm)
79/16IN. TEE
1613/
(427
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
Note: In this application, R-102 agent storage tanks must
be pressurized from a dedicated R-102 double-tank nitrogen
cartridge. The cartridge utilized for this hazard-specific Henny
Penny fryer protection cannot be shared with tanks intended
for standard R-102 protection. Standard protection will require
an expellant gas cartridge installed in another actuation device
such as an AUTOMAN regulated release or regulated actuator
assembly.
FRONT VIEW SIDE VIEW
(TEE BLOCK LOCATION) FIGURE 4-73
1.25 IN.
(32 mm)
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
SPECIFIC APPLICATION BY MODEL (Continued)
Henny Penny Dual Lift System - Model PXE-100
Nozzle Type: One 1 N nozzle (Upper position)
One 1 nozzle (Lower position)
Nozzle Location:
iN Nozzle (Upper position): From the Tee Block, position
nozzle tip 16.75 in. (425 mm) up from base of fryer surface and
1.75 in. (44 mm) in from right side of appliance back shroud
1 F Nozzle (Lower position): Running down from the Tee Block
to the base of the fryer, position the nozzle tip 2 in. (51 mm) up
from the base of the fryer surface, and 2.25 in. (57 mm) in from
the right side of appliance back shroud
Nozzle Aiming Point:
1 N Nozzle: At center point of fry vat
1 F Nozzle: The 1 nozzle is a flat spray nozzle and the spray
must be horizontal to that of the edge of the back lip of the fry vat
System Coverage: Each fryer requires a minimum of 3 gal
(11.4 L) of ANSULEX Low pH agent discharging through the two
one-flow nozzles (1 N and 1 F)
NOTE 1: IT IS RECOMMENDED THAT THE AGENT DISTRIBUTION
HOSE KIT (PART NO. 435982) BE UTILIZED DURING SYSTEM
INSTALLATION.
NOTE 2: VAT DIMENSIONS -
14.93 IN. (379 mm) WIDTH
20.55 IN. (522 mm) LENGTH
17.42 IN. (442 mm) DEPTH
HEAT OUTPUT- 17kW
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. ii PAGE 4-37
Note: In this application, R-102 agent storage tanks must
be pressurized from a dedicated R-102 double-tank nitrogen
cartridge. The cartridge utilized for tk5 hazard-specific Henny
Penny fryer protection cannot be shared with tanks intended
for standard R-102 protection. Standard protection will require
an expellant gas cartridge installed in another actuation device
such as an AUTOMAN regulated release or regulated actuator
assembly.
16.7
(425
TOP VIEW
1.75 IN. (44 mm)
TOP NOZZLE
2 IN. ,.i1LJ!i1
(51 mm) rjD
2.25 IN. (57 mm)
BOTTOM NOZZLE
FRONT VIEW
(TEE BLOCK LOCATION)
SIDE VIEW
(NOZZLE LOCATION) FIGURE 4-74
009481
ADAPTOR
CLOSE NIPPLE
0
- ELBOW
._-CLOSE NIPPLE 3 IN. ±0.125 IN.
0 rrt1 \J (76mm±3mm)
2120 NOZZLE TO NOZZLE TIP
V
6.25 IN. * 0.125 IN.
(159 mm ± 3mm)
FIGURE 4-76
009459
FRYER FLUE
FIGURE 4-77
009460
SECTION 4 - SYSTEM DESIGN R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 4-38 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
SPECIFIC APPLICATION BY MODEL (Continued) NOZZLE CROSS SECTION VIEW
Pitco SPINFRESH Fryer - Models MElI, MGll, SE14, SE14R,
SE14X, SG144S, SG14RS, SEH50, SEH5017, SGH50,
SGH5017, SSH55, SSH55R
Nozzle Quantity/Type: Two 2120 nozzles
One Agent Distribution Hose and Restraining Cable Kit (Part
No. 435982) must be utilized for each fryer (see Figure 4-78)
The 3/8 in. Quik-Seal mechanical bulkhead fitting (Part No.
77285) must be utilized for the connections through fryer
cover.
Nozzle must be installed with the standard Metal Blow-Off Cap
(Part No. 439861) or the Stainless Steel Blow-Off Cap (Part
No. 439866).
Fryer electrical power source must be connected for electri-
cal shutdown upon system actuation through the use of the
ANSUL R-102 Snap Action Switch Kit (Part Nos. 423878-
423881).
FIGURE 4-75
009476
6 IN.
61N. (152m
(152 mrn)-4
14 IN.
(356 mm)
MEASURE TO THE CENTER
OF FITTINGS
AGENT
DISTRIBUTION HOSE
AND RESTRAINING
CABLE KIT
(PART NO. 435982)
FIGURE 4-78
009477
R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual SECTION 4—SYSTEM DESIGN I
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 4-39
SPECIFIC APPLICATION BY MODEL (Continued)
BELSHAW Century Fryers - Models C100, C200, C200G, I
C300G, C400, C400G, C600, C600G
Nozzle Type: 3N nozzle
Nozzle Spacing: 11.5 in. (292 mm) maximum from end of
fryer and 25.5 in. (647 mm) maximum on centers •
Nozzle Height: 35 in. (889 mm) above top of appliance
Nozzle Position: 2 in. (51 mm) in from inside edge of fry vat
Nozzle Aiming Point: Along the centerline of fry vat
v 11.5 N.
25.51 .i' (292 mm)
(647 mm)
25.5 IN.
92
35 IN.
40 I (889 MM)
( '-' • 35 IN.
006908.
FIGURE 4-79
BELSHAW Century Fryers
Specifications ClOD C200 C200G C300G C400 C400G C600 C600G
Fryer Vat Size • Length: Inches 65 65 65 65 122.25 122 122.25 122
(mm) (1651) (1651) (1651) (1651) (3105) (3099) (3105) (3099)
Width: Inches 12 20 20 31.25 20.25 21.25 31 31.25
(mm) (305) (508) (508) (794) (514) (540) (787) (794)
Depth: Inches 5.25 5.25 9.75 9.75 6.25 11.25 7.12 11.00
(mm) (133) (133) (248) (248) (159) (286) (181) (279)
BTU Rating: K - - 188 200 - 350 - 360 I
Vat Oil Capacity: Lb 110 188 346 700 478 600 675 1250 S
(kg) (49.8) (85.2) (156.9) (317.5) (216.8) (272.1) (306.1) (566.9)
S
I
S
35 IN.
(889 n
Fryer Specifications:
Vat Size:
Length: 122 in. (3098 m
Width: 31.3 in. (795 mrr
Depth: 11 in. (279 mm)
BTU Rating: 360k
Vat Oil Capacity:
1250 lb (566.9 kg)
OO75O5
FIGURE 4-80
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 4-40 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
SPECIFIC APPLICATION BY MODEL (Continued)
Dunkin Donuts Fryer Model DD400CGF
Nozzle Type: 3N nozzle
Nozzle Spacing: 11.5 in. (292 mm) maximum from end of
fryer and 25.5 in. (647 mm) maximum on
centers
Nozzle Height: 35 in. (889 mm) above top of appliance
Nozzle Position: 2 in. (51 mm) in from inside edge of fry vat
Nozzle Aiming Point: Along the centerline of fry vat
i. Krispy Kreme Flyers - Models 55M, 65 D/H, 110 D/H, 11 OM,
150 D/H, 220M, 270 D/H, 600 D/H, and 1000 D/H
Nozzle Type: 3N nozzle
Nozzle Spacing: 11.5 in. (292 mm) maximum from end of
fryer and on maximum 25.5 in. (647 mm)
centers
Nozzle Height: 35 in. (889 mm) above top of appliance
Nozzle Position: 2 in. (51 mm) from inside edge of fry vat
Nozzle Aiming Point:Along centerline of fry vat
Note: Figure 4-81 shows maximum size fryer (Model 1000 D/H).
Smaller size fryers (Models 150 D/H, 270 D/H, and 600 D/H) can
be protected with less nozzles but nozzle spacings, height
requirements, and positions, must be maintained as shown in
Figure 4-81.
11.5 IN.
(292 mm)
25.5 IN.
(647 mr
25.5 IN. J'
(1 25.5 IN. (647 mm)
(647 pm)
11.5 IN.
(292 mm)
35 IN.
(889 mm)
FIGURE 4-81
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
SPECIFIC APPLICATION BY MODEL (Continued)
Garland Electric Dual-Side Clamshell Broiler - Model
CXBE12
Nozzle Quantity/Type: One iN nozzle
Nozzle Height: 12 in. (304.8 mm) to 15 in. (381 mm) above
lower cooking surface
Nozzle Location: 1 in. (26 mm) from side of appliance at
12 in. (304.8 mm) up
1 in. (26 mm) to 3 in. (76 mm) from side of
appliance at 15 in. (381 mm) up
See Figure 4-82
Nozzle Aiming Point: Center of lower cooking surface
)ZZLE CENTERED WITH
WER COOKING SURFACE
NOZZLE AIMED TO CENTER OF LOWER
KING SURFACE
2 IN. TO 15 IN. (304.8 mm to 381 mm) ABOVE
DWER COOKING SURFACE
IN. (26 mm) FROM SIDE OF APPLIANCE AT 12 IN.
04.8 mm) UP; 1 IN. TO 3 IN. (26 mm to 76 mm) FROM
IDE OF APPLIANCE AT 15 IN. (361 mm) UP
TOP COOKING SURFACE: 10.2 IN. x 22.4 IN.
(259 mm x 569 mm)
BOTTOM COOKING SURFACE: 10.8 IN. x 22.2 IN.
(274 mm x 564 mm)
TOTAL LOAD: 16 kW
FIGURE 4-82
I
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN I
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 4-41
S
I
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
I
S
S
I
S
I
S
S
Nozzle Aiming Point: Aimed at at center of impedance plate
LOW SIDE
OF PLATE Note: If the deflector or flue gas diverter is rotated 180 degrees,
the nozzles must also rotate to discharge into the opening.
61/2 IN.
(165 mm)
61/2 IN. (165 mm) FROM EDGE OF APPLIANCE
THAT IMPEDANCE PLATE IS
ANGLED TOWARD (SEE SIDE VIEW)
15 IN. ...Li7 1/4
PERFORATED
GRILL
CENTER
DUCT
oomm
TOP VIEW
245 NOZZLE FLUE GAS
DIVERTER
6 1/2 IN. (165 mm) 8IN mm)to
FROM EDGE OF 15 IN. (381 mm)
APPLIANCE THAT NOZZLE HEIGHT
IMPEDANCE
PLATE IS ANGLED
TOWARD I
PRDUCT
-INPUT
PRODUCT
OUTPUT
BACK FRONT
008099
SIDE VIEW
FIGURE 4-84
290 NOZZLE
15-20 IN.
(381-508 mm)
Front View (Feed Side)
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 4-42 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
SPECIFIC APPLICATION BY MODEL (Continued)
DUKE Chain Broiler - Model FBB-High Proximity
DUKE Chain Broiler With or Without Catalyst View:
Nozzle Quantity/Type: One 290 nozzle
Nozzle Height: 15 to 20 in. (381 to 508 mm) above top of
appliance
Nozzle Location: Centered 6 1/2 in. (165 mm) back from
front feed edge of appliance. Nozzle must be oriented to
spray onto impedance plate.
Nozzle Aiming Point: Aimed at center of impedance plate
Side View
R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
DUKE Chain Broiler With or Without Catalyst View
Exhaust Deflector Size - 6.25 in. (159 mm) x 26.75 in.
(679 mm):
Nozzle Quantity/Type: Two 245 nozzles
Nozzle Height: 8 in. to 15 in. (203 mm to 381 mm) above top
of appliance.
Nozzle Location: 6.5 in. (165 mm) from front or back edge
of hazard
First nozzle positioned 17.25 in. (438 mm)
from right side of broiler (facing broiler)
Second nozzle positioned 15 in. (381 mm)
from first nozzle
Nozzle must be oriented to spray onto
impedance plate. 290
NOZZLE
PRODUCT
INPUT
FIGURE 4-83
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
SPECIFIC APPLICATION BY MODEL (Continued)
DUKE Electric Broiler - Model FBB - High Proximity
DUKE Electric Broiler with or without Catalyst View
Nozzle Quantity/Type: Two 1 N nozzles
Nozzle Height: 18 in. (457 mm)
Nozzle Location: 6.5 in. (165 mm) from edge of appliance that
impedance plate is angled toward
First nozzle positioned 5 in. (127 mm) to left
of opening centerline
Second nozzle positioned 5 in. (127 mm) to
right of opening centerline
See Figure 4-85
Nozzle Aiming Point: Aimed at center of opening
(2) - 1 N NOZZLE
T
18 IN. (457 mm)
6 1/2 IN. (165 mm) NOZZLE HEIGHT
FROM EDGE OF--0- APPLIANCE THAT
IMPEDANCE I
PLATE IS ANGLE I
TOWARDD PRODUCT
PRODUCT INPUTI I OUTPUT I
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 4-43
DUKE Electric Broiler - Model FBB - High Proximity
DUKE Electric Broiler without Catalyst View
Nozzle Quantity/Type: One 290 nozzle
I. Nozzle Height: 15 to 20 in. (381 to 508 mm)
Nozzle Location: 6.5 in. (165 mm) from edge of appliance that
impedance plate is angled toward
See Figure 4-86
Nozzle Aiming Point: Aimed at center of opening
(1)_29O NOZZLE __\\
N I 15 INTO 20 IN. (381 mm to 508 mm)
6 1/2 IN. (165 mm) I NOZZLE HEIGHT
FROM EDGE OF-'1 APPLIANCE THAT
IMPEDANCE
PLATE IS ANGLED
TOWARD PRODUCT
PRODUCT I INPUT
OUTPUT
BACK I I FRONT
SIDE VIEW 008365
EXHAUST OPENING
gIN. (229 mm) x 26.75 IN. (679 mm)
BACK FRONT SIDE VIEW 008365
CENTERED
ON OPENING
d 00
14- PERFORATED I GRILL
00 b 000 0
0 1 ox1 0
000q000
000 000
61/2 IN. (165 mm) FROM
EDGE OF APPLIANCE
. THAT IMPEDANCE PLATE
IS ANGLED TOWARD
(SEE SIDE VIEW)
PRODUCT -
OUTPUT
61/2 IN. (165 mm) FROM
EDGE OF APPLIANCE
THAT IMPEDANCE PLATE
IS ANGLED TOWARD
(SEE SIDE VIEW)
PRODUCT
OUTPUT
PERFORATED
GRILL
CENTER
DUCT
-CENTER
DUCT
PRODUCT
INPUT
008366
TOP VIEW
008366
TOP VIEW
PRODUCT
INPUT
FIGURE 4-85
FIGURE 4-86
151N. 171/21N.
61/2 IN. (165 mm) FROM 4
i(381 mml (444 mmt
I I EDGE OF APPLIANCE -
THAT IMPEDANCE PLATE - PERFORATED IS ANGLED TOWARD OO 0 Q 0 GRILL (SEE SIDE VIEW) ocootboo
I PRODUCT 0 —CENTER QjX lo DUCT OUTPUT
0000000
0000000
12 IN. TO 13 IN.
(305 mm to 330 mm) f-F: <I -
S-i-- -----Id
000250
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 4-44 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
SPECIFIC APPLICATION BY MODEL (Continued)
DUKE Electric Broiler - Model FBB - Low Proximity
DUKE Electric Broiler with or without Catalyst View
Nozzle Quantity/Type: Two 245 nozzles
Nozzle Height: 8 in. (203 mm) to 15 in. (381 mm)
Nozzle Location: 6.5 in. (165 mm) from edge of appliance that
impedance plate is angled toward
First nozzle positioned 17.5 in. (444 mm)
from right side of broiler (facing broiler)
Second nozzle positioned 15 in. (381 mm)
from first nozzle
See Figure 4-87
Nozzle Aiming Point: Aimed at center of opening
(2) - 245 NOZZLE_\
8 IN. (203 mm) TO
6 1/2 IN. (165 mm) 15 IN. (381 mm)
NOZZLE HEIGHT
FROM EDGE OF-H_______________________________ APPLIANCE THAT t
IMPEDANCE I
PLATE IS ANGLED I
TOWARD I PRODUCT
PRODUCT I I INPUT
OUTPUT . I
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
Nieco Broiler Model 940, 962 or 960 With Catalytic
Converter Protection
Note: Nieco broilers without catalytic converters use standard
chain broiler protection options.
Certain models of the Nieco broiler (Models 940, 962, and 960)
are equipped with a catalytic converter to comply with new clean
air laws. Because of the converter, it is necessary to protect
these broilers in a special way. The guidelines for protecting
these broilers are as follows:
-The maximum internal broiling area is 29 in. x 23.5 in.
(737 mm x 596 mm).
-An R-102 3-gallon system with a maximum of six flow
numbers, must be used for protection of each broiler, includ-
ing plenum and duct.
- Each individual broiler must be protected with a minimum of
two 1N nozzles. The nozzles must be located as shown in
Figure 4-88.
- The broiler must be fitted with two 1 in. (25 mm) high agent
barriers on the angled surface of the broiler. If these have
not been completed by the equipment supplier, they must be
added in the field.
BACK I I FRONT (2) 1 NOZZLES
SIDE VIEW 008365
[1 El (362 mm ± 25 mm)
PRODUCT LOCATE NOZZLES 2 13/16 IN. (71 mm) ON
008368
INPUT EACH SIDE OF BROILER CENTER LINE
TOP VIEW
FIGURE 4-87
14.25±1 IN.
(362mm ± 25 mm)
000774
FIGURE 4-88
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
SPECIFIC APPLICATION BY MODEL (Continued)
Nieco Broiler - Model 950, 960, 980, 1424
Nozzle Quantity/Type: One 2W nozzle
Nozzle Height: 20 in. (508 mm) above top of appliance. See
Figure 4-89a.
Nozzle Location: 6 1/2 in. (165 mm) back from front edge of
appliance. See Figure 4-89a.
Nozzle Aiming Point: Aimed at center of opening. See Figure
4-89a.
Nieco Broiler - Model 950, 960, 980, 1424 (with Catalytic
Converter)
Nozzle Quantity/Type: Two 2W nozzles
Nozzle Height: 20 in. (508 mm) above top of appliance. See
Figure 4-89b.
Nozzle Location: 6 1/2 in. (165 mm) back from front edge of
appliance. See Figure 4-89b.
Nozzle Aiming Point: Aimed at center of opening. See Figure
4-89b - Side View.
Nozzle Aiming Point: Aimed at point 3 in. (76 mm) each side
of center. See Figure 4-89b - Front View.
CATALYTIC /
CONVERTER \ L.. 61/21N.
./(165 mm)
SIDE VIEW
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 4-45
Nieco Broiler - Model 9015 (With or Without Catalytic
Converter)
Nozzle Quantity/Type: Two 2W nozzles
Nozzle Height: 20 in. (508 mm) above top of appliance. See
Figure 4-90.
Nozzle Location for Large Chamber: 6 1/2 in. (165 mm)
back from front edge of appliance. See Figure 4-90.
Nozzle Location for Small Chamber: Nozzle to be located
6 1/2 in. (165 mm) back from front edge of appliance and
12 in. (305 mm) over from large chamber nozzle.
Nozzle Aiming Point for Large Chamber: Aimed at center of
opening. See Figure 4-90.
Nozzle Aiming Point for Small Chamber: Nozzle to be aimed
12 in. (305 mm) over from large chamber nozzle aiming point.
'C
-6 1/2 IN.
(165 mm)
(2) 2W NOZZLES
$ 12IN. $
(305 mm) -b-I
20 IN.
(508 mm)
- 6 1/2 IN.
(165 mm)
2W NOZZLE
20 N.
(508 mm)
CENTERLINE OF
LARGE OPENING
FRONT VIEW
2W NOZZLE
31N. 31N.
(76mm) (76mm) ,
20 IN.
(508 mm)
CENTERLINE OF
LARGE OPENING
FRONT VIEW
CENTERLINE OF
LARGE OPENING
FRONT VIEW
FIGURE 4-90
007010
FIGURE 4-89a FIGURE 4-89b
006486 007034
TOP VIEW
-6 1/2 IN.
(165 mm)
6 1/2 IN. (165 mm) TYP.
ANY SIDE
L-T
- L
-
007322
M)
61/
)16
TYF
SID
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 4-46 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
SPECIFIC APPLICATION BY MODEL (Continued)
Nieco Broiler - Model 9025 (With or Without Catalytic
Converter)
Nozzle Quantity/Type: Two 2W nozzles
Nozzle Height: 20 1/2 in. (520 mm) above top of appliance.
See Figure 4-91.
Nozzle Location: 6 1/2 in. (165 mm) back from front edge of
appliance. See Figure 4-91.
Nozzle Aiming Point: Aimed at center of each opening. See
Figure 4-91.
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
Nieco Broiler - Model MPB94 and MPB84 - High Proximity
(With or Without Catalytic Converters)
Nozzle Quantity/Type: One 2W nozzle'
Nozzle Height: 20 in. (508 mm) above top of converter. See
Figure 4-92.
Nozzle Location: Centered 6 1/2 in. (165 mm) back from any
edge of the appliance. See Figure 4-92.
- Nozzle Aiming Point: Aimed at center of opening. See Figure
4-92.
(2) 2W NOZZLES
I 18-20 1/2 IN.
I i (457-520 mm)
- - I
CENTERLINE CENTERLINE
OF OPENING OF OPENING
FRONT VIEW
FIGURE 4-91
004355
SIDE VIEWS
007323
FIGURE 4-92
006407
R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
SPECIFIC APPLICATION BY MODEL (Continued)
Nieco Broiler - Model MPB94 - Low Proximity (With or
Without Catalytic Converter)
Nozzle Quantity/Type: Two 245 nozzles
Nozzle Height: 8 in. to 15 in. (203 mm to 381 mm) measured
from top of converter
Nozzle Location: 6.5 in. (165 mm) from front or back edge of
hazard.
First nozzle positioned 7.5 in. (190 mm) to
the right from center of hazard.
Second nozzle positioned 7.5 in. (190 mm) to
the left from center of hazard.
See Figure 4-93.
Nozzle Aiming Point: Aimed at openingon respective center
lines
AIM POINT
245 NOZZLE
-
-.-
' AIMPOINT
008C97
TOP VIEW
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 4-47
Nieco Broiler - Model MPB84 - Low Proximity (With
Catalytic Converter)
Nozzle Quantity/Type: Two 245 nozzles
Nozzle Height: 8 in. to 15 in. (203 mm to 381 mm) measured
from top of converter
Nozzle Location: 6.5 in. (165 mm) from front or back edge of
hazard.
First nozzle positioned 7.5 in. (190 mm) to
the right from center of hazard.
Second nozzle positioned 7.5 in. (190 mm)to
the left from center of hazard.
See Figure 4-94.
Nozzle Aiming Point: Aimed at opening on respective center
lines
AIM POINT
245 NOZZLE
(165 mm) ---1 AIM POINT
008097
It
TOP VIEW
BACK FRONT
245 NOZZLE
7112 IN.
(190mm)
4 -c_ 71/2 IN. (190 mm) .1
(165 rnm)'
BACK FRONT
-r
7112 IN.
(191 mm)
4 _ç
7 1/2 IN.
(191 mm)
- d
245 NOZZLE
245 NOZZLE
245 NOZZLE
IT
SIDE VIEW 008098
SIDE VIEW 008098
FIGURE 4-93 FIGURE 4-94
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 4-48 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
SPECIFIC APPLICATION BY MODEL (Continued)
Nieco Broiler - Model MPB84 and MPB94 - High Proximity
(With Perforated Cap OR with Catalytic Converter and
Chimney)
Nozzle Quantity/Type: Two 1 N nozzles
Nozzle Height: 18 in. (457 mm) to 20 in. (508 mm)
Nozzle Location: 6.5 in. (165 mm) from front or back edge of
hazard
First nozzle positioned 5 in. (127 mm) to left
of opening centerline
Second nozzle positioned 5 in. (127 mm) to
right of opening centerline
See Figure 4-95
Nozzle Aiming Point: Aimed at center of opening
(2)- 1 NOZZLE
WITH OR WITHOUT
CHIMNEY
61/2 IN. (165 mm) 18 IN. (457 mm)TO
FROM FRONT - 20 IN. (508 mm)
OR BACK EDGE _....._. - - NOZZLE HEIGHT
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
Nieco Broiler - Model MPB84 and MPB94 - Low Proximity
(With Perforated Cap OR with Catalytic Converter and
Chimney)
Nozzle Quantity/Type: Two 245 nozzles
Nozzle Height: 8 in. (203 mm) to 15 in. (381 mm)
Nozzle Location: 6.5 (165 mm) from front or back edge of
hazard
First nozzle positioned 7.5 in. (190 mm) to the
right of hazard centerline
Second nozzle positioned 7.5 in. (190 mm) to
the left of hazard centerline
See Figure 4-96
Nozzle Aiming Point: Aimed at center of opening
(2) - 245 NOZZLE WITH OR WITHOUT
CHIMNEY
61/2 IN. (165 mm) SIN. (203 mm)TO
FROM FRONT -,- 15 IN. (381 mm)
OR BACK EDGE I.__l._ ___. NOZZLE HEIGHT
PRODUCT
I FRONT
SIDE VIEW 008369
-
FRONT
008370
PRODUCT
OUTPUT...,
BACK
(2) - 1 N NOZZLE
5 IN. (127 mm)
5 IN. (127 m
6 1/2 IN. (165 mm)
FROM FRONT OR -'
BACK EDGE
BACK
r ll
M
10;,&4CP0d
AI
DINT
1,0000 I
I 'ô I 08
O'd
0000 1
& 0 01
000
AIM
POINT I4_I
PRODUCT PRODUCT
INPUT OUTPUT...
BACK
(2) - 245 NOZZLE
7 1/2 IN.
(1 90
mm:
71/2 IN. (19±,
61/2 IN. (165 mm) FROM FRONT OR —' BACK EDGE
BACK
SIDE VIEW 008369
l
I
—
~4#0=000P
AIM OINT
I
I "& I 0p
O0O
0I
080 [ 001 o.% AIM POINT H
FRONT .
-
FRONT
008370
TOP VIEW TOP VIEW
FIGURE 4-95 FIGURE 4-96
SPECIFIC APPLICATION BY MODEL (Continued)
Nieco Broiler - Model JF94E Electric Broiler - High
Proximity (With Catalyst)
Nozzle Quantity/Type: Two 230 nozzles
Nozzle Height: 20 in. (508 mm)
Nozzle Location: 6 1/2 in. (165 mm) from front or back edge of
hazard
Nozzles positioned 15 in. (381 mm) apart
See Figure 4-97
Nozzle Aiming Point: Center of catalyst
(2) - 230 NOZZLE
-\ T
61/2 IN. (165 mm) 20 IN. (508 mm)
FROM EDGE
'
NOZZLE HEIGHT
PRODUCT
O PRODUCT OUTPUT INPUT
BACK FRONT
008434
SIDE VIEW
(2)- 230 NOZZLE
BACK
15 IN.
(381 mm)
L
61/2 IN. (165 mm)
FROM EDGE -'
FRONT
TOP VIEW
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
I
I SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 4-49
Nieco Broiler - Model JF94E Electric Broiler - Low
Proximity (With Catalyst)
Nozzle Quantity/Type: Two 245 nozzles
Nozzle Height: 8 in. (203 mm) to 15 in. (381 mm)
Nozzle Location: 6 1/2 in. (165 mm) from front or back edge of
hazard
Nozzles positioned 15 in. (381 mm) apart
See Figure 4-98
Nozzle Aiming Point: Center of catalyst
245 NOZZLE S(2) -
--
8 IN. (203 mm) -
61/2 IN. (165 mm)
FROM EDGE
15 IN. (381 mm)
_____________ NOZZLE HEIGHT
I -
PRODUCT
OUTPUT PRODUCT
INPUT
S
BACK FRONT
008430
SIDE VIEW 5
S
(2) - 245 NOZZLE
AIM CENTER
BACK FRONT
(203 mm)
15
(381 mm)
IN.15
-
IN. l''— (3 n) --1 L (203 1
61121N.(165mmL...,
mm)
FROM EDGE ______________
AIM CENTER
008431
I TCD \IIIAI FIGURE 4-97 i'-,, VLVV
FIGURE 4-98 •
I
S
S
S
Nieco Jet Flow Automatic Chain Broilers - Models JF64G,
JF84G, JF94G - High Proximity (With or Without Catalyst)
Nozzle Quantity/Type: Two 230 nozzles
Nozzle Height: 20 in. (508 mm)
Nozzle Location: 6.5 in. (165 mm) from front or back edge of
hazard
Nozzles positioned 15 in. (381 mm) apart
See Figure 4-99b
Nozzle Aiming Point: Center of catalyst front to back; 6 in.
(152 mm) in from each side of catalyst
15 IN. (381 mm)
SPACING CENTERED
AIMED 6 IN. OVER CATALYST AIMED 6 IN.
(152 mm) ' / (152 mm)
FROM SIDE OF FROM SIDE OF
CATALYST I CATALYST
lIit 1log I 1L
EXHAUST OPENING:
23.0 IN. (584 mm) WIDE x
14.2 IN. (360 mm) LONG
BROILER CHAMBER:
28.5 IN. (724 mm) WIDE x
20.0 IN. (508 mm) LONG
III III III - - -
W
AIMED TO CENTER / 20 IN. (508 mm)
NOZZLE HEIGHT
I 6.5 IN. (165 mm)
FROM EDGE
OF APPLIANCE
d
FIGURE 4-99b
009482
OF CATALYST
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 4-50 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
I
SPECIFIC APPLICATION BY MODEL (Continued)
Nieco Jet Flow Automatic Chain Broilers - Models JF62,
JF63, JF92, JF93, JF143 (With or Without Catalyst) S Nozzle Quantity/Type: One 245 nozzle
Nozzle Height: 20 in. (508 mm) to 25 in. (635 mm)
Nozzle Location: Centered above the catalyst to 5 in. (127 mm)
forward of catalyst front edge
See Figure 4-99a
INozzle Aiming Point: Center of catalyst
S ALLOWABLE NOZZLE
IN GRID' LOCATION CENTER LINE
CATALYSTIEXHA US''\\\ OPENING \ _________ AIM AT CENTER I
2OiN. _____ 25 IN. ________ 5IN. (635 mm) (508mm) \ (127 mm)
S
—I—
BACK FRONT . 008910
S AIM POINT CENTER LINE
S
I
BACK
CENTER LINE
S 008911 FRONT S
ALLOWABLE NOZZLE
LOCATION LINE
FIGURE 4-99a
S
S
I
I
R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
AIMED 4 IN. (102 mm)
FROM BACK
OF CATALYST
8 IN. 0 15 IN
(203 mm to 381 mm)
NOZZLE HEIGHT
6.5 IN. 1165 mm)
FROM EDGE
OF APPLIANCE
AIMED TO CENTER
I I OF CATALYST 6.5 IN. (165 mm)
FROM FRONT
EDGE OF
APPLIANCE
8 IN. TO 15 IN
(203 mm to 381 mm)
NOZZLE HEIGHT
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
SPECIFIC APPLICATION BY MODEL (Continued)
Nieco Jet Flow Automatic Chain Broilers - Models JF64G,
JF84G, JF94G - Low Proximity, Nozzles Rear-Mounted
Facing Forward (With or Without Catalyst)
Nozzle Quantity/Type: Two 245 nozzles
Nozzle Height: 8 in. (203 mm) to 15 in. (381 mm)
Nozzle Location: 6.5 in. (165 mm) from back edge of hazard
Nozzles positioned 15 in. (381 mm) apart
See Figure 4-99c
Nozzle Aiming Point: 4 in. (102 mm) from back edge of cata-
lyst; 6 in. (152 mm) in from each side of
catalyst
15 IN. (381 mm)
SPACING CENTERED
AIMED 6 IN. OVER CATALYST AIMED 6 IN.
(152 mm) / (152 mm)
FROM SIDE OF 1 FROM SIDE OF
CATALYST CATALYST
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 4-50.1
Nièco Jet Flow Automatic Chain Broilers - Models JF64G,
JF84G, JF94G - Low Proximity, Nozzles Front-Mounted
Facing Rearward (With or Without Catalyst)
Nozzle Quantity/Type: Two 245 nozzles
Nozzle Height: 8 in. (203 mm) to 15 in. (381 mm)
Nozzle Location: 6.5 in. (165 mm) from front edge of hazard
Nozzles positioned 15 in. (381 mm) apart
See Figure 4-99d
Nozzle Aiming Point: Center of catalyst front to back;
6 in. (152 mm) in from each side of
catalyst
15 IN. (381 mm)
SPACING CENTERED
AIMED 6 IN. OVER CATALYST AIMED 6 IN.
(152 mm) \ 1 (152 mm)
FROM SIDE OF FROM SIDE OF
CATALYST 1 CATALYST
; 4~m ~
FIGURE 4-99c I FIGURE 4-99d
009483 0. 009484
e SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 4-50.2 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
SPECIFIC APPLICATION BY MODEL (Continued)
Bakers Pride Broiler - Models CH6, CH8, CHIO, XX6, XX8,
I XX10 (With Wood Smoker Box and Chip Holders)
Nozzle Quantity/Type: Two 3N nozzles
Nozzle Height: 25 in. (635 mm) to 40 in. (1016 mm) above the
hazard surface
Nozzle Location: Each nozzle is to protect half of the cooking
area and located within 1 in. (25 mm) of the
center of the respective cooking area, aimed
at the center of that hazard area
See Figure 4-100
Note: Smoker Box and Chip Holders cannot exceed logs 4 in.
(101 mm) in diameter and a maximum allowable wood depth of
4 in. (101 mm).
3N NOZZLES
CENTER LINE
C
OF RESECTIVE
OOKING AREA NOZZLE HEIGHT +1- 1 IN. (25 mm)
251N.-401N. IN ANY DIRECTION
(635 mm -1016 mm)
I] LI
008494
1/2 OF 1/2 OF
AREA AREA I IN. (25 mm)
COOKING -+- COOKING - I
MAXIMUM I I IN. (25 mm)
MAXIMUM
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 4-51
Magikitch'n Gas Radiant Char-Broiler with Smoker Box
Models FM-RMB-660, FM-RMB-648, FM-RMB-636 (With Wood Smoker Box and Chip Holders)
Nozzle Quantity/Type: Three 3N nozzles
Nozzle Height: 25 in. (635 mm) to 40 in. (1016 mm) above the
broiler surface
Nozzle Location: All three nozzles are to be centered front to
back above the broiling surface. The middle
nozzle is to be centered left to right above the
broiling surface. The remaining two nozzles
are to be located 9 in. (229 mm) inside the
broiler sides.
See Figure 4-101
Note: Smoker Box and Chip Holders cannot exceed logs 4 in.
(101 mm) in diameter and a maximum allowable wood depth of
4 in. (101 mm).
9 IN.
(229 mm)
9 IN.
(229
3N CENTER OF 3N BROILER
U [
INIZ
CENTEROF
BROILER
25 TO 40 IN.
(635101016mm)
FRONT
COOKING
AREA
FIGURE 4-101
CENTER OF
RESPECTIVE
COOKING AREA
008495
FIGURE 4-100
CONVERTER TWO 1W NOZZLES
0034I8
FRONT VIEW
SECTION 4- SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 4-52 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
SPECIFIC APPLICATION BY MODEL (Continued)
Marshall Air - Model 2001 BK Multi-Chamber Broiler
Nozzle Quantity/Type: Two 1W nozzles
Nozzle Location: Front nozzle tip must be located 14 in.
(355 mm) directly above the appliance, aligned with the front
face and centerline of the catalytic converter. The aim point is
4 in. (101 mm) forward of the front edge of the converter on
the centerline.
The rear nozzle tip is a mirror image of the front. The rear
nozzle is located 14 in. (355 mm) vertically above the appli-
ance, aligned with the "rear" face and centerline of the cata-
lytic converter. The aim point is 4 in. (101 mm) behind the
"rear" edge of the converter on the centerline. See Figure
4-102.
System Limitation: Maximum of five flows for a 3.0 gallon
system: Remaining flow points available may be used to
protect other hazards.
CENTERED ON CONVERTER
NOZZLE ALIGNED WITH FRONT OF CONVERTER
NOZZLE ALIGNED WITH NOZZLE ALIGNED WITH BACK
FRONT OF CONVERTER, OF CONVERTER, AIMED
AIMED 4 IN. (101 mm) BACK 4 IN. (101 mm) FORWARD
11W 1W
NOZZLE NOZZLE
+ -
14 IN. 14 IN.
(355 mm) r -1 (355 mm)
SIDE VIEW
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
Marshall Air Electric Broiler - Model FR14B AutoBroil
Nozzle QuantitylType:One 260 Nozzle
Nozzle Height: 15 -20 in. (381 -508 mm) above the
top of the broiler
Nozzle Location: The nozzle must be centered above the
front edge of the broiler
Nozzle Aiming Point: Aimed at the center of the exhaust
opening of the broiler. See Figure
4-103.
24.25 IN. 14.50 IN I (615 mm) (368 mm)
15-20 IN. (381 508 mm) 24 IN.
(609 mm) 34.69 IN.
- + (881
48 IN.
(1219 mm)
FIGURE 4-103
008737
Grease Grabber80TM Two Stage Filtration System
The Grease Grabber-80 Two Stage Filtration System consists of
two components: The primary filter (The Grease-X Tractor) and
the secondary filter (The Grease Grabber-80).
The protection required for this application is the same as the
standard plenum/filter protection: One 1N nozzle protecting 10
(3.0 m) linear feet of plenum length by 4 ft (1.2 m) of plenum
chamber depth (width), positioned 2 in. to 4 in. (51 mm to 102 mm)
from peak of secondary filter. See Figure 4-104.
N.
102 mm)
)34188
FIGURE 4-102
NOTE: TWO NOZZLES MUST BE UTILIZED FOR V-BANK FILTER
ARRANGEMENT.
FIGURE 4-104
006526
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 4-53
For appliance hazard surfaces with listed protection exceed-
ing the standard hazard zone of 28 in. (711 mm) in depth, the
hazard surface(s) must be aligned with the back edge of the
hazard zone, with the front edge overhanging the front edge
of the zone. See Appliance Chart, Table 4-1.
For appliance hazard surfaces that exceed the listed protec-
tion sizes, multiple zones must be utilized. Align entire hazard
surface area within the multiple zones.
All hood, duct, individual appliance, piping, and flow limitations
are as specified in the R-102 Design, Installation, Recharge
and Maintenance Manual (Part No. 418087).
All appliance protection currently listed in the R-102 Design
Manual (Part No. 418087) is also approved protection. Zone
protection can be considered optional protection.
TABLE 4-1
Overlapping Nozzle Coverage (Zone Protection)
Appliance Type Maximum Cooking Hazard
Fryer 34 in. (863 mm) Deep x 5.8 ft2 (0.5 m2)
Griddle 30 in. (762 mm) Deep x Unlimited Length
Range 28 in. (711 mm) Deep x Unlimited Length
Wok, Maximum 30 in. (762 mm) Diameter x 8 in.
(203 mm) Deep
Wok, Minimum 11 in. (279 mm) Diameter x 3 in.
(76 mm) Deep
Braising Pan/lilt 34 in. (863 mm) Deep x Unlimited Skillet* Length
Lava Rock 32 in. (812 mm) Deep x Unlimited
Char-Broiler Length
Charcoal Broiler 32 in. (813 mm) Deep x Unlimited Length
(4 in. (102 mm) Maximum Fuel Depth)
Mesquite Wood 32 in. (812 mm) Deep x Unlimited Length
Broiler (12 in. (304 mm) Maximum Fuel Depth)
Gas Radiant 36 in. (914 mm) Deep x Unlimited
Char-Broiler Length
Electric Char-Broiler 34 in. (863 mm) Deep x 20 in. (508 mm)
* See Figure 4-105 for nozzle location
III t
0-6 IN. (0-152 mm) COVER MUST NOT I
::j I
INTERFERE WITH I I I
DISCHARGE
40-45 IN. 1 (1016-1143 mm)
I
I II: I I ZONE
00692*
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
OVERLAPPING NOZZLE COVERAGE
Overlapping Coverage - Option 1
For each group of protected appliances under a common
hood(s), the overlapping nozzles must be located from right
to left so that each end nozzle is located a maximum of 6 in.
(152 mm) inside the outside edge of the cooking hazard of each
end appliance, and the inside overlapping nozzles must be
located between the two end nozzles at a maximum spacing of
12 in. (304 mm).
Hazard Zone
The hazard zone is defined as a theoretical, flat and level, rect-
angular surface, that includes all of the cooking hazards of the
protected appliances under a common hood(s). The purpose of
the hazard zone is to provide a means of locating the appliances
and the overlapping nozzles, as well as aiming the overlapping
nozzles. The hazard zone measures 28 in. (711 mm) deep by
the length of the cooking hazard(s). The centerline of the hazard
zone must bisect the 28 in. (711 mm) depth (from front to back)
and run from right-to-left for the full width of the hazard zone.
Overlapping Nozzle Appliance Protection
Overlapping Nozzle Appliance Protection is defined as protec-
tion of cooking appliances by nozzles spaced uniformly at
uniform elevations under a common hood(s). Overlapping
protection of appliances is continuous for the full length of the
hood or divided when group(s) of protected appliances are
separated by counters or appliances not requiring protection.
Full hood continuous protection is defined as overlapping
nozzle appliance protection that covers the appliance line-up
located under the total hood length. All appliances requiring
protection are the appliances under the hood that can be an igni-
tion source of grease in the hood, grease removal device or the
duct.
Group protection is defined as overlapping nozzle appliance
protection that protects individual hazard zones located under a
common hood. These "groups" of appliances may be separated
by appliances not requiring protection, such as steam equipment
or work tables, or by dedicated appliance protection, such as
salamander broilers.
See Figure 4-108 (full hood continuous protection) and Figure
4-109 (multiple group protection).
Dedicated Nozzle Appliance Protection
Appliance protection using dedicated nozzle coverage is defined
as protection of cooking appliances with enclosed cooking
hazards, such as upright broilers, which cannot be protected
with overlapping nozzles and therefore must be protected with
nozzles dedicated to the appliance.
General Design Limitations
Maximum depth of zone is 28 in. (711 mm).
The 245 nozzle is the only approved nozzle for overlapping
(zone) protection.
Nozzle must be located 0 in. to 6 in. (0 mm to 152 mm) forward
of zone centerline, aimed back at the zone centerline.
Nozzles must be spaced a maximum of 6 in. (152 mm) from
each end of hazard and then a maximum of 12 in. (304 mm)
on center for the remaining overlapping nozzles until the
complete hazard is covered.
ZONE CENTER LINE
FIGURE 4-105
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 4-54 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
OVERLAPPING NOZZLE COVERAGE (Continued)
Overlapping Appliance Nozzle and Hazard Zone Locations
All overlapping appliance nozzles must be the 245 nozzle
and must be located under a common hood at the same
height above the hazard zone, in a straight line from right
to left and aimed at the centerline of the hazard zone. The
overlapping nozzle is used for both continuous overlapping
and multiple group overlapping protection.
The hazard zone must be positioned (located) so that all
appliance hazard surfaces are within the zone. For appli-
ance hazard surfaces with listed protection exceeding the
standard hazard zone size of 28 in. (711 mm) in depth (see
Table 1), the hazard surface(s) must be aligned with the
back edge of the hazard zone, with the front edge overhang-
ing the front of the zone.
The overlapping appliance nozzles must be located 40 in. to
45 in. (1016 mm to 1143 mm) above the top surface of the
protected appliances. See Figure 4-107.
Exception No. 1: Nozzle dimensions for wok protection are
measured to bottom of wok. Exception No. 2: When using
overlapping appliance nozzles in areas where there is a
back shelf, the nozzle cannot be positioned in the shaded
area as shown in Figure 4-106.
Also, back shelf must not extend more than 11 in. (279
mm) over the hazard zone and cannot be less than 20 in.
(508 mm) above the hazard zone. See Figure 4-106.
OVERLAPPING NOZZLE(S)
45
44
CANNOT BE POSITIONED
IN THIS SHADED AREA
43 I I
42
41
40 I
654
CENTER LINE OF
HAZARD ZONE
BACK
SHELF
I 11 IN. (279 mm) I MAXIMUM
20 IN.
(508 mm)
I_1
MINIMUM
28 IN. (711 mm)
FIGURE 4-106
006914
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
The overlapping appliance nozzles must be located 0 in. to
6 in. (0 mm to 152 mm) forward of the centerline or aimline
of the selected hazard zone. See Figure 4-107.
245 NOZZLE - NOZZLE MUST BE AIMED STRAIGHT
-
DOWN OR BACK AT CENTERLINE OF
HAZARD ZONE
45 IN.
(152 mm)
SIN. (1143m)
40 IN.
(1016 mm)
BACK OF ZONE /7
OF ZONE
FRONT
CENTERLINE OF
28 IN.
L
___ HAZARD ZONE
(711 mm)
ZONE
FIGURE 4-107
006915
R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
OVERLAPPING NOZZLE COVERAGE (Continued)
Overlapping Appliance Nozzle and Hazard Zone Locations
- Group Protection
For each group of protected appliances under a common
hood(s), the overlapping nozzles must be located from
right to left so that each end nozzle is located a maximum
of 6 in. (152 mm) inside the outside edge of the cooking
hazard of each end appliance, and the inside overlapping
nozzles must be located between the two end nozzles at a
maximum spacing of 12 in. (304 mm). See Figures 4-108
and 4-109.
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 4-55
2. When obstructions are located adjacent to appliance(s)
protected by overlapping nozzles, the overlapping appliance
nozzle spacing must start with the appliance(s) adjacent to
the obstruction. See Figure 4-110.
121N. 121N. 121N. i 121N. 6 IN. I304 mm) (304 mm) i (304 mm)l(304 mm)
(ls2mm).......,..
MAX.
.. 6 IN.
(152 MM)
MAX.
. OUTSIDE
4 MAX. 4 MAX. 4 MAX. 4MAX.4
I
I EDGE OF
COOKING
HAZARD I I I I
6 IN.
(152 mm)
MAXIMUM
FROM
EDGE OF
COOKING
HAZARD
12 IN. (304 mm) MAXIMUM
SPACING(S) BETWEEN
OVERLAPPING NOZZLES
'I' I ', / \ / \
\ 6 IN.
I " / •' / 'I (152 mm)
MAXIMUM
FROM /\ )\ / I' EDGE OF
/ 'I / COOKING
'HAZARD
FULL HOOD CONTINUOUS APPLIANCE PROTECTION
FIGURE 4-108
001710
HAZARD AREA 1 OBSTRUCTION FIGURE 4-110
001713
3. When an appliance requires dedicated protection with a
protected area intended for overlapping appliance nozzle
protection, the group protection option will be required for
appliances on either side of the appliances using dedicated
protection. Group protection using overlapping appliance
nozzles must begin with the protected appliance(s) adjacent
to the dedicated appliance protected. An overlapping appli-
ance nozzle(s) must be positioned within 6 in. (152 mm) of
the edge(s) of the appliance hazard surface area(s) adja-
cent to the dedicated nozzle protection. See Figure 4-111.
12 IN. (304 mm) 6 IN. (152 mm)
MAXIMUM MAXIMUM
4II- —I44 i 61N. - - 61N
(152 mm) 12 IN. (152 mm)
MAXIMUM (304 mm) MAXIMUM FROM
EDGE OF -.
MAXIMUM
'\ / .
FROM
EDGE OF
COOKING ' ' COOKING
HAZARD EDGE OF HAZARD
COOKING
HAZARD
GROUP APPLIANCE PROTECTION
FIGURE 4-109
001720
EDGE OF COOKING
HAZARD
61N. IT 12 IN. T I I 12 IN. Y 12 IN. V
(152mm)...I 1(304 mm) I I 1(304 mm)l(304 mm)I I 6 IN.
MAX. I IMAX I b -
MAX. MAX. (152 mm)
MAX.
EDGE 6 IN. (152 mm) 6 IN. (152 mm) EDGE ..,... OF I MAXIMUM I MAXIMUM OF COOKING COOKING HAZARD 1 I
1
HAZARD
DEDICATED NOZZLE
APPLIANCE
FIGURE 4-111
001756
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 4-56 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
OVERLAPPING NOZZLE COVERAGE (Continued)
Overlapping Appliance Nozzle and Hazard Zone Locations
- Group Protection (Continued)
4. On protected appliances, all hazard surfaces located in a
group must be within 40-45 in. (1016-1143 mm) from the
nozzle(s). Once that dimension is exceeded, a new group
must be started. See Figure 4-112.
Note: The supply pipe feeding nozzle groups is to be at the
same elevation. Adjust height for each group only by varying
lengths of nozzle drops.
6 IN. (152 6 IN. (152 mm)
MAXIMUM" MAXIMUM I
I NOZZLES I
I NOZZLES I
f
£
I 401N. 45 IN. (1016 mm) I (1143 mm) 401N. 451N (1016 mm) 143 mm) I
I
1. GROUP "A" •1 GROUP-B'--øl
FIGURE 4-112
006917
Detection Requirements For Overlapping Appliance
Protection
When utilizing overlapping appliance protection, fusible link
detectors must be installed on a maximum of 2 It (0.6 m) centers,
starting with detectors located in (under) the duct opening(s).
Starting from the detector under the duct opening, add detectors
on 2 ft (0.6 m) maximum spacing until the complete length of the
plenum area is covered, from one end to the other. The location
of the last detector on each end of the plenum must not exceed
2 ft (0.6 m) from end of plenum.
Note: Standard detector coverage, as specified in "Design
Section," is acceptable when utilizing dedicated nozzle
coverages.
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 4-57
OVERLAPPING NOZZLE COVERAGE (Continued)
Overlapping Coverage - Option 2
For each group of protected appliances under a common
hood(s), the overlapping nozzles must be located from right
to left so that each end nozzle is located a maximum of 11.5
in. (292 mm) inside the outside edge of the cooking hazard of
each end appliance, and the inside overlapping nozzles must be
located between the two end nozzles at a maximum spacing of
25.5 in. (647 mm).
Hazard Zone
The hazard zone is defined as a theoretical, flat and level, rect-
angular surface, that includes all of the cooking hazards of the
protected appliances under a common hood(s). The purpose of
the hazard zone is to provide a means of locating the appliances
and the overlapping nozzles, as well as aiming the overlapping
nozzles. The hazard zone measures 28 in. (711 mm) deep by
the length of the cooking hazard(s). The centerline of the hazard
zone must bisect the 28 in. (711 mm) depth (from front to back)
and run from right-to-left for the full width of the hazard zone.
Overlapping Nozzle Appliance Protection
Overlapping Nozzle Appliance Protection is defined as protec-
tion of cooking appliances by nozzles spaced uniformly at
uniform elevations under a common hood(s). Overlapping
protection of appliances is continuous for the full length of the
hood or divided when group(s) of protected appliances are
separated by counters or appliances not requiring protection.
Full hood continuous protection is defined as overlapping
nozzle appliance protection that covers the appliance line-up
located under the total hood length. All appliances requiring
protection are the appliances under the hood that can be an
ignition source of grease in the hood, grease removal device or
the duct.
Group protection is defined as overlapping nozzle appliance
protection that protects individual hazard zones located under a
common hood. These "groups" of appliances may be separated
by appliances not requiring protection, such as steam equipment
or work tables, or by dedicated appliance protection, such as
salamander broilers.
See Figure 4-116 (full hood continuous protection) and Figure
4-117 (multiple group protection).
Dedicated Nozzle Appliance Protection
Appliance protection using dedicated nozzle coverage is defined
as protection of cooking appliances with enclosed cooking
hazards, such as upright broilers, which cannot be protected
with overlapping nozzles and therefore must be protected with
nozzles dedicated to the appliance.
General Design Limitations
If overlapping appliance protection is mixed with dedi-
cated appliance protection on the same pipe system, THE
OVERLAPPING APPLIANCE PROTECTION PIPING
REQUIREMENTS MUST BE FOLLOWED.
Overlapping protection requires the use of 3.0 gal (11.4 L)
tank(s) and a maximum of six flows per tank.
In installations using tanks only intended for overlapping
protection, a single Double Tank nitrogen expellant gas
cartridge can be utilized with up to three 3.0 gal (11.4 L) tanks.
In installations using both overlapping protection and conven-
tional non-overlapping protection (ex. hood/duct or dedicated
appliance protection), a single Double Tank nitrogen expellant
gas cartridge can be utilized with up to three 3.0 gal (11.4 L)
tanks, as long as none of the 3.0 gal (11.4 L) tanks exceed a
total flow output of more than six flows.
If more than six flows will be used in a conventional non-over-
lapping tank, it cannot share the same cartridge as tanks
intended for overlapping protection. In this case, an additional
Regulated Actuator Assembly with another expellant gas
cartridge will be required.
The 245 nozzle must be used for "end of zone" protection.
The 260 nozzle must be used for zone protection.
Maximum depth of zone is 28 in. (711 mm).
Refer to overlapping system piping requirements listed in
Table 4-2.
Nozzle must be located 0 in. to 12 in. (0 mm to 304 mm)
forward of zone centerline, aimed back at the zone centerline.
Nozzles must be spaced a maximum of 11.5 in. (292 mm)
from each end of hazard and then a maximum of 25.5 in. (647
mm) on center for the remaining overlapping nozzles until the
complete hazard is covered.
For appliance hazard surfaces with listed protection exceed-
ing the standard hazard zone of 28 in. (711 mm) in depth, the
hazard surface(s) must be aligned with the back edge of the
hazard zone, with the front edge overhanging the front edge
of the zone. See Appliance Chart, Table 4-1.
For appliance hazard surfaces that exceed the listed protec-
tion sizes, multiple zones must be utilized. Align entire hazard
surface area within the multiple zones.
All hood, duct, and individual appliance protection are as spec-
ified in the R-102 Design, Installation, Recharge and Mainten-
ance Manual (Part No. 418087).
All appliance protection currently listed in the R-102 Design
Manual (Part No. 418087) is also approved protection. Zone
protection can be considered optional protection.
SECTION 4 - SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 4-58 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
OVERLAPPING NOZZLE COVERAGE (Continued)
TABLE 1
Overlapping Nozzle Coverage (Zone Protection)
Appliance Type Maximum Cooking Hazard
Fryer 34 in. (863 mm) Deep x 5.8 ft2 (0.5 m2)
Griddle 30 in. (762 mm) Deep x Unlimited Length
Range 30 in. (762 mm) Deep x Unlimited Length
Wok, Maximum 30 in. (762 mm) Diameter x 8 in.
(203 mm) Deep
Wok, Minimum 11 in. (279 mm) Diameter x 3 in.
(76 mm) Deep
Braising Pan/Tilt 34 in. (863 mm) Deep x Unlimited Length Skillet*
'4- 0-12 IN.
INTERFERE
RFE/ I
I
COVER MUST NOT I (0-304 mm) I
EDGE OF
DISCHARGE , I
PATTERN I / 40-45 IN.
I (1016-1143 mm) I / I I
I' I
ZONE
ZONE CENTER LINE
FIGURE 4-113
006927
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
Overlapping Appliance Nozzle and Hazard Zone Locations
All overlapping appliance nozzles must be the 245 nozzle
for "end of zone" protection and the 260 nozzle for zone
protection, and must be located under a common hood at
the same height above the hazard zone, in a straight line
from right to left and aimed at the centerline of the hazard
zone. The overlapping nozzle is used for both continuous
overlapping and multiple group overlapping protection.
The hazard zone must be positioned (located) so that all
appliance hazard surfaces are within the zone. For appli-
ance hazard surfaces smaller than the standard hazard
zone size, the hazard surface can be located anywhere
within the standard hazard zone. For appliance hazard
surfaces with listed protection exceeding the standard
hazard zone size of 28 in. (711 mm) in depth (see Table
4-1), the hazard surface(s) must be aligned with the back
edge of the hazard zone, with the front edge overhanging
the front of the zone.
The overlapping appliance nozzles must be located 40 in. to
45 in. (1016 mm to 1143 mm) above the top surface of the
protected appliances. See Figure 4-115.
Exception No. 1: Nozzle dimensions for wok protection are
measured to bottom of wok. Exception No. 2: When using
overlapping appliance nozzles in areas where there is a
back shelf, the nozzle cannot be positioned in the shaded
area as shown in Figure 4-114.
Also, back shelf must not extend more than 11 in. (279
mm) over the hazard zone and cannot be less than 18 in.
(458 mm) above the hazard zone. See Figure 4-114.
OVERLAPPING NOZZLE(S)
45 CANNOT BE POSITIONED
44 I IN THIS SHADED AREA
43 I
42 I
41 I I
40 ll
12108 6 402
CENTER LINE OF
HAZARD ZONE
BACK
SHELF
71 I
11 IN. (279m)
MAXIMUM
18 IN.
(458 mm)
MINIMUM
[,-
28 IN. (711 mm)
FIGURE 4-114
006914
Lava Rock 26 in. (660 mm) Deep x Unlimited Length
Char-Broiler (see Note 1)
Charcoal Broiler 30 in. (762 mm) Deep x Unlimited Length
(4 in. (101 mm) Maximum Fuel Depth)
Mesquite Wood 30 in. (762 mm) Deep x Unlimited Length 3.
Broiler (6 in. (152 mm) Maximum Fuel Depth)
Gas Radiant 36 in. (914 mm) Deep x Unlimited Length
Char-Broiler
Electric Char-Broiler 34 in. (863 mm) Deep x Unlimited Length
* See Figure 4-113 for nozzle location
Note 1: Always try to place Lava Rock Char-Broiler(s) near the center of the
zone. When the Lava Rock Char-Broiler is the first or last appliance in the zone,
the outside edge of the broiler must not be more than 6 in. (152 mm) outside the
end nozzle.
R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
OVERLAPPING NOZZLE COVERAGE (Continued)
4. The overlapping appliance nozzles must be located 0 in. to
12 in. (0 mm to 304 mm) forward of the centerline or aimline
of the selected hazard zone. See Figure 4-115.
245 OR 260 NOZZLE MUST BE AIMED STRAIGHT
DOWN OR BACK AT CENTERLINE OF HAZARD ZONE
I
451N.
(11 121N. (1143 mm)
- (304 mm)
40 IN.
(1016 mm)
FRONT_________ - BACK OF ZONE
OF ZONE
28
CENTERLINE OF
HAZARD ZONE
711 mm)
ZONE
FIGURE 4-115
007537
TABLE 4-2
Overlapping System Piping Limitations
Max.
Total 3/8 in. Max. Max.
System Flow Pipe No. of Elevation Cartridge
Size Numbers Length Elbows Rise Size
3 Gallon 6 75 ft 25 loft LT-30-R
(11.4 L) (22.9 m) (3.0 m)
6 Gallon 12 75 ft 25 lOft Double
(22.7 L) (22.9 m) (3.0 m) Tank!
Manifolded LT-A-
101 30*
9 Gallon 18 75 ft 25 loft Double
(34.1 L) (22.9 m) (3.0 m) Tank!
LT-A-
101 30*
50 ft (15.2 m) maximum pipe from first to last nozzle.
50 ft (15.2 m) maximum pipe after the split on a split system.
*Use with regulated actuator only.
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 4-59
Overlapping Appliance Nozzle and Hazard Zone Locations
- Group Protection
1. For each group of protected appliances under a common
hood(s), the overlapping nozzles must be located from right
to left so that each end nozzle is located a maximum of
11.5 in. (292 mm) inside the outside edge of the cooking
hazard of each end appliance, and the inside overlapping
nozzles must be located between the two end nozzles at a
maximum spacing of 25.5 in. (647 mm). See Figures 4-116
and 4-117.
25.5 IN. (647 mm) MAXIMUM
SPACING(S) BETWEEN
OVERLAPPING NOZZLES I
i I I M IS
11.5 IN.
(292 mm) / / 11.5 IN.
/ \ / \
/ S .' \ / \ / \,J (292 mm) MAXIMUM / / \, / MAXIMUM
FROM , FROM
EDGE OF I I\ A / EDGE OF
COOKING COOKING
HAZARD / / \ / / \\ \
HAZARD
FULL HOOD CONTINUOUS APPLIANCE PROTECTION
FIGURE 4-116
007538
25.5 IN. (647 mm) 11.5 IN. (292 mm)
MAXIMUM MAXIMUM
11.5 IN. -
-
-4 '- —'1 I ' 245 245 I
- 11.5 IN.
(292 mm) 245 260 245 25.5 IN. (292 mm)
MAXIMUM
. .
(647 mm)
.
MAXIMUM
FROM
EDGE OF
.0
\ /
MAXIMUM FROM
EDGE OF
COOKING COOKING
HAZARD EDGE OF
]HAZARD
HAZARD
COOKING
GROUP APPLIANCE PROTECTION
Note: On group appliance protection, start and end of EACH zone
group must be protected with a 245 nozzle.
FIGURE 4-117
001720
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 4-60 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
OVERLAPPING NOZZLE COVERAGE (Continued)
Overlapping Appliance Nozzle and Hazard Zone Locations
- Group Protection (Continued)
2. When obstructions are located adjacent to appliance(s)
protected by overlapping nozzles, the overlapping appliance
nozzle spacing must start with the appliance(s) adjacent to
the obstruction. See Figure 4-118.
25.5 IN. 25.5 IN. i 25.5 IN. 25.5 IN. 11.5 IN. (647 mm) (647 mm) (647 mm)(647 mm)I (292mm)......,.. .4 ,... 11.5 IN.
MAX. + MAX. 4 MAX. 4MAX.j MAX. 4 (292 mm)
245 260 260 260 245 MAX.
,. OUTSIDE
I EDGE OF
I I I
COOKING
HAZARD
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
4. On protected appliances, all hazard surfaces located in a
group must be within 40-45 in. (1016-1143 mm) from the
nozzle(s). Once that dimension is exceeded, a new group
must be started. See Figure 4-120.
Note: The supply pipe feeding nozzle groups is to be at the
same elevation. Adjust height for each group only by varying
lengths of nozzle drops.
11.5 IN. (292 mm)
MAXIMUM
A
I END OF
I 1,140
t
NOZZLES ZONE
A I A NOZZLES I 1N.
I 45 IN. (1016 mm) I
40 IN. I 45 IN.
(1143 mm) END OF
j
ZONE (1016 mm) 1(1143mm)
T 14 HAZARD AREA 10
OBSTRUCTION
Note: On continuous appliance protection, start and end with 245
nozzles and 260 nozzle(s) in the middle.
FIGURE 4-118
001713 1.1 GROUP GROUP B"
When an appliance requires dedicated protection with a
protected area intended for overlapping appliance nozzle
protection, the group protection option will be required for
appliances on either side of the appliances using dedicated
protection. Group protection using overlapping appliance
nozzles must begin with the protected appliance(s) adjacent
to the dedicated appliance protected. An overlapping appli-
ance nozzle(s) must be positioned within 11.5 in. (292 mm)
of the edge(s) of the appliance hazard surface area(s) adja-
cent to the dedicated nozzle protection. See Figure 4-119.
EDGE OF COOKING
Note: On group appliance protection, start and end of EACH zone
group must be protected with a 245 nozzle.
FIGURE 4-120
007539
Detection Requirements For Overlapping Appliance
Protection
When utilizing overlapping appliance protection, fusible link
detectors must be installed on a maximum of 2 ft (0.6 m) centers,
starting with detectors located in (under) the duct opening(s).
Starting from the detector under the duct opening, add detectors
on 2 ft (0.6 m) maximum spacing until the complete length of the
plenum area is covered, from one end to the other. The location
of the last detector on each end of the plenum must not exceed
2 ft (0.6 m) from end of plenum.
11.5 IN.
(292mm)...l
I 725.5 IN. 7
(647 mm)I Y 25.5 IN.Y 25.5 IN.
1(647 mm4(647 mm I MAX. IMAX.
t t
I MAX. I MAX.
EDGE - 11.5 IN. 11.5 IN. (292 mm)
OF
COOKING
(292 mm) MAX.
HAZARD
r
MAXIMUM
I
Note: Standard detector placement can also be utilized when
using overlapping protection. However, the overlapping detector
11.5 IN option cannot be used when utilizing standard R-102 protection.
(292 mm) Refer to Pages 4-71 - 4-73 for detector placement.
MAX.
EDGE
OF
COOKING
HAZARD
DEDICATED NOZZLE
APPLIANCE
Note: On group appliance protection, Start and end of EACH zone
group must be protected with a 245 nozzle.
FIGURE 4-119
001756
R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
TANK AND CARTRIDGE REQUIREMENTS
Once the hazard analysis is completed and the total nozzle flow
numbers are established, the quantity and size of agent tanks
and cartridges needed to supply the nozzles with the proper
volumes of agent at the proper flow rates can be determined.
For cartridges used in the regulated release mechanism, flow
capacities, tank quantities and sizes, and regulated release
cartridge options are given in the table below.
Total Quantity and Regulated Release
Flow Size of Cartridge Options
Numbers* Tank(s) Nitrogen Carbon Dioxide
1 - 5 (1) 1.5 Gallon LT-20-R 101-10
6-11 (1) 3.0 Gallon LT-30-R 101-20
11 -16 (1) 1.5 Gallon Double 101-30
3.0 Gallon
16-22 3.0 Gallon Double 101 30**
16 -22 (2) 3.0 Gallon Double -
(Manifold)
22 -33 (3) 3.0 Gallon Double -
When one or more regulated actuators are used, the following
tank and cartridge combinations apply for each regulated actu-
ator:
Regulated Actuator Regulated Actuator
Tank(s) Cartridge
(1) 1.5 Gallon LT-20-R or 101-10
(1) 3.0 Gallon LT-30-R or 101-20
(1) 1.5 Gallon and LT-A-101-30 or 101-30" or
3.0 Gallon double tank
3.0 Gallon LT-A-101-30 or 10130** or
double tank
(2) 3.0 Gallon (Manifold) LT-A-101-30 or Double
(3) 3.0 Gallon LT-A-101-30 or Double
* For exceptions to maximum flow numbers, see Distribution Piping Requirements for 1.5
gallon and 3.0 gallon systems in this Section.
The 101-30 cartridge can not be used when two 3.0 gallon tanks are manitolded together.
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 4-61
For higher total flow numbers (23 to 110), multiple cartridges
and regulated actuators are required as shown in the System
Selection Guide in "Appendix" Section
ACTUATION AND EXPELLANT GAS LINE REQUIREMENTS
This section contains the guidelines for installing the actuation
and expellant gas lines between the regulated release mech-
anism regulator, each regulated actuator regulator, and each
agent tank. These limitations should be considered when select-
ing the component mounting locations.
The actuation gas line is the length of pipe and/or hose that is
run from either the AUTOMAN Regulated Release Assembly or
the Remote Release Assembly that directs high pressure from
the cartridge in the release to actuate one or more additional
Regulated Actuator Assemblies. The actuation gas line can
consist of 1/4 in. Schedule 40 black iron, chrome-plated, stain-
less steel, or galvanized steel pipe and fittings, and/or factory
supplied stainless steel braided actuation hose.
The expellant gas line is the length of pipe that is run from the
regulator in either the AUTOMAN Regulated Release Assembly
or a Regulated Actuator Assembly that directs regulated pres-
sure to the agent storage tanks to pressurize the tank and
discharge the agent. The expellant gas line shall consist of 1/4
in. Schedule 40 black iron, chrome-plated, stainless steel, or
galvanized steel pipe and fittings.
Actuation Gas Line - 6 to 8* Tanks Maximum
* 8 Tank maximum reflects the utilization of 3 tank regulated actuators.
Use only 1/4 in. Schedule 40 black iron, hot-dipped galva-
nized, chrome-plated, or stainless steel pipe and fittings.
The actuation gas line piping is installed from the regulated
release mechanism to each regulated actuator connected
within the system. The total length of the actuation gas line
from the regulated release assembly to the regulated actua-
tor assembly(ies) must not exceed 20 ft (6.0 m) when using
an LT-20-R, an LT-30-R nitrogen cartridge, or a 101-10 or a
101-20 carbon dioxide cartridge. See Figure 4-121.
REGULATED ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY
EXPELLANT GAS LINES
NOT INCLUDED IN ACTUATION
GAS LINE LENGTH TOTALS
ACTUATION GAS LINE WITH AN LT-20.R,
LT-30-R, 101-10 OR 101-20 CARTRIDGE
MAXIMUM LENGTH OF 20 FT (6.0 m);
MAXIMUM NO. OF FITTINGS 9
AUTOMAN
REGULATED RELEASE
ASSEMBLY
FIGURE 4-121
000775
%. CHECK VALVE
MAXIMUM OF
._ 5 REMOTE
RELEASE
MECHANISMS
(PART NO.
I 433485) OR
'-' ONE REGULATED
RELEASE (PART
NO. 429853)
FIGURE 4-123
000301
SECTION 4 - SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 4-62 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
ACTUATION AND EXPELLENT GAS LINE REQUIREMENTS
(Continued)
Actuation Gas Line - 6 to 8* Tanks Maximum (Continued)
If an expellant gas line is connected to the regulated
release assembly along with an actuation gas line, the total
combined length of the actuation and expellant gas line
must not exceed 30 ft (9.1 m) when using a "double-tank"
nitrogen cartridge or a LT-A-101-30 nitrogen cartridge or a
101 -30 carbon dioxide cartridge. See Figure 4-122.
A combined total of nine fittings may be used in these lines,
eight 900 elbows and one tee. Two 450 elbows equal one
90° elbow.
Actuation Gas Line - 10 to 15* Tanks Maximum
* 15 Tank maximum reflects the utilization of 3 tank regulated actuators.
1. Use only 1/4 in. Schedule 40 black iron, hot-dipped galva-
nized, chrome-plated, or stainless steel pipe and fittings.
Note: Stainless steel hose and fittings can also be used.
See Component Section for detailed information.
ACTUATOR AND EXPELLANT GAS LINES WITH A
DOUBLE TANK CARTRIDGE OR A 101-30
OR A LT-A-101-30 CARTRIDGE
MAXIMUM COMBINED LENGTH -30 FT (9
MAXIMUM COMBINED FITTINGS -9 '*
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
The actuation gas line piping is installed from the 101
remote mechanical release to each R-1 02 regulated actua-
tor assembly. The total length of the actuation gas line from
the remote mechanical release to the regulated actuator
assemblies must not exceed 100 ft (30.4 m).
A combined total of 20 elbows and 9 tees may be used
in these lines. Two 450 elbows equal one 900 elbow. See
Figure 4-123.
Use only a 101-10 carbon dioxide cartridge in the 101
remote mechanical release.
A safety vent relief valve (Part No. 15677) is required in the
actuation gas line to relieve residual pressure after actua-
tion.
Actuation Gas Line - Using 1/4 in. Stainless Steel Hose
* 15 Tank maximum reflects the utilization of three tank regulated actuators.
Maximum total length of hose cannot exceed 17.5 ft (5.3 m).
Note: A combination of 1/4 in. stainless steel braided hose
and 1/4 in. NPT pipe can be used as long as the total
combined actuation gas line length does not exceed 17.5 ft
(5.3 m). Stainless steel braided hose cannot be used for
expellant gas lines. See Figure 4-123 for additional details.
Maximum of five regulated actuators allowed
Actuated with remote release (Part No. 433485) or Regulated
Release Assembly (Part No. 429853)
SAFETY
RELIEF
REGULATED
ACTUATOR
ASSEMBLY
REGULATED REGULATED ACTUATOR
ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY EXPELLANT
ASSEMBLY GAS LINES NOT INCLUDED
AUTOMAN IN COMBINED TOTALS
REGULATED RELEASE ASSEMBLY
FIGURE 4-122
000262
YPFI I ANT
20 ELBOWS
9 TEES MAXIMUM MAXIMUM
REGULATED ACTUATOR
WITH TANK
MAXIMUM OF AGENT TANK REGULATED
ACTUATORS
REMOTE RELEASE MECHANISMS
(PART NO. 433485) 5 MAXIMUM
1/4 IN. STAINLESS STEEL HOSE OPTIONS
SAFETY 1.4..... 42 IN. (1066 mm) 1/4 IN. STAINLESS RELIEF VALVE MAX. HOSE STEEL HOSE LENGTH (TYP.)
I I.j I I.j
i,
I I.j
I
I I.j I II
I ¼)
I
I
I
II
I
I !
II
I
I I
II
I
I
REGULATED ACTUATOR
WITH TANK MAXIMUM OF 5
REGULATED ACTUATORS
NOTE: WHEN MULTIPLE RELEASE ASSEMBLIES ARE UTILIZED, A 1/4 IN. CHECK VALVE
(PART NO. 25627) WILL BE REQUIRED AFTER EACH REGULATED RELEASE.
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
ACTUATION AND EXPELLENT GAS LINE REQUIREMENTS
(Continued)
Expellant Gas Line
The expellant gas line is installed from the regulated release
mechanism in double, three, and multiple-tank systems,
and from the regulated actuator assembly in multiple-tank
systems. The expellant gas line is the piping and/or hose
between the regulator and the tank-enclosure/tank-bracket
assembly. The total length of the expellant gas line from
the regulated release mechanism or each regulated actu-
ator assembly must not exceed 30 ft (9.1 m) when using
a "double-tank" cartridge, an LT-A-101-30 Cartridge, or a
101-30 Cartridge. See Figures 4-124 and 4-125.
EXPELLANT GAS LINE
MAXIMUM LENGTH -30 FT (9.1 m);
MAXIMUM NO. OF FITTINGS -9
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 4-63
If two tanks are connected to the regulated release
assembly in a multiple-tank system arrangement, the total
combined length of the actuation and expellant gas lines
must not exceed 30 ft (9.1 m) when using a "double-tank"
nitrogen cartridge, an LT-A-101-30 nitrogen cartridge, or a
101-30 carbon dioxide cartridge. See Figure 4-122.
If three 3.0 gallon tanks are connected to the regulator in
either a regulated release or regulated actuator assembly,
only factory supplied expellant gas hose assemblies will
be utilized. Refer to Distribution Piping Requirements - 9.0
Gallon System, page 4-70 for additional design requirements.
DISTRIBUTION PIPING REQUIREMENTS
Once the nozzle placement and quantity of tanks has been
determined, it is then necessary to determine the piping config-
urations between the tank adaptor and each discharge nozzle.
This section contains the guidelines and limitations for designing
the distribution piping so that the liquid agent will discharge from
the nozzles at a proper flow rate. These limitations should also
be referred to when selecting the mounting location for the regu-
lated release mechanism and agent tank.
EXPELLANT GAS LINE
MAXIMUM LENGTH -30 FT (9.1 m);
MAXIMUM NO. OF FITTINGS -9
AUTOMAN REGULATED
RELEASE ASSEMBLY
FIGURE 4-124
000776
General Piping Requirements
All R-102 system piping is straight line. Therefore, the need
for critical lengths and balancing is minimized.
Two 450 elbows count as one 900 elbow.
Each branch line includes the tee or elbow leading to it, and
all fittings within the branch line itself.
The minimum piping length of Schedule 40, 3/8 in. pipe from
the tank outlet to any nozzle protecting a range, fryer, or wok
must be 6 ft (1.9 m).
Pipe lengths are measured from center of fitting to center of
fitting. See Figure 4-126.
CENTER TO CENTER
REGULATED ACTUATOR
ASSEMBLY
FIGURE 4-125
000777
2. A combined total of nine fittings may be used in these lines,
eight 900 elbows and one tee. Two 450 elbows equal one
90° elbow.
FIGURE 4-126
000776
All distribution piping must be 3/8 in. Schedule 40 black iron,
chrome-plated, or stainless steel. Do not use hot dipped
galvanized pipe on the distribution piping.
All threaded connections located in and above the protected
area must be sealed with pipe tape. Tape should be applied
to male threads only. Make certain tape does not extend over
the end of the thread, as this could cause possible blockage
of the agent distribution.
Before installing blow-off caps on nozzles, apply a small
amount of Dow Corning No. 111 silicone grease across the
opening in the nozzle tip and also a small amount coating the
exterior of the blow-off cap. This will help keep cooking grease
from building up on the cap.
Tees used in the distribution piping can be used as thru tees,
side outlet tees, or bull tees.
SUPPLY
LINE TEE
END OF
SUPPLY LINE
(NOZZLES FOR
PLENUM
PROTECTION)
DOF
SUPPLY LINE
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 4-64 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
DISTRIBUTION PIPING REQUIREMENTS (Continued)
Supply and Branch Line Identification
The R-102 distribution piping network is broken down into
four specific pipe runs: the Supply Line, the Duct Branch Line,
the Plenum Branch Line, and the Appliance Branch Line. See
Figure 4-127.
DUCT BRANCH
LINE
R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
SUPPLY LINE
The Supply Line is defined as the length of pipe which runs from
the agent tank outlet to the last branch line (whether a duct,
appliance, or plenum branch line). This includes all supply line
fittings except for the tees or elbows leading to the branch lines.
See Figures 4-127 and 4-128.
SUPPLY
LINE
PLENUM APPLIANCE
BRANCH LINE BRANCH LINE
NOTE: THIS IS CONCEPTUAL DRAWING ONLY.
THIS IS NOT AN ACTUAL INSTALLATION. FIGURE 4-127
000779
NOTE: THESE ARE EXAMPLES ONLY. OTHER CONFIGURATIONS CAN BE DESIGNED.
END OF
SUPPLY LINE
END OF
YLINE
END OF
SUPPLY LINE
(NOZZLES FOR
PLENUM
PROTECTION)
BRANCH LINE CANNOT BRANCH LINE CANNOT START AHEAD OF A START AHEAD OF A SUPPLY LINE TEE SUPPLY LINE TEE
FIGURE 4-128
000780
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
DISTRIBUTION PIPING REQUIREMENTS (Continued)
Supply and Branch Line Identification (Continued)
NOTICE
Branch lines cannot start ahead of a supply
line tee.
DUCT BRANCH LINE
The Duct Branch Line is defined as the length of pipe which
runs from the supply line to the duct nozzle(s). This includes all
branch line fittings as well as the tee or elbow used to start the
branch line. See Figures 4-128 and 4-129.
DUCT BRANCH LINE
(ELBOW INCLUDED)
$
$ DUCT BRANCH LINE
(TEE INCLUDED)
II U DUCT BRANCH LINE
(TEES INCLUDED)
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 4-65
PLENUM BRANCH LINE
The Plenum Branch Line is defined as the length of pipe which
runs from the supply line to the plenum nozzle(s). This includes
all branch line fittings as well as the tee or elbow used to start
the branch line. See Figures 4-128 and 4-130.
--.4
- - - . -----
PLENUM BRANCH LINE
(TEE INCLUDED)
PLENUM BRANCH LINE
I
(TEE INCLUDED)
FIGURE 4-130
000782
APPLIANCE BRANCH LINE
The Appliance Branch Line is defined as the length of pipe
which runs from the supply line to the appliance nozzle(s). This
includes all branch line fittings as well as the tee or elbow used
to start the branch line. See Figures 4-128 and 4-131.
-a
APPLIANCE BRANCH LINES
(TEES INCLUDED)
FIGURE 4-129
000781
FIGURE 4-131
000763
START OF LAST
BRANCH LINE
START OF FIRST
BRANCH LINE
FIGURE 4-132
000784
1W NOZZLE
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 4-66 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
DISTRIBUTION PIPING REQUIREMENTS (Continued)
Distribution Piping Requirements —1.5 Gallon System
DUCT, PLENUM, AND APPLIANCE PROTECTION
This option allows for duct protection, plenum protection,
appliance protection, or any combination. However, only one
duct nozzle may be used, either a 1W or a 2W, nozzle.
All distribution piping, supply and branch, must be 3/8 in.
Schedule 40 black iron, chrome-plated, or stainless steel.
Each 1.5 gallon tank allows a maximum of five flow
numbers.*
The pipe length between the start of the first branch line and
the start of the last branch line must not exceed 8 ft (2.4 m).
When the supply line is split, the combined length of both
legs of the supply line (start of first branch line to start of last
branch line) must not exceed 8 ft (2.4 m). See Figure 4-132.
The combined length of all branch lines must not exceed 22
ft (6.7 m). See Figure 4-133.
The requirements of the following table must not be
exceeded:
START OF LAST
BRANCH LINE
START OF FIRST
BRANCH LINE
SUPPLY
LINE TEE TOTAL LENGTH
MUST NOT
EXCEED 8 FT
(2.4m)
(BRANCH LINES IN BOLD) COMBINED LENGTH MUST
NOT EXCEED 22 FT (6.7 m)
FIGURE 4-133
amiss
1.5 GALLON SYSTEM
Supply Duct Plenum Appliance
Requirements Line Branch Line Branch Line Branch Line
Pipe Size 3/8 in. 3/8 in. 3/8 in. 3/8 in.
Maximum Length 40 ft 6 It 4 ft loft
(12.1 m) (1.8 m) (1.2 m) (3.0 m)
Maximum Tees 1 1 2 3
Maximum Flow Numbers 5* 2 2 3
Exceptions:
Six flow numbers are allowed when a duct branch line is the fast branch line on the piping network and no 1 N nozzles are used to protect woks or griddles.
Six flow numbers are allowed when six 1 N nozzles are used and none of the nozzles are used to protect woks, griddles, ranges, and salamanders.
Note: Only five flow numbers are allowed if a 1 N nozzle is used for wok, griddle, range, or salamander protection.
Six flow numbers are allowed when only two 3N nozzles are used.
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
ULEX347O ULCEX347O
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 4-67
DISTRIBUTION PIPING REQUIREMENTS (Continued)
Distribution Piping Requirements - 3.0 Gallon System
The maximum length between the start of the first branch
line and the start of the last branch line must not exceed
24 ft (7.3 m). When the supply line is split, the combined
total of both legs of the supply line (from the start of the
first branch line to the start of the last branch line) must not
exceed 24 ft (7.3 m). See Figure 4-134.
The total length of all branch lines must not exceed 36 ft
(10.9 m). See Figure 4-134.
Use a 3/8 in. union to connect the tank adaptor to the 3/8 in.
supply line.
A maximum of two nozzles are allowed per duct branch line.
The requirements of the following table must not be
exceeded:
SUPPLY
TEE (
ri I COMBINED LENGTH OF
9 BOTH LEGS OF SUPPLY
LINE MUST NOT
EXCEED 24 FT (7.3 m)
2W NOZZLE
000266
\
3 BRANCH LINES
1 NOZZLE :)r_,~
4— IN NOZZLE
[J 230 NOZZLE /
245 NOZZLE 1/2N NOZZLE
(BRANCH LINE IN BOLD)
COMBINED LENGTH MUST 000502
NOT EXCEED 36 FT (10.9 m)
FIGURE 4-134
3.0 GALLON SYSTEM
Duct Plenum Appliance
Requirements Supply Line Branch Line Branch Line Branch Line
Pipe Size 3/8 in. 3/8 in. 3/8 in. 3/8 in.
Maximum Length 40 ft 8 ft 4 ft 12 ft
(12.1 m) (2.4 m) (1.2 m) (3.6 m)
Maximum Rise 6 ft 4 ft 2 ft 2 ft
(1.8 m) (1.2 m) (0.6 m) (0.6 m)
Maximum 900 9 4 4 6
Elbows
Maximum Tees 1 2 2 4
Maximum Flow 11* 4 2 4
Numbers
*Exceptions:
Twelve flow numbers are allowed in any one tank for duct and plenum protection only.
Twelve flow numbers are allowed with any one tank using only two-flow appliance nozzles.
Twelve flow numbers are allowed with any one tank using only three-flow appliance nozzles.
Special Instructions:
Twelve flow numbers are allowed when four Dean Industries GTI Gas Fryers are protected at low proximity as shown in Figure 4-66 on Page 4-32. The discharge piping must be
as shown in Figure 4-67 on Page 4-32.
For certain McDonald's applications, 11.5 flow numbers are allowed when using a combination of one 2W duct nozzle, one 1/2N electrostatic precipitator nozzle,
one iN plenum nozzle, and tour two-flow appliance nozzles. Contact the Applications Engineering Department for additional information.
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 4-68 REV. 11 , 2014-SEP-01
DISTRIBUTION PIPING REQUIREMENTS (Continued)
Distribution Piping Requirements - 6.0 Gallon Manifolded
System
As an option to piping two 3.0 gallon tanks separately, two 3.0
gallon tanks can be manifolded together to share a common
agent distribution line. Only 3.0 gallon tanks connected to the
same regulator can be manifolded. The following requirements
must be met when manifolding:
All piping must be 3/8 in. Schedule 40.
See Figure 4-136 for tank connections.
The length of supply line piping between the start of the first
branch line and the start of the last branch line must not
exceed 24 ft (7.3 m). See Figure 4-135. When the supply
line is split, the combined total of both legs of the supply
line (from the start of the first branch line to the start of the
last branch line) must not exceed 24 ft (7.3 m).
The combined length of all branch lines must not exceed
36 ft (10.9 m). See Figure 4-135.
A maximum of 22 flow numbers are allowed.
The requirements of the following table must not be
exceeded.
R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
LENGTH OF PIPING MUST NOT EXCEED 24 FT.
(7.3 m) FROM START OF FIRST BRANCH LINE
TO START OF LAST BRANCH LINE
START OF LAST
BRANCH LINE -
2W
2LE
ZZLE
2 FLOW APPLIANCE NOZZLE
(BRANCH LINES IN BOLD)
COMBINED LENGTH MUST NOT EXCEED 36 FT (10.9 m)
FIGURE 4-135
000267
6.0 GALLON SYSTEM
Duct Plenum Appliance
Requirements Supply Line Branch Line Branch Line Branch Line
Pipe Size 3/8 in. 3/8 in. 3/8 in. 3/8 in.
Maximum Length 32 ft 8 ft 4 ft 12 ft
(9.7 m) (2.4 m) (1.2 m) (3.6 m)
Maximum Rise 6 ft 4 ft 2 ft 2 ft
(1.8 m) (1.2 m) (0.6 m) (0.6 m)
Maximum 900 8 4 4 6
Elbows
Maximum Tees 2 2 2 4
Maximum Flow 22 4 2 4
Numbers
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
DISTRIBUTION PIPING REQUIREMENTS (Continued)
Distribution Piping Requirements - 6.0 Gallon Manifolded
System (Continued)
This configuration consists of two 3 gallon tanks. Both tanks are
connected to a common manifold tee and are pressurized from
a single double tank (Part No. 73022) nitrogen cartridge in the
regulated release assembly. See Figure 4-136, Note: A tank
mounting bracket can be utilized instead of the tank/enclosure
assembly.
3/8 IN.
3/8 IN. 3/8 IN.
SUPPLY SUPPLY
USE HOSE! SEE I
GROMMET NOTE
PACKAGE \ I NO. 1
(PART NO. 3/8 IN BRANCH
418511) '-IN-LINE BURST DISC
ASSEMBLY -SEE NOTE NO.4
- REMOVE
BURST DISC -
SEE NOTE NO.3
3.0 3.0
GALLON GALLON
TANK TANK DOUBLE TANK
NITROGEN
CARTRIDGE OR
N(LTA10130 CARTRIDGE-
REGULATED 3.0 GALLON REGULATED RELEASE 008127
ACTUATOR ONLY) ASSEMBLY OR 3.0 GALLON REGULATED
ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY
TANK/ENCLOSURE
ASSEMBLY
NOTE 1: THE PIPE CONNECTION FROM TANK CENTER TO TANK
CENTER CANNOT EXCEED 81/2 IN. (215 mm). ALSO, OEM
RELEASE/BRACKET ASSEMBLY CAN BE UTILIZED WHEN
MANIFOLDING 3.0 GALLON TANK.
NOTE 2: ONLY 3 GALLON TANKS CAN BE MANIFOLDED.
NOTE 3: THE BURST DISC THAT IS PART OF THE TANK ADAPTOR!
BURST DISC ASSEMBLY MUST BE REMOVED AND
MODIFIED. SEPARATE THE ALUMINUM DISC MATERIAL
FROM THE PLASTIC GASKET. DISCARD THE ALUMINUM
DISC MATERIAL AND REINSTALL THE PLASTIC GASKET
BACK INTO THE TANK ADAPTOR/BURST DISC ASSEMBLY.
NOTE 4: THE IN-LINE BURST DISC ASSEMBLY (PART NO. 416970)
IS TO BE MOUNTED AS CLOSE TO THE TANK OUTLET AS
POSSIBLE. AFTER SYSTEM DISCHARGE, THE ASSEMBLY
MUST BE DISASSEMBLED AND A NEW BURST DISC
INSTALLED.
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 4-69
Distribution Piping Requirements - With Independent Pipe
Runs
Independent pipe runs can also be used with the regulated
release assembly and the tank/enclosure assembly or tank
mounting brackets. See Figure 4.137. When manifolding is not
used, each of the two 3 gallon tanks utilize the piping limitations
of a single tank system.
HOSE!
PACKAGE
(PART NO.
•JJ. 418511)
III 3.0 GALLON 3.0 GALLON II, TANK TANK
DOUBLE TANK
NITROGEN
CARTRIDGE
OR LT-A-101-30
CARTRIDGE
(LT-A-101-30 REGULATED RELEASE ASSEMBLY OR CARTRIDGE - REGULATED ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY REGULATED
TANK/ENCLOSURE ACTUATOR ONLY)
ASSEMBLY
FIGURE 4-137
000786
Note: If an expellant gas hose is to be used for a second tank
in an adjacent tank enclosure or tank bracket assembly, the
second tank will need to be installed on the left side of the
AUTOMAN Regulated Release, with the outlets a maximum of
8.5 in. (215 mm) from center to center, similar to the manifolded
system in Figure 4-136. Otherwise, the second tank will require
1/4 in. NPT pipe instead of expellant gas hose.
FIGURE 4-136
SECTION 4- SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 4-70 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
DISTRIBUTION PIPING REQUIREMENTS (Continued)
Distribution Piping Requirements - 9.0 Gallon System
This optional configuration consists only of three 3-gallon tanks,
all pressurized from a single double-tank nitrogen cartridge with
expellant gas hoses connected as shown in Figure 4-138. Tanks
No. 1 and No. 2 must be connected directly to the regulator with
separate expellant gas hoses and Tank No. 3 must be connected
to Tank No. 2 with a third expellant gas hose as shown in Figure
4-136. Each tank must be connected to an independent distribu-
tion piping network as shown in Figure 4-138. Distribution piping
requirements for each network must be as follows:
The maximum length between the start of the first branch
line and the start of the last branch line must not exceed
24 ft (7.3 m). When the supply line is split, the combined
total of both legs of the supply line (from the start of the
first branch line to the start of the last branch line) must not
exceed 24 ft (7.3 m). See Figure 4-134.
The total length of all branch lines must not exceed 36 ft
(10.9 m). See Figure 4-138.
Use a 3/8 in. union to connect the tank adaptor to the 3/8 in.
supply line.
A maximum of two nozzles are allowed per duct branch line.
When using this 9.0 gallon system configuration, no mani-
folding of distribution piping is allowed.
When an AUTOMAN Regulated Release is utilized in this
configuration, additional regulator actuators cannot be used.
Only 3-gallon tanks can be utilized in this configuration.
The requirements of the following table must not be
exceeded for each 3-gallon tank:
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
TWO TANK ENCLOSURE 3 GALLON REGULATED DOUBLE TANK NITROGEN
ASSEMBLY (PART NO. RELEASE ASSEMBLY, CARTRIDGE OR
430324) (INCLUDES OR 3 GALLON LT-A-101-30 CARTRIDGE
HOSES AND GROMMETS) REGULATED (REGULATED ACTUATOR
ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY ONLY)
NOTE: WHEN THREE 3.0 GALLON TANKS ARE CONNECTED TO ONE
AUTOMAN REGULATED RELEASE ASSEMBLY, NO ADDITIONAL
REGULATED ACTUATOR(S) ASSEMBLIES CAN BE USED.
FIGURE 4-138
008126
9.0 GALLON SYSTEM
Duct Plenum Appliance
Requirements Supply Line Branch Line Branch Line Branch Line
Pipe Size 3/8 in. 3/8 in. 3/8 in. 3/8 in.
Maximum Length 40 ft 8 ft 4 ft 12 ft
(12.1 m) (2.4 m) , (1.2 m) (3.6 m)
Maximum Rise 6 ft 4 ft 2 ft 2 ft
(1.8 m) (1.2 m) (0.6 m) (0.6 m)
Maximum 900 9 4 4 6
Elbows
Maximum Tees 1 2 2 4
Maximum Flow 11* 4 2 4
Numbers
ExceptIons:
Twelve flow numbers are allowed in any one tank for duct and plenum protection ONLY.
Twelve flow numbers are allowed with any one tank using only two-flow appliance nozzles.
Twelve flow numbers are allowed with any one tank using only three-flow appliance nozzles.
Special Instructions:
When four Dean Industries GTI Gas Fryers are protected at low proximity as shown in Figure 4-66 on Page 4-32, the discharge piping must be as shown in Figure 4-67 on
Page 4-32.
For certain McDonald's applications, 11.5 flow numbers are allowed when using a combination of one 2W duct nozzle, one 112N electrostatic precipitator nozzle,
one 1 N plenum nozzle, and four two-flow appliance nozzles. Contact the Applications Engineering Department for additional information. -
R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 4-71
DETECTION SYSTEM REQUIREMENTS
Once the fire suppression system design has been determined,
a detection system design must be completed. This section
contains guidelines and limitations for detection system instal-
lation.
Detector Identification
-
The two types of detectors are distinguished from each other by
their location in the detection system.
The Terminal Detector is the last in a series of detectors,
or the only detector used in a single-detector system. This
detector is thus named because it is at the point at which the
wire rope ends, or "terminates."
A Series Detector is any detector located in-line between the
regulated release mechanism and the terminal detector.
Detector/Pulley Elbow/Conduit Offset Design Limitations
1. Conduit runs, pulley elbows, and number of detectors per
system must be within the approved system guidelines. The
following requirements must not be exceeded: NOTICE
20 FT (6.0 m)
MAXIMUM
FIGURE 4-139
000271
Maximum Maximum Maximum
Number of Number of Length of
Detectors Elbows 1/2 in. Conduit
per System per System per System
Scissors Style 15 20 150 ft (45.7 m)
Detector
(Without
Offset Conduit
Scissors Style 15 16 150 ft (45.7 m)
Detector (With
Offset Conduit
When gas appliances are used and the flue
gases from the burner are exhausted into the
duct, the detector must be kept out of the air
stream of these exhaust gases. These gases
can be very hot and could actuate the system
unnecessarily.
Duct openings that are long and narrow or
large enough to require multiple duct nozzles
may require additional detectors.
ELECTROSTATIC PRECIPITATOR
2. If the hazard requires more than 15 detectors, up to five
101 Remote Releases (Part No. 433485) can be used for If an electrostatic precipitator is located at or near the base of
system actuation. Each 101 remote release allows the use the exhaust duct, it is necessary to locate a detector below the
of a maximum of 15 "scissor" style detectors (14 series and precipitator, at the base of the duct, and also locate one in the
1 terminal) for a total of 75 detectors if needed. duct, just above the precipitator. See Figure 4-140.
Detector Placement Requirements
EXHAUST DUCTS
Each exhaust duct must have at least one detector installed
in the duct entrance, located in the airstream of the cooking
vapors, or at a maximum of 20 ft (6.0 m) into the duct opening.
See Figure 4-139
When installing the detector bracket and system conduit, make
certain they do not interfere with the operation of the precipitator.
Note: On secondary filtration units utilizing multiple filter stages/
i. media, contact Technical Services for instructions.
FIGURE 4-140
000268
APPLIANCE APPLIANCE APPLIANCE
REQUIRES COVERED BY REQUIRES
SEPARATE DETECTOR SEPARATE
DETECTOR UNDER DUCT DETECTOR FIGURE 4-142
000270
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 4-72 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
DETECTION SYSTEM REQUIREMENTS (Continued)
Detector Placement Requirements (Continued)
COOKING APPLIANCES
If the cooking appliance is located under an exhaust duct where
a detector has been mounted, it is normally not necessary to
utilize another detector for that cooking appliance, provided the
detector is not more than 12 in. (304 mm) into the duct and the
appliance has no larger cooking surface than 48 in. x 48 in.
(1219 mm x 1219 mm). See Figure 4-141.
Note: If two appliances are located under a duct opening where
a detector has been mounted and both appliances together
do not exceed a cooking surface of 48 in. x 48 in. (1219 mm x
1219 mm) and the detector is located above both the protected
appliances, it is not necessary to utilize an additional detector
provided the duct detector is not more than 12 in. (304 mm) into
the duct opening.
NOTICE
The conduit offset can be used at the top or
bottom of the regulated release to change
direction of the conduit. The conduit offset
cannot be used with pulley tees. All other
changes in direction must be made by using
ANSUL approved pulley elbows (Part No.
423254 or 415670). See Figure 4-142.
FIGURE 4-141
000269
Each cooking appliance with a continuous cooking surface not
exceeding 48 in. x 48 in. (1219 x 1219 mm) can be protected by
a minimum of one detector. Cooking appliances with a continu-
ous cooking surface exceeding 48 in. x 48 in. (1219 x 1219 mm)
must be protected by at least one detector per 48 in. x 48 in.
(1219 x 1219 mm) cooking area. Detectors used for cooking
appliances must be located above the protected appliance
toward the exhaust duct side of the appliance. The detector
should be located in the air stream of the appliance to enhance
system response time.
Note: For overlapping detector coverage, see Page 4-60 for
design requirements.
Detection Line Requirements
CONDUIT
Rigid conduit or 1/2 inch EMT thin-wall conduit may be used.
Standard steel conduit fittings (compression type are recom-
mended) must be employed to properly install the detection
system. All conduit or pipe must be firmly supported. When
using pipe, make certain that all ends are carefully reamed,
deburred and blown clear of chips and scale before assembly.
Fusible Link Selection
When possible, temperature readings should be taken at each
detector location to determine correct fusible link temperature
rating. Temperature can be recorded using either a maximum
registering thermometer (Part No. 15240) temperature tape or
any other accurate thermometer.
AN8U..
TEMPERATURE RATING
STAMPED ON FUSIBLE
LINK BODY
0
_ 000170 000171 SL STYLE A-PC STYLE
FIGURE 4-143
Select correct UL Listed fusible link(s) for installation in detec-
tor(s) according to the temperature condition. Two styles are
available. See Figure 4-143. See Component Section for
detailed temperature ratings.
R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
DETECTION SYSTEM REQUIREMENTS (Continued)
r Electric Thermal Detector
When electric thermal detection is used, the detection circuit
must be supervised in accordance with NFPA 17A, Standard for
Wet Chemical Extinguishing Systems. Electric thermal detectors
must be used in conjunction with either the AUTOPULSE 542R
Control Panel (Part No. 433607) or the AUTOPULSE Z-10
Control Panel (Part No. 430525), and the 24VDC Regulated
Release Assembly.
Note: Consider the rate of temperature increase in the location
chosen for the detector when using electric thermal detection.
A transient rush of warm air up to 40 OF (4 °C) per minute may
expand the shell, but not enough to trigger the AUTOPULSE
control panel. Temperature increases over 40 OF (4 °C) per
minute however, may initiate an alarm condition in the control
panel.
After determining the maximum ambient temperature at the
thermal detector location, select the correct thermal detector
according to the temperature condition chart in the System
Components" section.
MANUAL PULL STATION REQUIREMENTS
A remote manual pull station allows the R-102 system to be
manually operated at some point distant from the regulated
release assembly. The pull station should be installed at a height
of 42-48 in. (1067-1219 mm), in accordance with the require-
ments of the American Disabilities Act (ADA) and the Authority
having Jurisdiction, and located in the path of egress. The pull
station is the only source of manual actuation of the regulated
release assembly.
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 4-73
TEE CLOSE TO AUTOMAN (EXAMPLE)
PULLEY TEE
12 IN.
(304 mm) J
GAS VALVE OR AUTOMANGAS VALVE OR
MANUAL PULL MANUAL PULL
149 FT (45.4 m) AND 20 PULLEY ELBOWS MAXIMUM
PER EACH SIDE OF TEE
TEE CLOSE TO GAS VALVES OR MANUAL PULL (EXAMPLE)
121N. 121N.
(304 mm) (304 mm)
PULLEY TEE LE
GAS VALVE OR GAS VALVE OR
MANUAL PULL MANUAL PULL
AUTOMAN
149 FT (45.4 m) AND 20 PULLEY ELBOWS BETWEEN
AUTOMAN AND TEE
TEE HALFWAY BETWEEN AUTOMAN AND GAS VALVES OR MANUAL PULL (EXAMPLE)
75 FT (22.8 m) AND 10 PULLEY ELBOWS
75 FT (22.8 m) AND 75 FT (22.8 m) AND
10 PULLEY ELBOWS 10 PULLEY ELBOWS
6 PULLEY TEE-1
AUTOMAN GAS VALVE OR GAS VALVE OR
MANUAL PULL MANUAL PULL
FIGURE 4-144
004907
The total length of the cable used for each manual pull station
within a system must not exceed 150 ft (45.7 m). Manual Pull Station - Part No. 435960 or 434618
The maximum number of pulley elbows that may be used per
pull station is 20.
One pulley tee is allowed per cable system.
The maximum length of cable from the AUTOMAN to a pull
station is 150 ft (45.7 m) with a maximum of 20 pulley elbows
used per side of the tee. As the tee is located farther from the
AUTOMAN, the 150 ft (45.7 m) maximum must be observed but
as pulley elbows are placed between the AUTOMAN and the
tee, they must be deducted from the available pulley elbows (20)
allowed on each side.
Example: If 10 pulley elbows are placed between the AUTOMAN
and the pulley tee, the maximum available pulley elbows left for
use on each side of the tee is 10 per side. See Figure 4-144
for three different examples. (Note: Both must be gas valves or
both must be pull stations. Mixing is not allowed.)
Parts that may be used for installation of a metal stamped
remote manual pull station are:
Description Part No.
Remote Manual Pull Station Assembly* 435960
Remote Manual Pull Station Assembly 434618
Pulley Elbow 423250
Pulley Elbow 415670
Pulley Tee 427929
*Assembly includes parts listed below:
1/16 in. Stainless Steel Cable 50 ft (15.2 m) 15821
Oval Press-To-Crimp Sleeves 4596
Glass Break Rod (1) 4834
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 4-74 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
MECHANICAL GAS VALVE REQUIREMENTS
An ANSUL or ANSUL approved mechanical gas shut-off valve
system can be attached to the R-102 system. The system works
both mechanically and pneumatically by use of an air cylinder
located inside the regulated release assembly. Upon actuation
of the fire suppression system, a pneumatically-operated air
cylinder assembly will mechanically close the gas shut-off valve.
The total length of the cable for each mechanical gas valve must
not exceed 150 ft (45.7 m). The maximum number of pulley
elbows that may be used is 20 for each valve.
One pulley tee is allowed per cable system.
The maximum length of cable from the AUTOMAN to a gas valve
is 150 ft (45.7 m) with a maximum of 20 pulley elbows used per
side of the tee. As the tee is located farther from the AUTOMAN,
the 150 ft (45.7 m) maximum must be observed but as pulley
elbows are placed between the AUTOMAN and the tee, they
must be deducted from the available pulley elbows (20) allowed
on each side.
Example: If 10 pulley elbows are placed between the AUTOMAN
and the pulley tee, the maximum available pulley elbows left for
use on each side of the tee is 10 per side. See Figure 4-144 for
three different examples.
Parts that may be used for installation of a Mechanical Gas
Shut-off Valve are:
Description Part No.
Gas Valve/Actuator 3/4 in. Assembly (ANSUL)* 55598
Gas Valve/Actuator 1 in. Assembly (ANSUL)* 55601
Gas Valve/Actuator 1 1/4 in. Assembly (ANSUL)* 55604
Gas Valve/Actuator 1 1/2 in. Assembly (ANSUL)* 55607
Gas Valve/Actuator 2 in. Assembly (ANSUL)* 55610
Gas Valve/Actuator 2 1/2 in. Assembly (ASCO)* 25937
Gas Valve/Actuator 3 in. Assembly (ASCO)* 25938
Pulley Elbow 423250
Pulley Elbow 415670
Pulley Tee 427929
1/16 in. Stainless Steel Cable 15821 or
50 ft (15.2 m) or 500 ft (152.4 m) roll 79653
Oval Press-To-Crimp Sleeve 4596
Stop Sleeve (2) 26317
'Assembly includes parts listed below:
Air Cylinder Assembly 15733
Air Cylinder 15521
Tubing Assembly 15529
Copper Tubing, 1/8 in. 15525
Male Elbow 15523
Male Connector 15522
Machine Screw (2) 15421
Hex Nut (2) 15527
Lockwasher (2) 4141
Visual Inspection Seal (2) 197
All valves above are UL listed and approved. They may be
mounted in any position. Pipe threads are type NPT. Ambient
operating temperature range of all valves is 32 OF to 120 OF
(0 °C to 49 °C). The valves are not weatherproof and must
be located indoors in areas approved by the "authority having
jurisdiction."
R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
ELECTRICAL GAS VALVE REQUIREMENTS
A UL Listed electrically-operated gas shut-off valve can be
attached to the R-102 system to provide an electrical means of
shutting off the gas line at a predetermined point. If an electric
gas shut-off valve is used in the system it must be attached
with both an electric (snap-action) switch and a manual reset
relay. For more information on the types of electric (snap-action)
switches, refer to the Electrical Switch, Field Installation section.
The manual reset relay is reviewed in this section.
All electrical connections should be performed by a QUALIFIED
ELECTRICIAN and in accordance with authority having
jurisdiction.
The following is a brief explanation of how the R-102 system
operates with an Electric Gas Shut-off Valve attached:
With the regulated release cocked in the ready condition, the
normally closed contacts in the snap-action switch allow current
to flow to the manual reset relay. With the relay coil energized,
normally open contacts in the reset relay close, allowing the
solenoid in the gas valve to be energized.
Once the R-102 system is activated, the normally closed
contacts in the snap-action switch will open, de-energizing the
reset relay. This will, in turn, open the contacts in the relay which
will cause the gas valve to become de-energized and close.
The system must be re-armed and the "push to reset" button on
the reset relay must be operated to reopen the gas valve.
It is important to note that a power failure or an electrical power
interruption will cause the gas valve to close even though the
system was not fired.
In either case, whether in a fired condition or when a power
failure has occurred, the manual reset relay and electric gas
shut-off valve must be reset to resume a normal operating condi-
tion. For resetting, refer to the "Recharge and Reselling
Procedures" section in this manual.
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 4-75
ELECTRICAL GAS VALVE REQUIREMENTS (Continued)
Approvals
ANSUL gas valves listed in this section are UL listed and
approved for 110 VAC. If more information is required, refer to
the Gas and Oil Equipment List of Underwriters Laboratories,
Inc. under Electrically Operated Valves Guide No. 440 As" or
consult Tyco Fire Protection Products, Marinette, Wisconsin
54143-2542.
If other gas valves are used, they shall be "UL listed electrical-
ly-operated safety valves for natural or LP gas as required, of
appropriate pressure and temperature rating, 110 VAC/60 Hz."
The information on temperature and type of gas that the valves
are suitable for may be found in the Gas and Oil Equipment List
of Underwriters Laboratories, Inc. under 'Electrically Operated
Valves Guide No. 440 A5."
The electrically operated gas valve must be of the type that
needs to be energized to remain open.
Note: For electrical wiring diagrams, see Installation Instructions"
Section, Pages 5-40 through 5-42.
Parts that may be used for installation of a 110 VAC Gas Shut-
off Valve are:
Description Part No.
Electric Solenoid Valve, 3/4 in. NPT* 13707
Electric Solenoid Valve, 1 in. NPT* 13708
Electric Solenoid Valve, 1 1/4 in. NPT" 550360
Electric Solenoid Valve, 1 1/2 in. NPT* 13709
Electric Solenoid Valve, 2 in. NPT* 13710
Electric Solenoid Valve, 2 1/2 in. NPT* 550363
Electric Solenoid Valve, 3 in. NPT" 17643
Manual Reset Relay (110 VAC) 426151
'Valves are normally closed when de-energized.
ALARM INITIATING SWITCH REQUIREMENTS
The Alarm Initiating Switch can be field mounted within the
AUTOMAN release. The switch must be used to close a super-
vised alarm circuit to the building main fire alarm panel when
the AUTOMAN release actuates. This action will signal the fire
alarm panel that there was a system actuation in the kitchen
area. The switch kit contains all necessary mounting compo-
nents along with a mounting instruction sheet. See Page 5-39
for wiring information.
The switch is rated 50 mA, 28VDC.
Part No. Description
428311 Alarm Initiating Switch Kit
ELECTRICAL SWITCH REQUIREMENTS
Note: Electrical connections shall not be made in the
AUTOMAN.
The electric (snap-action) switches for the R-102 system are
specially designed to fit the regulated release assembly. The
switches are intended for use with electric gas valves, alarms,
contactors, lights, contractor supplied electric power shut-off
devices, and other electrical devices that are designed to shut
off or turn on when the fire suppression system is actuated.
(See Figures 5-122 through 5-124 in Installation Section for
reference).
Contractors shall supply "UL listed, enclosed industrial control
equipment or magnetic switch having a rating matching that of
the cooking appliance, coil 110 VAC/60 Hz or 24 VAC/60 Hz."
All electrical connections should be performed by a QUALIFIED
ELECTRICIAN and in accordance with authority having
jurisdiction.
Electric (Snap-Action) Switches that may be field installed are:
Part No. Description
423878 One Switch Kit
423879 Two Switch Kit
423880 Three Switch Kit
423881 Four Switch Kit
436770 Two Switch Kit (no wire leads)
Each switch has a set of single-pole, double throw contacts
rated at 21 amp, 1 HP, 125, 250, 277 VAC or 2 HP, 250, 277
VAC.
Note: A relay must be supplied by others if the equipment load
exceeds the rated capacity of the switch.
Electrical wiring and equipment shall be installed in accordance
with NFPA 70 (National Electrical Code) or the requirements of
the authority having jurisdiction.
If a fire alarm system is provided, the fire extinguishing system
shall be connected to the alarm system in accordance with the
requirements of NFPA 72, National Fire Alarm Code, so that the
actuation of the extinguishing system will sound the fire alarm as
well as provide the extinguishing function of the system.
If supervision of the electrical detection, electrical actuation or
electrical power supply circuit is provided, it shall give prompt
audible or visual indication of trouble and shall be distinctive
from alarms or indicators indicating operation or hazardous
conditions as specified in NFPA 17A.
SECTION 4— SYSTEM DESIGN R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 4-76 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
NOTES:
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS
The installation information listed in this section deals with the
limitations and parameters of this pre-engineered system. Those
individuals responsible for the installation of the R-102 system
must be trained and hold a current ANSUL certificate in an
R-102 training program.
Before attempting any installation, the entire system design
must have been determined including: Nozzle Placement,
Tank Quantity, Actuation and Expellant Gas Piping, Distribution
Piping, and Detection System Requirements and an installation
sketch should be completed.
b. INSTALLING RELEASE ASSEMBLY COMPONENTS
For successful system performance, the regulated release assem-
bly, regulated actuator assembly(ies), and tank-enclosure(s) or
tank-bracket assembly(ies) used must be located in areas where
the air temperature will not fall below 32 OF (0 °C) or exceed
130 OF (54 °C). The R-102 system is limited to interior applica-
tions only. Also, the components must be arranged to conform to
the actuation and expellant gas line, and the distribution piping
guidelines noted in "System Design."
SECTION 5— INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 5-1
Remove the 7/8 in. (22 mm) knockout on the left side
of the AUTOMAN release box and remove the 1 in. (25
mm) knockout on the right side of the tank-enclosure
box. Install grommets in each (use ANSUL hose/grommet
package (Part No. 418511)). Remove 1/4 in. plug from
back side of R-102 regulator and install fixed end of
secondary expellant gas hose (included in hose/grommet
package in 1/4 in. regulator outlet and wrench tighten.
If not already done, mount both boxes to a rigid surface
using appropriate fasteners.
Fill tanks per instructions listed in Steps 3 and 4 on
Page 5-3.
Next, route hose through grommets and wrench tighten
into 1/4 in. inlet of the adaptor on the tank in the tank/
enclosure assembly. Also install hose to tank adaptor in
regulated release and wrench tighten. See Figure 4-135
in "System Design" for details of hose routing.
REGULATED RELEASE ASSEMBLY/REGULATED
ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY/DOUBLE TANK ENCLOSURE
16 1/2 IN.
(419 mm)
Use only an AUTOMAN Regulated Release assembly or 1313/16 IN.
OEM Release/Bracket Assembly. The regulator in this (351 mm) 1 3/8 IN.
assembly is specifically designed to allow a regulated flow • - ...- (35 mm)
of expellant gas into the agent tank(s). Absence of this -
regulator could cause the tank(s) to rupture or create an - improper system discharge. -
Mount the regulated release assembly, OEM Release 23 1/2 IN. 0 I (597 mm)
Assembly, and each regulated actuator assembly required 19 7/16 IN. by completing the following steps: See Figures 5-1, 5-2, and (494 mm)
5-3.
a. Select a rigid surface for mounting the enclosure. The
mounting locations must allow the regulated release
assembly and the regulated actuator assembly(ies) to
be within the limitation of the actuation and expellant gas 2IN,
line lengths and must be able to support the weight of (191 mm)
the assembly(ies). When the OEM Release Assembly is
mounted inside a cabinet, clearances shall be provided FIGURE &i
for unrestricted movement of the release assembly 000287
components within the closed cabinet.
Detach cover from the enclosure. Remove agent tank
from enclosure and the expellant gas line hose from the
tank/adaptor assembly.
Secure enclosure box to selected mounting location
using the four mounting holes. Use appropriate type of
fasteners depending on the mounting surface.
When mounting a 6 gallon manifolded system (or a 6
gallon individual piped system) it is critical that each
mounting box is located as shown in Figure 5-3. There
must be a 5/16 in. (7.9 mm) space between each box.
Less than 5/16 in. (7.9 mm) will cause interference with
the covers, and more than 5/16 in. (7.9 mm) will cause a
gap between the two hose grommets which will expose
the hose to possible tampering or damage.
3 GALLON TANK BRACKET
31/2 IN.
99
93/4 IN.
(248 mm)
713/16
(198 mm
SINGLE TANK ENCLOSUREIREMOTE RELEASE
gIN. I
(229 mm)
;so 0
231/2 IN.
(597 mm)
FIGURE 5-4
. SECTION 5— INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 5-2 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
I
MOUNTING THE COMPONENTS (Continued)
OEM RELEASE/BRACKET ASSEMBLY
I J'V~(15~mm)
6IN 0.381N. 5.371N. 71N. 00M )_ _(136 mm)__1 - 125 IN. (178 mm) 1.00 IN. - (32 mm)
(25 mm) _
O .1 G
Is . 1 15.00 IN. s o . 18.5 IN. (381 mm)
(470 mm)
S 000787 • •
—0 0 . 2.50 IN.I
(64 mm)
0.62 IN. 5.75 IN. ___.j. _0.63 IN.
(16 mm) (146 mm) 009478 (16 mm)
FIGURE 5-2 S
5
MOUNTING HOLE DIMENSIONS
65/16 IN. I (160 mm) 1313/16 IN.
LOCATION OF (351 mm)
I .5
GROMMETS
97/16 IN 197/161N. -- 1 5 (494 mm)
L T
(494 mm)
O 4- 0.28 IN. (7 mm) S 5/16 IN. HOLE (TYP) (8 mm)
FIGURE 5-3
000788
S •
Do not install cartridge at this time. Failure to comply may
result in accidental system actuation.
2. Mount each tank-enclosure or tank-bracket assembly by
completing the following steps:
Select a rigid, vertical surface for mounting the enclosure
or bracket. (Keep in mind that the 3 gallon tank is taller
than the bracket. (See Figure 5-4) Allow sufficient space S for convenient piping and removal).
Remove tank from enclosure or bracket, and secure
enclosure or bracket to the mounting location using the S four mounting holes. Use appropriate type of fasteners
depending on the mounting surface.
R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
MOUNTING THE COMPONENTS (Continued)
3. Fill each agent tank by completing the following steps:
a. Remove tank adaptor/tube assembly from tank fill
opening. Visually inspect tank adaptor to determine
bursting disc is in place and that silver side is away from
tank. See Figure 5-5.
FIGURE 5-5
000291
10
Safety glasses should be worn during transfer opera-
tions of ANSULEX Low pH Liquid Fire Suppressant.
Avoid contact with skin or eyes. In case of contact,
flush immediately with water for 15 minutes. If irritation
persists, contact a physician. Do not take internally.
If taken internally do not induce vomiting. Dilute with
water or milk and contact a physician immediately.
Place plastic funnel in fill opening and fill tank with 1.5
(5.8 L) or 3.0 (11.6 L) gallons of only ANSULEX Low
PH Liquid Fire Suppressant. See Figure 5-6 for detailed
filling tolerances. Note: Use a funnel with a screen to
stop any foreign material from entering the tank. See
Figure 5-6.
During filling, the agent temperature should be 60 OF
to 80 OF (16 °C to 27 °C). DO NOT FILL WITH COLD
AGENT. DO NOT OVERFILL. Overfilling may result
in agent entering gas hoses and regulator potentially
causing system malfunction.
SECTION 5— INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 5-3
STAINLESS STEEL TANKS
2 1/4 IN. ± 1/8 IN. (57 mm ±3 mm)
s-
FROM THE TOP OF THE COLLAR
FOR THE 3.0 GALLON TANK
OR
1 3/4 IN. ± 1/8 IN. (45 mm ± 3mm)
FROM THE TOP OF THE COLLAR
FOR THE 1.5 GALLON TANK
0002m
FIGURE 5-6
c. Reinstall adaptor/tube assembly to tank by tightening
until metal to metal contact is achieved between bottom
of adaptor and tank collar.
4. Place each tank into its enclosure or bracket.
SECTION 5 - INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS
UL EX3470 U LC EX3470
PAGE 5-4 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
INSTALLING THE DISTRIBUTION PIPING
Before the following procedures can be completed, the piping
design must already be determined; and the actuation and
expellant gas lines from the regulated release, each regulated
actuator, and each tank-enclosure or tank-bracket assembly
should already be installed.
These installation instructions are identical for single, double,
and multiple-tank systems except for the quantity of tanks and
hazard areas to be covered.
General Piping Requirements
Use Schedule 40 black iron, chrome-plated, or stainless
steel pipe and fittings.
NOTICE
Do not use hot-dipped galvanized iron
pipe or fittings in the agent distribution
piping.
Before assembling the pipe and fittings, make certain all
ends are carefully reamed and blown clear of chips and
scale. Inside of pipe and fittings must be free of oil and dirt.
The distribution piping and fitting connections, located in or
above the hood or the protected area, must be sealed with
pipe tape. When applying pipe tape, start at the second
male thread and wrap the tape (two turns maximum) clock-
wise around the threads, away from the pipe opening.
NOTICE
Do not allow tape to overlap the pipe
opening as the pipe and nozzles could
become plugged.
Thread sealant or compound must not be
used as it could plug the nozzles.
Distribution piping may be run independently or two agent
tanks may be manifolded together and run to the prede-
termined hazard area. Only agent tanks expelled from the
same cartridge may be manifolded.
NOTICE
Closely follow the piping requirements
for each size system, as detailed in the
"System Design" section, when installing
distribution piping.
Branchline tees can be used to create more than one
branch and can be installed as a thru tee, side outlet tee or
bull tee.
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
Pipe Hanger Recommended Guidelines
Space hangers as follows:
Maximum Recommended
Pipe Size Distance Between Hangers
3/8 in. 5ft(1.5m)
Hangers should be placed between elbows when the
distance is greater than 2 ft (0.6 m).
Piping Installation
Starting at the tank, pipe directly from the union located on
the tank adaptor. A reducing fitting may be necessary to
conform to the distribution piping.
Based on the piping sketch developed in the "System
Design" section of this manual, install the supply line and
position the tees at points where branch lines must be
installed. See Figure 5-7.
Run all branch lines to the hazard area and connect each
nozzle. (Make certain all piping is securely bracketed.)
JL-----------1
FIGURE 5-7
000302
Make certain all threaded connections are properly tight-
ened. Threaded connections located in the protected
area(s) and above the hood must be sealed with Teflon
pipe tape, as a minimum. Apply pipe tape to male threads
only. Make certain tape does not extend over the end of the
thread, as this could cause possible blockage of the agent
distribution.
Pipe tape minimizes friction between bearing surfaces of
the threads when threading pipe to fittings. The resulting
heat may expand the pipe threads before the joint is prop-
erly made. When the pipe threads cool and contract in
the fitting, the joint may become loosened causing cooking
grease to migrate into the distribution piping, and/or leakage
at the fitting during a pressure test or agent discharge.
Note: When required to provide pressure testing of pipe
or a system discharge test, it is recommended that all pipe
connections utilize Teflon pipe tape.
Install the correct nozzle(s) for each hazard area as previ-
ously designed. Some nozzles are required to be properly
oriented before they are positioned for aiming.
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual SECTION 5— INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 5-5
INSTALLING THE DISTRIBUTION PIPING (Continued)
Piping Installation (Continued)
Aim the nozzles to a pre-determined aim point in accor-
dance with the instructions in the "System Design" section.
Using the Nozzle Aiming Device will aid in the aiming
process. The device clamps to the nozzle and emits a small
laser light that reflects on the surface where it is aiming. If
the nozzle is used with a Swivel Adapter, the nozzle with the
Aiming Device can be rotated to the exact aiming point and
then tightened to hold that angle.
Before installing blow-off caps on nozzles, apply a small
amount of Dow Corning No. 111 silicone grease across the
opening in the nozzle tip. Also apply a small amount to coat
the exterior of the blow-off cap. DO NOT FORCE SILICONE
GREASE INTO NOZZLE TIP OPENING OR FILL CAP
WITH GREASE.
NOTICE
When using old style metal blow-off cap
with spring clips, make certain the spring
clip rotates freely on the metal cap and
coat the outside of the cap, including the
clip, with Dow Corning No. 111 silicone
grease.
Make certain a blow-off cap is in place over each nozzle
tip. These blow-off caps are designed to keep grease from
building-up on the nozzle orifice and inhibiting the agent
flow. See Figure 5-8.
000303 000304 000306
FIGURE 5-8
INSTALLING THE AGENT DISTRIBUTION HOSE
(FOR CASTERED/MOVEABLE EQUIPMENT)
Agent Distribution Hose can be used in the supply line or appli-
ance branch line to allow a castered cooking appliance with
castered supports with nozzles attached directly to the appliance,
to be moved out of its normal operating position for service or
cleaning.
The following instructions must be followed in their entirety.
Failure to do so may result in the R-102 Fire Suppression
System not functioning properly due to incorrect installation.
CRITICAL INSTALLATION REQUIREMENTS
Design and installation must be performed by qualified
personnel. -
The Agent Distribution Hose shall not be concealed within
or run through any wall, floor, or partition, and shall not have
any direct exposure to excessive heat or radiant flame from
the cooking appliances.
Strong cleaning solutions or chemical substances must not
come in contact with the Agent Distribution Hose. These
may include acids, solvents, fluxes with zinc chloride, or
other chlorinated chemicals. In case of contact, rinse down
the Agent Distribution Hose with water and dry thoroughly.
Contact with foreign objects, sharp edges, wiring, or
substances must be avoided.
Bending and flexing of Agent Distribution Hose on move-
able appliances (i.e. those factory equipped with casters)
should be limited to pulling and pushing the appliances in
or out for cleaning or maintenance. The hose shall never
be installed or bent tighter than a 3 in. (76 mm) radius (6 in.
(152 mm) diameter) loop.
The Agent Distribution Hose must not be kinked, twisted,
or have sharp bends when installed or when equipment is
pulled away from the wall.
Make sure that all fittings are tightened properly.
Adequate means must be provided to limit the movement
of castered appliances. A 36 in. (914 mm) long Restraining
Cable supplied with the agent distribution hose is required
to be used for all castered appliances using the Agent
Distribution Hose. (Refer to Restraining Cable Installation
Instructions.)
The Restraining Cable requires periodic maintenance to
ensure proper operation.
The Restraining Cable must be attached to the wall and
appliance anytime the distribution hose is connected to the
appliance.
Do not over-extend the Agent Distribution Hose when
moving equipment (for cleaning, maintenance, etc.).
AGENT DISTRIBUTION HOSE INSTALLATION
INSTRUCTIONS
Before proceeding, CAREFULLY read all instructions, including
all CRITICAL INSTALLATION REQUIREMENTS.
General Requirements
The Agent Distribution Hose (which is part of the Discharge
Hose and Restraining Cable Kit), is 0.5 in. (13 mm) diameter
x 60 in. (1524 mm) long and is provided with two male NPT
swivels for ease of installation.
Maximum of six Agent Distribution Hoses can be used in
each agent distribution piping network.
Agent Distribution Hose can only be used for castered appli-
ances or appliances setting on castered supports.
TETHER I
6-8 IN (152-203 mm) OFFSET
CENTER TO CENTER PIPE (SUPPLIED ONLY WITH
HENNY PENNY FRYER NOZZLE KIT
(PART NO. 434455))
FIGURE 5-9
007828
SECTION 5 - INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 5-6 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
AGENT DISTRIBUTION HOSE INSTALLATION
INSTRUCTIONS (Continued)
General Requirements (Continued)
S 4. Maximum of two Agent Distribution Hoses are allowed in the
supply line. However, the Agent Distribution Hose can only
be used at the castered appliance.
5. Maximum of two Agent Distribution Hoses are allowed in
the branch line. An acceptable installation scenario would
be providing separate protection of two (side-by-side) appli-
ances, each with its own Agent Distribution Hose and tether,
supplied from the same appliance branch.
6. The Agent Distribution Hose is to only be used in the distri-
bution piping of a single 1 1/2 or 3 gal (5.7 or 11.4 L) tank or
two manifolded 3 gal (11.4 L) R-1 02 extinguishing systems . or larger systems using combinations thereof. However, the
Agent Distribution Hose is never to be used to manifold two
3 gal (11.4L) tanks.
S Installation Requirements
1. Agent Distribution Hose must be connected to 3/8 in. NPT
S black iron, chrome-plated, or stainless steel fittings. The
connection from hose to fitting requires a 1/2 in. x 3/8 in.
reducing coupling (Part No. 436228). All Agent Distribution
Hose connections must be sealed with pipe tape. When
applying pipe tape, start at the second male thread on
the swivel ends of the hose. Wrap the tape (two turns
maximum) clockwise around the threads, away from the
hose end fitting opening.
2. All connections of distribution piping to Agent Distribution
Hose for castered appliances, with distribution nozzles
installed/affixed to the appliance, must be located behind
S the cooking equipment in an area protected from obstruc-
tions and possible wear or damage.
I 3. 3/8 in. schedule 40 pipe will need to be run from the hose
S connection to the distribution nozzle(s) installed/affixed
to the appliance. Pipe must be installed and adequately
secured at a height at or below the cooking surface of the
S appliance. (See Figure 5-14.)
4. All existing distribution pipe and fitting limitations must be
observed and followed. Each flex distribution hose used
S is to be considered as an equivalent length of 3/8 in. pipe
when calculating the acceptable length of allowable distribu-
tion pipe. Each hose is 5 ft (1.5 m) long.
S 5. All hose-to-pipe connection fittings are to be oriented in a
vertical down position.
S 6. The hose connections must be positioned below an eleva-
tion where the hose could be exposed to the radiant or
convected heat generated by normal cooking operations
(such as the horizontal plane of appliance's cooking
S surface), or to heat from appliance exhaust. As a minimum
height, the hose connection shall be no lower than 30 in.
(762 mm) from the floor. The distribution piping shall be . supported and secured per local plumbing practices.
7. Hose ends are to be offset 6 to 8 in. (152 to 203 mm) center
to center of fittings (See Figure 5-9) to maximize hose life
expectancy and facilitate appliance movement. With the
R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
appliance in its normal operating position, check the hose
bend to make certain the bend is not less than a 3 in.
(76 mm) bend radius (6 in. (152 mm) diameter).
OVERHEAD VIEW
P PIPE (NOT
I APPLIANCE W
SUPPLIED IN KIT)
FLEX I
HOSE I
Restraining Cable Installation
Important: A Restraining Cable shall always be permanently
attached to the appliance and wall directly behind the appliance
when the Agent Distribution Hose is installed. Removal of this
cable shall only occur when the Agent Distribution Hose is not
installed to the appliance.
See Figure 5-10 for mounting the Restraining Cable to the wall.
See Figure 5-11 for mounting the Restraining Cable to the back
of an appliance.
RESTRAINING CABLE - WALL-MOUNTED OPTION
11 SHEET METAL
WALL —0.-I I COVERED
-
STUD WALLS
WALL
MOUNT
BRACKET SCREW
EYE BOLT 0
4 SELF TAPPING
SHEET METAL
SCREWS
FIGURE 5-10
008008
RESTRAINING CABLE - APPLIANCE-MOUNTED OPTION
BACK OF
APPLIANCE
NUT NYLON
EYE LOCKNUT
BOLT-
WASH ER
WASHER
FIGURE 5-11
008089
R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual SECTION 5— INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 5-7
BACK OF--o-
APPLIANCE
PHILIPS
SCREW
EYE
NUT WASHER
FIGURE 5-12
008097
The Restraining Cable must be connected from the appli-
ance to the wall or some other structurally sound object
capable of restraining the castered appliance from being
able to be pulled or pushed out to a point that will result in
strain or stress to the Agent Distribution Hose.
The Restraining Cable should be installed in line with the
Agent Distribution Hose.
For sheet metal covered walls, the Restraining Cable
Assembly includes four 3/4 in. x #8 self tapping sheet
metal screws, and a Restraining Cable Bracket. Securely
attach the Restraining Cable Bracket to the sheet metal
covered wall using the 3/4 in. x #8 self tapping metal screws
provided.
For mounting to wall studs, the Restraining Cable Assembly
includes one screw eye lag bolt, 5/16 in. x 2.5 in. (64 mm) long.
Locate a structural area (frame) on the rear side of the
equipment that is in line with the wall attachment. Note: It
may be necessary to contact the appliance manufacturer for
a suitable location. Drill a 5/16 in. (7.9 mm) diameter hole.
Use caution when drilling hole, so that internal components
are not damaged.
The Restraining Cable Assembly also includes a 5/16 in.
threaded eye-bolt, 5/16 in. hex head nut, 5/16 in nylon lock
nut, and two 5/16 in. flat washers. Thread the included hex
nut onto the eye-bolt. Slide one washer onto the eye-bolt
threads next to the nut. Then, slide the eye-bolt through
the drilled hole and place a washer and nylon locknut onto
the eye-bolt on the inside frame of the equipment. Tighten
securely.
Attach one of the snap hooks (included in the Restraining
Cable package) on the end of the Restraining Cable to the
wall bracket and the other snap hook to the eye-bolt (See
Figure 5-13). After snap-hooking the assembly, seal the
Restraining Cable Loops to the wall bracketry and appliance
connection hardware with Lead Wire Seal (Part No. 197).
Note: For the Henny Penny Pressure Fryers that utilize the
ANSUL Henny Penny Fryer Nozzle Kit, Part No. 434455,
the 5/16 in. philips screw supplied in the Henny Penny
Fryer Nozzle Kit, the 5/16 in. eye nut, and 5/16 in. washer
included in the Restraining Cable Assembly Kit, must be
used. (See Figure 5-12).
RESTRAINING CABLE
INSTALLATION PACKAGE
A - RESTRAINING CABLE
Aga
B-STAPLE F-5/16 IN NYLON
BRACKET LOCK NUT
TM G-5/161N 0f) X5/161N
C-314 IN. X#8 WASHERS
SCREWS (4) (2)
H - SCREW
EYE BOLT
D - EYE BOLT
I - SNAP
HOOK
E - 5/16 IN HEX NUT
A- RESTRAINING-
, CABLE I - SNAP HOOK
D - EYE BOLT
VJ
EYE BOLT FASTENING-ø-
HARDWARE
FIGURE 5-13
007829
Final Installation Guidelines and Checkout Procedures
After the Agent Distribution Hose and the Restraining Cable is
properly installed, carefully push the appliance back to its normal
operating position. Check that the hose does not have sharp
bends, and is not kinked, twisted, or caught on anything behind
the appliance.
Verify the Restraining Cable limits the travel of the appli-
ance and prevents the application of any pull force or
bending stress on the Agent Distribution Hose or hose-to-
pipe connections.
Make certain there are no sharp bends and kinks in the
hose when pulling out the cooking equipment.
The Agent Distribution Hose should always be in a vertical
natural loop, never having any bends greater than a 3 in.
(76 mm) radius (6 in. (152 mm) diameter), hose twists, or
sharp bends. (See Figure 5-14.) If any of these conditions
exist, the hose and/or hose connections will require installa-
tion modifications.
AGENT DISTRIBUTION HOSE INSTALLATION
INSTRUCTIONS (Continued)
Restraining Cable Installation (Continued)
RESTRAINING CABLE - HENNY PENNY-MOUNTED OPTION
B - STAPLE BRACKET
I - SNAP
HOOK
SECTION 5— INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 5-8 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
AGENT DISTRIBUTION HOSE INSTALLATION
INSTRUCTIONS (Continued)
Final Installation Guidelines and Checkout Procedures
(Continued)
SIDE VIEW
ACCEPTABLE HOSE ORIENTATION
AGENT
DISTRIBUTION
3/8 IN
PIPING
HEIGHT
OF HOSE
CONNECTION'S P MAXIMUM
TO BE BELOW 30 IN THE APPLIANCE (762 COOKING MM) SURFACE
UNACCEPTABLE HOSE ORIENTATION
SHARP BENDS TWISTING FATIGUE
6 V
- 6
FIGURE 5-14
007830
4. Return the appliance to its normal operating position in
accordance with NFPA 96. Means shall be provided to
verify that the appliance returns to its original designed
positioning. Failure to do so may result in undue stress and
fatigue of the hose and hose connections.
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
INSTALLING THE ACTUATION AND EXPELLANT GAS LINE
Before installing any actuation or expellant gas line, the design
must be determined; and the regulated release assembly, each
regulated actuator assembly and each tank-bracket assembly
should be securely mounted.
General Piping Requirements
Use only 1/4 in. Schedule 40 black iron, hot-dipped galva-
nized, chrome-plated, or stainless steel pipe and fittings.
Before assembling the pipe and fittings, make certain all
ends are carefully reamed and blown clear of chips and
scale. Inside of pipe and fittings must be free of oil and dirt.
The piping and fitting connections must be sealed with pipe
tape. When applying pipe tape, start at the second male
thread and wrap the tape (two turns maximum) clockwise
around the threads, away from the pipe opening.
NOTICE
Do not allow tape to overlap the pipe
opening, as this could cause possible
blockage of the gas pressure.
Thread sealant or compound must not
be used.
When connecting actuation or expellant gas line piping,
install a 1/4 in. union near the tank inlet for easy disassem-
bly later.
Note: Expellant gas line cannot use stainless steel braided
hose.
Actuation Gas Line
Install actuation gas line from the regulated release mechanism
high pressure side outlet (side opposite regulated outlet) through
the appropriate knockout in the enclosure by completing the
following steps:
Remove the 1/8 in. plug from high pressure side outlet.
Install the appropriate fitting for additional equipment attach-
ment as required. A 1/4 x 1/8 in. reducing fitting is required
to connect the 1/4 in. actuation line. See Figure 5-15.
Run piping or hose up through the regulated release assem-
bly enclosure knockout to the inlet on top of each regulated
actuator assembly used within the system.
R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
INSTALLING THE ACTUATION AND EXPELLANT GAS LINE
(Continued)
Actuation Gas Line (Continued)
3. The total combined length of the actuation gas line from the
regulated release assembly to all regulated actuator assem-
blies must not exceed 20 ft (6 m) when using an LT-20-R
nitrogen cartridge, an LT-30-R nitrogen cartridge, a 101-10
002 cartridge, or a 101-20 002 cartridge. See Figure 5-16.
Note: When using stainless steel actuation line, a maximum
of 17.5 ft (5.3 m) of hose may be used.
SECTION 5— INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 5-9
If an expellant gas line is connected to the regulated
release assembly along with an actuation gas line, the total
combined length of the actuation and expellant gas line
must not exceed 30 ft (9.1 m). See Figure 5-17.
A combined total of nine fittings may be used in these lines,
eight 900 elbows and one tee. Two 450 elbows equal one
90° elbow.
Typical Arrangements for a One Device Connection to Cartridge Receiver
000293
Typical Arrangements for a Two Device Connection to Cartridge Receiver
Typical Arrangements for a Three Device Connection to Cartridge Receiver
000295
Typical Arrangements for Regulator Connections
TO TANK IN TO REGULATED ACTUATOR
BRACKET OR /' ASSEMBLY(IES)
ENCLOSURE
(PIPE OR HOSE)
0002%
TO TANK IN REGULATED
RELEASE ASSEMBLY
SINGLE TANK DOUBLE AND MULTIPLE TANKS
NOTE: WHEN PIPE IS USED, ALL PIPE AND FITTINGS SHALL BE SCHEDULE 40 (STANDARD WEIGHT) BLACK
IRON, HOT-TIPPED GALVANIZED, CHROME-PLATED, OR STAINLESS STEEL.
FIGURE 5-15
SECTION 5— INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 5-10 REV. ii 2014-SEP-01
INSTALLING THE ACTUATION AND EXPELLANT GAS
LINE (Continued)
P.
Actuation Gas Line (Continued)
ACTUATION GAS LINE WITH AN LT-20-R,
LT-30-R, 101-20 OR 101-30 CARTRIDGE
MAXIMUM LENGTH -20 FT (6.0 m)o-.
MAXIMUM NO. OF FITTINGS -9
REGULATED ACTUATOR
ASSEMBLY EXPELLANT GAS LINES
NOT INCLUDED IN ACTUATION GAS
LINE LENGTH TOTALS
REGULATED ACTUATOR
ASSEMBLY
REGULATED ACTUATOR
ASSEMBLY
AUTOMAN REGULATED
RELEASE ASSEMBLY
FIGURE 5-16
000775
ACTUATION AND EXPELLANT GAS LINES WITH
A"DOUBLE-TANK'OR 101-30 CARTRIDGE
MAXIMUM COMBINED LENGTH -30 FT (9.1 m),
MAXIMUM COMBINED FITTINGS -9
ASSEMBLY
ACTUATOR
SSEMBLY EXPELLANT
GAS LINES NOT INCLUDED
IN COMBINED TOTALS REGULATED ACTUATOR
ASSEMBLY
REGULATED ACTUATOR
ASSEMBLY
REGULATED RELEASE
ASSEMBLY
AUTOMAN REGULATED
RELEASE ASSEMBLY
FIGURE 5-17
0002%
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
INSTALLING THE ACTUATION AND EXPELLENT GAS LINE
(Continued)
Expellant Gas Line From The Regulated Release Assembly
Install expellant gas line from the regulated release assembly
regulator in the enclosure by completing the following steps:
The regulated release assembly is shipped with a facto-
ry-installed regulator. The regulator has two 1/4 in. outlets,
one at the back and one at the bottom. The bottom outlet
connects the expellant gas hose to the agent tank which
is mounted inside the enclosure. The back outlet is sealed
with a 1/4 in. plug.
Connect expellant gas hose to the agent tank mounted
inside the enclosure.
TWO TANK, THREE TANK, AND MULTIPLE TANK
SYSTEMS:
If the expellant gas piping is required because an additional
tank-enclosure or tank-bracket assembly is being installed,
the plug installed in the back outlet must be removed. (See
Figure 5-6 for proper connections to the regulator.)
Pipe the 1/4 in. expellant gas line from the regulator back
outlet through one of the knockouts provided in the enclo-
sure.
The total length of the expellant gas line from the regulated
release assembly must not exceed 30 ft (9.1 m) when
using a "double-tank" nitrogen cartridge or a 101-30 CO2
cartridge. See Figure 5-18.
FIGURE 5-18
000776
SECTION 5— INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 5-11
If an actuation gas line is connected to the regulated
release assembly along with an expellant gas line, the total
combined length of the gas lines must not exceed 30 ft
(9.1 m) when using a "double-tank" nitrogen cartridge or a
101-30 CO2 cartridge. See Figure 5-17.
A combined total of nine fittings may be used in these lines,
eight 900 elbows and one tee. Two 450 elbows equal one
90° elbow.
Expellant Gas Line From The Regulated Actuator
Assembly
Install expellant gas piping from the regulated actuator assembly
regulator through the appropriate knockout in the enclosure by
completing the following steps:
The regulated actuator is shipped with a factory-installed
regulator. The regulator has two 1/4 in. outlets 135° from
each other. One outlet is sealed by a 1/4 in. plug and the
other contains the expellant gas hose for the agent tank
which will be mounted within the enclosure. Connect expel-
lant gas hose to the agent tank that is mounted inside the
enclosure.
Remove the 1/4 in. pipe plug from the regulator side outlet
and pipe the 1/4 in. expellant gas line from the regula-
tor through the knockout provided in the enclosure to a
tank-enclosure or tank-bracket assembly. A maximum of
one tank-enclosure or tank-bracket assembly is allowed per
regulated actuator assembly.
The maximum length of the expellant gas line from the
regulated actuator to the tank-bracket assembly must not
exceed 30 ft (9.1 m). See Figure 5-19.
A total of nine fittings may be used in these lines, eight 900
elbows and one tee. Two 45° elbows equal one 900 elbow.
EXPELLANT GAS LINE
MAXIMUM LENGTH -30 FT (9.1
MAXIMUM NO. OF FITTINGS -9
EXPELLANT GA
MAXIMUM LEN(
MAXIMUM NO. I
REGULATED
ACTUATOR
ASSEMBLY
FIGURE 5-19
000777
SECTION 5 - INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 5-12 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
INSTALLING THE ACTUATION AND EXPELLENT GAS
LINE (Continued)
Actuation Gas Line From Remote Release(s) to Regulated
Actuators
Install actuation gas piping from the remote release(s) to the
regulated actuators by completing the following:
Pipe the 1/4 in. actuation gas line from the 1/4 in. outlet in
the remote release receiver, through the knockout provided
in the top of the release enclosure, to each regulated actu-
ator assembly.
The maximum length of the actuation gas line from the
remote release to all regulated actuators must not exceed
100 ft (30.4). See Figure 5-20.
A maximum of nine tees and twenty elbows are allowed in
the actuation piping. Two 450 elbows equal one 900 elbow.
See Figure 5-20.
3.A safety relief valve (Part No. 15677) must be installed in
the actuation piping. See Figure 5-20.
SAFETY RELIEF
VALVE
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
Actuation Gas Line - 15* Tanks Maximum - Using 1/4 in.
Stainless Steel Hose
Note: Not for use with expellent gas line.
Maximum hose length cannot exceed 17.5 ft (5.3 m). See
Figure 5-21.
Maximum of five regulated actuators allowed.
Actuated with Remote Release (Part No. 433485) or
Regulated Release Assembly (Part No. 429853).
9 TEES 20 ELBOWS MAXIMUM MAYIMI IM
1/4 IN. ACTUATION LINE -100 FT (30.4 m) MAXIMUM
I CHECK
EXPELLANT II VALVE
G
EXPELLA
AS LINE
I U A
LII
r
I1J2Lflh] 1 III r I r I
II I I
I
1=t
IL4 I Ii
II I
EP 11
IEL
I I
I
L
I Iii I il
H
__ ________________________________
_
REMOTE RELEASE
MECHANISMS
REGULATED
ACTUATOR AGENT TANK AND BRACKET OR (5 MAXIMUM)
WITH TANK (TYP.) AGENT TANK IN ENCLOSURE (TYP.)
FIGURE 5-20
000301
1/4 IN. STAINLESS STEEL HOSE OPTIONS
SAFETY 421N * 2IN. (1066 mm)
'.4— MAX. HOSE 1/4 IN. STAINLESS
RELIEF VALVE I LENGTH (TYP.) STEEL HOSE CHECK VALVE
iii I I iI rviI
II
I
liii I Iii
-
.
MAXIMUM OF
... 5 REMOTE IiI I I
I I I
RELEASE
MECHANISMS
I I I II II (PART NO. I I I I 433485) OR I I
I I I I I I I I I I '- ONE
I I I I I I I
. I I I I I REGULATED
RELEASE (PART
REGULATED ACTUATOR NO. 429853)
WITH TANK MAXIMUM OF 5
REGULATED ACTUATORS
NOTE: WHEN MULTIPLE RELEASE ASSEMBLIES ARE UTILIZED, A 1/4 IN. CHECK VALVE (PART NO. 25627)
WILL BE REQUIRED AFTER EACH REGULATED RELEASE.
NOTE: '.15 TANKS MAXIMUM REFLECTS THE UTILIZATION OF THREE TANK REGULATED ACTUATORS. FIGURE 5-21
000301
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual SECTION 5— INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 5-13
INSTALLING THE DETECTION SYSTEM
Before the following procedure's can be completed, the detection
design must already be completed. These installation instruc-
tions are identical for single, double, and multiple-tank systems
except for the number of hazard areas to be covered.
NOTICE
Inform customer that fusible links should
not be exposed to ammonia-based chemical
cleaners or steam.
NOTICE
No attempt is to be made to disassemble,
repair, or clean a Model SL or Model A-PC
fusible link. The complete assembly must
be replaced if there is any sign of potential
malfunction.
Based on the requirements listed in the "System Design"
section, mount the detectors in their predetermined loca-
tions.
2. Run 1/2 in. conduit from the regulated release mechanism
trip hammer assembly knockout hole to locations selected
for mounting the detectors.
Note: Before assembling the conduit and fittings, make
certain all ends are carefully reamed and blown clear of
chips and scale. Inside of pipe and fittings must be free of
oil and dirt.
When changing the direction of conduit, use only ANSUL
pulley elbows, except, at the top of the regulated release, it
is acceptable to use the Conduit Offset Assembly.
Note: If stainless steel scissor linkage is used in the system
while using conduit offset assembly, the following limitations
must be observed:
Maximum number of elbows - 16
Maximum number of detectors - 15
Maximum length of 1/2 in. EMT Conduit - 150 ft (45.7 m)
Part No. 435546 and 435547 are the "scissor" style series
and terminal detector assemblies. These detector assem-
blies use a detector linkage assembly which does not
require the wire rope to be threaded through the linkage
assembly while it is being fed through the detection system.
"Scissor" Style Linkage Installation
Secure the conduit to the detector bracket using the two
1/2 in. steel compression fittings on the series detector
bracket or the single 1/2 in. steel compression fitting on the
terminal detector bracket. See Figure 5-22.
COMPRESSION
FITTING NUT
1/2 IN. STEEL /
COMPRESSION FITTING
FIGURE 5-22
000306
NOTICE
Do not use zinc die cast compression connec-
tors on the detection conduit lines as these
will not withstand the normally high tempera-
tures experienced in the plenum area.
For a terminal detector located in a duct or header opening,
secure both sides of the detector bracket with conduit, as
shown in Figure 5-23.
002463
002464
FIGURE 5-23
FIGURE 5-26
000311
SECTION 5— INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 5-14 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
INSTALLING THE DETECTION SYSTEM (Continued)
"Scissor" Style Linkage Installation (Continued)
3. Starting at the release assembly, feed the wire rope through
the hole in the release mechanism locking clamp, allowing
the excess wire rope to hang down. (Do not tighten set
screws in locking clamp at this time.) See Figure 5-24.
2-3 IN.
(51-76
LOCKING
CLAMP
-
FIGURE 5-27
FIGURE 5-24 000312
4. From the release assembly, run the stainless steel wire rope
through the conduit, pulley elbows and detector brackets to
the terminal detector.
NOTICE
If wire rope requires splicing, make certain
splice is at least 12 in. (305 mm) away from
any pulley elbow or conduit adaptor to avoid
interference.
Feed the wire rope through the terminal detector bracket as
shown in Figure 5-25 or as shown in Figure 5-26 if the termi-
nal detector is mounted within a duct or header opening,
and install the stop sleeve approximately 2 to 3 in. (51 to 76
mm) from the end of the wire rope. See Figure 5-27. Use
the National Telephone Supply Company Nicopress Sleeve
Tool (Stock No. 51-C-887) or equal to properly crimp the
stop sleeve.
FIGURE 5-25
000310
6. To give a constant tension on the wire rope during instal-
lation of the detector linkage, hang a vice grip or other
weighted device on the excess stainless steel wire rope,
leaving an adequate length of spare wire rope between the
locking clamp and the weighted device.
NOTICE
When attaching the weighted device to the
excess wire rope, allow approximately 3 in.
(76 mm) of wire rope for each detector linkage
for proper installation.
Example: If the system has six detectors, there should be
approximately 18 in. (457 mm) of excess wire rope between
the locking clamp and the weighted device, which will be
utilized when the linkage is put in place.
Install detector scissor assembly as shown in Figure
5-28. Note that the AUTOMAN release or remote release
assembly is located on the left side of the detector bracket.
Slightly crimp the two assembly "boot-hooks" over the
cable with pliers so the cable is captured under each hook
but the whole assembly can move from side to side. Center
the assembly in the detector bracket.
AUTOMAN RELEASE OR OlD REMOTE RELEASE ASSEMBLY
FIGURE 5-28
000503
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
INSTALLING THE DETECTION SYSTEM (Continued)
"Scissor" Style Linkage Installation (Continued)
Hook the fusible link on the AUTOMAN release or remote
release assembly side of the hook assembly, then pull the
fusible link to the opposite side and complete the hookup
as shown in Figures 5-29 and 5-30. The top of the hook
assembly must be inside the bracket stiffeners. The hook
assembly with the ANSUL fusible link in place must be
located toward the terminal detector side of the bracket.
FIGURE 5-29
000554
FIGURE 5-30
000324
Install the linkage and the correct ANSUL approved fusible
link in the remainder of the detector brackets. Make certain
all detector linkages are positioned against either the front
or back upper lip of the formed detector bracket. See Figure
5-31.
FIGURE 5-31
004429
SECTION 5— INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 5-15
Insert cocking lever (Part No. 441042 or Part No. 441041)
on left side of the release mechanism, with the movable
flange resting securely against the corner of the cartridge
receiver and spring housing, and with the notched lever
portion engaging the cocking pin on both sides of the
release mechanism. See Figure 5-32.
co(
)CKING PIN
FIGURE 5-32
:pii
11;Using long handle cocking lever (Part No. 441041) or
wrench on short handle cocking lever (Part No. 441042),
pull down to raise cocking pin until the trip lever indented
surface moves underneath the pin and locks the pin in the
up position. See Figure 5-33.
FIGURE 5-33
000320
SECTION 5— INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 5-16 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
INSTALLING THE DETECTION SYSTEM (Continued)
"Scissor" Style Linkage Installation (Continued)
Remove cocking lever and fully insert Lock Pin (Part No.
438031) through the hole in the trip lever on the left side of
the release. (The release mechanism cannot be actuated,
nor can enclosure cover be replaced until the lock pin is
removed.) See Figure 5-34.
(PIN
DERLY
ALLIED
FIGURE 5-34
009462
Make certain tension lever is in the "UP" position. See
Figure 5-35.
R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
Raise trip hammer 3/8 in. to 1/2 in. (9.5 to 12.7 mm), pull
all slack out of wire rope, and tighten set screws on locking
clamp.
Lower tension lever to "DOWN" position and inspect the base
of the wire rope locking clamp to make certain that there is
a minimum of 1/4 in. (6.4 mm) and a maximum of 3/8 in.
(9.5 mm) clearance between the base of the trip hammer
locking clamp assembly and the cable lever assembly. See
Figure 5-36. (If clearance is not between 1/4 in. (6.4 mm) or
3/8 in. (9.5 mm), raise tension lever, loosen set screws on
locking clamp and repeat Steps 15 and 16.)
Make certain the hook assembly with the ANSUL fusible
link in place is located toward the terminal detector side of
each bracket. Failure to do so may restrict travel of detec-
tion line, causing system to malfunction.
LOCKING
CLAMP
1/4 IN. MINIMUM
(6.4 mm)
3/8 in. MAXIMUM
(9.5 mm)
CABLE
LEVER
ASSEMBLY
FIGURE 5-35
O322
14. Verify each detector linkage assembly, with correct fusible
link, is in the detector bracket, located fully toward the termi-
nal detector side.
NOTICE
Due to the close adjustment between the trip
hammer and cable lever assemblies, use only
the particular fusible link(s) selected for instal-
lation in each detector, including terminal
detector, to ensure correct adjustment when
performing Steps 15 and 16.
FIGURE 5-36
000323
Do not install cartridge at this time as an accidental actu-
ation could cause system discharge.
Test detection system in accordance with the Testing and
Placing in Service Section, Page 6-3 - 6-4, of this manual.
When testing has been completed, cut off excess wire rope
in the regulated release assembly, leaving approximately
2 in. (51 mm) of wire rope below the locking clamp.
SE
ANISM
JUNCTION BOX
(SUPPLIED BY OTHERS)
FIGURE 5-37
009463
REMOTE MANUAL PULL STATION DUAL APPLICATION - OPTION 1
(ONE WIRE ROPE CONNECTED TO CABLE LEVER ASSEMBLY)
6 IN. (153 mm) MINIMUM
FROM CRIMP SLEEVE
TO PULLEY TEE
2 IN. (51 mm) MINIMUM
FROM CRIMP SLEEVE
TO COMPRESSION
FITTING
PULLEY
11 PULLEY TEE
NO PULLEY ELBOWS
ALLOWED WHERE TWO WIRE
PRESENT ROPES ARE
USE TWO
ELBOW
j141596~)T
VAL SLEEVES
A NO.
RELEASE
MECHANISM
I M ilil.. 11 :1
JUNCTION BOX REMOTE
(SUPPLIED BY OTHERS)) MANUAL PULL STATION
FIGURE 5-38
009494
REMOTE MANUAL PULL STATION DUAL APPLICATION - OPTION 2
(TWO WIRE ROPES CONNECTED TO CABLE LEVER ASSEMBLY)
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual SECTION 5— INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 5-17
INSTALLING REMOTE MANUAL PULL STATION
REMOTE MANUAL PULL STATION SINGLE APPLICATION
GENERAL INSTALLATION REQUIREMENTS
To install a remote manual pull station complete the following
steps:
Make certain that regulated release assembly enclosure
cover is detached and lock pin is properly inserted within the
regulated release mechanism.
NOTICE
Failure to follow these instructions may
lead to system actuation.
Verify that cartridge has been removed from regulated
release assembly and that the regulated re)ease assembly
is in the cocked position.
If regulated release assembly does not have lock pin
inserted or cartridge removed, refer to the "Semi-Annual
Maintenance," Page 8-1, in "Maintenance Examination"
section, and complete Steps 2 and 3 before completing the
following installation steps.
Select a convenient location in the path of egress for mount-
ing the pull station(s) to the wall. The pull station should
be installed at a height of 42 in. to 48 in. (1067 mm to
1219 mm) in accordance with the authority having jurisdic-
tion and the American Disabilities Act (ADA) requirements.
A maximum of two manual pull stations can be connected
to each AUTOMAN release.
INSTALLATION FOR REMOTE MANUAL PULL STATION
UTILIZING EMT CONDUIT ONLY
The total length of the wire rope used for each manual pull
station within a system must not exceed 150 ft (45.7 m).
The maximum number of pulley elbows that may be used
per each manual pull station is 20.
If junction box(es) is used, fasten a 4 in. (102 mm) junction
box to wall or in wall where pull station is to be mounted,
with mounting screws positioned so that when pull station
cover is positioned in place, the printing will appear right
side up and readable.
Install and secure 1/2 in. conduit, pulley tee (if required),
and pulley elbows from each pull station junction box to
regulated release assembly as necessary. See Figure 5-37.
See Figures 5-38 thru 5-40 for optional methods of installing
wire rope when utilizing a pulley tee.
PULLEY TEE PULLEY OVAL ELBOW
SLEEVE
RELEASE
MECHANISM
CABLE LEVER
JUNCTION BOX REMOTE
(SUPPLIED BY OTHERS) MANUAL PULL STATION
FIGURE 5-39
009465
REMOTE MANUAL PULL STATION APPLICATION - OPTION 3
CAE
LEV
MINIMUM OF
6 IN. (153 mm)
MINIMUM OF
6 IN. (153 mm)
SPLICED WIR
ROPE
2- OVAL SLEEVES
(PART NO. 4596)
NO ELBOWS ALLOWED
WHERE TWO WIRE
ROPES ARE PRESENT
CONTINUOUS WIRE
ROPE \.
PULLEY TEE (PART
NO. 427929) ONLY
TO EITHER GAS VALVES OR PULL—
STATIONS. MIXING IS NOT ALLOWED.
SECTION 5- INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 5-18 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
INSTALLING REMOTE MANUAL PULL
STATION (Continued)
NOTICE
INSTALLATION FOR REMOTE MANUAL PULL STATION
UTILIZING EMT CONDUIT ONLY (Continued) Make certain that wire rope rides on top
and in center of pulley sheave. If the 50
ft (15.2 m) wire rope has been spliced
to accommodate a longer run, do not
allow the spliced ends to be within 6 in.
(153 mm) of any pulley elbow or conduit
adaptor.
AN 5. Fasten pull station assembly to each junction box (if junction
box is used).
Slide oval crimp sleeve onto wire rope. Loop wire rope
through cable lever guide holes and back through the oval
crimp sleeve. See Figure 5-37.
Pull slack out of each wire rope and crimp sleeve. (Use the
National Telephone Supply Company Nicopress Sleeve
RELEASE Tool Stock No. 51-C-887 or equal to properly crimp stop
MECHANISM sleeve.) See Figure 5-37.
Note: When utilizing flexible conduit for remote manual pull
station or mechanical gas valve installation, refer to "Installation
of Remote Manual Pull Station or Mechanical Gas Valve Utilizing
Flexible Conduit" instructions on pages 5-22 through 5-34.
INSTALLING MECHANICAL GAS VALVE
FIGURE 5-40 NOTICE
009466 Mechanical gas valves are designed for
indoor installation only.
To install each Mechanical Gas Shut-off Valve complete the
4 following steps. (All gas valve installation and testing shall be
TO AIR made in accordance with the authority having jurisdiction.)
CYLINDER
FOR GAS Note: Mechanical gas valve air cylinder(s) can be installed
VALVES OR in regulated release assemblies and also regulated actuator R
CABLE
ELEASE assemblies. Installation in either is the same.
LEVER
A PULL 1. Make certain that regulated release assembly enclosure
STATIONS cover is detached and lock pin is properly inserted in the
regulated release mechanism.
NOTICE TWO WIRE ROPES CONNECTED BETWEEN A PULLEY
ELBOW AND A PULLEY TEE Failure to follow these instructions may
FIGURE 5-41 lead to system actuation.
008383
4. Feed wire rope from the AUTOMAN release through conduit
and pulley elbows and pulley tee, if provided, to the pull
station junction box. Follow the instructions for assembling
the pull station and block assembly and attaching the wire
rope to the pull station pull knob (see Figures 5-70 through
5-85).
2. Verify that cartridge has been removed from regulated
release assembly and that the regulated release mecha-
nism is in the cocked position.
If regulated release mechanism does not have lock pin
inserted or cartridge removed, refer to the "Semi-Annual
Maintenance," Page 8-1, in "Maintenance Examination"
section, and complete Steps 2 and 3 before completing the
following installation steps.
CARTRIDGE RECEIVER
STOP SLEEVE
MOUNTING BRACKET
1/8 IN. COPPER
TUBING AND FITTINGS
TOP KNO
BOTTOM
KNOCKOUTS
MOUNTING
BRACKETS
000342
1/8 IN. COPPER
TUBING AND FITTINGS
SYSTEMS USING PULLEY TEE (PART NO. 427929)
NOTE: NO ELBOWS ARE ALLOWED BETWEEN
AUTOMAN RELEASE AND PULLEY TEE
STOP
SLEEVES (2)
FIGURE 5-45
000342
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual SECTION 5— INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 5-19
INSTALLING MECHANICAL GAS VALVE (Continued)
Note: Two air cylinders are necessary only if the old style
pulley tee (Part No. 15342) is utilized. If new style pulley
tee (Part No. 427929) is utilized, only one air cylinder is
required. Individual wire ropes can be run from each gas
valve to a single air cylinder. See Figure 5-45.
5. To install second mechanical gas valve shut-off system,
locate second air cylinder and bracket assembly adjacent to
first assembly and over the two remaining 7/32 in. (6 mm)
PLUG holes provided on right side of the enclosure. Assemble
second cylinder with screws, lockwashers, and nuts as
required. Wrench tighten. See Figure 5-45.
SYSTEMS USING PULLEY TEE (PART NO. 15342)
FIGURE 5-42 WIRE ROPE'._
.-1S
STOP
LEEVES
3. Remove plug from cartridge receiver. See Figure 5-42.
4. Locate air cylinder and bracket assembly over the two 7/32
in. (5.6 mm) holes on right side of the enclosure. Assemble
with screws, lockwashers, and nuts. Wrench tighten. See
Figure 5-43. Air cylinder(s) can also be mounted in the
inverted position, allowing for direct exit out the knockout(s)
in the bottom of the enclosure. See Figure 5-44.
FOR MOUNTING ONE MECHANICAL GAS VALVE
FIGURE 5-43
000340
MECHANICAL
GAS VALVE
AIR CYLINDER
-102 REGULATED
ELEASE
FIGURE 5-44
000341
AIR CYLINDER
RODS
CORRECT WAY:
WRENCH APPLIED NEXT TO PIPE
BEING INSERTED PREVENTS
EXCESS STRAIN ON VALVE BODY.
WRONG WAY:
WRENCH APPLIED
AT THIS POINT
STRAINS VALVE
BODY.
000345
FIGURE 5-46
CORRECT WAY:
WRENCH APPLIED NEXT
TO PIPE BEING
INSERTED. PREVENTS
EXCESS STRAIN ON
VALVE BODY. \. WRONG WAY:
WRENCH APPLIED AT
THIS POINT STRAINS
VALVE BODY.
SECTION 5 - INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 5-20 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
INSTALLING MECHANICAL GAS VALVE (Continued)
6. Install the necessary 1/8 in. copper tubing and fittings for
each air cylinder to the accessories piping arrangement on
the regulated release mechanism. See Figures 5-43 and
5-45.
NOTICE
Do not kink 1/8 in. copper tubing or form
a bend too close to a fitting. Secure each
fitting without over tightening. Over tight-
ening could result in pressure leakage or
line separation at actuation.
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
ANSUL MECHANICAL GAS VALVES
CORRECT WAY:
VISE GRIP ENDS NEXT TO PIPE
BEING INSERTED. PREVENTS
EXCESS STRAIN ON VALVE
To reduce the risk of explosion due to leaking gas, make
certain that the gas line is turned off before connecting
the gas valve. Failure to comply may result in serious
personal injury or death. Gas valve installation shall be
performed by qualified individuals in accordance with local
jurisdiction requirements.
Install mechanical gas valve to its selected location in gas
line so that it ensures safe shut-off to all predetermined
appliances being protected upon actuation of the system.
Mechanical gas valves may be mounted in any convenient
horizontal or vertical position. See Figure 5-46.
Use new pipe, properly reamed and cleaned of metal
chips.
Make certain gas flow is in the same direction as arrow
shown on gas valve. To avoid cracking the gas valve
casting, do not overtighten pipe connections. If pipe
tape, paste, spray, or similar lubricant is used, extra care
should be taken to avoid overtightening. Apply lubricant
to male threads only.
Wrench tighten pipe to gas valve. DO NOT USE GAS
VALVE AS A LEVER WHEN INSTALLING OR VALVE
DAMAGE MAY OCCUR. See Figure 5-46.
If strainer is utilized, attach strainer ahead of gas valve.
If necessary, install drip leg in gas line in accordance
with the authority having jurisdiction.
The total length of wire rope allowed for each valve must
not exceed 150 ft (45.7 m).
The maximum number of pulley elbows allowed for each
gas valve is 20.
ASCO MECHANICAL GAS VALVES
CORRECT WAY:
VISE GRIP APPLIED NEXT
TO PIPE BEING INSERTED
PREVENTS EXCESS
STRAIN ON VALVE BODY.
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual SECTION 5— INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 5-21
INSTALLING MECHANICAL GAS VALVE (Continued)
Install 1/2 in. conduit, and pulley elbow(s) from the mechan-
ical gas valve to regulated release assembly enclosure as
necessary.
Beginning at the regulated release assembly, thread the
end of the wire rope through hole provided in air cylinder
rod. See Figure 5-43.
Feed end of wire rope through conduit and each pulley
elbow.
Make certain that wire rope rides on top and in center of
pulley sheave. If the 50 ft (15.2 m) wire rope has been
spliced to accommodate a longer run, do not allow the
spliced ends to be within 12 in. (305 mm) of any pulley
elbow or conduit adaptor.
Remove side cover on gas valve and thread end of wire
rope through hole in cocking lever. Slide stop sleeve (Part
No. 26317) on to wire rope and crimp. (Use the National
Telephone Supply Company Nicopress Sleeve Tool Stock
No. 51-C-887 or equal to properly crimp stop sleeve.) Make
certain crimp is on top of trigger, with wire rope curled under
lever. See Figure 5-47.
FIGURE 5-47
000347
With the end of wire rope already threaded through hole in
air cylinder rod, slide stop sleeve (Part No. 26317) onto wire
rope and leave loose. Do not crimp stop sleeve at this time.
See Figure 5-43.
Cock mechanical gas valve as shown in Figure 5-48.
Note: A valve cocking tool is available. Order Part No.
416018.
ANSUL MECHANICAL GAS VALVE
COCKED OPEN POSITION FIRED CLOSED POSITION
ASCO MECHANICAL GAS VALVE
COCKED OPEN POSITION FIRED CLOSED POSITION
FIGURE 5-48
Raise air cylinder rod "UP" to its maximum extended posi-
tion. See Figure 5-43.
Manually pull wire rope to remove excess slack.
NOTICE
Slide stop sleeve against air cylinder rod, make certain all
slack is removed from wire, and crimp stop sleeve. See
Figure 5-43.
Cut off any excess wire rope approximately 3/4 in. (19 mm)
from end of stop sleeve.
Note: If utilizing a pulley tee to operate either a single
mechanical gas valve from two AUTOMAN releases or
two mechanical gas valves from one air cylinder in an
AUTOMAN release, see Figures 5-49 and 5-50 for instal-
lation instructions. Maximum length of wire rope to each
AUTOMAN release must not exceed 150 ft (45.7 m) and
maximum number of elbows must not exceed 20.
TWO AIR CYLINDERS - ONE MECHANICAL GAS VALVE
TO AIR CYLINDER IN TO AIR CYLINDER IN
"AUTOMAN AUTOMAN'
RELEASE NO. 1 7LPWQ::~_RELEASE NO. 2
BIN. (153 mm) MINIMUM NO PULLEY ELBOWS
FROM CRIMP SLEEVE ALLOWED WHERE TWO
TO PULLEY TEE WIRE ROPES ARE PRESENT
2 IN. (51 mm) MINIMUM USE TWO OVAL
FROM CRIMP SLEEVE SLEEVES (PART
TO COMPRESSION NO. 4596)
FITTING
FIGURE 5-49
001091
DO NOT ACTUATE THE MECHANICAL
GAS VALVE. Each Mechanical Gas Valve
IE ROPE System must have gas valve cocked and
air cylinder rod extended "UP" to its
maximum extension before completing
next step.
TRIGGER
Note: When installing flexible conduit, make sure to feed wire
rope through conduit directly from the spool. DO NOT pre-cut
wire rope. Feeding pre-cut rope through flexible conduit will
cause excessive kinks in the rope, making it difficult to install.
The maximum distance from an AUTOMAN release to a
mechanical gas valve is 75 ft (22.8 m) with a maximum of
4-900 bends in the flexible conduit and 4 pulley elbows.
Any portion of the flexible conduit system can be substituted
with EMT conduit provided the proper connections are used
to join the two types of conduit.
All bends in the flexible conduit system must have a minimum
bend diameter of 6 in. (153 mm).
When the flexible conduit is used to make 900 bends between
an AUTOMAN release and a mechanical gas valve, the bends
must start at the gas valve. No pulley elbows can be used
between the bends. If more than 3600 of bends are needed,
then pulley elbows can be used.
When the flexible conduit is used to make 900 bends between
an AUTOMAN release and a pull station, the bends must start
at the AUTOMAN release. No pulley elbows can be used
between the bends. If more than 360° of bends are needed,
then pulley elbows can be used.
When not utilizing a conduit offset 2-450 bends in the flexible
conduit are allowed between the Strain relief fitting on top of
the AUTOMAN release, and the location where the flexible
conduit is supported.
When installing flexible conduit, conduit should be secured at
intervals not to exceed 5 ft (1.5 m) and before and after each
bend. Flexible conduit CANNOT slide in the clamp(s) used for
mounting. Make certain mounting clamp(s) do not pinch the
conduit. The following style clamp (P clip) (Part No. 436150)
is a suitable type for use on flexible conduit. See Figure 5-51.
Ri
FIGURE 5-51
008141
TABLE 1
Mechanical
Manual Pull Gas Valve Detection
90° Cable Bends
Bend Diameter - in. (mm)
Mechanical Corner Pulley
Conduit Secured Max. ft (m)
Conduit Max. Length ft (m)
Conduit Offset / 2-450 Bends
(Only between strain relief
fitting and support location)
Pulley Tees
Splices
4 4 N/A
6(153) 6(153) N/A
15 4 N/A
5(1.5) 5(1.5) N/A
140(42.6) 75(22.8) N/A
1 0 N/A
N/A
N/A
SECTION 5— INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 5-22 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
INSTALLING MECHANICAL GAS VALVE (Continued)
ONE AIR CYLINDER - TWO MECHANICAL GAS VALVES
r TO AIR CYLINDER IN
MINIMUM OF 6 IN. AUTOMAN
(153 mm) I RELEASE
TWO OVAL SLEEVES
EJ. (PART NO. 4596)
MINIMUM OF 6 IN, NO ELBOWS ALLOWED
(153 mm) II WHERE TWO WIRE ROPES
E PRESENT
r SPLICED WIRE ROPE CONTINUOUS b.
AR
WIRE ROPE
PULLEY TEE
(PART NO. 427929) ONLY
NOTE: EITHER BOTH MUST BE
GAS VALVES OR BOTH MUST
BE PULL STATIONS. MIXING IS
NOT ALLOWED.
FIGURE 5-50
008394
NOTICE
When connecting two mechanical gas valves
to one air cylinder, make certain both gas
valves properly operate (close) when the air
cylinder rod is in the down (operated) position.
INSTALLATION OF REMOTE MANUAL PULL STATION OR
MECHANICAL GAS VALVE UTILIZING FLEXIBLE CONDUIT
Flexible conduit allows for quicker installations and the conve-
nience of being able to route the cable over, under and around
obstacles.
Flexible conduit can be used as a substitute for standard EMT
conduit or can be used with EMT conduit.
NOTICE
Flexible conduit can be used only with NEW
Remote Pull Station (Part No. 434618) and
mechanical gas valve installations. Flexible
conduit is intended for indoor use ONLY.
These instructions address the components and installation of
both the pull station (Part No. 434618) and the flexible conduit.
Design Requirements
Flexible conduit cannot be utilized in detection systems.
Flexible conduit inserts (Part No. 434347) can ONLY be used
with the flexible conduit system.
The maximum distance from an AUTOMAN release to a pull
station is 140 ft (42.6 m) with a maximum of 3600 (for example,
3900 and 2-450 bends, 2900 and 4450 bends, etc.) bends in
the flexible conduit, one pulley tee (refer to pages 5-31 through
5-33 for detailed Splicing instructions), two splices, and 15
pulley elbows.
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
IF SLIGHTLY CRIMPED,
TURN IN DRYWALL
SCREW TO OPEN
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
INSTALLATION OF REMOTE MANUAL PULL STATION OR
MECHANICAL GAS VALVE UTILIZING FLEXIBLE CONDUIT
(Continued)
Installation Instructions
Note: Do not add any type of lubricants inside or on the flexible
conduit. Make certain stainless steel wire rope is clean and
debris-free.
The flexible conduit should be routed along the same path that
EMT conduit would normally be run. Stainless steel wire rope
should be routed through the flexible conduit as it is in EMT
conduit.
DO NOT cut the wire rope to length before feeding it into the
flexible conduit. The wire rope should be fed directly from its
spool through the flexible conduit. This method will help avoid
possible kinking of the wire rope which can make it difficult to feed.
Flexible conduit must not be located within 6 in. (153 mm) of
the hood or in areas exceeding 130 OF (54 °C). Also, do not
route flexible conduit in areas where conduit can be crushed,
pinched, or broken.
Flexible conduit can be used to connect an AUTOMAN release
to a remote pull station or mechanical gas valves.
Before starting the system installation, take a few minutes to
plan the layout of the system. This will minimize the amount of
components needed to complete the installation. Once the path
of the flexible conduit has been determined, verify that the layout
does not exceed the design requirements.
Connecting the Flexible Conduit to the AUTOMAN Release,
Electrical Junction Box, or MECHANICAL Gas Valve
1. Layout the flexible conduit and secure it in place. Note: If
inner liner is crimped, turn a drywall screw into the end to
open it. See Figure 5-52.
FIGURE 5-52
SECTION 5— INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 5-23
FIGURE 5-53
007986
Unscrew the nut from the EMT conduit connector and
remove the compression ring. Discard ring. See Figure
5-54.
FIGURE 5-54
007987
Thread the stainless steel wire rope through the EMT
conduit connector and flexible conduit insert. Make certain
thread in flexible conduit insert is facing out toward end of
connector. See Figure 5-55.
007985
2. Starting at the AUTOMAN release, connect the conduit FIGURE 5-55
connector using the supplied nut. Use only ANSUL conduit
fittings (Part No. 55813). See Figure 5-53.
FIGURE 5-61
007994
SECTION 5— INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 5-24 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
INSTALLATION OF REMOTE MANUAL PULL STATION OR
MECHANICAL GAS VALVE UTILIZING FLEXIBLE CONDUIT
(Continued)
Connecting the Flexible Conduit to the AUTOMAN
Release, Electrical Junction Box, or Mechanical Gas Valve
(Continued)
5. Tighten the nut to the connector body, locking the flexible
conduit insert in place. See Figure 5-56.
TIGHTEN
CONNECTOR
NUT TO LOCK
IN FLEXIBLE
CONDUIT
INSERT
R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
8. Thread the wire rope through the flexible conduit. See
Figure 5-59. (If a splice is required in the flexible conduit,
proceed to "Splicing Installation Instructions."
- FIGURE 5-59
j 9. Slide the flexible conduit into the strain relief until it is
approximately 1/16 in. (1.6 mm) from the bottom of the flex-
ible conduit insert. See Figure 5-60.
FIGURE 5-56
007989
Loosen the nut on the strain relief and thread the wire rope
through a strain relief. See Figure 5-57.
FIGURE 5-57
007998
Tighten the body of the strain relief to the conduit connector.
See Figure 5-58.
STOP FLEXIBLE
CONDUIT
APPROXIMATELY
1/16 IN. (1.6 mm)
/ FROM THE BOTTOM J / OF INTERNAL
/ FLEXIBLE CONDUIT
INSERT
FIGURE 5-60
007993
10. Tighten the strain relief nut onto the strain relief. See Figure
5-61.
TIGHTEN NUT
ON STRAIN
RELIEF
TIGHTEN
STRAIN RELIEF
INTO CONDUIT
CONNECTOR 0 4'
FIGURE 5-58
007991
R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
INSTALLATION OF REMOTE MANUAL PULL STATION OR
MECHANICAL GAS VALVE UTILIZING FLEXIBLE CONDUIT
(Continued)
Connecting Flexible Conduit to Pulley Elbows, Pulley
Tees, or Union Fittings
1. Unscrew the nut from pulley elbow, pulley tee, or EMT
conduit connector and remove the compression ring.
Discard ring. See Figure 5-62.
SECTION 5— INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 5-25
4. Loosen the nut on the strain relief and thread the wire rope
through the strain relief. See Figure 5-65.
LOOSEN NUT OF
STRAIN RELIEF
DISCARD
RING
FIGURE 5-65
007098
5. Tighten the body of the strain relief to the conduit connector
See Figure 5-66.
FIGURE 5-62
007996
2. Thread the stainless steel wire rope through the EMT
conduit connector and flexible conduit insert. Make certain
thread in flexible conduit insert is facing out toward end of
connector. See Figure 5-63.
THREADS FACING ./AWAY FROM BODY
OF FITTING
/45
00
TIGHTEN STRAIN
/ RELIEF INTO CONDUIT
CONNECTOR
, 00"
1IL
FIGURE 5-66
007999
6. Push the wire rope into the flexible conduit. See Figure
5-67.
FIGURE 5-63
007996
3. Tighten the nut to the connector conduit body, locking the
flexible conduit insert in place. See Figure 5-64.
FLEXIBLE
L(
CONDUIT
INSERT
LOCKED - IN PLACE H;
FLEXIBLE
CONDUIT
FIGURE 5-67
000000
FIGURE 5-64
007997
SECTION 5— INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 5-26 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
INSTALLATION OF REMOTE MANUAL PULL STATION OR
MECHANICAL GAS VALVE UTILIZING FLEXIBLE CONDUIT
(Continued)
Connecting Flexible Conduit to Pulley Elbows, Pulley
Tees, or Union Fittings (Continued)
Slide the flexible conduit into the strain relief until it is
approximately 1/16 in. (1.6 mm) from the bottom of the flex-
ible conduit insert. See Figure 5-68.
SLIDE FLEXIBLE CONDUIT
APPROXIMATELY 1/16 IN.
(1.6 mm) FROM BOTTOM OF
FLEXIBLE CONDUIT INSERT
Ut
FIGURE 5-68
008001
Tighten the strain relief nut onto the strain relief. See Figure
5-69.
j
TIGHTEN STRAIN
RELIEF NUT
0011 T.
FIGURE 5-69
Complete the same procedures on the other end of the
conduit fitting as described in Steps 1 through Step 8 above.
Assembling the Block
Note: For installations that do not require the tee block,
refer to page 5-34 for instructions.
1. The flexible conduit and wire rope should be connected to
the electrical box as described in "Connecting the Flexible
Conduit to the AUTOMAN Release, Electrical Box, or
Mechanical Gas Valve." See Figure 5-70.
Note: For 1 1/2 in. (38 mm) deep electrical box, the bearing
should be installed in the block's shallow box location.
For 2 1/8 in. (54 mm) deep electrical box, the bearing should
be installed in the block's deep box location.
FIGURE 5-70
008003
Thread the wire rope through the small end of the block into
the bearing area to be used. See Figure 5-71.
FIGURE 5-71
008004
Pull slack, make a loop and insert the rope through the
larger opening in the bearing area. See Figure 5-72.
PUSH WIRE
ROPE THROUGH
LARGER
OPENING .
io*pi
FIGURE 5-72
008006
INSTALLATION OF REMOTE MANUAL PULL STATION OR
MECHANICAL GAS VALVE UTILIZING FLEXIBLE CONDUIT
(Continued)
Assembling the Block (Continued)
4. Pull wire rope out of the large end of the block. See Figure
5-73.
FIGURE 5-73
Place the bearing against the wire rope. Make certain wire
rope is in the bearing groove. See Figure 5-74.
FIGURE 5-74
008007
Align the bearing against the wire rope so that the bearing
center and the hole in the block line up. See Figure 5-75.
FIGURE 5-75
R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
I
SECTION 5— INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS I
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 5-27
7. Insert the supplied bolt into the bearing and tighten securely. S
Take care not to strip the thread. See Figure 5-76.
1•
\ .
FIGURE 5-76
Connecting the Block and the Faceplate
The block can be inserted into the faceplate at 900 intervals. S
See Figure 5-77.
CAN BE INSERTED
AT 90 INTERVALS
/ S
FIGURE 5-77
00801(
Thread the wire rope through the faceplate. Insert the block
by depressing the tabs and pushing the block into the face-
plate until it snaps in place. See Figure 5-78.
PUSH 5 BLOCK INTO ... .
FACEPLATE
FIGURE 5-78
008011
SECTION 5 - INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 5-28 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
INSTALLATION OF REMOTE MANUAL PULL STATION OR
MECHANICAL GAS VALVE UTILIZING FLEXIBLE CONDUIT
(Continued)
Connecting the Block and the Faceplate (Continued)
Place the faceplate over the top of the electrical box and insert
the two screws to secure the faceplate. See Figure 5-79.
FIGURE 5-79
008012
Thread the wire rope through the pull knob. See Figure 5-80.
FIGURE 5-80
008013
Thread the wire rope through stop sleeve and leave approxi-
mately 1/4-3/8 in. (6.4-9.5 mm) extended past sleeve. Crimp
stop sleeve twice using Crimping tool, National Telephone
Supply Co. Nicopress Sleeve Tool (Stock No. 51-C-887).
Verify stop sleeve is secure on wire rope. See Figure 5-81.
LEAVE 1/4.3/8 IN.
(6-9 mm)
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
Insert the break rod into the two holes toward the top of the
pull knob. See Figure 5-82.
FIGURE 5-82
008015
Pull the excess slack back to the AUTOMAN release. This
will pull the pull knob assembly in place. See Figure 5-83.
FIGURE 5-83
008016
Hold the pull knob assembly against the faceplate. Rotate
the pull knob assembly counterclockwise until the break rod
and pull knob snap in place. See Figure 5-84.
Note: Take care in snapping in the ends of the break rod
into the pull station side shields while rotating the entire
assembly.
/_g_®•-'
7'
I
ROTATE
COUNTER-
CLOCKWISE
FIGURE 5-84 FIGURE 5-81 008017
008014
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
INSTALLATION OF REMOTE MANUAL PULL STATION OR
MECHANICAL GAS VALVE UTILIZING FLEXIBLE CONDUIT
(Continued)
Connecting the Block and the Faceplate (Continued)
9. Snap the pull tab onto the pull knob so it is legible. See
Figure 5-85.
FIGURE 5-85
008018
Refer to R-102 or PIRANHA installation manual to complete
system installation.
Test Remote Manual Pull Station and Mechanical Gas
Valves in accordance with the "Testing and Placing
in Service - Testing Manual Pull Station and Testing
Mechanical Gas Valves" section of this manual.
SECTION 5—INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 5-29
Installing Flexible Conduit Through a Conduit Offset
Starting at the AUTOMAN release, connect the conduit
connector using the supplied nut. Use only ANSUL conduit
fittings (Part No. 55813). See Figure 5-86.
FIGURE 5-86
007886
Install Conduit Offset (Part No. 435961) into conduit
connector and tighten nut. See Figure 5-87.
0
FIGURE 5-87
Install compression union to opposite end of conduit offset.
Tighten securely. See Figure 5-88.
FIGURE 5-88
SECTION 5— INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 5-30 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
INSTALLATION OF REMOTE MANUAL PULL STATION OR
MECHANICAL GAS VALVE UTILIZING FLEXIBLE CONDUIT
(Continued)
Installing Flexible Conduit Through a Conduit Offset
(Continued)
4. Install the conduit required to get above the ceiling. See
Figure 5-89.
FIGURE 5-89
008041
Install compression union to top of conduit riser. See Figure
5-90.
*••-
FIGURE 5-90
008042
Remove union nut and ring. Discard ring. Do not reinstall
nut at this time. See Figure 5-91.
R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
Remove strain relief nut and install strain relief body into
compression union. See Figure 5-92.
FIGURE 5-92
008044
Install union nut over strain relief body and tighten nut. See
Figure 5-93.
FIGURE 5-93
008045
Install strain relief nut onto strain relief body. Do not tighten
nut at this time. See Figure 5-94.
p
FIGURE 5-94
16
FIGURE 5-91
SECTION 5— INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 5-31
Flexible Conduit Splicing (Allowed on Pull Station
Installations Only)
Note: Wire rope cannot be spliced together, only the flexible
conduit.
Flexible conduit can be spliced together using EMT compression
fitting union (Part No. 79827).
Remove rings from both ends of compression union. See
Figure 5-97.
FIGURE 5-97
008061
Install strain relief nut, strain relief, compression union nut,
flexible conduit insert and compression union over the flexi-
ble conduit with wire rope installed. See Figure 5-98.
_CJ;r oil*
FIGURE 5-98
008049
Tighten compression union nut onto union body, locking
flexible conduit insert in place. See Figure 5-99.
R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
INSTALLATION OF REMOTE MANUAL PULL STATION OR
MECHANICAL GAS VALVE UTILIZING FLEXIBLE CONDUIT
(Continued)
Installing Flexible Conduit Through a Conduit Offset
(Continued)
10. Push flexible conduit completely through conduit offset.
Flexible conduit should stop flush or +1— 1/2 in. (13 mm)
from bottom conduit fitting in AUTOMAN release. See
Figure 5-95.
FIGURE 5-95
008047
11. Tighten nut on strain relief on top of conduit riser. See
Figure 5-96.
FIGURE 5-96
008048
12. Complete the remainder of the flexible conduit and wire
rope installation to the pull station or the gas valve.
FIGURE 5-99
008050
SECTION 5— INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 5-32 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
INSTALLATION OF REMOTE MANUAL PULL STATION OR
MECHANICAL GAS VALVE UTILIZING FLEXIBLE CONDUIT
(Continued)
Flexible Conduit Splicing (Allowed on Pull Station
Installations Only) (Continued)
4. Install strain relief body into compression union and tighten.
See Figure 5-100.
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
7. Install strain relief nut, strain relief, and compression union
nut on remaining section of flexible conduit and install flexi-
ble conduit insert on wire rope. See Figure 5-103.
ts '-~i . -4 - , - JFjW
-
FIGURE 5-100
008051
5. Push flexible conduit into strain relief until it is approximately
1/16 in. (1.6 mm) from the bottom of the flexible conduit
insert, then tighten strain relief nut onto strain relief body.
See Figure 5-101.
FIGURE 5-103
008054
8. Push wire rope completely through remaining section of
flexible conduit. See Figure 5-104.
FIGURE 5-101
008052
6. Starting on the opposite end of the compression union,
remove the nut. See Figure 5-102.
FIGURE 5-104
008055
9. Tighten compression union nut onto union body, securing
flexible conduit insert in place. See Figure 5-105.
FIGURE 5-102
008053
FIGURE 5-105
008056
R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
INSTALLATION OF REMOTE MANUAL PULL STATION OR
MECHANICAL GAS VALVE UTILIZING FLEXIBLE CONDUIT
(Continued)
Flexible Conduit Splicing (Allowed on Pull Station
Installations Only) (Continued)
10. Tighten strain relief into compression union. See Figure
5-106.
SECTION 5— INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 5-33
FIGURE 5-108
007884
FIGURE 5-106
008057
Push flexible conduit into strain relief until it is approximately
1/16 in. (1.6 mm) from the bottom of the flexible conduit
insert, then tighten strain relief nut onto strain relief body.
See Figure 5-107.
FIGURE 5-107
008058
Complete the remainder of the flexible conduit and wire
rope installation to the pull station or the gas valve.
Component Removal Instructions
REMOVAL OF BLOCK
Using thumbs on the clips on each side of the block, press firmly in
the direction of the center of the block, at the same time pressing
in a slightly downward direction. As the clips on the side of the
block release from the pull station cover, the block will release
and be free to be removed from the backside of the cover. See
Figure 5-108.
REMOVAL OF PULL KNOB
Insert a small screwdriver into slot at bottom of pull knob. Push
slightly on the screwdriver and turn pull knob clockwise, then
pull knob can be removed without breaking the glass rod. See
Figure 5-109.
FIGURE 5-109
008059
REMOVAL OF PULL CAP
Using a small screwdriver or other blunt object, push on the back-
side of the pull cap. This will free the cap from the pull knob. See
Figure 5-110.
FIGURE 5-110
880088
SECTION 5— INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 5-34 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
INSTALLATION OF REMOTE MANUAL PULL STATION OR
MECHANICAL GAS VALVE UTILIZING FLEXIBLE CONDUIT
(Continued)
Pull Station Installation without Pulley Block Assembly
Note 1: When using this installation option, the distance
from the back of the faceplate and the connection to the 1/2
in. EMT conduit compression fitting must not exceed 6 in.
(152 mm).
Note 2: To provide for a straight run of wire rope from the pull
station, an octagonal junction box with a center knockout in the
back of the junction box will be needed. See Figure 5-111. If a
pre-fabricated box or enclosure is to be used, it must allow the
pull station face plate to be firmly attached to the box or enclo-
sure, with a hole or knockout suitable for a 1/2 in. EMT threaded
conduit compression connector to be installed directly in line
with the center of the pull station pull knob.
F-'
FIGURE 5-111
008415
Attach a 1/2 in. EMT conduit compression fitting (Part No.
55813) to the back center knock out of the junction box.
If something other than a junction box is to be utilized, a
method of securing the flexible conduit or EMT conduit
directly in line with the center of the pull station pull knob
must be used. This will ensure that in the event of manual
operation the wire rope, exiting the back of the pull station
faceplate, will be pulled straight out without binding or result-
ing in undue additional pull force due to friction loss.
Remove the block assembly from the pull station face plate.
Thread the wire rope from either flexible conduit or 1/2 in.
EMT conduit attached to the back of the junction box or
fabricated enclosure through the back side of the pull station
faceplate and through the pull knob.
Thread the wire rope through the stop sleeve (Part No.
26317) and leave approximately 1/4 in. to 3/8 in. (6.4 mm to
9.5 mm) extending past the sleeve.
Crimp the stop sleeve twice using the crimping tool National
Telephone Supply Co. Nicopress Sleeve Toll (Stock No,
51 -C-887). Verify the sleeve is secure on the wire rope.
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual SECTION 5— INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 5-35
INSTALLING ELECTRICAL GAS VALVES
NOTICE
Electric gas valves are designed for indoor
installation only.
The following instructions and schematics illustrate methods of
procedures for installing 110 VAC Electric Gas Shut-off Valves.
1. Make certain that regulated release assembly enclosure
cover is detached and lock pin is properly inserted within the
regulated release mechanism.
NOTICE
Failure to follow these instructions may lead
to system actuation.
CORRECT WAY:
VISE GRIP ENDS NEXT TO PIPE
BEING INSERTED. PREVENTS
EXCESS STRAIN ON VALVE BODY.
001092
CORRECT WAY:
WRENCH APPLIED NEXT TO PIPE
BEING INSERTED PREVENTS
EXCESS STRAIN ON VALVE BODY.
WRONG WAY:
WRENCH APPLIED AT
THIS POINT STRAINS
VALVE BODY.
Verify that cartridge has been removed from regulated
release assembly and that the regulated release mecha-
nism is in the cocked position.
If regulated release mechanism does not have lock pin
inserted or cartridge removed, refer to the "Semi-Annual
Maintenance," Page 8-1, in "Maintenance Examination" 6.
section, and complete Steps 2 and 3 before completing the
following installation steps.
AyAyIA!1IIrp
001093
FIGURE 5-112
Before working on any electrical wiring, make certain
main power has been disconnected. Failure to disconnect
main power may cause serious personal injury or death if
contact is made with energized wires
To reduce the risk of explosion due to leaking gas, make
certain that the gas line is turned off before connecting
the gas valve. Failure to comply may result in serious
personal injury or death. Gas valve installation shall be
performed by qualified individuals in accordance with local
jurisdiction requirements.
Install each electric gas valve to its selected location in gas
line so that it ensures safe shut-off to all predetermined
appliances being protected upon actuation of the system.
Refer to manufacturer's instructions (if provided). See
Figure 5-112.
Use new pipe properly reamed and clean of metal chips.
Install valve so that the actuator is above the horizontal
pipe line with no more than a five degree (50) lean either
way.
Make certain gas flow is in the same direction as arrow
shown on gas valve.
If strainer is utilized, attach strainer ahead of gas valve.
If necessary, install drip leg in gas line in accordance
with authority having jurisdiction.
Install and secure 1/2 in. conduit from each electric gas
valve to manual reset relay enclosure.
Tag and connect electrical wiring to each electric gas valve.
Then, feed wire through conduit to manual reset relay. Tape
or place a wire nut on any unused wire leads in accordance
with authority having jurisdiction. Refer to Figures 5-122 -
5-125 at the end of this section for typical wiring diagrams.
NOTICE
All electrical wiring/connections shall
be performed by qualified individuals in
accordance with local jurisdiction require-
ments.
Connect electrical wiring to manual reset relay along with
any contactor, or contractor supplied devices needed. Refer
to manufacturer's instructions and proper figure listed for
assistance.
Tape or place a wire nut on any unused wire leads in accor-
dance with authority having jurisdiction.
Install and secure 1/2 in. conduit from the regulated release
assembly enclosure to manual reset relay enclosure.
If snap-action switches have not been attached, go to
"Electric Switch" section and install them at this time by
completing Steps 3 through 8.
Tag and connect electrical wiring to each electric (snap-ac-
tion) switch. Then, feed wire through conduit to manual
reset relay.
Connect wiring from each electric (snap-action) switch
to manual reset relay terminals. Refer to manufacturer's
instructions (if provided) and proper figure for assistance.
Tape or place a wire nut on any unused wire leads in accor-
dance with authority having jurisdiction.
Properly return electrical power to the system.
R-702 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
I I'!Ii
T.LEVER PIN I,
TRIP LEVER PIN
FIGURE 5-113
001621
Install one or two of the electrical (snap-action) switches into
the switch cover for the upper tab of the switch mounting
bracket. See Figure 5-114.
Note: When applicable, always place the low voltage alarm
initiating switch(es) on the upper tab of the switch mounting
bracket. Never place low voltage alarm initiating switch(es)
on the lower tab of the switch mounting bracket.
FIGURE 5-114
009128
Slide switch cover onto the upper tab of the switch mounting
bracket, ensuring that the tab slides into the channels on the
back side of the switch cover, until the screw holes line up.
See Figure 5-115.
SECTION 5 - INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 5-36 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
INSTALLING ELECTRICAL SWITCHES
The procedure for field installing an electric (snap-action) switch
is as follows:
Unused wire leads will become "hot" when the system is
operated. Failure to adequately cover exposed wire end(s) will
cause electric shock if touched.
Before working on any electrical wiring, make certain main
power has been disconnected. Failure to disconnect main
power could cause personal injury or death if contact is made
with energized wires.
NOTICE
Except for the Alarm Initiating Switch, all
electrical wiring connections are to be made
outside the AUTOMAN release enclosure in
suitable enclosures in accordance with local
jurisdiction requirements.
Make certain that regulated release assembly enclosure
cover is detached with lock pin properly inserted within the
regulated release mechanism.
NOTICE
Failure to follow these instructions may lead
to system actuation.
Verify that cartridge has been removed from regulated
release assembly and that the regulated release mech-
anism is in the cocked position. If regulated release
mechanism does not have lock pin inserted or cartridge
removed, refer to "Semi-Annual Maintenance," Page 8-1, in
"Maintenance Examination" section, and complete Steps 2
and 3 before completing the following installation steps.
If regulated release mechanism has a factory installed sole-
noid, it will also have two factory installed switches.
FIGURE 5-115
009129
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual SECTION 5—INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 5-37
P. INSTALLING ELECTRICAL SWITCHES (Continued)
Install two switch mounting screws and nuts, ensuring that
the screws pass through the holes in the cover, though
the mounting holes in each of the switches, and through
the holes in the mounting bracket tab. See Figure 5-116.
Tighten screws securely.
Note: To meet UL requirements, the screws and nuts must
be installed. The switch cover is not intended to secure the
switches to the bracket.
FIGURE 5-116
009130
Wire the upper switch(es) according to the switch wiring
diagram provided with each release mechanism. See
Figure 5-117.
SWITCH WIRING DIAGRAM
SHOWN IN COCKED POSITION
UPPER SWITCH
REO
BLACK
'H
PERSI1T01
BROWLEAD
&VM LEAD BLACK LEAD LWERSI1C# REDLEAD
LOWER SWITCH BROWN
FLED
EXCEPT FOR ALARM WLATNG SWTFCH, NoWrnE CONNECTIONS ARE To T4SC0NTFOL HEARE1.ESP$ OE)flCE 51*tTCHES MUST BE SECLREf) WITh SCL.S
10 MEET UL AEOUIREMen
21Al2S, • 1HP125VAC0R2MP250VAC
FIGURE 5-117
009145
If necessary, install one or two of the snap-action switches
into the switch cover for the lower tab of the switch mount-
ing bracket. These switches will be oriented opposite of the
upper switch(es) so that the levers will appear on the top
side of the switch when mounted to the lower tab of the
switch mounting bracket.
Note: Never place low voltage alarm initiating switch(es) on
the lower tab of the switch mounting bracket.
8. Slide switch cover onto the lower tab of the switch mounting
bracket, ensuring that the tab slides into the channels on the
back side of the switch cover, until the screw holes line up.
See Figure 5-118.
FIGURE 5-118
009131
Install two switch mounting screws and nuts, ensuring that
the screws pass through the holes in the cover, though the
mounting holes in each of the switches, and through the
holes in the mounting bracket tab. Tighten screws securely.
Note: To meet UL requirements, the screws and nuts must
be installed. The switch cover is not intended to secure the
switches to the bracket.
Wire the lower switches according to the switch wiring
diagram provided with each release mechanism. See
Figure 5-117.
Note: All wiring to be performed by a certified individual(s).
Restore power to release assembly.
Before proceeding with Step 13, test electric (snap-action)
switches:
Remove lock pin. With the AUTOMAN release in the
cocked or ready position, press the lever of each switch up.
If the switch is working properly there should be an audible
click. See Figure 5-119.
FIGURE 5-119
009133
With the AUTOMAN release in the fired position, press
the lever of each switch up, there should be no audible
click.
When installing multiple switches, make certain all
switches transfer when the release operates. If they do
not, readjust their position.
SECTION 5— INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 5-38 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
INSTALLING ELECTRICAL SWITCHES (Continued)
' c. If an audible click is heard in the fired position adjust-
ments can be made by removing the snap action switch
and bending the lever slightly.
d. After adjustments repeat steps a and b. Then, recock
AUTOMAN release and install lock pin.
NOTICE
All electrical wiring/connections shall
be performed by qualified individuals in
accordance with local jurisdiction require-
ments
13. The switch may now be connected to compatible compo-
nents that are predetermined to shut off or turn on. Refer
to component manufacturer's instructions for proper wiring
connections to compatible components.
NOTICE
Except for the Alarm Initiating Switch, all
electrical wiring connections are to be made
outside the AUTOMAN release enclosure in
suitable enclosures in accordance with local
jurisdiction requirements.
p14. Tape or place a wire nut on any unused wire leads in accor-
dance with authority having jurisdiction.
NOTICE
Do not connect power source to any relay,
contactor, or contractor supplied devices until
all other electrical connections are made.
Refer to proper section or manufacturer
supplied instructions for recommended instal-
lation procedures for these devices.
15. Turn off power source and connect power line to any relay,
contactor, or contractor supplied devices where used.
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
INSTALLING ALARM INITIATING SWITCH
The Alarm Initiating Switch Kit (Part No. 428311) consists of:
Alarm Initiating Switch Assembly - Rated 50 mA 28VDC (or
0.1A, 125VAC)
Switch Cover
Mounting Screw with Nut (4)
Self-Tapping Screws (2)
Trip Lever Pin
Hex Nut for Trip Lever Pin
Instruction Sheet
The Alarm Initiating Switch is installed in the AUTOMAN Release
on the upper tab of the switch mounting bracket.
Install round trip lever pin with hex nut provided.
Install the alarm initiating switch into the switch cover for
the upper tab of the switch mounting bracket. To install the
alarm initiating switch in the switch cover, slide the switch
into the large opening of the switch cover, oriented with the
switch lever on the bottom side of the switch. See Figure
5-120.
SECTION 5— INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 5-39
4. Install two switch mounting screws and nuts, ensuring that
the screws pass through the holes in the cover, though the
mounting holes in each of the switches, and through the
holes in the mounting bracket tab. Tighten screws securely.
Note: To meet UL requirements the screws and nuts must
be installed. The switch cover is not intended to secure the
switches to the bracket.
See NFPA 72, "National Fire Alarm Code," Initiating Devices
section, for the correct method of wiring connection to the
fire alarm panel.
NOTICE
All connections to fire alarm control panels
must be made by trained and qualified person-
nel in accordance with fire alarm control panel
manufacturer's recommendations.
END-OF-LINE RESISTOR
FIRE ALARM OR NEXT DEVICE
CONTROL PANEL \
ALARM
CIRCUIT
ALARM
INITIATING
SWITCH
SWITCH
0r1j
"ItSt%VER
ALARM INITIATING
SWITCH
004891
SWITCH
MOUNTING
BRACKET
FIGURE 5-120
009137
INCORRECT
NOTICE
The alarm initiating switch must always
be installed on the upper tab of the switch
mounting bracket.
3. Slide switch cover onto the upper tab of the switch mounting
bracket, ensuring that the tab slides into the channels on the
back side of the switch cover, until the screw holes line up.
l
I 1 I
I I 004905
IN OUT IN OUT
CORRECT - SEPARATE INCOMING AND OUTGOING CONDUCTORS
FIGURE 5-121
Note: With the exception of the Alarm Initiating Switch, all elec-
trical connections must be made in an approved electrical box
which also meets NEC article 314.40 (D) Grounding Provisions.
SECTION 5— INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 5-40 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
ELECTRICAL SWITCH REQUIREMENTS
Electric (110 VAC/60 Hz) Gas Shut-off Valve
INSTALLATION OVERVIEW
POWER SOURCE MANUAL RESET
RELAY
ELECTRIC
SNAP-ACTION
SWITCH
ELECTRIC GAS VALVE
JUNCTION BOXES
(NOT SUPPLIED BY TYCO)
WIRING SCHEMATIC
WIRING SCHEMATIC - RELAY PART NO. 426151
UPPER SWITCH LOWER SWITCH
BLACK BROWN
ANSUL SNAP-ACTION SWITCH
(SWITCH CONTACTS SHOWN WITH AUTOMAN RED RED
RELEASE IN THE COCKED POSITION) BROWN BLACK
I-----------------
I RESET POWER
INDICATOR I TO TO -O- GND ______ __________ 4 3
I
I AB _SCREWI_5
L2 NEUTRAL
IILJ
110 VAC/60HZ Li HOT I RELAY COIL r __14
13
3-
I 4,
MANUAL RESET RELAY
I (PART NO. 426151) -I
_______
ELECTRIC RATING
1/3 HP, 10 Amp, 120 VAC GAS VALVE 1/2 HP, 10 Amp, 240 VAC SEE NOTE 3 002462 13 Amp, 28 VDC
NOTE:
_______ DENOTES FIELD INSTALLATION.
-----DENOTES FACTORY INSTALLATION.
CONTRACTORS: "UL LISTED ENCLOSED INDUSTRIAL CONTROL EQUIPMENT OR MAGNETIC SWITCH HAVING A RATING MATCHING
THAT OF THE COOKING APPLIANCE COIL, 110V/60HZ.
DO NOT USE BLACK WIRE ON SNAP-ACTION SWITCH IN NORMAL INSTALLATION. BLACK WIRE TO BE USED ONLY
FOR EXTRANEOUS ALARM, LIGHT CIRCUITS, ETC.
000273
FIGURE 5-122
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual SECTION 5— INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 5-41
ELECTRICAL SWITCH REQUIREMENTS (Continued)
Electric (110 VAC/60 Hz) Application with Customer Supplied Contactor and Heating Element Load
INSTALLATION OVERVIEW
POWER SOURCE 01
RELAY
MANUAL RESET
ELECTRIC
SNAP-ACTION
SWITCH
CONTACTOR
(CUSTOMER SUPPLIED)
JUNCTION BOX
(NOT SUPPLIED BY TYCO)
! ® I
POWER ON-OFF
SWITCH
(CUSTOMER SUPPLIED)
000276
WIRING SCHEMATIC
WIRING SCHEMATIC - RELAY PART NO. 426151
UPPER SWITCH LOWER SWITCH
BLACK BROWN
r, RED
BROWN
RED
ANSUL SNAP-ACTION SWITCH BLACK
-- -
(SWITCH CONTACTS SHOWN WITH AUTOMAN
RELEASE IN THE COCKED POSITION)
----------RESET POWER TO TO
NDICATOR 4 3
GND
RED.F-
A
Ii
FOISCRMW! B
[RELAY COIL L2 NEUTRAL 110VAC/60HZ
34 2
CONTACTOR (CUSTOMER SUPPLIED)
r - i POWER ON-OFF SWITCH
MANUAL RESET RELAY I (CUSTOMER SUPPLIED)
I (PART NO. 426151)
--------------------
f]
ELECTRIC RATING
:
TO HEATING _______ TO POWER SUPPLY ________ 1/3 HP, 10 Amp, 120 VAC ELEMENT LOAD -a 1/2 HP, 10 Amp, 240 VAC
13 Amp, 28 VDC 002460 NOTE:
1. ___________ DENOTES FIELD INSTALLATION.
2.DENOTES FACTORY INSTALLATION.
GAS VALVES: UL LISTED ELECTRICALLY-OPERATED SAFETY VALVE FOR NATURAL, OR LP GAS AS NEEDED OF APPROPRIATE PRESSURE AND TEMPERATURE RATING,
110V/60 HZ" OR ANSUL GAS VALVES, PART NUMBERS 13707, 13708, 13709, 13710, AND 17643.
DO NOT USE BLACK WIRE ON SNAP-ACTION SWITCH IN NORMAL INSTALLATION. BLACK WIRE TO BE USED ONLY
FOR EXTRANEOUS ALARM, LIGHT CIRCUITS, ETC.
FIGURE 5-123
SECTION 5— INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 5-42 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
ELECTRICAL SWITCH REQUIREMENTS (Continued)
Electric (110 VAC/60 Hz) Application with Customer Supplied Contactor and Heating Element Load, and Power Supply Switch
INSTALLATION OVERVIEW
POWER SOURCE —øl 0
0
ELECTRIC
SNAP-ACTION
SWITCH
MANUAL RESET
RELAY
SWITCH OR
THERMOSTAT
(CUSTOMER SUPPLIED)
JUNCTION BOX
(NOT SUPPLIED BY TYCO)
CONTACTOR
(CUSTOMER SUPPLIED)
000279
WIRING SCHEMATIC
WIRING SCHEMATIC - RELAY PART NO. 426151
RESET POWER
_T
INDICATOR
GND
R ~EDRED 4
RELAY COIL
6 13
3 12 -
S 1 ir
MANUAL RESET RELAY
L PART NO. 426151) J
ELECTRIC RATING
1/3 HP, 10 Amp, 120 VAC
1/2 HP, 10 Amp, 240 VAC
13 Amp, 28 VDC
LOWER SWITCH
.I:--- BROWN
RED
BLACKl
-JI
TO TO
4 3
L2 NEUTRAL
110 VAC/60HZ
Li HOT
.1 'CONTACTOR
SWITCH OR THERMOSTAT (CUSTOMER SUPPLIED)
(CUSTOMER SUPPLIED) r,-- ;"I
IL"QQjI
TO HEATING
L TOPOWERSUPPLY ELEMENT LOAD j 220V/440V
002461
ANSUL SNAP-ACTION SWITCH
(SWITCH CONTACTS SHOWN WITH AUTOMAN
RELEASE IN THE COCKED POSITION)
UPPER SWITCH
BLACK
RED
BROWN
NOTE:
DENOTES FIELD INSTALLATION.
-----DENOTES FACTORY INSTALLATION.
CONTRACTORS: "UL LISTED ENCLOSED INDUSTRIAL CONTROL EQUIPMENT OR MAGNETIC SWITCH HAVING A RATING MATCHING THAT OF THE
COOKING APPLIANCE COIL, 110V/6OHZ."
DO NOT USE BLACK WIRE ON SNAP-ACTION SWITCH IN NORMAL INSTALLATION. BLACK WIRE TO BE USED ONLY
FOR EXTRANEOUS ALARM, LIGHT CIRCUITS, ETC.
FIGURE 5-124
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual SECTION 5— INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 5-43
WIRING 24VDC REGULATED RELEASE ASSEMBLY
Refer to the following notes and wiring diagram for instruction on
wiring the 24VDC regulated release assembly.
Notes:
Do not install cartridge or remove tank assembly unless release
is cocked and ring pin is in place. Failure to comply may result 1. To be connected to a nominal 24VDC releasing circuit.
in accidental system actuation. L Input power: 750 mA at 24VDC nominal (1.02 at 30VDC
maximum).
If the following occurs during installation, the solenoid for the 2. Polarization: Observe polarity when connected to a release
releasing assembly may be damaged, rendering the system circuit; Terminal 4 positive, Terminal 8 negative.
inoperable. 1, 3. All interconnecting wiring number 14 - 18 AWG.
If the release is electrically tripped (fired) with the ring pin 4. S1 and S2 contact ratings: 20A, 125/250 VAC 2 HP, 250 VAC
inserted such that the release mechanism is pinned in the 1 HP, 125 VAC.
cocked position. 5. SOL coil resistance: 28 OHMS +1- 10% at 77 °F (25 °C).
The lever arm of the mounted switch is bent such that the 6. Install the in-line supervisory device SD across terminals switch does not operate when the release roll pin is bottomed No. 4 and No. 5. Refer to the releasing panel installation out in the fired position. instructions for supervisory device requirements. If an in-line
Trying to recock the release mechanism while power is supervisory device is not required, install jumper J2 across
applied to the release through the alarm contacts. terminals No. 4 and No. 5.
For complete recharging, inspection, and maintenance instruc- 7. S3 contact ratings: 24VDC, 240mA maximum.
tions, refer to applicable fire suppression system manual.
THESE SWITCH CONTACTS TRANSFER UPON
HIGH ACTUATION OF RELEASE
TB1
Take extreme care when wiring release assembly. Failure to
comply may cause an electrical shock, resulting in possible
serious injury or death.
ACCESSORY
POWER
SOURCE
Si
LOW -
4
51 S2
UL LISTED
SUPERVISED NC
RELEASING _________________
CONTROL UNIT
IN-LINE _______________
(9
SUPERVISORY DEVICE
TZ1
8
VOLTAGE IS0Li
TRANSIENT /
SUPPRESSOR
9
I
* AUXILIARY ALARMING DEVICES, SEE S1 RATINGS
** FUEL SHUT-OFF VALVE, BLOWER MOTOR, DOOR CLOSER, ETC., SEE S1 RATINGS.
FIGURE 5-125
008468
SECTION 5— INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 5-44 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
NOTES:
R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual SECTION 6— TESTING AND PLACING IN SERVICE
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 6-1
After the system has been completely installed, and BEFORE
INSTALLING THE CARTRIDGE, the system must be tested at
the regulated release assembly. The testing information listed
in this section deals with the limitations and parameters of this
pre-engineered system. Those individuals responsible for the
testing of the R-102 system must be trained and hold a current
ANSUL certificate in an R-102 training program.
Note: AUTOMAN Release must be in the cocked position
before testing manual pull station. Make certain to remove lock
pin before performing pull station testing.
TESTING MANUAL PULL STATION
To test each remote manual pull station, complete the following
steps:
With the expellant gas cartridge removed, remove lock pin
from regulated release assembly cable lever.
On pull station, remove break rod from the pull station by
inserting a small screwdriver into slot at bottom of pull knob
to facilitate turning the pull knob. Push slightly on the screw-
driver and turn pull knob clockwise, then the pull knob can
be removed without breaking the glass rod.
NOTICE
Take care in removing the break rod from
the pull station side shields while rotating
the break rod/pull knob assembly.
Pull ring handle on pull station. If the regulated release
assembly is tripped easily, the remote manual pull station
is properly installed. If the regulated release assembly does
not trip, remove pulley tee (if provided) and each pulley
elbow cover to make certain wire rope is resting on the
pulley sheave. If this does not correct the problem, there is
too much slack in the line and it must be retightened.
Recock regulated release assembly using cocking lever
(Part No. 441042 or 441041) and reinstall lock pin (Part No.
438031).
On pull station, insert the break rod into the two holes
toward the top of the pull knob. Rotate the pull knob coun-
terclockwise.
NOTICE
Take care in snapping in the ends of the
break rod into the pull station side shields
while rotating the entire assembly.
NOTICE
If no other devices are being attached,
proceed to Page 6-3, Step No. 1, and test
the detection system.
TESTING MECHANICAL GAS VALVES
To test each mechanical gas shut-off valve complete the
following steps:
tvIi1-1uIrr
To reduce the risk of explosion due to leaking gas, before
the gas line is turned on, make certain to extinguish any
open flames and turn off all burners and any electrical
or mechanical devices that are capable of igniting gas.
Failure to comply may result in serious personal injury or
death.
Turn gas line on.
Manually push each air cylinder rod to full "DOWN" posi-
tion. The gas valve should close. If mechanical gas valve
does not trip, remove each pulley elbow cover to make
certain wire rope is resting on each pulley elbow sheave.
If this does not correct the problem there may be too much
slack in the line and it should be retightened.
Test for gas leaks by painting connections with a soap
solution. Bubbles indicate a gas leak. Tighten connections
where leaks appear and repeat test again to make certain
no other gas leaks exist.
If no gas leak is found, pull air cylinder rod to full "UP"
position.
Recock mechanical gas valve.
Check burners for gaseous odor. IF GASEOUS ODOR
EXISTS, MANUALLY PUSH THE AIR CYLINDER ROD
TO THE FULL "DOWN" POSITION IMMEDIATELY. This
will cause the mechanical gas valve to shut the gas line off.
Open any doors and/or windows to clear the area of
gaseous fumes, then correct the gas leak before proceeding
any further.
If no gaseous odor exists, pilot light may be ignited at this
time.
Reinstall side covers to gas valve housing. Make certain roll
pin is positioned within both sides of the valve housing slot.
Connect visual inspection seals (Part No. 197) on ANSUL
type valves. See Figure 6-1 (next page).
Make certain the regulated release mechanism is cocked
with lock pin in place.
NOTICE
If no other devices are being attached,
proceed to Page 6-3, Step No. 1, and test
the detection system.
SECTION 6— TESTING AND PLACING IN SERVICE
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 6-2 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
TESTING MECHANICAL GAS VALVES (Continued)
'ECTION
NO. 197)
FIGURE 6-1
000359
TESTING ELECTRICAL GAS VALVES
To test each Electric Gas Shut-off Valve complete the following
steps:
I, lie 1.
To reduce the risk of explosion due to leaking gas, before
the gas line is turned on, make certain to extinguish any
open flames and turn off all burners and any electrical
or mechanical devices that are capable of igniting gas.
Failure to comply may result in serious personal injury or
death.
Turn gas line on.
2. Make certain electric (snap-action) switch is properly wired.
Make certain all other devices connected to the manual
reset relay are properly wired. Refer to typical wiring
diagrams in Figures 5-122, 5-123, 5-124, and 5-125 in
"Installation Instructions" section.
Test for gas leaks by painting connections with a soap
solution. Bubbles indicate a gas leak. Tighten connections
where leaks appear. Repeat test again to make certain no
other gas leaks exist.
If no gas leaks are found, turn power source on and depress
the reset button on the manual reset relay (RED LIGHT ON)
to energize (OPEN) electric gas valve.
Remove lock pin from regulated release mechanism.
Do not install cartridge at this time or system may be
actuated.
Manually actuate the system by operating the remote pull
station. (It may be necessary to remove the glass break
rod prior to operating pull station.) Manual reset relay (RED
LIGHT OUT) will de-energize (CLOSE) the electric gas
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
valve, thus shutting off the gas line. If this does not happen,
turn power source off. Then re-examine all wiring connec-
tions for proper hookup. Refer to Figures 5-122, 5-123,
5-124, and 5-125 in "Installation Instructions" section for
typical wiring diagrams.
If test is successful, recock regulated release mechanism
using cocking lever (Part No. 441042 or 441041) and rein-
stall lock pin (Part No. 438301). Depress reset button on
manual reset relay (RED LIGHT ON).
Check burners for gaseous odor. IF GASEOUS ODOR
EXISTS, TURN OFF POWER SOURCE IMMEDIATELY.
This will cause the electric gas valve to shut the gas line off.
Open any doors and/or windows to clear the area of
gaseous fumes, then correct the gas leak before proceeding
any further.
If no gaseous odor exists, pilot light may be ignited at this
time.
NOTICE
If no other devices are being attached,
proceed to Page 6-3, Step No. 1, and test
the detection system.
TESTING ELECTRIC SWITCH
The procedure for testing a field installed electric (snap-action)
switch is as follows:
NOTICE
If an electrical gas shut-off valve is attached
to system, perform proper test procedure
for the gas valve first, before completing the
following steps.
Turn power source on and if installed, depress reset button
on manual reset relay (RED LIGHT ON). All electrical
devices should be operating at this time.
Remove lock pin.
Do not install cartridge at this time or system may be
actuated.
Manually actuate the system by operating the remote pull
station. It may be necessary to remove the glass break rod
prior to operating pull station. (If installed, the manual reset
relay will de-energize the electric gas valve, thus shutting
off the gas line.) All electrically-operated devices prede-
termined to shut off or turn on should do so. If this does
not occur, turn power source off and make sure all wiring
is properly connected and retest. Refer to Figures 5-122,
5-123, 5-124, and 5-125 in "Installation Instructions" section
for typical wiring diagrams.
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
TESTING ELECTRIC SWITCH (Continued)
4. If test is successful, recock regulated release mechanism
using cocking lever (Part No. 441042 or 441041) and rein-
stall lock pin (Part No. 438031). If a manual reset relay is
installed, depress the reset button (RED LIGHT ON). It will
also be necessary to re-light any pilot lights on the cooking
appliances.
NOTICE
If no other devices are being attached,
proceed to Page 6-3, Step No. 1, and test
the detection system.
TESTING DETECTION SYSTEM
1. Test detection system by completing the following steps:
Raise the regulated release mechanism tension lever to
the "UP" position.
Remove the fusible link from the terminal detector and
install a test link (Part No. 24916). See Figure 6-2.
FIGURE 6-2
000363
Locate detector linkage and center in each bracket.
For "clip on" style linkage, locate linkage in bracket
slightly toward termination end of detection run.
For "scissor" style linkage, locate linkage in bracket all
the way toward termination end of detection run.
Lower regulated release mechanism tension lever to
b. "DOWN" position and remove lock pin.
Using a wire cutter, cut the test link at the terminal detec-
tor to simulate automatic actuation.
If system actuates successfully, go to Step 4.
2. If the regulated release mechanism does not actuate, check
the following components and remedy any disorder as
follows:
Check the detector linkage for correct positioning.
Check the wire rope for knotting or jamming.
Check pulley elbows to see that wire rope is free and
centered in pulley sheaves. If any evidence of pulley
elbow deformation is found, replace the pulley elbow.
I- d. Make certain that lock pin is removed.
Make certain that regulated release mechanism is
cocked.
Make certain that tension lever is in "DOWN" position.
SECTION 6— TESTING AND PLACING IN SERVICE
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 6-3
3. Re-test the system by completing the following steps:
Make certain regulated release is cocked and lock pin is
inserted. -
Raise the regulated release mechanism tension lever to
the "UP" position.
Install a new test link (Part No. 24916) on the terminal
detector.
Lower the regulated release mechanism tension lever to
the "DOWN" position.
Check for 1/4 in. (6.4 mm) minimum 3/8 in. (9.5 mm)
maximum clearance between the trip hammer assembly
and the cable lever assembly.
Remove the lock pin.
Using a wire cutter, cut the test link at the terminal detec-
tor to simulate automatic actuation.
4. Upon successful actuation of the system, complete the
following steps:
Raise tension lever to "UP" position and install a proper-
ly-rated fusible link in the terminal detector.
Cock regulated release mechanism using cocking lever
(Part No. 441042 or 441041) and insert lock pin (Part
No. 438031).
Lower tension lever to "DOWN" position.
For scissor-style linkage, locate linkage in bracket all the
way toward termination end of detection run.
Make certain the 1/4 in. (6.4 mm) minimum to 3/8 in.
(9.5 mm) maximum clearance was maintained between
the base of the trip hammer assembly and the cable
lever assembly.
NOTICE
Reset any electrical equipment that may
have been affected by the system actu-
ation.
Remove shipping cap and weigh each cartridge. Replace
if weight is 1/2 ounce (14.2 g), or more, below weight
stamped on cartridge.
Install cartridge into the regulated release mechanism
receiver and each regulated actuator receiver. Hand
tighten firmly.
Remove the lock pin.
SECTION 6— TESTING AND PLACING IN SERVICE
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 6-4 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
TESTING DETECTION SYSTEM (Continued)
Install cover on regulated release assembly and each
regulated actuator assembly and secure with appropriate
fasteners or visual inspection seal. Insert seal (Part No.
197) in each upper and lower cover hole, if applicable. If
system is installed in an OEM enclosure, attach enclosure
cover and secure with appropriate hardware or procedure.
Before installing cover, make certain detection tension
lever is secured in the "DOWN" position to enable
automatic detection and operation of the AUTOMAN
Regulated Release.
Record installation date on tag attached to unit and/or in a
permanent file.
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
The recharge information listed in this section deals with the
limitations and parameters of this pre-engineered system. Those
individuals responsible for the recharge of the R-102 system
must be trained and hold a current ANSUL certificate in an
R-102 training program.
For continued tire protection, the R-102 restaurant fire
suppression system must be recharged immediately after
use. Recharge procedures for single, double, and multiple-tank
systems are as follows.
CLEANUP PROCEDURES
Although there is no unusual cleanup procedure of ANSULEX
or ANSULEX Low pH agents, due to the alkaline nature of these
agents, they should be cleaned from kitchen surfaces within 24
hours after system discharge. The reaction from the wet chemi-
cal agent on cooking grease or oil produces a foamy bi-product
that can be wiped up with a cloth or sponge. The following
procedures should be followed:
Before attempting any cleanup, make certain that all fuel
sources to the equipment to be cleaned have been shut off.
Make certain that the exhaust hood and all appliance electri-
cal controls have been de-energized to avoid any chance of
electrical shock resulting from the cleaning process or from
electrically conductive alkaline liquid agent and/or its residue.
Make certain all surfaces to be cleaned have cooled down to
room temperature.
Do not use water to clean any appliances that contain hot
grease or cooking oils. Doing so may result in violent steaming
and/or spattering causing personal injury.
The agent is non-toxic; however, food product and cooking
grease/oil that has come in contact with the agent will no
longer be suitable for human consumption and should be
discarded.
Sponge up as much of the agent as possible using sponges
or clean rags. Dispose of these sponges or rags in a local
sanitary land fill site in accordance to local authorities.
Wear rubber gloves during cleanup as sensitive skin may
become irritated. If the ANSULEX agent or its residue
comes in contact with skin or eyes, flush thoroughly with
clean water.
Using hot, soapy water and either a clean cloth or sponge,
wipe away all foamy residue and thoroughly scrub all
surfaces that have come in contact with the agent.
After thoroughly cleaning all affected surfaces, adequately
rinse and allow to completely dry before re-energizing the
equipment.
SECTION 7— RECHARGE AND RESETTING PROCEDURES
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 7-1
RECHARGE
NOTICE
Determine the cause of system discharge and
correct immediately before performing system
recharge.
Remove the enclosure cover from the AUTOMAN
regulated release assembly and each regulated actuator
assembly.
From tank in regulated release enclosure: Disconnect the
expellant gas hose from each tank adaptor assembly.
From tank in mounting bracket or mounting enclosure:
Disconnect expellant gas piping union at each tank adaptor
inlet line(s).
Disconnect distribution piping union at each tank adaptor
outlet line(s).
From tank in enclosure: Remove tank.
From tank in bracket assembly: Loosen wingnut, disengage
bracket band, and remove each tank.
Remove each tank adaptor/tube assembly and complete
the following:
Remove 0-ring and inspect for damage.
Clean and coat 0-ring with a good grade of extreme
temperature grease and reinstall into adaptor groove.
See Figure 7-1.
Remove 1/4 in. vent plug.
Clean and inspect for free movement and corrosion. If
necessary, replace Vent Plug (Part No. 74247).
Reinstall vent plug into adaptor body.
FIGURE 7-1
' SECTION 7— RECHARGE AND RESETTING PROCEDURES
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 7-2 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01 I
O RECHARGE (Continued)
.6. s1iUjI[s] S Do not flush pipe with only water or other non-approved
material, as this could cause internal corrosion, leading to
possible improper discharge.
Piping system must be flushed to remove any wet chemical
residue. To prepare the system for flushing:
Pour the complete contents of one 32-oz. bottle of ANSUL
Flushing Concentrate (Part No. 79656) into an empty
R-1 02 agent tank. One complete bottle is used for either
size tank, the 1.5 gallon or the 3 gallon.
Fill the tank approximately half full with warm, clean water.
Agitate the tank for a few seconds and then add more
warm water to bring the fill level to within approximately
1 in. (25 mm) from the bottom of the fill opening.
Install adaptor/tube assembly and tighten.
7. To perform the flushing procedure, either secure heavy-duty
plastic bags to each nozzle (See Figure 7-2) or remove
each nozzle tip and strainer and attach plastic tubing. See
Figure 7-3.
If using plastic bags, secure bags and proceed to Step 9.
If using plastic tubing, proceed to Step 8.
NOZZL
F ITT IN
HEAVY GAUGE
PLASTIC BAG
FIGURE 7-2
001739
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
NOZZLE TIP N END NOZZLE
BODY
HIGH
4 PRESSURE
PLASTIC
TUBING
1/2 IN. NPT COMPRESSION
FITTING/THREADED ADAPTOR
/
U'
FIGURE 7-3
001740
8. If using the plastic tubing option, utilize 1/2 in. (13 mm) OD
plastic tubing with wall thickness not to exceed 0.062 in.
(1.5 mm), and make certain it can withstand the pressures
of at least 90 psi (6.2 bar) expelled during the flushing and
blowdown procedures.
Also required is a container with some means of securing
tubing to it such as a five-gallon plastic pail and cover that
snaps onto the pail.
To prepare the plastic tubing:
Cut as many tubing lengths as required, making them
long enough to reach the container from each nozzle
outlet.
Using the nozzle tip end, slide a length of 1/2 in. (13 mm)
plastic tubing over the rib on the nozzle tip and secure
with a 1/2 in. (13 mm) adjustable hose clamp. See Figure
7-4.
In the pail cover, drill the number of holes required, large
enough to insert 1/2 in. NPT fittings, with one additional
hole that can be used for venting.
Secure 1/2 in. compression fitting/threaded adaptors to
the pail cover, using 1/2 in. conduit nuts. See Figure 7-4.
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual SECTION 7— RECHARGE AND RESETTING PROCEDURES
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 7-3
RECHARGE (Continued)
10. Fill each tank with 1.5 gal (5.8 L) or 3.0 gal (11.6 L) of
NOZZLE TIP END ANSULEX Low pH Liquid Fire Suppressant. See Figure
RIB ON NOZZLE 7-5. Note: Use a funnel with a screen to stop any foreign
material from entering the tank. See Page 5-3, Figure 5-6,
1/2 IN. TUBING for additional detailed filling instructions.
1/2 IN. ADJUSTABLE STAINLESS
2 1/4 IN ± 1/8 IN (58 mm ± 3mm)
STEEL TANKS
HOSE CLAMP
FROM THE TOP OF THE COLLAR
FOR THE 3.0 GALLON TANK
OR
1 3/4 IN. :t 1/8 IN. (45mm ± 3mm)
FROM THE TOP OF THE COLLAR
FOR THE 1.5 GALLON TANK
TUBING 1/2 IN. COMPRESSION
FITTING/THREADED INSERT-...
,
,
.f ADAPTOR
000292
1/2 IN.
CONDUIT-.'.
.114 COVER _____________________________ PAIL
NUTS
FIGURE 7-4
000367 - RED PAINTED STEEL TANK
Attach the tubing ends to the compression fittings. 1 IN. TO 11/8 IN. (26-28 mm)
Tubing inserts will be required. See Figure 7-4. FROM THE BOTTOM OF THE FILL OPENING
Install nozzle/tubing ends to nozzle bodies in discharge FOR BOTH 3.0 GALLON AND
piping. 1.5 GALLON TANKS
Make certain each length of tubing is fastened to the pail
cover with the cover snapped securely to the pail.
9. Complete the following steps in the flushing procedure:
Connect discharge piping and expellant gas line to agent
tank adaptor.
Cock AUTOMAN Release Mechanism and insert lock
pin. Refer to Components Section of this manual for 000292a FIGURE 7-5 detailed part numbers.
Install LT-30-R Cartridge; hand tighten.
Remove lock pin.
If regulated actuators are included in the system, also During filling, the agent temperature should be 60 OF
install LT-30-R cartridges in them. to 80 OF (16 °C to 27 °C). DO NOT FILL WITH COLD
f. Actuate system via pull station. AGENT. DO NOT OVERFILL. Overfilling may result in
agent entering gas hose and regulator potentially causing Wash out all system nozzles and strainers in warm system malfunction. See Page 5-3. soapy water, rinse and return all nozzles and strainers
to their appropriate locations in the discharge piping. 11. Replace bursting disc (Part No. 416974) in adaptor assem-
Verify that all nozzle types are correct. Utilizing the bly. Make certain silver side of disc is away from tank.
nozzle aiming device, ensure that all nozzles are 12. Replace adaptor/tube assembly and tighten into place. correctly aimed at the appropriate location on the appli- Return and secure each tank in regulated release assembly ance. and mounting bracket/enclosure. Reconnect expellant gas
Apply a small amount of Dow Corning No. 111 silicone and distribution piping and/or as required.
grease across the opening of the nozzle tip. Install blow- 13. Raise tension lever to "UP" position. off caps onto nozzles.
14. Cock regulated release mechanism using cocking lever Remove empty tank. I. (Part No. 441042 or 441041) and install lock pin (Part No.
0. 438031).
SECTION 7- RECHARGE AND RESETTING PROCEDURES
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 7-4 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
RECHARGE (Continued)
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
27. Remove lock pin.
15. Remove empty cartridge from regulated release assembly 28. Manually test the regulated release mechanism by operat-
and each regulated actuator assembly as required. ing the remote manual pull station.
Do not install replacement cartridge at this time or system
may be actuated.
Install properly-rated fusible links in all detectors except the
terminal detector.
NOTICE
If actuation was caused by a fire situation,
all fusible links must be replaced.
Install test link (Part No. 24916) in terminal detector.
Lower tension lever to "DOWN" position.
Remove the lock pin.
Using wire cutter, cut the test link at the terminal detector to
simulate automatic actuation.
NOTICE
If regulated release mechanism does not
actuate, refer to Steps 2 and 3 of the
"Testing Detection System" portion of the
"Testing and Placing In Service" section,
Page 6-3, of this manual.
After successful actuation, raise the tension lever to "UP"
position
Install properly-rated, ANSUL approved, fusible link in termi-
nal detector.
Cock the regulated release mechanism and install lock pin
(Part No. 438031).
Locate detector linkage and correctly position in each
bracket.
Lower tension lever to "DOWN" position.
Inspect the base of the wire rope clamping device to make
certain there is a minimum of 1/4 in. (6.4 mm) to a maximum
of 3/8 in. (9.5 mm) clearance between the base of the trip
hammer assembly and the cable lever assembly.
NOTICE
If clearance is not 1/4 in. (§.4 mm) minimum
to a maximum of 3/8 in. (9.5 mm), raise
tension lever to "UP" position, raise trip
hammer 3/8-1/2 in. (9.6-12.7 mm), tighten
set screws, and repeat Steps 25 and 26.
Recock the regulated release mechanism and insert the
lock pin.
Reset all devices which were affected by the system actua-
tion. Refer to the following "Resetting" section.
RESETTING
Resetting Remote Manual Pull Station
Metal Stamped Style (Part No. 4835 and 54011)
Reset each remote manual pull station by completing the follow-
ing steps:
If necessary, remove set screw that is retaining the break
glass rod.
If necessary, carefully remove any remaining broken glass
from station.
Press and position ring handle in proper location against
cover and slide the replacement glass break rod (Part No.
4834) through stud and handle.
Tighten set screw into stud.
If no other resetting is required, refer to "Replacement
Cartridge," Page 7-5, and complete steps 1 through 5.
Molded Composite Style with Side Shields (Part No.
434618 and 435960)
If necessary, carefully remove any remaining broken glass
from station.
Insert the break rod into the two holes toward the top of the
pull knob.
Pull the excess slack back into the AUTOMAN Release.
This will pull the pull knob assembly in place.
NOTICE
Take care in snapping in the ends of the
break rod into the pull station side shields
while rotating the entire assembly.
Hold the pull knob assembly against the faceplate. Rotate
the pull knob assembly counterclockwise until the break rod
and pull knob snap in place.
Snap the PULL tab onto the pull knob so it is legible.
If no other resetting is required, refer to "Replacement
Cartridge," Page 7-5, and complete steps 1 through 5.
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
RESETTING (Continued)
Resetting Mechanical Gas Shut-Oft Valve
Reset each mechanical gas shut-off valve by completing the
following steps:
To reduce the risk of explosion due to leaking gas, before the
gas line is turned on, make certain to extinguish any open
flames and turn oft all burners and any electrical or mechanical
devices that are capable of igniting gas. Failure to comply may
result in serious personal injury or death.
Remove side cover from gas valve housing.
Extend air cylinder rod to full "UP" position. Air cylinder is
located inside the regulated release assembly enclosure.
Recock gas valve by pulling valve stem up so pin in stem
engages in cocking lever.
Check burners for gaseous odor. IF GASEOUS ODOR
EXISTS, MANUALLY PUSH THE AIR CYLINDER ROD TO
THE FULL "DOWN" POSITION IMMEDIATELY. This will
cause the mechanical gas valve to shut the gas line off.
Open any doors and/or windows to clear the area of
gaseous fumes, then correct the gas leak before proceeding
any further.
If no gaseous odor exists, pilot light may be ignited at this
time.
Reinstall side cover to gas valve housing. On ANSUL type
valve, make certain roll pin is positioned within both sides
of the valve housing slot and secure visual inspection seal
(Part No. 197).
If no other resetting is required, refer to "Cartridge
Replacement" and complete steps 1 through 5.
Resetting Electrical (Snap-Action) Switch
Reset the electrical (snap-action) switch by completing the
following steps:
Make certain the power source is on.
Electric (snap-action) switch is reset automatically when the
regulated release mechanism is recocked.
If no other resetting is required, refer to "Cartridge Replace-
ment" and complete steps 1 through 5.
SECTION 7— RECHARGE AND RESETTING PROCEDURES
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 7-5
Resetting Electrical Gas Shut-Off Valve
Reset each electric gas shut-off valve by completing the follow-
ing steps:
To reduce the risk of explosion due to leaking gas, before the
gas line is turned on, make certain to extinguish any open
flames and turn oft all burners and any electrical or mechanical
devices that are capable of igniting gas. Failure to comply may
result in serious personal injury or death.
Make certain the power source is on.
Depress reset button on manual reset relay (red light on).
Gas valve will resume its normal operating (open) position.
Check burners for gaseous odor. IF GASEOUS ODOR
EXISTS, TURN OFF POWER SOURCE IMMEDIATELY.
This will cause the electric gas valve to shut the gas line off.
Open any doors and/or windows to clear the area of gaseous
fumes, then correct the gas leak before proceeding any
further.
If no gaseous odor exists, pilot light may be ignited at this
time.
If no other resetting is required, refer to "Replacement
Cartridge" and complete steps 1 through 5.
SECTION 7— RECHARGE AND RESETTING PROCEDURES
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 7-6 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
RESETTING (Continued)
Resetting Pressure Switch
Reset the pressure switch by completing the following:
Depress the reset button(s) on the pressure switch cover.
The pressure switch assembly(ies) is located on the right
side of the regulated release enclosure. An audible click
will be heard to verify the pressure switch has resumed its
normal (non-actuated) condition.
If no other resetting is required, refer to "Replacement
Cartridge" and complete steps 1 through 5.
REPLACEMENT CARTRIDGE
To complete the recharge and resetting procedures:
Remove shipping cap and weigh replacement cartridge.
Replace if weight is 1/2 ounce (14.2 g), or more, below
weight stamped on cartridge.
Make certain regulated release mechanism is cocked and
lock pin is installed. Then, install replacement cartridge into
the regulated release assembly and each regulated actua-
tor receiver and hand tighten.
Remove lock pin.
Snap cover on regulated release and each regulated actua-
tor assembly, insert visual seal (Part No. 197) in upper and
lower cover hole and secure.
Before installing cover, make certain detection tension
lever is secured in the "DOWN" position to enable auto-
matic detection and operation of the AUTOMAN Regulated
Release.
Record recharge date on tag attached to unit and/or in a
permanent file.
R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual SECTION 8— MAINTENANCE EXAMINATION
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 8-1
The maintenance information listed in this section deals with
the limitations and parameters of this pre-engineered system.
Those individuals responsible for the maintenance of the R-102
system must be trained and hold a current ANSUL certificate in
an R-102 training program.
Maintenance is required semi-annually. At the 12 year interval,
along with the normal maintenance exam, the tank(s) must be
hydro-tested and the regulator(s) must be flow tested.
Prior to performing the required maintenance steps, verify that
the R-1 02 system protection is designed and installed correctly
for the existing appliance and ventilation system configuration. If
not, make corrections as required.
SEMI-ANNUAL MAINTENANCE EXAMINATION
Semi-annual maintenance procedures for single, double, and
multiple-tank systems are as follows.
NOTICE
Under certain circumstances hood and
duct cleaning operations may render the
fire suppression system ineffective due to a
coating of cleaning chemical left on the detec-
tion equipment or mishandling of the system
by cleaning service personnel. Therefore, it
is strongly recommended that the R-102
system be completely inspected and
serviced by an authorized ANSUL distribu-
tor immediately following any such clean-
ing operations.
Remove the enclosure cover from the AUTOMAN
regulated release assembly and each regulated actuator
assembly.
Insert the lock bar (Part No. 14985) or lock pin (Part No.
438031) on the cocked regulated release mechanism. See
Figure 8-1 or Figure 8-2.
FIGURE 8-2
009462
Remove cartridge from regulated release assembly and
each regulated actuator assembly, install safety shipping
cap, and set aside in a safe location.
Check to make certain the actuation line used to connect
the regulated actuator assembly(s) to the AUTOMAN regu-
lated release assembly is connected to the high pressure
side (right side) of the cartridge receiver in the AUTOMAN
and that it is intact, with all fittings securely tightened. This
includes any 1/8 in. copper tubing and fittings used to
connect to the air cylinder for the ANSUL mechanical gas
valve.
tUI I [SJ
If the actuation line leaks pressure, the regulated actuator
assembly(s) may not operate. A severe leak can render
the entire system inoperable.
To check for leaks in the actuation line, a hand held or
electric vacuum pump may be used:
Disconnect the actuation line from the AUTOMAN regu-
lated release cartridge receiver and connect the pump to
the line.
The pump should pull a vacuum to 20 inches of mercury,
as shown on the gauge. Leaks should not exceed 5
inches of mercury loss within a 30 second time frame.
If the gauge indicates a leak in the line, examine for
loose connections or damage. Repair or replace as
needed.
LOCK EAR
PROPERLY
INSTALLED
(PIN
ERLY.
6LLED
If leakage is not due to piping, disassemble the pneu-
FIGURE 8-1 matic actuator assembly(s) in the regulated actuator(s)
000321 and inspect the actuator and the 0-ring in the actuator.
Repair or replace as needed.
Note: Vacuum pumps can be obtained from automotive
parts/supply stores.
SECTION 8 - MAINTENANCE EXAMINATION
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 8-2 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
SEMI-ANNUAL MAINTENANCE EXAMINATION (Continued)
Alternate Test Method:
The actuation line can also be pressurized with either CO2
or N2 from a cartridge or with dry air, CO2, or N2 from a
larger cylinder.
Cock the AUTOMAN regulated release assembly and
carefully insert lock bar (Part No. 14985) or lock pin (Part
No. 438031). See Figure 8-9 or Figure 8-10.
Make certain expellant gas line hose and/or pipe from
the regulator in the AUTOMAN regulated release is
disconnected from agent storage tanks.
Connect Regulator Test Kit (Part No. 56972) to one
of the expellant gas line hoses and securely cap the
remaining hose or pipe. See Figure 8-12.
Verify that no cartridges are installed in the AUTOMAN
or the regulated actuator assembly(s).
To verify operation of the regulated actuator assem-
bly(s), Pressure Adaptor (Part No. 427560) can be used
to connect to a pressurized CO2 or N2 cylinder, instead
of using a CO2 or N2 cartridge.
R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
Once the pneumatic actuator is disassembled, remove
the actuator piston assembly and check the interior
walls of the actuator body for signs of damage or corro-
sion.
Check the 0-ring for elasticity or cuts. Replace, if
necessary. Clean and coat 0-ring with a good grade of
extreme temperature silicone grease and reinstall.
Re-assemble the actuator assembly(s), and reconnect
all actuation and all expellant piping or hose.
Remove gasket from cartridge receiver in regulated release
mechanism and each regulated actuator. Check gasket for
elasticity or cuts and replace Gasket (Part No. 181) if neces-
sary. Clean and coat gasket lightly with a good grade of
extreme temperature grease. Reinstall gasket into cartridge
receiver(s).
From tank in regulated release assembly: Disconnect the
expellant gas hose from each tank adaptor assembly.
From tank in bracket/enclosure assembly: Disconnect the
expellant gas piping union at each tank adaptor inlet line.
Disconnect distribution piping union at each tank adaptor
outlet line.
Note: The pressure adaptor assembly comes with a 1/4 in.
NPT pipe plug that is required to be installed in the side of 9. From tank in enclosure: Remove tank. Keep in upright posi-
tion to avoid spilling the agent. the adaptor.
Install a suitable 1/4 inch air pressure quick connect From tank in bracket assembly: Loosen wingnut, disengage
fitting (supplied by others) to the bottom of the adaptor. bracket band, and remove each tank. Keep tank in upright
position to avoid spilling the agent. Install and hand tighten the adaptor to the cartridge
receiver and securely attach the corresponding connec- 10. Remove tank adaptor/tube assembly from each tank. See
tor from the gas cylinder hose assembly. Figure 8-3.
With the valve on the regulator test kit closed, remove
the lock bar or lock pin and operate the remote cable
operated pull station to operate the regulated release.
Open the pressure cylinder valve to verify that the regu-
lated actuator assembly(s) has operated properly and the
air cylinder has unlatched the ANSUL mechanical gas.
valve, if used.
Once regulated actuator and gas valve operation is veri-
fied, close the valve on the pressurized cylinder, if used,
and open the valve on the regulator test kit to relieve any
residual pressure.
Note: Although only required at 12 year intervals, the
regulator in the AUTOMAN regulated release can also be
verified. See Maintenance steps on page 8-6.
Re-cock the AUTOMAN regulated release and remove
the spent cartridge or pressure adaptor from the cartridge
receiver.
I. If there were leaks in the actuation line or in the 1/8 inch
copper gas tubing for the air cylinder(s), re-tighten the
fittings or replace damaged components.
m. If the cartridge puncture pin in the regulated actuator(s)
did not fully extend, dismantle the actuator and inspect
components of the actuator assembly.
FIGURE 8-3
000291
11. Make certain that each tank is filled with 1.5 (5.8 L) or 3.0
(11.6 L) gallons of only ANSULEX Low pH Liquid Fire
Suppressant. Fill level to be ONLY to the level indicated
in the "Installation" section. See Page 5-3, Figure 5-6, for
detailed filling tolerances.
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
SEMI-ANNUAL MAINTENANCE EXAMINATION (Continued)
Alternate Test Method: (Continued)
Examine threads on each tank adaptor and tank collar for
nicks, burrs, or cross-threading. Clean and coat 0-ring with
a good grade of extreme temperature grease. See Figure
8-4. Remove 1/4 in. vent plug and clean and inspect for
free movement and corrosion (if necessary, replace Vent
Plug (Part No. 74247)). Reinstall vent plug. Make certain
bursting disc is in place and silver side is away from tank.
Clean seating surface and return adaptor/tube assembly to
each tank. Tighten securely.
SILVER SIDE OF DISC
AWAY FROM TANK
FIGURE 8-4
000364
Place fully charged tanks in enclosures and/or brackets and
secure.
Carefully assemble and wrench tighten all expellant gas and
agent distribution piping.
Remove blow-off caps from nozzles. Inspect each blow-off
cap and replace if deteriorated. On older style metal blow-
off caps with spring clips, make certain Spring clip rotates
freely on cap. On newer metal blow-off caps, make certain
integral 0-ring is intact and undamaged. If there are signs of
deterioration, replace cap(s).
Verify that all nozzle types are correct. Check all nozzles
to ensure that they are free of cooking grease build-up and
have a thin coating of clean silicone grease across the
orifice.
Note: Do not allow silicone grease to enter nozzle orifice.
Note: If there is any evidence of cooking grease or other
residue in the nozzles or distribution piping or agent or
agent residue in the distribution piping, the entire piping
network must be inspected and thoroughly cleaned.
Portions of piping that cannot be thoroughly cleaned must
be replaced.
Utilizing the Nozzle Aiming Device (Part No. 431992 or Part
No. 439877) ensure that all nozzles are correctly aimed at
the appropriate location on the appliance. Reinstall blow-off
caps.
SECTION 8— MAINTENANCE EXAMINATION
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 8-3
Remove the lock bar or lock pin and manually test the regu-
lated release assembly by operating the remote manual
pull station. Check pull station cover for damage or wear.
Replace cover if cable has worn a groove in the cover as
deep as the diameter of the cable. If flexible conduit is used
in installation, check conduit for damage, cuts and sharp
bends.
Cock the regulated release mechanism using cocking lever
0. (Part No. 14995 or 435603/Part No. 441042 or 441041).
See Figure 8-5.
Before proceeding with Step 18, test electric (snap-action)
switches:
With the AUTOMAN in the cocked or ready position,
press the lever of each switch up. If the switch is working
properly, there should be an audible click.
With the AUTOMAN in the fired position, press the lever
of each switch up, there should be no audible click.
If an audible click is heard in the fired position several
adjustments can be made. The trip lever extension pin
can be rotated so the peak of one of the hex points is
pointed up against the switch levers. Tighten it in that
position. If this doesn't resolve the problem, loosen the
screws holding the switches, apply a small counterclock-
wise torque on the switches and retighten the screws. If
necessary, a final adjustment can be made by removing
the snap action switch and bending the lever slightly.
After adjustments, repeat Steps a. and b. Then, recock
AUTOMAN and insert lock bar or lock pin.
FIGURE 8-5
006400
NOTICE
.. '...
,-p Rubber blow-off caps that have been
installed in the system for one year or
more must be replaced.
SECTION 8— MAINTENANCE EXAMINATION
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 8-4 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
SEMI-ANNUAL MAINTENANCE EXAMINATION (Continued)
Alternate Test Method: (Continued)
19. Raise tension lever to "UP" position. See Figure 8-6.
FIGURE 8-6
000322
Install test link (Part No. 24916) in terminal detector.
Lower tension lever to "DOWN" position. See Figure 8-7.
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
Remove and destroy all existing fusible links from the termi-
nal and series detector brackets and replace with proper-
ly-rated ANSUL approved, fusible links in accordance with
NFPA 17A.
Inspect wire rope at all detector locations, pulley elbows,
pulley tee and at AUTOMAN release. If wire rope shows
signs of wear or fraying, replace entire length.
Lower the tension lever to "DOWN" position.
Recock the regulated release mechanism and insert the
lock bar or lock pin.
Inspect the base of the wire rope locking clamp to make
certain that there is a minimum of 1/4 in. (6.4 mm) and a
maximum of 3/8 in. (9.5 mm) clearance between the base of
the trip hammer locking clamp assembly and the cable lever
assembly. See Figure 8-8.
TRIP HAMMER
ASSEMBLY fll] LOCKING
CLAMP
1/4 IN. (6.4 mm)
MINIMUM
3/8 IN. (9.5 mm)
MAXIMUM
TENSION LEVER
IN "UP" POSITION
CABLE LEVER
ASSEMBLY
TENSION LEVER
IN DOWN" POSITION
(5
FIGURE 8-8
000329
NOTICE
FIGURE 8-7
001000
Using wire cutter, cut test link at terminal detector to simu-
late automatic actuation.
NOTICE
If regulated release mechanism does not
actuate, refer to Steps 2 and 3 of "Testing
Detection System" in "Testing and Placing
in Service," Section 6, Page 6-3.
After successful actuation, raise the tension lever to "UP"
position.
If clearance is not between 1/4
in. (6.4 mm) or 3/8 in. (9.5 mm),
raise tension lever to "UP" position,
raise trip hammer 3/8-1/2 in. (9.5-
12.7 mm), tighten set screws, and repeat
Steps 24 and 26.
For scissor-style linkage, locate linkage and properly posi-
tion in each bracket all the way toward termination end of
detection run.
If a mechanical gas valve is installed, begin the test proce-
dure by removing both side covers.
At the regulated release, push the air cylinder rod fully
down.
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
SEMI-ANNUAL MAINTENANCE EXAMINATION (Continued)
Alternate Test Method: (Continued)
32. The gas valve should operate.
33. Pull the air cylinder rod to its fully extended position.
34. Re-cock the gas valve by pulling the valve stem up until the
pin in the stem engages the cocking lever.
35. Reinstall side covers on the gas valve and connect the
visual indication seal.
36. Test electric switches and electric gas valves by completing
steps on Page 6-2 in Section 6, "Testing and Placing In
Service."
37. Before reinstalling cartridge, reset all additional equipment
by referring to appropriate section of "Recharge and Resetting
Procedures," Section 7.
38. Remove shipping cap and weigh each cartridge. Replace if
weight is 1/2 ounce (14.2 g), or more, below weight stamped
on cartridge.
39. Make certain regulated release mechanism is cocked and
lock bar or lock pin is installed, then screw replacement
cartridge into regulated release mechanism and each regu-
lated actuator receiver(s) and hand tighten.
40. Remove lock bar or lock pin.
Make certain tension lever is in the "DOWN" position after
completing all tests. Failure to put the tension lever in the
"DOWN" position will cause the system to not operate
automatically.
41. Snap cover on regulated release and each regulated actua-
tor, insert visual seal (Part No. 197) through holes in cover
and box, and secure.
42. If system contains an Agent Distribution Hose and
Restraining Cable Assembly, also perform the following
steps:
Carefully pull or push out the appliance and verify that
the Restraining Cable limits the travel of the appliance
and prevents the application of any pull force or bending
stress on the Agent Distribution Hose or hose-to-pipe
connections.
Check the Restraining Cable to verify it is not frayed
and is securely fastened to the appliance and the wall or
restraining location.
Check the hose and hose fittings and verify that the
hose remains in a vertical natural loop with no noticeable
fatigue at hose end couplings, no hose twists, no hose
kinking or sharp bends.
Check the outer hose covering for signs of damage,
checking, tears, or wear. If any of these signs are
observed, replace the hose.
SECTION 8— MAINTENANCE EXAMINATION
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 8-5
Return the appliance to its normal operating position.
Again, check the hose and hose fittings to verify that
the hose does not have sharp bends, and is not kinked,
twisted, or caught on anything behind the appliance.
If any of these conditions exist, the hose and/or hose
connections, will require installation modifications.
With the appliance in its normal operating position,
check the hose bend to make certain the bend is not
less than a 3 in. (77 mm) bend radius (6 in. (153 mm)
diameter). If less, replace hose.
Verify that the appliance is returned to its original desired
location. Failure to do so may result in undue stress and
fatigue of the hose and hose connections.
43. Record semi-annual maintenance date on tag attached to
unit and/or in a permanent file.
ANNUAL MAINTENANCE EXAMINATION
In addition to performing all the steps necessary for Semi-
Annual Maintenance, disconnect the agent discharge piping
from the storage tank outlet(s) and verify that the agent distribu-
tion piping is not obstructed.
At least annually, use dry air or nitrogen and blow through
the agent distribution piping with the nozzle blow-off caps
removed, verifying that dry air or nitrogen is discharging at
each nozzle location.
If nozzles show signs of cooking grease migration into
the orifice of the nozzle, or if there is evidence of agent
residue in the nozzle(s) or the inlet to the agent distribution
piping, some or all of the piping may require dismantling to
verify that the piping is not obstructed.
At least annually, all rubber nozzle blow-off caps must be
replaced.
Note: Annual replacement is not necessary for metal blow-off
caps.
SECTION 8 - MAINTENANCE EXAMINATION
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 8-6 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
12-YEAR MAINTENANCE EXAMINATION
In addition to performing all of the steps necessary for semi-an-
nual and annual maintenance, the following twelve-year mainte-
nance procedures for single, double, and multiple-tank systems
must be performed.
NOTICE
Under certain circumstances hood and duct
cleaning operations may render your fire
suppression system ineffective due to a
coating of cleaning chemical left on the detec-
tion equipment or mishandling of the system
by cleaning service personnel.
Therefore, it is strongly recommended that
the R-102 system be completely inspected
and serviced by an authorized ANSUL
distributor immediately following any
such cleaning operations.
At twelve-year intervals, the liquid agent
tank(s) must be hydrostatically tested and
refilled with a fresh charge of ANSULEX
Low pH Liquid Fire Suppressant. The date of
manufacture is stamped on the bottom of the
agent tank or on the tank label.
Remove the enclosure cover from the AUTOMAN
regulated release assembly and each regulated actuator
assembly.
2. Insert the lock bar (Part No. 14985) or lock pin (Part No.
438031) on the cocked regulated release mechanism. See
Figure 8-9 or Figure 8-10.
FIGURE 8-9
000321
)CK PIN
ROPERLY
ISTALLED
FIGURE 8-10
009462
Remove cartridge from regulated release assembly and
each regulated actuator assembly, install safety shipping
cap, and set aside in a safe location.
Do not reinstall cartridge at this time or system may be
actuated.
Remove gasket from cartridge receiver in regulated release
mechanism and each regulated actuator. Check gasket for
elasticity or cuts and replace Gasket (Part No. 181) if neces-
sary. Clean and coat gasket lightly with a good grade of
extreme temperature grease. Reinstall gasket into cartridge
receiver(s).
From tank in enclosure: Disconnect the expellant gas piping
or hose from each tank adaptor assembly.
From tank in bracket assembly: Disconnect expellant gas
piping union at each tank adaptor inlet line.
Disconnect distribution piping union at each tank adaptor
outlet line.
From tank in enclosure: Remove tank.
From tank in bracket assembly: Loosen wingnut, disengage
bracket band, and remove each tank. Keep tank in upright
position to avoid spilling the agent.
Loosen tank adaptor/tube assembly and remove.
LOCK BAR
PROPERLY
INSTALLED
Date Code Table
UL541L
Month*
Jan A
Feb B
Mar C
Apr D
May E
Jun F
Jul G
Aug H
Sep J
Oct K
Nov L
Dec M
Year*
1981 K
1982 L
1983 M
1984 N
1985 P
1986 R
1987 S
1988 T
1989 U
1990 V
1991 W
1992 V
1993 Z
1994 A
1995 B
1996 C
1997 D
1998 E
1999 F
2000 G
2001 H
2002 J
2003 K
2004 L
2005 M
*STAMPED MONTH 1ST, YEAR
2ND
UL74FF
Year*
2005 E
2006 F
2007 G
2008 H
2009 I
2010 J
2011 K
Month**
Jan A
Feb B
Mar C
Apr 0
May E
Jun F
Jul G
Aug H
Sep
Oct J
Nov K
Dec L
*STAMPED YEAR 1ST, MONTH
2ND
**STAMPED "I" FOR SEPTEMBER
UL74FF
Month* Year*
2011
2012
2013
2014
2015
2016
2017
2018
2019
2020
2021
2022
Jan A T
Feb B Ui
Mar C U2
Apr D U3
May E U4
Jun F U5
Jul G U6
Aug H U7
Sep J U8
Oct K U9
Nov L Vi
Dec M V2
2023 V3
2024 V4
2025 V5
*STAMPED MONTH 1ST, YEAR
2ND
SECTION 8— MAINTENANCE EXAMINATION
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 8-7
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
12-YEAR MAINTENANCE EXAMINATION (Continued)
Safety glasses should be worn during transfer operations
of ANSULEX Low pH Liquid Fire Suppressant. Avoid
contact with skin or eyes. In case of contact, flush immedi-
ately with water for 15 minutes. If irritation persists, contact
a physician. Do not take internally. If taken internally do
not induce vomiting. Dilute with water or milk and contact
a physician.
Pour the liquid agent from the tank into a clean, plastic
container, and flush tank with clear water.
At this point, each liquid agent tank, including the 1/4 in.
gas hose assembly, must be HYDROSTATICALLY
TESTED to 330 psi (26.6 bar). Refer to "Hydrostatic Test
Instructions," F-7602, for test adaptors and instructions.
NOTICE
DO NOT hydrostatically test a red painted
mild steel agent storage tank. Instead,
replace the tank with a new stainless
steel tank shipping assembly (3 Gallon
(Part No. 429862) or 1.5 Gallon (Part No.
429864)).
Verify date stamped on cartridge. The cartridge must also
be hydrotested at intervals not greater than 12 years.
(European cartridges are not refillable, therefore cannot be
hydrotested and refilled. They must be discarded).
If cartridge date indicates the need for hydrotesting, the
cartridge must be bled down through normal AUTOMAN
release operation, returned to Tyco Fire Protection Products
for credit (or hydrotested by properly trained personnel at
authorized cartridge refilling stations), and replaced with a
charged, replacement cartridge.
NOTICE
Cartridge bleed down can be used to
verify pneumatic accessories operation.
If system contains an Agent Distribution Hose and
Restraining Cable Assembly, a hydrostatic test is required
at 220 psi (15.2 bar) for hose assembly.
The regulator must be flow tested at 12 year intervals.
Check the date code stamped on the regulator body to
determine if the regulator(s) requires the 12 year testing
(see data code table). If regulator does not require testing,
proceed to step 12. Flow test the regulator(s) per the follow-
ing table:
SECTION 8— MAINTENANCE EXAMINATION
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 8-8 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
12-YEAR MAINTENANCE EXAMINATION (Continued)
Step 14 (Continued)
a. Regulated Release Mechanism
For First Tank: Disconnect expellant gas pipe or hose
from tank. Connect regulator test kit (Part No. 56972) to
hose. See Figure 8-11.
FIGURE 8-11
003369
For Second Tank: Disconnect expellant gas piping at
union. Remove union from expellant gas piping and install
pipe cap to prevent cartridge pressure from escaping
during test. See Figure 8-12.
FIGURE 8-12
000370
Pressure Switch: If an ANSUL supplied pressure switch
is still in good operating condition, it should remain
connected as part of system maintenance test.
NOTICE
For multiple-tank systems, one test kit
(Part No. 56972) is required for each
regulator in the system.
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
b. Regulated Actuator
For First Tank: Disconnect expellant gas hose from tank.
Connect regulator test kit (Part No. 56972) to hose. See
Figure 8-13.
FIGURE 8-13
003371
For Second Tank: Disconnect expellant gas piping at
union. Remove union from expellant gas piping and
install pipe cap to prevent cartridge pressure from
escaping during test. See Figure 8-14.
FIGURE 8-14
000372
NOTICE
Make certain valve is closed on regulator
test kit or pressure will escape before test
can be performed.
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual SECTION 8— MAINTENANCE EXAMINATION
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 8-9
12-YEAR MAINTENANCE EXAMINATION (Continued)
Step 14 (Continued)
Install either a nitrogen or CO2 cartridge into release
mechanism and each regulated actuator provided with the
system. (Cartridge should be conditioned to approximately
70 OF (21 °C) before test.)
NOTICE
Before continuing with Step d, make
certain valve on test kit is closed.
Remove lock bar or lock pin and operate remote manual
pull station to actuate the regulated release and supply
pressure to each test kit.
Two styles of regulators are used with the R-102 release mech-
anisms. The diaphragm style (see Figure 8-15) was used in
R-1 02 systems up to approximately 1988. The piston style (see
Figure 8-15) has been used since 1988. Each style requires a
slightly different flow test procedure. Use the appropriate flow
test procedure as stated in Step e.
DIAPHRAGM STYLE PISTON STYLE
(USED UNTIL 1988) (USED AFTER 1988)
FIGURE 8-15
002301
Flow test each regulator by completing the following
steps:
Diaphragm Style -The correct pressure should read 90
to 110 psi (6.2 to 7.6 bar) with the valve on the test kit
closed and 80 psi (5.5 bar) with the valve on the test kit
opened. Keep the valve opened to completely empty the
pressure cartridge after pressure test has been verified.
Piston Style - Open the valve on the regulator test kit.
The correct pressure should read between 95 to 125 psi
(6.6 to 8.6 bar). Keep the valve open to completely empty
the pressure cartridge.
If necessary, continue to flow test at each additional regu-
lated actuator. Test each regulated actuator by repeating
Step e.
Cock release mechanism using cocking lever (Part No.
14995 or 435603/Part No. 441042 or 441041) and insert
lock bar (Part No. 14985) or lock pin (Part No. 438031).
Remove empty nitrogen cartridge(s) from release mech-
anism and each regulated actuator.
Remove test kit(s) from release mechanism and each
regulated actuator.
If regulator test was not successful, replace regulator.
Reconnect all expellant gas lines.
Reset all additional equipment that was operated by
release mechanism.
15. Examine threads on each adaptor and tank collar for nicks,
burrs, or cross-threading. Clean and coat 0-ring with a good
grade of extreme temperature grease. Make certain burst-
ing disc is in place and silver side is away from tank. See
Figure 8-16.
FIGURE 8-16
Examine pick-up tube for signs of damage or corrosion.
Replace assembly if needed.
Refill each tank with 1.5 (5.8 L) or 3.0 (11.6 L) gallons
of only new ANSULEX Low pH Liquid Fire Suppressant.
Note: Use a funnel with a screen to stop any foreign
material from entering the tank.
During filling, the agent temperature should be 60 OF
to 80 OF (16 °C to 27 "C). DO NOT FILL WITH COLD
AGENT. Refer to the "Installation" section, Page 5-3 for
maximum fill heights for ANSULEX Low pH agent storage
tanks. DO NOT OVERFILL. Overfilling may result in
agent entering gas hose and regulator, potentially causing
system malfunction.
Clean seating surface and return each adaptor/tube assem-
bly to tank. Firmly tighten.
NOTICE
Do not reinstall any tank at this time.
Remove blow-off caps from nozzles. Inspect each blow-off
cap and replace if deteriorated. On older style metal blow-
off caps with spring clips, make certain spring clip rotates
freely on cap. On newer metal blow-off caps, make certain
integral 0-ring is intact and undamaged. If there are signs of
deterioration, replace cap(s).
NOTICE
Rubber blow-off caps that have been
installed in the system for one year or
more must be replaced.
iq
Io
C
/
' '••s_ \6\
TENSION LEVER
IN "UP POSITION
SECTION 8— MAINTENANCE EXAMINATION
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 8-10 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
.
db 12-YEAR MAINTENANCE EXAMINATION (Continued)
20. Check all nozzles to ensure that they are free of cooking
grease build-up and have a covering of clean silicone
grease on the orifice. Reinstall blow-off caps.
0 11
21. Remove lock bar or lock pin and manually test the regulated
release assembly by operating the remote manual pull
station.
22. Cock the regulated release mechanism using cocking lever
(Part No. 14995 or 435603/Part No. 441042 or 441041).
See Figure 8-17.
FIGURE 8-17
000000
5 23. Raise the tension lever to "UP" position. See Figure 8-18.
.'
S
S
S
FIGURE 8-18
000362
W 24. Install test link (Part No. 24916) in terminal detector.
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
25. Lower tension lever to "DOWN" position. See Figure 8-19.
TENSION LEVER
IN DOWN" POSITION
FIGURE 8-19
001000
Using wire cutter, cut test link at terminal detector to simu-
late automatic actuation.
NOTICE
If regulated release mechanism does not
actuate, refer to Steps 2 and 3 of "Testing
Detection System" in "Testing and Placing
in Service," Section 6.
After successful actuation, raise the tension lever to "UP"
position.
Remove and destroy all existing fusible links from the
terminal and series detector brackets and replace with
properly-rated ANSUL approved, fusible links in accordance
with NFPA 17A.
Lower tension lever to "DOWN" position.
Recock the regulated release mechanism and insert lock
P. bar or lock pin.
R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual SECTION 8— MAINTENANCE EXAMINATION
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 8-11
12-YEAR MAINTENANCE EXAMINATION (Continued) 39. Remove lock bar or lock pin.
Inspect the base of the wire rope locking clamp to make 40. Install cover on regulated release assembly and each regu-
certain that there is a minimum of 1/4 in. (6.4 mm) and a lated actuator assembly and secure with appropriate fasten-
maximum of 3/8 in. (9.5 mm) clearance between the base of ers or visual inspection seal. Insert seal (Part No. 197) in
the trip hammer locking clamp assembly and the cable lever each upper and lower cover hole, if applicable. If system is
assembly. See Figure 8-20. installed in an OEM enclosure, attach enclosure cover and
secure with appropriate hardware or procedure.
TRIP HAMMER ASSEMBLY LOCKING
CLAMP
_____________________________
' i I Before installing cover, make certain tension lever is in the
1/4 IN. (6.4 mm) "DOWN" position after completing all tests. Failure to put
MINIMUM the tension lever in the "DOWN" position will cause the
3/8 IN. (9.5 mm) system to not operate automatically. MAXIMUM
41. Record date of 12 year maintenance examination on tag
attached to enclosure and/or in a permanent file.
HAMMER
BASE
FIGURE 8-20
000329
NOTICE
If clearance is not between 1/4 in. (6.4
mm) or 3/8 in. (9.5 mm), raise tension
lever to "UP" position, raise trip hammer
3/8-1/2 in. (9.5-12.7 mm), tighten set
screws, and repeat Steps 29 and 31.
Locate detector linkage and properly position in each
bracket.
Make certain additional devices have operated as intended.
Before reinstalling cartridge, reset all additional equip-
ment by referring to appropriate section of "Recharge and
Resetting Procedures," Section 7.
Place each fully charged tank in enclosure and/or bracket
and secure.
Reconnect all distribution piping and expellant gas piping
unions as required. Wrench tighten.
Check each gas cartridge by removing shipping cap and
weighing cartridge. Replace if weight is 1/2 ounce (14.2 g),
or more, below weight stamped on cartridge.
Make certain regulated release mechanism is cocked and
lock bar or lock pin is installed, then screw replacement
cartridge into regulated release mechanism and each regu-
lated actuator receiver(s) and hand tighten.
SECTION 8— MAINTENANCE EXAMINATION R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 8-12 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
NOTES:
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual SECTION 9— APPENDIX
UL EX3470 U LC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 9-1
SYSTEM SELECTION GUIDE
Note: System options do not cover all conceivable/acceptable variations. They are listed here as a general guideline to show
the most common type arrangement for multiple systems. Based on certain system designs utilizing manifolding, non-manifolding,
3-tank systems, etc., other tank/cartridge combinations can be designed. The combinations below are based on 11 flow, 3 gallon tanks
and 5 flow, 1.5 gallon tanks. More competitive designs may be available by utilizing 12 flow and 6 flow systems when appropriate.
Total Tank Type of Carbon Dioxide Nitrogen
Flow No.* Quantity System Type of Hardware Cartridge Required Cartridge Required
1-5 1 Single 1.5 Gal. Reg. Release 101-10 (423439) LT-20-R (423429)
6-11 1 Single 3 Gal. Reg. Release 101-20 (423441) LT-30-R (423435)
12-16 2 Double 1.5 Gal. Reg. Release 101-30 (423443) Double (423493)
3 Gal. Additional Tank
17-22 2 Double 3 Gal. Reg. Release 101-30 (423443)** Double (423493)
3 Gal. Additional Tank
17-22 2 Manifold 3 Gal. Reg. Release - Double (423493)
3 Gal. Additional Tank
23-27 3 Multiple 1.5 Gal. Reg. Release 101-10 (423439) LT-20-R (423429)
3 Gal. Reg. Actuator 101-30 (423443)*** LT-A-1 01-30 (42349 1)
3 Gal. Additional Tank
23-33 3 Multiple 3 Gal. Reg. Release 101-20 (423441) LT-30-R (423435)
3 Gal. Reg. Actuator 101-30 (423443)*** LT-A-101-30 (42349 1)
3 Gal. Additional Tank
23-33 3 Multiple 3 Gal. Reg. Release N/A Double (423493)
(Optional) (2) 3 Gal. Additional Tanks
34-38 4 Multiple 1.5 Gal. Reg. Release 101-10 (423439) LT-20-R (423435)
3 Gal. Reg. Actuator N/A LT-A-1 01-30 (423491)
Double 3 Gal. Tank Box
34-38 4 Multiple 1.5 Gal. Reg. Release 101-30 (423443) Double (423493)
(Optional) 3 Gal. Additional Tank
3 Gal. Reg. Actuator 101-30 (423443)*** LT-A-101-30 (42349 1)
3 Gal. Additional Tank
39-44 4 Multiple 3 Gal. Reg. Release 101-20 (423441) LT-30-R (423435)
3 Gal. Reg. Actuator N/A LT-A-1 01-30 (423491)
Double 3 Gal. Tank Box
39-44 4 Multiple 3 Gal. Reg. Release 101-30 (423443)** Double (423493)
(Optional) 3 Gal. Additional Tank
3 Gal. Reg. Actuator 101-30 (423443)*** LT-A-101-30 (42349 1)
3 Gal. Additional Tank
45-49 5 Multiple 1.5 Gal. Reg. Release 101-30 (423443) Double (423493)
3 Gal. Additional Tank
3 Gal. Reg. Actuator N/A LT-A-101-30 (42349 1)
Double 3 Gal. Tank Box
* Based on 5 flow numbers for a 1.5 gal system and 11 flow numbers for a 3 gal. system.
** f tanks are manifolded, Only a 'double tank" nitrogen cartridge (Part No. 423493) can be used.
If tanks are manifolded, either an LT-A-101-30 nitrogen cartridge (Part No. 423491) Or a double tank cartridge (Part No. 423493) can be used.
SECTION 9— APPENDIX R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 9-2 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
SYSTEM SELECTION GUIDE (Continued)
Total Tank Type of Carbon Dioxide Nitrogen
Flow No.* Quantity System Type of Hardware Cartridge Required Cartridge Required
45-49 5 Multiple 1.5 Gal. Reg. Release 101-10 (423439) LT-20-R (423429)
(Optional) 3 Gal. Reg. Actuator 101-30 (423443)*** LT-A-101-30 (423491)
3 Gal. Additional Tank
3 Gal. Reg. Actuator 101-30 (423443)*** LT-A-1 01-30 (423491)
3 Gal. Additional Tank
50-55 5 Multiple 3 Gal. Reg. Release 101-30 (423443) Double (423493)
3 Gal. Additional Tank
3 Reg. Actuator N/A LT-A-101-30 (423491)
Double 3 Gal. Tank Box
50-55 5 Multiple 3 Gal. Reg. Release 101-20 (423441) LT-30-R (423435)
(Optional) 3 Gal. Reg. Actuator 101 -30 (423443)*** LT-A-101-30 (42349 1)
3 Gal. Additional Tank
3 Gal. Reg. Actuator 101-30 (423443)*** LT-A-1 01-30 (423491)
3 Gal. Additional Tank
56-60 6 Multiple 1.5 Gal. Reg. Release 101-30 (423443) Double (423493)
3 Gal. Additional Tank
3 Gal. Reg. Actuator 101-30 (423443)*** LT-A-1 01-30 (423491)
3 Gal. Additional Tank
3 Gal. Reg. Actuator 101-30 (423443)*** LT-A-1 01-30 (42349 1)
- 3 Gal. Additional Tank
61-66 6 Multiple 3 Gal. Reg. Release 101-30 (423443)** Double (423493)
3 Gal. Additional Tank
3 Gal. Reg. Actuator 101-30 (423443)*** LT-A-101-30 (423491)
3 Gal. Additional Tank
3 Gal. Reg. Actuator 101-30 (423443)*** LT-A-101-30 (42349 1)
3 Gal. Additional Tank
67-71 7 Multiple 1.5 Gal. Reg. Release 101-10 (423439) LT-20-R (423429)
(2) 3 Gal. Reg. Actuator N/A (2) LT-A-101-30 (423491)
(2) Double 3 Gal. Tank Box
67-71 7 Multiple Remote Mechanical Release 101-10 (423439) - -
(Optional) 3 Gal. Reg. Actuator 101-30 (423443) LT-A-1 01-30 (423491)
1.5 Gal. Additional Tank
3 Gal. Reg. Actuator 101-30 (423443)*** LT-A-101-30 (42349 1)
3 Gal. Additional Tank
3 Gal: Reg. Actuator 101-30 (423443)*** LT-A-1 01-30 (42349 1)
3 Gal. Additional Tank
3 Gal. Reg. Actuator 101-20 (423441)-** LT-30-R (423435)
72-77 7 Multiple 3 Gal. Reg. Release 101-20 (423441) LT-30-R (423435)
(2) 3 Gal. Reg. Actuator N/A (2) LT-A-101-30 (42349 1)
(2) Double 3 Gal. Tank Box
72-77 7 Multiple Remote Mechanical Release 101-10 (423439) --
(Optional) 3 Gal. Reg. Actuator 101-30 (423443)*** LT-A-1 01-30 (423491)
3 Gal. Additional Tank
3 Gal. Reg. Actuator 101-30 (423443)*** LT-A-1 01-30 (423491)
3 Gal. Additional Tank
3 Gal. Reg. Actuator 101-30 (423443)*** LT-A-101-30 (42349 1)
3 Gal. Additional Tank
3 Gal. Reg. Actuator 101-20 (423441) LT-30-R (423435)
Based on 5 flow numbers for a 1.5 gal. system and 11 flow numbers for a 3 gal. system.
** If tanks are manitolded, only a double tank' nitrogen cartridge (Part No. 423493) can be used.
If tanks are manifolded, either an LT-A-101-30 nitrogen cartridge (Part No. 423491) or a double tank cartridge (Part No. 423493) can be used.
R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual SECTION 9— APPENDIX
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 9-3
SYSTEM SELECTION GUIDE (Continued)
Total Tank Type of
Flow No.* Quantity System
78-82 8 MLltiple
Type of Hardware
1.5 Gal. Reg. Release
3 Gal. Additional Tank
(2) 3 Gal. Reg. Actuator
(2) Double 3 Gal. Tank Box
Remote Mechanical Release
3 Gal. Reg. Actuator
1.5 Gal. Additional Tank
3 Gal. Reg. Actuator
3 Gal. Additional Tank
3 Gal. Reg. Actuator
3 Gal. Additional Tank
3 Gal. Reg. Actuator
3 Gal. Additional Tank
Carbon Dioxide
Cartridge Required
101-30 (423443)
N/A
101-10 (423439)
101-30 (423443)
101-30 (423443)***
101-30 (423443)***
101-30 (423443)***
Nitrogen
Cartridge Required
LT-30-R (423435)
(2) LT-A-1 01-30 (423491)
LT-A-1 01-30 (423491)
LT-A-1 01-30 (423491)
LT-A-1 01-30 (423491)
LT-A-1 01-30 (423491)
78-82 8 Multiple
(Optional)
83-88 8
83-88 8
(Optional)
Multiple 3 Gal. Reg. Release
3 Gal. Additional Tank
(2) 3 Gal. Reg. Actuator
(2) Double 3 Gal. Tank Box
Multiple Remote Mechanical Release
3 Gal. Reg. Actuator
3 Gal. Additional Tank
3 Gal. Reg. Actuator
3 Gal. Additional Tank
3 Gal. Reg. Actuator
3 Gal. Additional Tank
3 Gal. Reg. Actuator
3 Gal. Additional Tank
101-30 (423443) LT-30-R (423435)
N/A (2) LT-A-101-30 (423491)
101-10 (423439)
101-30 (423443)*** LT-A-1 01-30 (423491)
101-30 (423443)*** LT-A-1 01-30 (423491)
101-30 (423443)*** LT-A-1 01-30 (423491)
101-30 (423443)*** LT-A-1 01 -30 (423491)
89-99 9 Multiple Remote Mech. Release 101-10 (423439)
(3) 3 Gal. Reg. Actuator N/A
(3) Double 3 Gal. Tank Box
89-93 9 Multiple Remote Mechanical Release 101-10 (423439)
(Optional) 3 Gal. Reg. Actuator 101-30 (423443)***
3 Gal. Additional Tank
3 Gal. Reg. Actuator 101-30 (423443)***
3 Gal. Additional Tank
3 Gal. Reg. Actuator 101-30 (423443)***
3 Gal. Additional Tank
3 Gal. Reg. Actuator 101-30 (423443)***
1.5 Gal. Additional Tank
3 Gal. Reg. Actuator 101-20 (423441)
94-99 9 Multiple Remote Mechanical Release 101-10 (423439)
(Optional) 3 Gal. Reg. Actuator 101-30 (423443)***
3 Gal. Additional Tank
3 Gal. Reg. Actuator 101-30 (423443)***
3 Gal. Additional Tank
3 Gal. Reg. Actuator 101-30 (423443)***
3 Gal. Additional Tank
3 Gal. Reg. Actuator 101-30 (423443)***
3 Gal. Additional Tank
3 Gal. Reg. Actuator 101-20 (423441)
* Based on 5 flow numbers for a 1.5 gal. system and 11 flow numbers for a 3 gal. system.
** If tanks are manifolded, only a double tank' nitrogen cartridge (Part No. 423493) can be used.
If tanks are manitolded, either an LT-A-1 O1-30 nitrogen cartridge (Part No. 423491) or a double tank cartridge (Pail No. 423493) can be used.
N/A
(3) LT-A-1 01-30 (423491)
LT-A-101730 (423491)
LT-A-1 01-30 (423491)
LT-A-i 01-30 (42349 1)
LT-A-i 01-30 (42349 1)
LT-30-R (423435)
LT-A-1 01-30 (423491)
LT-A-1 01-30 (423491)
LT-A-i 01-30 (42349 1)
LT-A-1 01-30 (423491)
LT-30-R (423435)
SECTION 9— APPENDIX R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 9-4 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
SYSTEM SELECTION GUIDE (Continued)
Total Tank Type of Carbon Dioxide Nitrogen
Flow No.* Quantity System Type of Hardware Cartridge Required Cartridge Required
100-110 10 Multiple Remote Mech. Release 101-10 (423439) N/A
(3) 3 Gal. Reg. Actuator N/A (3) LT-A-101-30 (423491)
(3) Double 3 Gal. Tank Box
3 Gal. Reg. Actuator 101-20 (423441) LT-30-R (423435)
100-104 10 Multiple Remote Mechanical Release 101-10 (423439) - -
(Optional) 3 Gal. Reg. Actuator 101-30 (423443) LT-A-1 01-30 (423491)
1.5 Gal. Additional Tank
3 Gal. Reg. Actuator 101-30 (423443)*** LT-A-1 01-30 (423491)
3 Gal. Additional Tank
3 Gal. Reg. Actuator 101-30 (423443)*** LT-A-1 01 -30 (423491)
3 Gal. Additional Tank
3 Gal. Reg. Actuator 101-30 (423443)*** LT-A-1 01-30 (423491)
3 Gal. Additional Tank
3 Gal. Reg. Actuator 101-30 (423443)*** LT-A-101-30 (423491)
3 Gal. Additional Tank
100-104 10 Multiple Remote Mech. Release 101-10 (423439) N/A
(Optional) (2) 3 Gal. Reg. Actuator N/A (2) LT-A-101-30 (423491)
(2) Double 3 Gal. Tank Box
(2) 3 Gal. Reg. Actuator (2)101-30 (423443) (2) LT-A-101-30 (423491)
3 Gal. Additional Tank
1.5 Gal. Additional Tank
105-110 10 Multiple Remote Mechanical Release 101-10 (423439) --
(Optional) 3 Gal. Reg. Actuator 101-30 (423443)*** LT-A-101-30 (42349 1)
3 Gal. Additional Tank
3 Gal. Reg. Actuator 101-30 (423443)*** LT-A-101-30 (423491)
3 Gal. Additional Tank
3 Gal. Reg. Actuator 101-30 (423443)*** LT-A-1 01-30 (423491)
3 Gal. Additional Tank
3 Gal. Reg. Actuator 101-30 (423443)*** LT-A-101-30 (423491)
3 Gal. Additional Tank
3 Gal. Reg. Actuator 101-30 (423443)*** LT-A-101-30 (423491)
3 Gal. Additional Tank
Based on 5 flow numbers for a 1.5 gal. system and 11 flow numbers for a 3 gal. system.
If tanks are manifolded, Only a "double tank" nitrogen cartridge (Part No. 423493) can be used.
If tanks are manifolded, either an LT-A-101-30 nitrogen cartridge (Part No. 423491) or a double tank cartridge (Part No. 423493) can be used.
Options are available up to a maximum of 15 tanks. Contact Technical Services Department for detailed information.
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual SECTION 9—APPENDIX
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 9-5
SYSTEM COMPONENT INDEX
Part No. Description
429853 Mechanical AUTOMAN Regulated Release
Shipping Assembly
Includes: Regulated Release Mechanism in
Stainless Steel Mounting Enclosure
429856 Electric AUTOMAN Regulated Release
Shipping Assembly (120VAC)
Includes: Regulated Release Mechanism with
Solenoid and Switch in
Stainless Steel Mounting Enclosure
429850 Regulated Actuator Shipping Assembly
Includes: Actuator and Regulator in
Stainless Steel Mounting Enclosure
429870 Stainless Steel Mounting Box Shipping Assembly
Includes: Stainless Steel Mounting Box
429872 Two Tank EncIosue Shipping Assembly
Includes: Two Expellant Gas Hoses
Two Grcmmets
Stainless Steel Mounting Box
429859 24VDC Regulated Release Shipping Assembly
Includes: 24VDC AUTOMAN Il-C Release
Mechanism in Stainless Steel
Mounting Box
Part No. Description
418054 OEM Regulated Electric Release Shipping
Assembly (120VAC)
Includes: Regulated Release Mechanism with
Solenoid and Switch
1/4 in. Hose and Mounting Bracket
79493 OEM Regulated Mechanical Release Shipping
Assembly
Includes: Regulated Release Mechanism
1/4 in. Hose and Mounting Bracket
418691 OEM Regulated Actuator Shipping Assembly
Includes: Actuator and Regulator
Hose
Bracket
429878 3 Gallon Bracket Assembly
(Bracket Only)
433485 Remote Release Assembly
439946 OEM Remote Release Assembly
418522 OEM Regulated Actuator Shipping Assembly
Includes: Actuator and Regulator
Hose
429862 3 Gallon Tank Shipping Assembly
429864 1.5 Gallon Tank Shipping Assembly 430299 3 Gallon Mechanical Release Shipping Assembly
including: 56972 Regulator Test Kit
429853 Mechanical Regulated Release Assembly Includes: Gauge, Hose and Valve Assembly
429862 3 Gallon Tank Assembly 79694 1.5 Gallon (5.8 L) Container of ANSULEX Low pH
430300 1.5 Gallon Mechanica Release Shipping Assembly Liquid Fire Suppressant
including: 79372 3.0 Gallon (11.6 L) Container of ANSULEX Low 429853 Mechanical Regulated Release Assembly pHLiquid Fire Suppressant 429864 1.5 Gallon Tank Assembly
430309 3 Gallon Regulated Actuator Shipping Assembly
including:
429850 Regulated Actuator Assembly
429862 3 Gallon Tank Assembly
430316 1.5 Gallon Stainless Steel Enclosure Shipping
Assembly including:
429870 Single Tank Mounting Box Assembly
429864 1.5 Gallon Tank Assembly
430317 3 Gallon Stainless Steel Enclosure Shipping
Assembly including:
429870 Single Tank Mounting Box Assembly
429862 3 Gallon Tank Assembly
430324 6 Gallon Stainless Steel Enclosure Shipping
Assembly including:
429872 Two Tank Mounting Box Assembly
429862 3 Gallon Tank Assembly (2)
430332 3 Gallon Mounting Bracket Shipping Assembly
including:
429878 3 Gallon Mounting Bracket Assembly
429862 3 Gallon Tank Assembly
423429 Cartridge Shipping Assembly (LT-20-R) (TC/DOT)
423435 Cartridge Shipping Assembly (LT-30-R) (TC/DOT)
423493 Cartridge Shipping Assembly (R-102 Double-Tank)
(TC/DOT)
423491 Cartridge Shipping Assembly (LT-A-1 01-30)
(TC/DOT)
423439 Cartridge Shipping Assembly (101-10) (TC/DOT)
15850 Cartridge Shipping Assembly (101-10) (DOT)
423441 Cartridge Shipping Assembly (101-20) (TC/DOT)
423443 Cartridge Shipping Assembly (101.30) (TC/DOT)
428440 Cartridge Shipping Assembly (LT-20-R) (European)
428441 Cartridge Shipping Assembly (LT-30-R) (European)
428446 Cartridge Shipping Assembly (R-102 Double Tank)
(European)
428442 Cartridge Shipping Assembly (LT-A-1 01-30)
(European)
SECTION 9 - APPENDIX R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
•
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 9-6 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
SYSTEM COMPONENT INDEX (Continued)
Part No. Description Part No. Description
428443 Cartridge Shipping Assembly (101-10) (European) 419385 Swivel Adaptor Shipping Assembly
428445 Cartridge Shipping Assembly (101-20) (European) Includes: 9 Swivel Adaptors
428444 Cartridge Shipping Assembly (101-30) (European) 423572 Swivel Adaptor Shipping Assembly
Includes: 25 Swivel Adaptors
428948 Cartridge Shipping Assembly (LT-20-R) (Australian) 77695 Blow-Off Cap Shipping Assembly (Spare)
426553 Cartridge Shipping Assembly (LT-30-R) (Australian) Includes: 50 Blow-Off Caps
•
426563 Cartridge Shipping Assembly (R-102 Double Tank) 77411 Blow-Off Cap Shipping Assembly
(Australian) Includes: 12 Blow-Off Caps
426555 Cartridge Shipping Assembly (LT-A-1 01-30) 433208 GB Metal Blow-Off Cap Shipping Assembly
I
(Australian) Includes: 10 Blow-Off Caps
439839 Nozzle Shipping Assembly (1W) p439861 Metal Blow-Oft Cap Shipping Assembly
Includes: 25 1W Nozzles Includes: 10 Blow-Oft Caps
25 Blow-Off Caps 434707 CB Stainless Steel Blow-Oft Cap Shipping Assembly
439837 Nozzle Shipping Assembly (1/2N) Includes: 10 Blow-Off Caps
I
Includes: 9 1/2N Nozzles
9 Blow-Off Caps '439866 Stainless Steel Blow-Off Cap Shipping Assembly
'439838
Includes: 10 Blow-Off Caps
Nozzle Shipping Assembly N) (1
Includes: 25 1 Nozzles '439848 Metal Blow-Oft Cap 0-Ring Shipping Assembly
25 Blow-Off Caps Includes: 25 0-Rings
'439841 Nozzle Shipping Assembly (3N) '416970 In-Line Burst Disc Union Assembly
Includes: 9 3N Nozzles 417911 In-Line Burst Disc Shipping Assembly
9 Blow-Off Caps Includes: 10 Burst Discs
439840 Nozzle Shipping Assembly (2W) 25627 1/4 in. Check Valve
Includes: 25 2W Nozzles
25 Blow-Off Caps 1-551265 Nozzle Aiming Device (without Adaptor)
439842 Nozzle Shipping Assembly (230) I 439877
I
Nozzle Aiming Device with Adaptor
Includes: 25 230 Nozzles I 439876 Aiming Device Adaptor
25 Blow-Oft Caps
435547 Series Detector Shipping Assembly ("Scissor")
0.439843 Nozzle Shipping Assembly (245)
Includes: 25 245 Nozzles 435548 Series Detector, Pack of 25 ("Scissor")
25 Blow-Off Caps 435546 Terminal Detector Shipping Assembly ("Scissor")
'439844 Nozzle Shipping Assembly (260) Includes: Test Link
Includes. 9 260 Nozzles I 435545 Detector Hook Assembly ('Scissor")
9 Blow-Off Caps I
'439515 Detector Hook Assembly ("Scissor") '439845 Nozzle Shipping Assembly (290) Includes: 10 Detectors
Includes: 9 290 Nozzles
9 Blow-Off Caps 415671 Pulley Elbows Shipping Assembly (Socket End) -
to 700 OF (371 "C) 1-439846 Nozzle Shipping Assembly (2120)
Includes: 9 2120 Nozzles
Includes: 50 Elbows
9 Blow-Off Caps 423251 Pulley Elbows Shipping Assembly (Compression
End) — to 700 OF (371 °C) '439836 Nozzle Shipping Assembly (1 F) Includes: 50 Elbows
Includes: 9 1 F Nozzles
9 Blow-Off Caps 427929 Pulley Tee
439865 Stainless Steel Nozzle Shipping Assembly (1 N) 15821 Wire Rope (50 ft (15.2 m))
Includes: 1 Blow-Oft Cap 79653 Wire Rope (500 ft (152.4 m))
'439864 Stainless Steel Nozzle Shipping Assembly (1W) 24919 Stop Sleeve Package
• Includes: 1 Blow-Oft Cap Includes: 10 Stop Sleeves
H
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual SECTION 9— APPENDIX
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 9-7
SYSTEM COMPONENT INDEX (Continued)
Part No. Description Part No. Description
550122 Oval Sleeve Package 426151 Gas Shut-off Equipment (Electrical 110 VAC, 60 Hz)
Includes: 100 Oval Sleeves Includes: Relay - Manual Reset
436063 Conduit Offset Shipping Assembly 423878 One Electric Switch (Field Mounted) Kit
Includes: 6 Conduit Offsets Includes: Electric Switch (SPDT)
78196 1/4 in. "Quik-Seal" Adaptor Package Mounting Hardware
Includes: 24 "Quik-Seals" 423879 Two Electric Switch (Field Mounted) Kit
77285 3/8 in. "Quik-Seal" Adaptor Package Includes: 2 Electric Switches (SPDT)
Mounting Includes: 24 "Quik-Seals" Hardware
77287 1/2 in. "Quik-Seal" Adaptor Package 423880 Three Electric Switch (Field Mounted) Kit
Includes: 24 "Quik-Seals" Includes: 3 Electric Switches (SPDT)
Mounting Hardware
77289 3/4 in. "Quik-Seal" Adaptor Package
Includes: 24 "Quik-Seals" 423881 Four Electric Switch (Field Mounted) Kit
Includes: 4 Electric Switches (SPDT)
79149 1/4 in. "Compression-Seal" Pipe Adaptor Package Mounting Hardware
Includes: 24 "Compression-Seals" 428311 Alarm Initiating Switch Kit
79151 3/8 in. "Compression-Seal" Pipe Adaptor Package
Includes: 24 "Compression-Seals" 55598 Gas Shut-oft Equipment Mechanical (ANSUL)
Includes: Mechanical Gas Valve - 3/4 in.
79147 1/2 in. "Compression-Seal" Pipe Adaptor Package
Includes: 24 "Compression-Seals" 55601 Gas Shut-off Equipment Mechanical (ANSUL)
Includes: Mechanical Gas Valve - 1 in.
79153 1/2 in. "Compression-Seal" EMT Conduit Adaptor
Package 55604 Gas Shut-off Equipment Mechanical (ANSUL)
Includes: 24 "Compression-Seals' Includes: Mechanical Gas Valve - 1 1/4 in.
423253 Hood Seal Adaptor Shipping Assembly 55607 Gas Shut-oft Equipment Mechanical (ANSUL)
Includes: 6 Hood Seals Includes: Mechanical Gas Valve - 1 1/2 in.
436228 Reducing Coupling 55610 Gas Shut-off Equipment Mechanical (ANSUL)
Includes: Mechanical Gas Valve - 2 in.
1-441042 Short Handle Cocking Lever with Lock Pin
(Mechanical/Electrical AUTOMAN) 25937 Gas Shut-off Equipment Mechanical (ASCO)
Includes: Mechanical Gas Valve - 2 1/2 in.
'441041 Long Handle Cocking Lever with Lock Pin
(Mechanical/Electrical AUTOMAN) 25938 Gas Shut-off Equipment Mechanical (ASCO)
Includes: Mechanical Gas Valve - 3 in.
26310 Cocking Lever (AUTOMAN II-C) 15733 Gas Shut-off Equipment
416018 Cocking Lever (Mechanical Gas Valve) Includes: Air Cylinder and Tube Assembly
'438031 Lock Pin 434618 Remote Manual Pull Station Assembly
13707 Gas Shut-off Equipment (Electrical 110 VAC, 60 Hz) 435960 Remote Manual Pull Station Assembly
Includes: Solenoid Valve - 3/4 in. Includes: 50 ft (15.2 m) of Wire Rope
13708 Gas Shut-off Equipment (Electrical 110 VAC, 60 Hz) 24915 Break Rod Package
Includes: Solenoid Valve - 1 in. Includes: 10 Glass Break Rods (Part No. 4834)
550360 Gas Shut-off Equipment (Electrical 110 VAC, 60 Hz) (Replacement)
Includes: Solenoid Valve - 1 1/4 in. 427074 Trim Rings (Pack of 10)
13709 Gas Shut-off Equipment (Electrical 110 VAC, 60 Hz) 434525 Flexible Conduit - 500 It (152.4 m)
Includes: Solenoid Valve - 1 1/2 in. 435959 Flexible Conduit —500 ft (152.4 m)
13710 Gas Shut-off Equipment (Electrical 110 VAC, 60 Hz) Includes: 500 ft (152.4 m) of Wire Rope
Includes: Fluid Power Gas Valve - 2 in. 435979 Flexible Conduit Strain Relief
550363 Gas Shut-off Equipment (Electrical 110 VAC, 60 Hz) Includes: 50 Strain Reliefs
Includes: Fluid Power Gas Valve - 2 1/2 in. 434347 Flexible Conduit Inserts
17643 Gas Shut-oft Equipment (Electrical 110 VAC, 60 Hz) Includes: 50 Inserts
Includes: Fluid Power Gas Valve - 3 in.
SECTION 9— APPENDIX
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 9-8 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
SYSTEM COMPONENT INDEX (Continued)
Part No. Description
'439104 Pre-Fed Flexible Conduit —50 ft (15.2 m)
• 436150 P-Clip Shipping Assembly
Includes: 50 P-Clips
31809 16 in. (406 mm) Stainless Steel Actuation Hose
1 32335 20 in. (508 mm) Stainless Steel Actuation Hose
I 32336 24 in. (610 mm) Stainless Steel Actuation Hose
430815 42 in. (1067 mm) Stainless Steel Actuation Hose
435982 Agent Distribution Hose and Restraining Cable Kit
434455 Henny Penny Fryer Nozzle Kit
24916 Test Link Shipping Assembly
•
Includes: 10 Test Links . 439085 SL Style Fusible Link - 165 OF (74 °C)
Includes: 25 Links
439086 SL Style Fusible Link —212 OF (100 °C)
Includes: 25 Links
• 439087 SL Style Fusible Link - 280 OF (138 °C)
Includes: 25 Links
1 439088 OF °C) SL Style Fusible Link —360 (182
Includes: 25 Links
439089 SL Style Fusible Link - 450 OF (232 °C)
• Includes: 25 Links
439227 Tyco A-PC Style Fusible Link - 165 OF (74 °C)
Includes: 10 Links
439228 Tyco A-PC Style Fusible Link —212 OF (100 °C)
•
Includes: 10 Links . 439229 Tyco A-PC Style Fusible Link - 280 OF (138 °C)
Includes: 10 Links
439230 Tyco A-PC Style Fusible Link —360 OF (182 °C)
Includes: 10 Links
• 439231 Tyco A-PC Style Fusible Link - 450 OF (232 °C)
Includes: 10 Links
1 439232 OF °C Tyco A-PC Style Fusible Link - 500 (260
Includes: 25 Links
439517 Trip Hammer Set Screw . Includes: 25 Screws
15240 Maximum Registering Thermometer
197 Lead and Wire Seal
181 Cartridge Receiver Gasket
74274 Vent Plug Assembly
'418087 R-102 System Manual
R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
14 (ORDE
NT
21
18
000373
R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual SECTION 9— APPENDIX
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 9-9
AUTOMAN REGULATED RELEASE ASSEMBLY
Figure Mechanical Electrical
No. Description Part No. Part No.
- Regulated Release Shipping Assembly 429853 429856
1 Mounting Box 419293 419293
2 Basic Release w/Regulator 79140 -
Basic Release w/Solenoid, Switch, and Regulator - 79288
3 Self-Tapping Screw 71342 71342
4 Spacer 76555 76555
5 Tension Spring 79094 79094
6 Lever and Bracket Assembly 79300 79300
7 Machine Screw 14973 14973
8 Lockwasher 7310 7310
9 Hex Nut 14732 14732
10 Caution Label 57652 57652
11 Gasket 181 181
12 Expellant Gas Cartridge Assembly
LT-30-R/101-20 (Ordered Separately) 423435 / 423441 423435 / 423441
Double Tank/101-30 (Ordered Separately) 423493 / 423443 423443 / 423443
13 Safety Shipping Cap 77251 77251
14 Tank Assembly 1.5/3 Gal. (Ordered Separately) 429864/429862 429864 / 429862
15 Hose Assembly 79007 79007
16 Enclosure Cover (Includes Label) 423744 423744
17 Solenoid Assembly - 423575
18 Electric Snap-Action Switch - 423878
19 Cover Screw 15362 15362
20 Speed Nut 423479 423479
21 Set Screw (25 Pack) 439517 439517
SECTION 9— APPENDIX
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 9-10 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
REGULATED ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY
S
I
S
12
I
S
S
S
I
I
I
5 Figure
10
(ORDERED
SEPARATELY) Vll~ -~
L2
R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
6
8
11
00.0374 13, 14
• No. Description
5
- Regulated Actuator Assembly
1 Mounting Box
2 Pneumatic Actuator Assembly Including Regulator
5 3 Hex Jam Nut
4 Hole Adaptor (2)
5 Lockwasher
• 6 Gasket
7 Expellant Gas Cartridge Assembly
LT-20-R/101 -10 (Ordered Separately) . LT-30-R/101 -20 (Ordered Separately)
Double Tank/101-30 (Ordered Separately)
• LT-A-101-30/101-30 (Ordered Separately)
8 Safety Shipping Cap •9 Label
10 Tank Assembly 1.5/3 Gal. (Ordered Separately)
5 11 Hose Assembly
• 12 Enclosure Cover (Without Labels)
13 Cover Screw
• 14 Speed Nut
419293
79340
67990
423277
69521
181
423429 / 423439
423435 / 423441
423493 / 423443
423491 /423443
77251
426953
429864 / 429862
79007
419294
15362
423479
ENCLOSURE ASSEMBLY
Figure
No. Description
Enclosure Shipping Assembly
1 Enclosure
2 Cover
3 Nameplate
4 Screw
5 Speed Nut
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppress.0n Manual
2 ------
o~ S . J,@
SECTION 9—APPENDIX
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-Ol REV. 11 PAGE 9-11
. o .
S
000290
Part No.
429870
419295 I
419296
429871
15362 5 423479
S
S
S
S
70amTo'.
fl J
SECTION 9— APPENDIX R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 9-12 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
BRACKET ASSEMBLY
/
000376
Figure 3 Gallon
No. Description Part No.
- Bracket Shipping Assembly 429878
1 Bracket Assembly
2 Grommet 14089
3 Grommet 8688
4 Wing Nut 12065
TANK ASSEMBLY
8
000375
Figure 1.5 Gallon
No. Description Part No.
- Tank Assembly 429864
1 Tank Adaptor Shipping Assembly 430103
2 Pickup Tube Assembly 429883
3 Vent Plug Assembly 74247
4 0-Ring 56909
5 Union Nut 417705
6 Union Tail Piece 417706
7 Burst Disc 416974
8 Shell 429861
9 Nameplate N/A
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
I
SECTION 9— APPENDIX
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 9-13
3 .
S
S
I
3 Gallon
Part No.
429862
79522
417700
74247
I 56909
417705
417706
416974
429860
I N/A
I
I
S
S
S
S
S
14
12 -
0
11
4
3
7, 8
SECTION 9— APPENDIX R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 9-14 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
REMOTE RELEASE
5
Figure
No. Description Part No.
- Remote Release 433485
1 Mounting Box 419295
2 Cover 419296
3 Maintenance Label 17351
4 Spring 79094
5 Speed Nut 423479
6 Machine Screw 14973
7 Hex Nut 14732
8 Lockwasher 7310
9 101 Release 433702
10 Spacer 76555
11 Screw 71342
12 Cover Screw 15362
13 Tension Lever and Bracket Assembly 79300
14 Gasket 181
15 101 Cartridge (Order Separately) (Not Shown) (TC/DOT) 423439
(DOT) 15850
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual SECTION 9- APPENDIX
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 9-15
MULTIPLE NOZZLE FRYER PROTECTION CALCULATION
EXAMPLES
Example No. 1 - Donut Fryer Without Dripboard. This fryer
has a frypot that measures 26 in. depth x 28 in. length (660 mm
x 711 mm). Because the frypot exceeds the maximum dimen-
sions for one nozzle, multiple nozzles will be required.
Procedure:
Find the area of the fryer by multiplying the 26 in. depth
x the 28 in. length (660 mm x 711 mm) which equals
728 in.2 (46,967 mm2). Using the 3N nozzle (approved for
fryers with the longest side of 25 3/8 in. (644 mm) and a
maximum of 370.5 in.2 (23,903 mm2) in area), divide the total
area of 728 in.2 (46,967 mm2) by 370.5 in.2 (23,903 mm2) to
find the number of nozzles needed. 728 in.2 (46,967 mm2)
divided by 370.5 in.2 (23,903 mm2) per nozzle = 2 nozzles
required. Then, verify the maximum longest side dimension
of 25 3/8 in. (644 mm). Doing this will require doubling the
3N nozzles to = a total of 4 nozzles, if we are to protect the
26 in. (660 mm) depth and the 28 in. (711 mm) length of the
fryer with this 3N nozzle option. See Figure 9-1.
Using the same process, but utilizing the 3N nozzle approved
for fryer protection with the longest side of 27 5/8 in. (702
mm) and the maximum of 324 in.2 (20,903 mm2) in area,
the calculation will change to 728 in.2 (46,967 mm2) divided
by 324 in.2 (20,903 mm2) per nozzle = 3 nozzles. Because
this 3N nozzle option will protect 27 5/8 in. (701 mm) on
the longest side, it will protect the 26 in. (660 mm) side in
this example, thus eliminating the need for extra nozzles.
Utilizing this option, in this example, will require a total of 9
flows, but allows less nozzles and less nozzle drops*. See
Figure 9-1.
2-flow appliance nozzles can also be Lsed. This option
requires a total of 4 nozzles (728 j2 (46,967 mm2) divided by
210 in.2 (13,548 mm2) per nozzle = 4 nozzles, or 8 total flows).
Using this option requires that the nozzles be placed over each
quadrant of frypot area protected and aimed to the center of the
modules. This option may be desirable if minimizing total system
flows is important.
I 14 IN 4 193/8 IN. 193/8 IN. 191/4 IN. 4 •4 -4
(355 mm) (238 mm) (238 mm) (234 mm
13IN. I
(330 mm) I
261N. 261N.
(660mm) (660 mm)
• I I
_____ 281N.
I
281N. ______
'I (711 mm) (711 MM)
FIRST 3N NOZZLE OPTION SECOND 3N NOZZLE OPTION
FIGURE 9-1
002466
Example No. 2 - Fryer With Dripboard. This fryer has an
overall fry vat, including a dripboard, that measures 24 in.
(609 mm) in depth x 20 in. (508 mm) in length. The actual frypot
measures 20 in. x 20 in. (508 mm x 508 mm). Because both the
frypot and the overall fry vat including the dripboard exceed the
maximum dimensions for one nozzle, multiple nozzles will be
required.
Procedure:
Divide the fryer cooking area from left to right or from front
to back into modules that do not exceed single nozzle area
limitations and longest side limitations as described in the
table for "Fryer Multiple Nozzle Protection" located in the
Design Section.
The example fryer can either be divided from left to right
into two modules, each measuring 10 in. x 24 in. (254 mm x
609 mm), or it can be divided from front to back. See Figure
9-2.
If the fryer is divided from front to back, two 2-flow nozzles
may be adequate. To determine this, first protect as much
of the rear portion of the vat (the frypot area) that is allowed
with 2-flow appliance nozzles using the maximum area of
210 in.2 (13,548 mm2) per nozzle with the maximum longest
side of 21 in. (533 mm) for multiple nozzles. See Figure 9-2.
In the example, the frypot is 20 in. (508 mm) from side
to side. Use the maximum area of 210 in.2 (13,548 mm2)
allowed for one nozzle and divide it by 20 in. (508 mm), a
total of 10 1/2 in. (266 mm) of the frypot can be protected
with one 2-flow nozzle (210 in.2 divided by 20 in. = 10.5 in.).
See Figure 9-2.
This leaves the remainder of 9 1/2 in. (241 mm) of frypot
and the entire dripboard yet to protect. One 2-flow appli-
ance nozzle will protect up to 10 1/2 in. (266 mm) of frypot,
therefore, there is no need to verify the remaining 9 1/2 in.
(241 mm). There is only the overall of 9 1/2 in. (241 mm)
remaining plus the dripboard to verify.
The dripboard measures 4 in. x 20 in. (101 mm x 508 mm),
with an overall remainder of frypot + dripboard area size
of 13 1/2 in. x 20 in. (342 mm x 508 mm) = 270 in.2
(17,419 mm2). Reviewing the "Multiple Nozzle Fryer Table,"
a 2-flow appliance nozzle can protect an area, including
dripboard, of 294 in.2 (18,967 mm2) with a longest side of
21 in. (533 mm). Because the area is less than the maximum
of 294 in.2 (18,967 mm2) and the longest side is less than
the maximum of 21 in. (533 mm), a 2-flow nozzle will be
sufficient. See Figure 9-2.
SECTION 9— APPENDIX
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 9-16 REV. 11 2014-SEP-01
MULTIPLE NOZZLE FRYER PROTECTION CALCULATION
EXAMPLES (Continued)
Example No. 2 - Fryer With Dripboard (Continued)
Adding the protection required for the back of the frypot to
the front protection requires two 2-flow appliance nozzles
as a minimum. See Figure 9-2.
2 20 IN. 0 IN.
(508 mm) (508 mm)
-I-
101/2 IN.
_ (508 mm)
J (266 mm)
201N. 241N. -- 241N. I (609 mm) 91/2 IN. (609 mm)
• (241 mm) •
_j
10IN.
4 IN. 4 IN. (101 mm) I
(101 MM f254 mm)
DIVIDED LEFT TO RIGHT DIVIDED FRONT TO BACK
FIGURE 9-2
002467
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
WIRING DIAGRAM
NFPA standards require simultaneous operation for fire suppres-
sion systems when two or more hazards can be simultaneously
involved in fire by reason of their proximity. To accomplish
simultaneous operation, the 120 VAC Electric AUTOMAN
Regulated Release Assembly can be used. This release can be
activated independently by fusible line operation exactly like the
mechanical version and can also be triggered electrically using
a snap action switch from another 120 VAC Electric AUTOMAN
Regulated Release Assembly or a Mechanical AUTOMAN
Regulated Release Assembly. The electrical wiring used to
connect from one AUTOMAN Regulated Release Assembly
to another will not be supervised. However, NFPA 96 allows
an exception for electrically operated systems which "include
automatic mechanical detection (fusible link) and actuation as a
backup detection system."
In the case of multiple hoods sharing a common exhaust duct,
NFPA 17A requires one of two forms of simultaneous operation.
The following wiring diagrams (See Figures 3 and 4) identify two
principle uses for the 120 VAC Electric AUTOMAN Regulated
Release Assembly. Refer to Components Section, Page 3-1,
Figure 3-3.
Simultaneous operation of all independent hood, duct, and
appliance protection systems. See Figure 9-3.
Simultaneous operation of any hood, duct, and appliance
protection system and the system(s) protecting the entire
common exhaust duct. See Figure 9-4.
Simultaneous Actuation of Multiple 120 VAC Electric AUTOMAN Regulated Release Assemblies
115 VAC
60 HZ
ALL SYSTEMS MUST BE CONNECTED TO THE SAME POWER SOURCE HOT
IAL
AUTOMAN 11 AUTOMAN 2 TYPICAL FOR ADDITIONAL AUTOMAN
REGULATED RELEASE ASSEMBLIES -UPT04 FIGURE 9-3
R- 102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual SECTION 9— APPENDIX
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
2014-SEP-01 REV. 11 PAGE 9-17
WIRING DIAGRAM (Continued).
Simultaneous Actuation of One or More 120 VAC Electric AUTOMAN Assemblies
from Multiple Mechanical AUTOMAN Assemblies
ALL SYSTEMS MUST BE CONNECTED TO THE SAME POWER SOURCE
MECHANIC
AUTOMAN
TYP. 5
SWITCH,
PART NO.
423678
120 VAC
60 HZ
HOT
FIGURE 4
Note 1: For fusible link detection only.
Note 2: Use AUTOMAN assemblies with solenoid and electric switch. Replace Single Electric Switch (Part No. 423878) with Dual Switch Kit (Part
No. 423879).
Note 3: See Installation section of this manual for power capacity of solenoid and switches.
Note 4: This method does not provide supervision for battery or system wiring. The authority having jurisdiction (Al-U) may waive this requirement.
Note 5: When any one of the Mechanical AUTOMAN assembles is activated, the microswitch will transfer to the N.O. position, completing the circuit
to the N.C. switch in the Electrical AUTOMAN assemby. This will activate the AUTOMAN assemby. When the AUTOMAN assemby fires, the
N.C. switch transfers to the NO. position, opening the circuit to the solenoid.
SECTION 9 - APPENDIX R-102 Restaurant Fire Suppression Manual
UL EX3470 ULC EX3470
PAGE 9-18 REV. ii 2014-SEP-01
NOTES